gdb
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24 @syncodeindex tp cp
25
26 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
27 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
28 @syncodeindex vr cp
29 @syncodeindex fn cp
30
31 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
32 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
33 @set EDITION Ninth
34
35 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
36 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
37
38 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
39
40 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
41 @c manuals to an info tree.
42 @dircategory Software development
43 @direntry
44 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
45 @end direntry
46
47 @copying
48 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996,
49 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
50 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
51
52 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
53 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
54 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
55 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
56 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
57 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
58
59 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
60 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
61 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
62 @end copying
63
64 @ifnottex
65 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
66
67 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
68 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
69 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
70 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
71 @end ifset
72 Version @value{GDBVN}.
73
74 @insertcopying
75 @end ifnottex
76
77 @titlepage
78 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
79 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
80 @sp 1
81 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
82 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
83 @sp 1
84 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
85 @end ifset
86 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
87 @page
88 @tex
89 {\parskip=0pt
90 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
91 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
92 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
93 }
94 @end tex
95
96 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
97 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
98 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
99 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
100 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
101
102 @insertcopying
103 @page
104 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
105 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
106 software in general. We will miss him.
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2010 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163
164 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
165
166 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
167 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
168 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
169 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
170 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
171 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
172 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
173 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
174 @value{GDBN}
175 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
176 the operating system
177 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
178 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
179 how you can copy and share GDB
180 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
181 * Index:: Index
182 @end menu
183
184 @end ifnottex
185
186 @contents
187
188 @node Summary
189 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
190
191 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
192 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
193 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
194
195 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
196 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
197
198 @itemize @bullet
199 @item
200 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
201
202 @item
203 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
204
205 @item
206 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
207
208 @item
209 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
210 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
211 @end itemize
212
213 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
214 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
215 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
216
217 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
218 @ref{D,,D}.
219
220 @cindex Modula-2
221 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
222 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
223
224 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
225 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
226
227 @cindex Pascal
228 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
229 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
230 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
231 syntax.
232
233 @cindex Fortran
234 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
235 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
236 underscore.
237
238 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
239 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
240
241 @menu
242 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
243 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
244 @end menu
245
246 @node Free Software
247 @unnumberedsec Free Software
248
249 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
250 General Public License
251 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
252 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
253 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
254 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
255 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
256 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
257
258 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
259 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
260 from anyone else.
261
262 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
263
264 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
265 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
266 include with the free software. Many of our most important
267 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
268 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
269 when an important free software package does not come with a free
270 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
271 gaps today.
272
273 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
274 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
275 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
276 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
277 them from the free software world.
278
279 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
280 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
281 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
282 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
283 contract to make it non-free.
284
285 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
286 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
287 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
288 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
289 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
290 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
291 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
292
293 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
294 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
295 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
296 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
297
298 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
299 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
300 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
301 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
302 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
303 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
304 community.
305
306 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
307 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
308 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
309 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
310 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
311 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
312 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
313 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
314 of the manual.
315
316 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
317 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
318 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
319 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
320 manual to replace it.
321
322 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
323 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
324 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
325 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
326 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
327 the free software community.
328
329 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
330 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
331 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
332 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
333 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
334 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
335 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
336 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
337 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
338
339 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
340 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
341 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
342 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
343 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
344 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
345 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
346 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
347
348 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
349 published by other publishers, at
350 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
351
352 @node Contributors
353 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
354
355 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
356 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
357 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
358 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
359 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
360 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
361 blow-by-blow account.
362
363 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
364
365 @quotation
366 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
367 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
368 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
369 @end quotation
370
371 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
372 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
373 releases:
374 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
375 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
376 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
377 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
378 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
379 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
380 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
381 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
382 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
383
384 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
385 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
386
387 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
388 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
389 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
390 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
391 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
392
393 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
394 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
395 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
396
397 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
398 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
399
400 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
401
402 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
403 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
404 support.
405 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
406 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
407 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
408 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
409 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
410 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
411 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
412 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
413 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
414 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
415 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
416 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
417 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
418 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
419 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
420 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
421
422 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
423
424 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
425 libraries.
426
427 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
428 about several machine instruction sets.
429
430 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
431 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
432 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
433 and RDI targets, respectively.
434
435 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
436 command-line editing and command history.
437
438 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
439 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
440
441 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
442 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
443 symbols.
444
445 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
446 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
447
448 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
449
450 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
451 processors.
452
453 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
454
455 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
456
457 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
458
459 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
460 watchpoints.
461
462 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
463
464 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
465
466 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
467 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
468
469 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
470 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
471 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
472 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
473 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
474 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
475 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
476
477 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
478 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
479
480 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
481 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
482 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
483 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
484 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
485 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
486 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
487 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
488 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
489 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
490 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
491 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
492 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
493 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
494 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
495
496 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
497 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
498
499 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
500 Hat.
501
502 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
503 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
504 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
505 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
506 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
507 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
508
509 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
510 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
511 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
512 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
513 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
514 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
515 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
516 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
517 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
518 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
520 Weigand.
521
522 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
523 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
524 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
525 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
526
527 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
528 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
529
530 @node Sample Session
531 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
532
533 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
534 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
535 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
536
537 @iftex
538 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
539 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
540 @end iftex
541
542 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
543 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
544
545 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
546 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
547 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
548 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
549 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
550 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
551 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
552 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
553 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
554
555 @smallexample
556 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
557 $ @b{./m4}
558 @b{define(foo,0000)}
559
560 @b{foo}
561 0000
562 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
563
564 @b{bar}
565 0000
566 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
567
568 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
569 @b{baz}
570 @b{Ctrl-d}
571 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
572 @end smallexample
573
574 @noindent
575 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
576
577 @smallexample
578 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
579 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
580 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
581 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
582 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
583 the conditions.
584 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
585 for details.
586
587 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
588 (@value{GDBP})
589 @end smallexample
590
591 @noindent
592 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
593 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
594 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
595 that examples fit in this manual.
596
597 @smallexample
598 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
599 @end smallexample
600
601 @noindent
602 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
603 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
604 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
605 @code{break} command.
606
607 @smallexample
608 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
609 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
610 @end smallexample
611
612 @noindent
613 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
614 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
615 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
616
617 @smallexample
618 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
619 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
620 @b{define(foo,0000)}
621
622 @b{foo}
623 0000
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
628 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
629 context where it stops.
630
631 @smallexample
632 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
633
634 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
635 at builtin.c:879
636 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
637 @end smallexample
638
639 @noindent
640 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
641 the next line of the current function.
642
643 @smallexample
644 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
645 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
646 : nil,
647 @end smallexample
648
649 @noindent
650 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
651 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
652 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
653 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
654
655 @smallexample
656 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
657 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
658 at input.c:530
659 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
660 @end smallexample
661
662 @noindent
663 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
664 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
665 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
666 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
667 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
668 stack frame for each active subroutine.
669
670 @smallexample
671 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
672 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
673 at input.c:530
674 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
675 at builtin.c:882
676 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
677 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
678 at macro.c:71
679 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
680 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
681 @end smallexample
682
683 @noindent
684 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
685 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
686 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
687
688 @smallexample
689 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
690 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
691 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
692 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
693 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
694 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
695 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
696 : xstrdup(rq);
697 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
698 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
699 @end smallexample
700
701 @noindent
702 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
703 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
704 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
705 (@code{print}) to see their values.
706
707 @smallexample
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
709 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
710 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
711 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
712 @end smallexample
713
714 @noindent
715 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
716 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
717 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
718
719 @smallexample
720 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
721 533 xfree(rquote);
722 534
723 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
724 : xstrdup (lq);
725 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
726 : xstrdup (rq);
727 537
728 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
729 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
730 540 @}
731 541
732 542 void
733 @end smallexample
734
735 @noindent
736 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
737 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
738
739 @smallexample
740 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
741 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
742 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
743 540 @}
744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
745 $3 = 9
746 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
747 $4 = 7
748 @end smallexample
749
750 @noindent
751 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
752 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
753 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
754 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
755 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
756 assignments.
757
758 @smallexample
759 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
760 $5 = 7
761 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
762 $6 = 9
763 @end smallexample
764
765 @noindent
766 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
767 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
768 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
769 example that caused trouble initially:
770
771 @smallexample
772 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
773 Continuing.
774
775 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
776
777 baz
778 0000
779 @end smallexample
780
781 @noindent
782 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
783 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
784 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
785
786 @smallexample
787 @b{Ctrl-d}
788 Program exited normally.
789 @end smallexample
790
791 @noindent
792 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
793 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
794 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
795
796 @smallexample
797 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
798 @end smallexample
799
800 @node Invocation
801 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
802
803 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
804 The essentials are:
805 @itemize @bullet
806 @item
807 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
808 @item
809 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
810 @end itemize
811
812 @menu
813 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
814 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
815 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
816 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
817 @end menu
818
819 @node Invoking GDB
820 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
821
822 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
823 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
824
825 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
826 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
827
828 The command-line options described here are designed
829 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
830 options may effectively be unavailable.
831
832 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
833 specifying an executable program:
834
835 @smallexample
836 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
837 @end smallexample
838
839 @noindent
840 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
841 specified:
842
843 @smallexample
844 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
845 @end smallexample
846
847 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
848 to debug a running process:
849
850 @smallexample
851 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
852 @end smallexample
853
854 @noindent
855 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
856 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
857
858 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
859 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
860 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
861 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
862 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
863
864 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
865 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
866 option processing.
867 @smallexample
868 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
869 @end smallexample
870 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
871 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
872
873 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
874 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
875
876 @smallexample
877 @value{GDBP} -silent
878 @end smallexample
879
880 @noindent
881 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
882 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
883
884 @noindent
885 Type
886
887 @smallexample
888 @value{GDBP} -help
889 @end smallexample
890
891 @noindent
892 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
893 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
894
895 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
896 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
897 @samp{-x} option is used.
898
899
900 @menu
901 * File Options:: Choosing files
902 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
903 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
904 @end menu
905
906 @node File Options
907 @subsection Choosing Files
908
909 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
910 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
911 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
912 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
913 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
914 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
915 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
916 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
917 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
918 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
919 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
920 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
921 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
922
923 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
924 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
925 argument and ignore it.
926
927 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
928 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
929 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
930 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
931 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
932
933 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
934 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
935 @c it.
936
937 @table @code
938 @item -symbols @var{file}
939 @itemx -s @var{file}
940 @cindex @code{--symbols}
941 @cindex @code{-s}
942 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
943
944 @item -exec @var{file}
945 @itemx -e @var{file}
946 @cindex @code{--exec}
947 @cindex @code{-e}
948 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
949 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
950
951 @item -se @var{file}
952 @cindex @code{--se}
953 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
954 file.
955
956 @item -core @var{file}
957 @itemx -c @var{file}
958 @cindex @code{--core}
959 @cindex @code{-c}
960 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
961
962 @item -pid @var{number}
963 @itemx -p @var{number}
964 @cindex @code{--pid}
965 @cindex @code{-p}
966 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
967
968 @item -command @var{file}
969 @itemx -x @var{file}
970 @cindex @code{--command}
971 @cindex @code{-x}
972 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
973 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
974 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
975
976 @item -eval-command @var{command}
977 @itemx -ex @var{command}
978 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
979 @cindex @code{-ex}
980 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
981
982 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
983 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
984
985 @smallexample
986 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
987 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
988 @end smallexample
989
990 @item -directory @var{directory}
991 @itemx -d @var{directory}
992 @cindex @code{--directory}
993 @cindex @code{-d}
994 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
995
996 @item -r
997 @itemx -readnow
998 @cindex @code{--readnow}
999 @cindex @code{-r}
1000 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1001 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1002 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1003
1004 @end table
1005
1006 @node Mode Options
1007 @subsection Choosing Modes
1008
1009 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1010 batch mode or quiet mode.
1011
1012 @table @code
1013 @item -nx
1014 @itemx -n
1015 @cindex @code{--nx}
1016 @cindex @code{-n}
1017 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1018 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1019 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1020 Files}.
1021
1022 @item -quiet
1023 @itemx -silent
1024 @itemx -q
1025 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1026 @cindex @code{--silent}
1027 @cindex @code{-q}
1028 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1029 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1030
1031 @item -batch
1032 @cindex @code{--batch}
1033 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1034 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1035 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1036 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1037 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1038 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1039 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1040
1041 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1042 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1043 make this more useful, the message
1044
1045 @smallexample
1046 Program exited normally.
1047 @end smallexample
1048
1049 @noindent
1050 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1051 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1052 mode.
1053
1054 @item -batch-silent
1055 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1056 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1057 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1058 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1059 for an interactive session.
1060
1061 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1062 messages, for example.
1063
1064 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1065 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1066
1067 @item -return-child-result
1068 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1069 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1070 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1071
1072 @itemize @bullet
1073 @item
1074 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1075 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1076 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1077 @item
1078 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1079 @item
1080 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1081 the exit code will be -1.
1082 @end itemize
1083
1084 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1085 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1086 interface.
1087
1088 @item -nowindows
1089 @itemx -nw
1090 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1091 @cindex @code{-nw}
1092 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1093 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1094 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1095
1096 @item -windows
1097 @itemx -w
1098 @cindex @code{--windows}
1099 @cindex @code{-w}
1100 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1101 used if possible.
1102
1103 @item -cd @var{directory}
1104 @cindex @code{--cd}
1105 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1106 instead of the current directory.
1107
1108 @item -fullname
1109 @itemx -f
1110 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1111 @cindex @code{-f}
1112 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1113 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1114 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1115 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1116 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1117 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1118 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1119 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1120 frame.
1121
1122 @item -epoch
1123 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1124 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1125 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1126 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1127 separate window.
1128
1129 @item -annotate @var{level}
1130 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1131 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1132 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1133 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1134 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1135 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1136 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1137 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1138 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1139
1140 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1141 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1142
1143 @item --args
1144 @cindex @code{--args}
1145 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1146 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1147 This option stops option processing.
1148
1149 @item -baud @var{bps}
1150 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1151 @cindex @code{--baud}
1152 @cindex @code{-b}
1153 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1154 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1155
1156 @item -l @var{timeout}
1157 @cindex @code{-l}
1158 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1159 for remote debugging.
1160
1161 @item -tty @var{device}
1162 @itemx -t @var{device}
1163 @cindex @code{--tty}
1164 @cindex @code{-t}
1165 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1166 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1167
1168 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1169 @item -tui
1170 @cindex @code{--tui}
1171 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1172 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1173 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1174 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1175 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1176 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1177 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1178
1179 @c @item -xdb
1180 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1181 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1182 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1183 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1184 @c systems.
1185
1186 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1187 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1188 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1189 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1190 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1191 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1192
1193 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1194 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1195 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1196 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1197 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1198 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1199
1200 @item -write
1201 @cindex @code{--write}
1202 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1203 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1204 (@pxref{Patching}).
1205
1206 @item -statistics
1207 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1208 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1209 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1210
1211 @item -version
1212 @cindex @code{--version}
1213 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1214 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1215
1216 @end table
1217
1218 @node Startup
1219 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1220 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1221
1222 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1223
1224 @enumerate
1225 @item
1226 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1227 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1228
1229 @item
1230 @cindex init file
1231 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1232 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1233 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1234 that file.
1235
1236 @item
1237 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1238 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1239 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1240 that file.
1241
1242 @item
1243 Processes command line options and operands.
1244
1245 @item
1246 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1247 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1248 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1249 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1250 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1251 @value{GDBN}.
1252
1253 @item
1254 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1255 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1256
1257 @item
1258 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1259 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1260 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1261 @end enumerate
1262
1263 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1264 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1265 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1266 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1267 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1268 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1269
1270 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1271 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1272
1273 @cindex init file name
1274 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1275 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1276 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1277 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1278 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1279 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1280 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1281 the file to the standard name.
1282
1283
1284 @node Quitting GDB
1285 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1286 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1287 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1288
1289 @table @code
1290 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1291 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1292 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1293 @itemx q
1294 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1295 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1296 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1297 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1298 error code.
1299 @end table
1300
1301 @cindex interrupt
1302 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1303 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1304 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1305 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1306 until a time when it is safe.
1307
1308 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1309 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1310 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1311
1312 @node Shell Commands
1313 @section Shell Commands
1314
1315 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1316 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1317 just use the @code{shell} command.
1318
1319 @table @code
1320 @kindex shell
1321 @cindex shell escape
1322 @item shell @var{command string}
1323 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1324 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1325 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1326 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1327 @end table
1328
1329 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1330 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1331 @value{GDBN}:
1332
1333 @table @code
1334 @kindex make
1335 @cindex calling make
1336 @item make @var{make-args}
1337 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1338 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1339 @end table
1340
1341 @node Logging Output
1342 @section Logging Output
1343 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1344 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1345
1346 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1347 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1348
1349 @table @code
1350 @kindex set logging
1351 @item set logging on
1352 Enable logging.
1353 @item set logging off
1354 Disable logging.
1355 @cindex logging file name
1356 @item set logging file @var{file}
1357 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1358 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1359 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1360 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1361 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1362 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1363 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1364 @kindex show logging
1365 @item show logging
1366 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1367 @end table
1368
1369 @node Commands
1370 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1371
1372 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1373 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1374 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1375 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1376 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1377
1378 @menu
1379 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1380 * Completion:: Command completion
1381 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1382 @end menu
1383
1384 @node Command Syntax
1385 @section Command Syntax
1386
1387 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1388 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1389 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1390 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1391 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1392 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1393
1394 @cindex abbreviation
1395 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1396 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1397 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1398 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1399 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1400 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1401 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1402
1403 @cindex repeating commands
1404 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1405 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1406 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1407 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1408 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1409 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1410 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1411
1412 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1413 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1414 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1415
1416 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1417 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1418 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1419 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1420 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1421
1422 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1423 @cindex comment
1424 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1425 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1426 Files,,Command Files}).
1427
1428 @cindex repeating command sequences
1429 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1430 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1431 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1432 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1433 for editing.
1434
1435 @node Completion
1436 @section Command Completion
1437
1438 @cindex completion
1439 @cindex word completion
1440 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1441 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1442 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1443 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1444
1445 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1446 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1447 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1448 enter it). For example, if you type
1449
1450 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1451 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1452 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1453 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1454 @smallexample
1455 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1456 @end smallexample
1457
1458 @noindent
1459 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1460 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1461
1462 @smallexample
1463 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1464 @end smallexample
1465
1466 @noindent
1467 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1468 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1469 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1470 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1471 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1472 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1473
1474 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1475 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1476 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1477 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1478 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1479 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1480 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1481 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1482 example:
1483
1484 @smallexample
1485 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1486 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1487 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1488 make_abs_section make_function_type
1489 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1490 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1491 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1492 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1493 @end smallexample
1494
1495 @noindent
1496 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1497 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1498 command.
1499
1500 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1501 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1502 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1503 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1504 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1505
1506 @cindex quotes in commands
1507 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1508 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1509 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1510 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1511 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1512 @value{GDBN} commands.
1513
1514 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1515 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1516 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1517 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1518 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1519 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1520 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1521 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1522 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1523 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1524 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1525
1526 @smallexample
1527 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1528 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1529 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1530 @end smallexample
1531
1532 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1533 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1534 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1535 place:
1536
1537 @smallexample
1538 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1539 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1540 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1541 @end smallexample
1542
1543 @noindent
1544 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1545 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1546 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1547
1548 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1549 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1550 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1551 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1552
1553 @cindex completion of structure field names
1554 @cindex structure field name completion
1555 @cindex completion of union field names
1556 @cindex union field name completion
1557 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1558 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1559 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1560 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1561 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1562 left-hand-side:
1563
1564 @smallexample
1565 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1566 magic to_delete to_fputs to_put to_rewind
1567 to_data to_flush to_isatty to_read to_write
1568 @end smallexample
1569
1570 @noindent
1571 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1572 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1573 follows:
1574
1575 @smallexample
1576 struct ui_file
1577 @{
1578 int *magic;
1579 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1580 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1581 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1582 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1583 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1584 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1585 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1586 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1587 void *to_data;
1588 @}
1589 @end smallexample
1590
1591
1592 @node Help
1593 @section Getting Help
1594 @cindex online documentation
1595 @kindex help
1596
1597 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1598 using the command @code{help}.
1599
1600 @table @code
1601 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1602 @item help
1603 @itemx h
1604 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1605 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1606
1607 @smallexample
1608 (@value{GDBP}) help
1609 List of classes of commands:
1610
1611 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1612 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1613 data -- Examining data
1614 files -- Specifying and examining files
1615 internals -- Maintenance commands
1616 obscure -- Obscure features
1617 running -- Running the program
1618 stack -- Examining the stack
1619 status -- Status inquiries
1620 support -- Support facilities
1621 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1622 stopping the program
1623 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1624
1625 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1626 commands in that class.
1627 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1628 documentation.
1629 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1630 (@value{GDBP})
1631 @end smallexample
1632 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1633
1634 @item help @var{class}
1635 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1636 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1637 help display for the class @code{status}:
1638
1639 @smallexample
1640 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1641 Status inquiries.
1642
1643 List of commands:
1644
1645 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1646 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1647 info -- Generic command for showing things
1648 about the program being debugged
1649 show -- Generic command for showing things
1650 about the debugger
1651
1652 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1653 documentation.
1654 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1655 (@value{GDBP})
1656 @end smallexample
1657
1658 @item help @var{command}
1659 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1660 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1661
1662 @kindex apropos
1663 @item apropos @var{args}
1664 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1665 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1666 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1667
1668 @smallexample
1669 apropos reload
1670 @end smallexample
1671
1672 @noindent
1673 results in:
1674
1675 @smallexample
1676 @c @group
1677 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1678 multiple times in one run
1679 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1680 multiple times in one run
1681 @c @end group
1682 @end smallexample
1683
1684 @kindex complete
1685 @item complete @var{args}
1686 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1687 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1688 command you want completed. For example:
1689
1690 @smallexample
1691 complete i
1692 @end smallexample
1693
1694 @noindent results in:
1695
1696 @smallexample
1697 @group
1698 if
1699 ignore
1700 info
1701 inspect
1702 @end group
1703 @end smallexample
1704
1705 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1706 @end table
1707
1708 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1709 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1710 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1711 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1712 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1713 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1714
1715 @c @group
1716 @table @code
1717 @kindex info
1718 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1719 @item info
1720 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1721 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1722 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1723 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1724 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1725 @w{@code{help info}}.
1726
1727 @kindex set
1728 @item set
1729 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1730 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1731 @code{set prompt $}.
1732
1733 @kindex show
1734 @item show
1735 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1736 @value{GDBN} itself.
1737 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1738 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1739 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1740 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1741
1742 @kindex info set
1743 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1744 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1745 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1746 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1747 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1748 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1749 @end table
1750 @c @end group
1751
1752 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1753 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1754
1755 @table @code
1756 @kindex show version
1757 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1758 @item show version
1759 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1760 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1761 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1762 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1763 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1764 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1765 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1766 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1767 @value{GDBN}.
1768
1769 @kindex show copying
1770 @kindex info copying
1771 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1772 @item show copying
1773 @itemx info copying
1774 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1775
1776 @kindex show warranty
1777 @kindex info warranty
1778 @item show warranty
1779 @itemx info warranty
1780 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1781 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1782
1783 @end table
1784
1785 @node Running
1786 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1787
1788 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1789 debugging information when you compile it.
1790
1791 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1792 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1793 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1794 kill a child process.
1795
1796 @menu
1797 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1798 * Starting:: Starting your program
1799 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1800 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1801
1802 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1803 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1804 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1805 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1806
1807 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1808 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1809 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1810 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1811 @end menu
1812
1813 @node Compilation
1814 @section Compiling for Debugging
1815
1816 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1817 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1818 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1819 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1820 and addresses in the executable code.
1821
1822 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1823 the compiler.
1824
1825 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1826 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1827 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1828 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1829 executables containing debugging information.
1830
1831 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1832 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1833 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1834 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1835 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1836
1837 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1838 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1839 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1840
1841 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1842 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1843 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1844 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1845 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1846 provides macro information if you specify the options
1847 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1848 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1849 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1850 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1851 @option{-g} alone.
1852
1853 @need 2000
1854 @node Starting
1855 @section Starting your Program
1856 @cindex starting
1857 @cindex running
1858
1859 @table @code
1860 @kindex run
1861 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1862 @item run
1863 @itemx r
1864 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1865 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1866 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1867 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1868 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1869
1870 @end table
1871
1872 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1873 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1874 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1875 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1876 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1877 message like this one:
1878
1879 @smallexample
1880 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1881 Try "help target" or "continue".
1882 @end smallexample
1883
1884 @noindent
1885 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1886 first (@pxref{load}).
1887
1888 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1889 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1890 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1891 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1892 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1893 divided into four categories:
1894
1895 @table @asis
1896 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1897 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1898 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1899 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1900 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1901 the arguments.
1902 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1903 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1904 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1905
1906 @item The @emph{environment.}
1907 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1908 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1909 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1910 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1911
1912 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1913 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1914 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1915 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1916
1917 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1918 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1919 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1920 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1921 set a different device for your program.
1922 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1923
1924 @cindex pipes
1925 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1926 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1927 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1928 wrong program.
1929 @end table
1930
1931 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1932 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1933 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1934 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1935 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1936
1937 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1938 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1939 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1940 your current breakpoints.
1941
1942 @table @code
1943 @kindex start
1944 @item start
1945 @cindex run to main procedure
1946 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1947 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1948 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1949 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1950 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1951 procedure, depending on the language used.
1952
1953 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1954 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1955 the @samp{run} command.
1956
1957 @cindex elaboration phase
1958 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1959 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1960 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1961 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1962 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1963 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1964 will remain to halt execution.
1965
1966 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1967 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1968 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1969 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1970 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1971
1972 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1973 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1974 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1975 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1976 elaboration code before running your program.
1977
1978 @kindex set exec-wrapper
1979 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
1980 @itemx show exec-wrapper
1981 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
1982 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
1983 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
1984 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
1985 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
1986 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
1987 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
1988 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
1989
1990 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
1991 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
1992 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
1993 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
1994
1995 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
1996 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
1997 environment:
1998
1999 @smallexample
2000 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2001 (@value{GDBP}) run
2002 @end smallexample
2003
2004 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2005 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2006
2007 @kindex set disable-randomization
2008 @item set disable-randomization
2009 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2010 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2011 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2012 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2013 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2014
2015 This feature is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux. You can get the same
2016 behavior using
2017
2018 @smallexample
2019 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2020 @end smallexample
2021
2022 @item set disable-randomization off
2023 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2024 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2025 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2026 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2027 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2028 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2029
2030 The virtual address space randomization is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2031 It protects the programs against some kinds of security attacks. In these
2032 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2033 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2034 a code at its expected addresses.
2035
2036 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2037 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2038 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2039 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2040 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2041 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2042 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2043 a randomly chosen address.
2044
2045 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2046 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2047 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2048 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2049 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2050
2051 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2052 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2053
2054 @item show disable-randomization
2055 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2056 the virtual address space of the started program.
2057
2058 @end table
2059
2060 @node Arguments
2061 @section Your Program's Arguments
2062
2063 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2064 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2065 @code{run} command.
2066 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2067 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2068 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2069 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2070 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2071
2072 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2073 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2074 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2075 the program, not by the shell.
2076
2077 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2078 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2079
2080 @table @code
2081 @kindex set args
2082 @item set args
2083 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2084 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2085 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2086 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2087 it again without arguments.
2088
2089 @kindex show args
2090 @item show args
2091 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2092 @end table
2093
2094 @node Environment
2095 @section Your Program's Environment
2096
2097 @cindex environment (of your program)
2098 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2099 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2100 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2101 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2102 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2103 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2104 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2105
2106 @table @code
2107 @kindex path
2108 @item path @var{directory}
2109 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2110 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2111 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2112 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2113 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2114 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2115 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2116
2117 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2118 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2119 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2120 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2121 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2122 @var{directory} to the search path.
2123 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2124 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2125
2126 @kindex show paths
2127 @item show paths
2128 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2129 environment variable).
2130
2131 @kindex show environment
2132 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2133 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2134 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2135 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2136 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2137
2138 @kindex set environment
2139 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2140 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2141 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2142 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2143 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2144 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2145 null value.
2146 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2147 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2148
2149 For example, this command:
2150
2151 @smallexample
2152 set env USER = foo
2153 @end smallexample
2154
2155 @noindent
2156 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2157 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2158 are not actually required.)
2159
2160 @kindex unset environment
2161 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2162 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2163 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2164 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2165 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2166 @end table
2167
2168 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2169 the shell indicated
2170 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2171 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2172 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2173 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2174 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2175 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2176 @file{.profile}.
2177
2178 @node Working Directory
2179 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2180
2181 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2182 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2183 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2184 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2185 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2186 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2187
2188 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2189 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2190 Specify Files}.
2191
2192 @table @code
2193 @kindex cd
2194 @cindex change working directory
2195 @item cd @var{directory}
2196 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2197
2198 @kindex pwd
2199 @item pwd
2200 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2201 @end table
2202
2203 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2204 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2205 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2206 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2207 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2208 current working directory of the debuggee.
2209
2210 @node Input/Output
2211 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2212
2213 @cindex redirection
2214 @cindex i/o
2215 @cindex terminal
2216 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2217 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2218 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2219 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2220 running your program.
2221
2222 @table @code
2223 @kindex info terminal
2224 @item info terminal
2225 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2226 program is using.
2227 @end table
2228
2229 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2230 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2231
2232 @smallexample
2233 run > outfile
2234 @end smallexample
2235
2236 @noindent
2237 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2238
2239 @kindex tty
2240 @cindex controlling terminal
2241 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2242 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2243 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2244 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2245 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2246
2247 @smallexample
2248 tty /dev/ttyb
2249 @end smallexample
2250
2251 @noindent
2252 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2253 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2254 that as their controlling terminal.
2255
2256 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2257 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2258 terminal.
2259
2260 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2261 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2262 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2263 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2264
2265 @cindex inferior tty
2266 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2267 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2268 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2269 program.
2270
2271 @table @code
2272 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2273 @kindex set inferior-tty
2274 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2275
2276 @item show inferior-tty
2277 @kindex show inferior-tty
2278 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2279 @end table
2280
2281 @node Attach
2282 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2283 @kindex attach
2284 @cindex attach
2285
2286 @table @code
2287 @item attach @var{process-id}
2288 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2289 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2290 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2291 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2292 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2293
2294 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2295 executing the command.
2296 @end table
2297
2298 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2299 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2300 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2301 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2302
2303 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2304 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2305 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2306 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2307 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2308 Specify Files}.
2309
2310 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2311 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2312 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2313 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2314 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2315 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2316 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2317
2318 @table @code
2319 @kindex detach
2320 @item detach
2321 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2322 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2323 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2324 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2325 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2326 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2327 executing the command.
2328 @end table
2329
2330 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2331 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2332 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2333 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2334 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2335 Messages}).
2336
2337 @node Kill Process
2338 @section Killing the Child Process
2339
2340 @table @code
2341 @kindex kill
2342 @item kill
2343 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2344 @end table
2345
2346 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2347 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2348 is running.
2349
2350 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2351 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2352 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2353 outside the debugger.
2354
2355 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2356 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2357 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2358 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2359 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2360 breakpoint settings).
2361
2362 @node Inferiors and Programs
2363 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2364
2365 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2366 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2367 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2368 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2369 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2370 from multiple executables.
2371
2372 @cindex inferior
2373 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2374 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2375 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2376 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2377 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2378 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2379 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2380 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2381 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2382 threads running in it.
2383
2384 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2385 inferiors}}:
2386
2387 @table @code
2388 @kindex info inferiors
2389 @item info inferiors
2390 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2391
2392 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2393
2394 @enumerate
2395 @item
2396 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2397
2398 @item
2399 the target system's inferior identifier
2400
2401 @item
2402 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2403
2404 @end enumerate
2405
2406 @noindent
2407 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2408 indicates the current inferior.
2409
2410 For example,
2411 @end table
2412 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2413
2414 @smallexample
2415 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2416 Num Description Executable
2417 2 process 2307 hello
2418 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2419 @end smallexample
2420
2421 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2422
2423 @table @code
2424 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2425 @item inferior @var{infno}
2426 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2427 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2428 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2429 @end table
2430
2431
2432 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2433 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2434 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2435 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2436 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2437 @w{@code{remove-inferior}} command.
2438
2439 @table @code
2440 @kindex add-inferior
2441 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2442 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2443 executable. @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2444 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2445 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2446 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2447
2448 @kindex clone-inferior
2449 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2450 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2451 @var{infno}. @var{n} defaults to 1. @var{infno} defaults to the
2452 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2453 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2454
2455 @smallexample
2456 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2457 Num Description Executable
2458 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2459 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2460 Added inferior 2.
2461 1 inferiors added.
2462 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2463 Num Description Executable
2464 2 <null> helloworld
2465 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2466 @end smallexample
2467
2468 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2469
2470 @kindex remove-inferior
2471 @item remove-inferior @var{infno}
2472 Removes the inferior @var{infno}. It is not possible to remove an
2473 inferior that is running with this command. For those, use the
2474 @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2475
2476 @end table
2477
2478 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2479 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2480 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2481 using the @w{@code{kill inferior}} command:
2482
2483 @table @code
2484 @kindex detach inferior @var{infno}
2485 @item detach inferior @var{infno}
2486 Detach from the inferior identified by @value{GDBN} inferior number
2487 @var{infno}. Note that the inferior's entry still stays on the list
2488 of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its Description will
2489 show @samp{<null>}.
2490
2491 @kindex kill inferior @var{infno}
2492 @item kill inferior @var{infno}
2493 Kill the inferior identified by @value{GDBN} inferior number
2494 @var{infno}. Note that the inferior's entry still stays on the list
2495 of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its Description will
2496 show @samp{<null>}.
2497 @end table
2498
2499 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2500 @code{detach inferior}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferior}, or after
2501 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2502 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2503
2504
2505 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2506 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2507
2508 @table @code
2509 @kindex set print inferior-events
2510 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2511 @item set print inferior-events
2512 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2513 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2514 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2515 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2516 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2517 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2518
2519 @kindex show print inferior-events
2520 @item show print inferior-events
2521 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2522 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2523 @end table
2524
2525 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2526 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2527 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2528
2529
2530 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2531 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2532 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2533 info program-spaces}} command.
2534
2535 @table @code
2536 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2537 @item maint info program-spaces
2538 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2539 @value{GDBN}.
2540
2541 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2542
2543 @enumerate
2544 @item
2545 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2546
2547 @item
2548 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2549 the @code{file} command.
2550
2551 @end enumerate
2552
2553 @noindent
2554 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2555 indicates the current program space.
2556
2557 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2558 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2559 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2560
2561 @smallexample
2562 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2563 Id Executable
2564 2 goodbye
2565 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2566 * 1 hello
2567 @end smallexample
2568
2569 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2570 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2571 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2572 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2573 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2574
2575 @smallexample
2576 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2577 Id Executable
2578 * 1 vfork-test
2579 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2580 @end smallexample
2581
2582 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2583 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2584 @end table
2585
2586 @node Threads
2587 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2588
2589 @cindex threads of execution
2590 @cindex multiple threads
2591 @cindex switching threads
2592 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2593 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2594 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2595 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2596 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2597 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2598 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2599
2600 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2601 programs:
2602
2603 @itemize @bullet
2604 @item automatic notification of new threads
2605 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2606 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2607 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2608 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2609 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2610 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2611 messages on thread start and exit.
2612 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2613 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2614 isn't compatible with the program.
2615 @end itemize
2616
2617 @quotation
2618 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2619 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2620 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2621 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2622 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2623 like this:
2624
2625 @smallexample
2626 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2627 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2628 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2629 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2630 @end smallexample
2631 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2632 @c doesn't support threads"?
2633 @end quotation
2634
2635 @cindex focus of debugging
2636 @cindex current thread
2637 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2638 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2639 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2640 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2641 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2642
2643 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2644 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2645 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2646 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2647 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2648 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2649 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2650 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2651 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2652 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2653
2654 @smallexample
2655 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2656 @end smallexample
2657
2658 @noindent
2659 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2660 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2661 further qualifier.
2662
2663 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2664 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2665 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2666 @c program?
2667 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2668 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2669 @c threads ab initio?
2670
2671 @cindex thread number
2672 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2673 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2674 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2675
2676 @table @code
2677 @kindex info threads
2678 @item info threads
2679 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2680 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2681
2682 @enumerate
2683 @item
2684 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2685
2686 @item
2687 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2688
2689 @item
2690 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2691 @end enumerate
2692
2693 @noindent
2694 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2695 indicates the current thread.
2696
2697 For example,
2698 @end table
2699 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2700
2701 @smallexample
2702 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2703 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2704 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2705 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2706 at threadtest.c:68
2707 @end smallexample
2708
2709 On HP-UX systems:
2710
2711 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2712 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2713 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2714 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2715 thread in your program.
2716
2717 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2718 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2719 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2720 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2721 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2722 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2723 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2724 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2725 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2726 HP-UX, you see
2727
2728 @smallexample
2729 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2730 @end smallexample
2731
2732 @noindent
2733 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2734
2735 @table @code
2736 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2737 @item info threads
2738 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2739 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2740
2741 @enumerate
2742 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2743
2744 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2745
2746 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2747 @end enumerate
2748
2749 @noindent
2750 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2751 indicates the current thread.
2752
2753 For example,
2754 @end table
2755 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2756
2757 @smallexample
2758 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2759 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2760 at quicksort.c:137
2761 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2762 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2763 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2764 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2765 @end smallexample
2766
2767 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2768 Solaris-specific command:
2769
2770 @table @code
2771 @item maint info sol-threads
2772 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2773 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2774 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2775 @end table
2776
2777 @table @code
2778 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2779 @item thread @var{threadno}
2780 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2781 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2782 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2783 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2784 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2785
2786 @smallexample
2787 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2788 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2789 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2790 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2791 @end smallexample
2792
2793 @noindent
2794 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2795 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2796 threads.
2797
2798 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2799 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2800 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2801 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2802 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2803 information on convenience variables.
2804
2805 @kindex thread apply
2806 @cindex apply command to several threads
2807 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2808 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2809 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2810 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2811 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2812 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2813 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2814 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2815
2816 @kindex set print thread-events
2817 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2818 @item set print thread-events
2819 @itemx set print thread-events on
2820 @itemx set print thread-events off
2821 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2822 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2823 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2824 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2825 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2826
2827 @kindex show print thread-events
2828 @item show print thread-events
2829 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2830 have started and exited.
2831 @end table
2832
2833 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2834 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2835 programs with multiple threads.
2836
2837 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2838 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2839
2840 @table @code
2841 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
2842 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
2843 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
2844 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
2845 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
2846 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
2847 an empty list.
2848
2849 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
2850 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
2851 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2852 to find @code{libthread_db}. If that fails, @value{GDBN} will continue
2853 with default system shared library directories, and finally the directory
2854 from which @code{libpthread} was loaded in the inferior process.
2855
2856 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
2857 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
2858 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
2859 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
2860 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
2861 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
2862 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
2863
2864 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
2865 only on some platforms.
2866
2867 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
2868 @item show libthread-db-search-path
2869 Display current libthread_db search path.
2870
2871 @kindex set debug libthread-db
2872 @kindex show debug libthread-db
2873 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
2874 @item set debug libthread-db
2875 @itemx show debug libthread-db
2876 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
2877 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
2878 @end table
2879
2880 @node Forks
2881 @section Debugging Forks
2882
2883 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2884 @cindex multiple processes
2885 @cindex processes, multiple
2886 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2887 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2888 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2889 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2890 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2891 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2892 will cause it to terminate.
2893
2894 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2895 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2896 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2897 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2898 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2899 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2900 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2901 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2902 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2903 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2904
2905 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2906 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2907 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2908 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2909
2910 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2911 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2912
2913 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2914 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2915
2916 @table @code
2917 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2918 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2919 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2920 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2921 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2922
2923 @table @code
2924 @item parent
2925 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2926 unimpeded. This is the default.
2927
2928 @item child
2929 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2930 unimpeded.
2931
2932 @end table
2933
2934 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2935 @item show follow-fork-mode
2936 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2937 @end table
2938
2939 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2940 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2941 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2942
2943 @table @code
2944 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2945 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2946 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2947 retain debugger control over them both.
2948
2949 @table @code
2950 @item on
2951 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2952 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2953 independently. This is the default.
2954
2955 @item off
2956 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2957 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2958 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2959 is held suspended.
2960
2961 @end table
2962
2963 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2964 @item show detach-on-fork
2965 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2966 @end table
2967
2968 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
2969 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
2970 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
2971 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
2972 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
2973 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
2974
2975 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2976 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferior}} command (allowing it
2977 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferior}}
2978 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
2979 and Programs}.
2980
2981 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2982 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2983 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2984 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2985 the child process's @code{main}.
2986
2987 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
2988 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2989
2990 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2991 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
2992 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
2993 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
2994 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
2995 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
2996 command.
2997
2998 @table @code
2999 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3000 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3001
3002 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3003 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3004
3005 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3006
3007 @table @code
3008 @item new
3009 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3010 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3011 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3012 original inferior.
3013
3014 For example:
3015
3016 @smallexample
3017 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3018 (gdb) info inferior
3019 Id Description Executable
3020 * 1 <null> prog1
3021 (@value{GDBP}) run
3022 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3023 Program exited normally.
3024 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3025 Id Description Executable
3026 * 2 <null> prog2
3027 1 <null> prog1
3028 @end smallexample
3029
3030 @item same
3031 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3032 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3033 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3034 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3035 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3036
3037 For example:
3038
3039 @smallexample
3040 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3041 Id Description Executable
3042 * 1 <null> prog1
3043 (@value{GDBP}) run
3044 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3045 Program exited normally.
3046 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3047 Id Description Executable
3048 * 1 <null> prog2
3049 @end smallexample
3050
3051 @end table
3052 @end table
3053
3054 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3055 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3056 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3057
3058 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3059 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3060
3061 @cindex checkpoint
3062 @cindex restart
3063 @cindex bookmark
3064 @cindex snapshot of a process
3065 @cindex rewind program state
3066
3067 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3068 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3069 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3070 later.
3071
3072 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3073 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3074 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3075 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3076 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3077
3078 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3079 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3080 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3081 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3082 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3083 start again from there.
3084
3085 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3086 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3087
3088 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3089
3090 @table @code
3091 @kindex checkpoint
3092 @item checkpoint
3093 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3094 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3095 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3096
3097 @kindex info checkpoints
3098 @item info checkpoints
3099 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3100 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3101 listed:
3102
3103 @table @code
3104 @item Checkpoint ID
3105 @item Process ID
3106 @item Code Address
3107 @item Source line, or label
3108 @end table
3109
3110 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3111 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3112 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3113 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3114 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3115 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3116 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3117
3118 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3119 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3120 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3121 the debugger.
3122
3123 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3124 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3125 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3126
3127 @end table
3128
3129 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3130 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3131 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3132 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3133 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3134 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3135 previously read data can be read again.
3136
3137 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3138 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3139 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3140 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3141 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3142 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3143
3144 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3145 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3146 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3147 different execution path this time.
3148
3149 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3150 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3151 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3152 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3153 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3154 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3155 potentially pose a problem.
3156
3157 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3158
3159 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3160 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3161 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3162 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3163 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3164 next.
3165
3166 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3167 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3168 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3169 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3170 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3171
3172 @node Stopping
3173 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3174
3175 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3176 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3177 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3178
3179 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3180 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3181 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3182 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3183 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3184 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3185 explicitly request this information at any time.
3186
3187 @table @code
3188 @kindex info program
3189 @item info program
3190 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3191 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3192 @end table
3193
3194 @menu
3195 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3196 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3197 * Signals:: Signals
3198 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3199 @end menu
3200
3201 @node Breakpoints
3202 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3203
3204 @cindex breakpoints
3205 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3206 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3207 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3208 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3209 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3210 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3211 program.
3212
3213 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3214 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3215 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3216 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3217 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3218 call).
3219
3220 @cindex watchpoints
3221 @cindex data breakpoints
3222 @cindex memory tracing
3223 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3224 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3225 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3226 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3227 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3228 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3229 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3230 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3231 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3232 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3233 same commands.
3234
3235 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3236 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3237 Automatic Display}.
3238
3239 @cindex catchpoints
3240 @cindex breakpoint on events
3241 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3242 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3243 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3244 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3245 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3246 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3247 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3248
3249 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3250 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3251 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3252 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3253 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3254 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3255 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3256 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3257 enable it again.
3258
3259 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3260 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3261 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3262 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3263 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3264 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3265 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3266
3267 @menu
3268 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3269 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3270 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3271 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3272 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3273 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3274 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3275 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3276 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3277 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3278 @end menu
3279
3280 @node Set Breaks
3281 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3282
3283 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3284 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3285 @c
3286 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3287
3288 @kindex break
3289 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3290 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3291 @cindex latest breakpoint
3292 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3293 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3294 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3295 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3296 convenience variables.
3297
3298 @table @code
3299 @item break @var{location}
3300 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3301 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3302 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3303 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3304 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3305
3306 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3307 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3308 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3309 that situation.
3310
3311 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3312 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3313 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3314
3315 @item break
3316 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3317 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3318 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3319 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3320 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3321 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3322 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3323 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3324 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3325 inside loops.
3326
3327 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3328 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3329 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3330 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3331 existed when your program stopped.
3332
3333 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3334 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3335 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3336 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3337 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3338 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3339 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3340
3341 @kindex tbreak
3342 @item tbreak @var{args}
3343 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3344 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3345 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3346 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3347
3348 @kindex hbreak
3349 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3350 @item hbreak @var{args}
3351 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3352 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3353 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3354 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3355 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3356 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3357 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3358 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3359 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3360 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3361 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3362 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3363 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3364 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3365 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3366 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3367 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3368 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3369
3370 @kindex thbreak
3371 @item thbreak @var{args}
3372 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3373 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3374 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3375 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3376 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3377 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3378 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3379 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3380
3381 @kindex rbreak
3382 @cindex regular expression
3383 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3384 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3385 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3386 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3387 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3388 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3389 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3390 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3391 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3392
3393 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3394 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3395 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3396 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3397 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3398 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3399
3400 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3401 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3402 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3403 classes.
3404
3405 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3406 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3407 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3408
3409 @smallexample
3410 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3411 @end smallexample
3412
3413 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3414 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3415 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3416 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3417 every function in a given file:
3418
3419 @smallexample
3420 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3421 @end smallexample
3422
3423 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3424 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3425
3426 @kindex info breakpoints
3427 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3428 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3429 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3430 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3431 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3432 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3433 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3434
3435 @table @emph
3436 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3437 @item Type
3438 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3439 @item Disposition
3440 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3441 @item Enabled or Disabled
3442 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3443 that are not enabled.
3444 @item Address
3445 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3446 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3447 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3448 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3449 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3450 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3451 @item What
3452 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3453 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3454 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3455 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3456 @end table
3457
3458 @noindent
3459 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3460 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3461 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3462 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3463 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3464 valid location.
3465
3466 @noindent
3467 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3468 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3469 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3470 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3471 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3472
3473 @noindent
3474 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3475 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3476 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3477 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3478 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3479 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3480 @end table
3481
3482 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3483 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3484 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3485 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3486
3487 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3488 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3489 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3490 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3491
3492 @itemize @bullet
3493 @item
3494 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3495 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3496
3497 @item
3498 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3499 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3500
3501 @item
3502 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3503 several places where that function is inlined.
3504 @end itemize
3505
3506 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3507 the relevant locations@footnote{
3508 As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3509 line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3510 will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3511 info with line numbers for them.}.
3512
3513 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3514 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3515 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3516 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3517 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3518 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3519 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3520
3521 For example:
3522
3523 @smallexample
3524 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3525 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3526 stop only if i==1
3527 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3528 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3529 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3530 @end smallexample
3531
3532 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3533 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3534 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3535 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3536 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3537 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3538 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3539 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3540 that belong to that breakpoint.
3541
3542 @cindex pending breakpoints
3543 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3544 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3545 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3546 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3547 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3548 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3549 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3550 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3551 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3552 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3553 is not yet resolved.
3554
3555 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3556 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3557 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3558 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3559 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3560 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3561
3562 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3563 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3564 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3565 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3566
3567 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3568 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3569 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3570
3571 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3572 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3573 address specification to an address:
3574
3575 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3576 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3577 @table @code
3578 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3579 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3580 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3581
3582 @item set breakpoint pending on
3583 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3584 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3585
3586 @item set breakpoint pending off
3587 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3588 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3589 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3590
3591 @item show breakpoint pending
3592 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3593 @end table
3594
3595 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3596 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3597 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3598
3599 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3600 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3601 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3602 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3603 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3604 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3605 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3606 breakpoints.
3607
3608 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3609
3610 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3611 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3612 @table @code
3613 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3614 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3615 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3616 breakpoint must be used.
3617
3618 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3619 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3620 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3621 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3622 @end table
3623
3624 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3625 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3626 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3627 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3628 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3629 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3630 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3631 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3632 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3633
3634 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3635 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3636 @table @code
3637 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3638 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3639 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3640 removed from the target when it stops.
3641
3642 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3643 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3644 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3645 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3646 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3647
3648 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3649 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3650 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3651 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3652 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3653 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3654 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3655 @end table
3656
3657 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3658 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3659 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3660 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3661 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3662 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3663 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3664 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3665
3666
3667 @node Set Watchpoints
3668 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3669
3670 @cindex setting watchpoints
3671 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3672 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3673 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3674 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3675 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3676
3677 @itemize @bullet
3678 @item
3679 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3680
3681 @item
3682 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3683 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3684 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3685
3686 @item
3687 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3688 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3689 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3690 @end itemize
3691
3692 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3693 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3694 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3695 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3696 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3697 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3698 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3699 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3700 the expression changes.
3701
3702 @cindex software watchpoints
3703 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3704 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3705 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3706 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3707 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3708 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3709 culprit.)
3710
3711 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3712 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3713 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3714
3715 @table @code
3716 @kindex watch
3717 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3718 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3719 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3720 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3721 to watch the value of a single variable:
3722
3723 @smallexample
3724 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3725 @end smallexample
3726
3727 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3728 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3729 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3730 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3731 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3732 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3733
3734 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
3735 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
3736 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
3737 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
3738 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
3739 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
3740 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
3741 error.
3742
3743 @kindex rwatch
3744 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3745 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3746 by the program.
3747
3748 @kindex awatch
3749 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3750 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3751 or written into by the program.
3752
3753 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3754 @item info watchpoints
3755 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
3756 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3757 @end table
3758
3759 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
3760 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
3761 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
3762 a never-changing value:
3763
3764 @smallexample
3765 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
3766 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
3767 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
3768 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
3769 @end smallexample
3770
3771 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3772 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3773 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3774 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3775 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3776 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3777
3778 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3779 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3780 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3781 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3782 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3783 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3784 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3785 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3786
3787 @table @code
3788 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3789 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3790 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3791
3792 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3793 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3794 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3795 @end table
3796
3797 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3798 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3799 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3800
3801 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3802
3803 @smallexample
3804 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3805 @end smallexample
3806
3807 @noindent
3808 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3809
3810 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3811 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3812 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3813 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3814 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3815 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3816 will print a message like this:
3817
3818 @smallexample
3819 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3820 @end smallexample
3821
3822 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3823 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3824 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3825 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3826 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3827 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3828 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3829 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3830
3831 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3832 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3833 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3834 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3835 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3836 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3837
3838 @smallexample
3839 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3840 @end smallexample
3841
3842 @noindent
3843 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3844
3845 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3846 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3847 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3848 expression with separately allocated resources.
3849
3850 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3851 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3852 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3853
3854 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3855 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3856 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3857 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3858 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3859 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3860 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3861 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3862 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3863
3864 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3865 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3866 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3867 watched expression from every thread.
3868
3869 @quotation
3870 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3871 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3872 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3873 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3874 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3875 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3876 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3877 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3878 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3879 @end quotation
3880
3881 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3882
3883 @node Set Catchpoints
3884 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3885 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3886 @cindex exception handlers
3887 @cindex event handling
3888
3889 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3890 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3891 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3892
3893 @table @code
3894 @kindex catch
3895 @item catch @var{event}
3896 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3897 @table @code
3898 @item throw
3899 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3900 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3901
3902 @item catch
3903 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3904
3905 @item exception
3906 @cindex Ada exception catching
3907 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3908 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3909 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3910 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3911 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3912
3913 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
3914 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
3915 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
3916 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
3917 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
3918 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
3919 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
3920 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
3921
3922 @item exception unhandled
3923 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3924
3925 @item assert
3926 A failed Ada assertion.
3927
3928 @item exec
3929 @cindex break on fork/exec
3930 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3931 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3932
3933 @item syscall
3934 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
3935 @cindex break on a system call.
3936 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
3937 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
3938 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
3939 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
3940 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
3941 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
3942 will be caught.
3943
3944 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
3945 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
3946 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
3947 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
3948
3949 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
3950 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
3951 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
3952 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
3953
3954 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
3955 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
3956 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
3957 available choices.
3958
3959 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
3960 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
3961 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
3962 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
3963 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
3964 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
3965 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
3966 behind the OS upgrades).
3967
3968 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
3969 arguments to it:
3970
3971 @smallexample
3972 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
3973 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
3974 (@value{GDBP}) r
3975 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
3976
3977 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
3978 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3979 (@value{GDBP}) c
3980 Continuing.
3981
3982 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
3983 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3984 (@value{GDBP})
3985 @end smallexample
3986
3987 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
3988
3989 @smallexample
3990 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
3991 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
3992 (@value{GDBP}) r
3993 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
3994
3995 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
3996 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
3997 (@value{GDBP}) c
3998 Continuing.
3999
4000 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4001 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4002 (@value{GDBP})
4003 @end smallexample
4004
4005 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4006 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4007 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4008
4009 @smallexample
4010 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4011 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4012 (@value{GDBP}) r
4013 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4014
4015 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4016 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4017 (@value{GDBP}) c
4018 Continuing.
4019
4020 Program exited normally.
4021 (@value{GDBP})
4022 @end smallexample
4023
4024 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4025 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4026 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4027 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4028
4029 @smallexample
4030 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4031 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4032 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4033 (@value{GDBP})
4034 @end smallexample
4035
4036 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4037 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4038 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4039 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4040 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4041 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4042
4043 @smallexample
4044 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4045 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4046 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4047 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4048 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4049 (@value{GDBP})
4050 @end smallexample
4051
4052 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4053
4054 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4055 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4056
4057 @smallexample
4058 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4059 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4060 @end smallexample
4061
4062 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4063
4064 @item fork
4065 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4066 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4067
4068 @item vfork
4069 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4070 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4071
4072 @end table
4073
4074 @item tcatch @var{event}
4075 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4076 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4077
4078 @end table
4079
4080 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4081
4082 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
4083 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
4084
4085 @itemize @bullet
4086 @item
4087 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4088 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4089 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4090 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4091 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4092 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4093 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4094 disabled within interactive calls.
4095
4096 @item
4097 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4098
4099 @item
4100 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4101 @end itemize
4102
4103 @cindex raise exceptions
4104 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
4105 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
4106 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
4107 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
4108 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
4109 out where the exception was raised.
4110
4111 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
4112 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
4113 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
4114 which has the following ANSI C interface:
4115
4116 @smallexample
4117 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
4118 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
4119 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
4120 @end smallexample
4121
4122 @noindent
4123 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
4124 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
4125 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
4126
4127 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
4128 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
4129 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
4130 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
4131 raised.
4132
4133
4134 @node Delete Breaks
4135 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4136
4137 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4138 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4139 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4140 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4141 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4142 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4143
4144 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4145 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4146 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4147 their breakpoint numbers.
4148
4149 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4150 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4151 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4152
4153 @table @code
4154 @kindex clear
4155 @item clear
4156 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4157 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4158 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4159 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4160
4161 @item clear @var{location}
4162 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4163 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4164 most useful ones are listed below:
4165
4166 @table @code
4167 @item clear @var{function}
4168 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4169 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4170
4171 @item clear @var{linenum}
4172 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4173 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4174 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4175 @end table
4176
4177 @cindex delete breakpoints
4178 @kindex delete
4179 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4180 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4181 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4182 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4183 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4184 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4185 @end table
4186
4187 @node Disabling
4188 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4189
4190 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4191 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4192 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4193 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4194 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4195
4196 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4197 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4198 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4199 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4200 do not know which numbers to use.
4201
4202 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4203 affects all of its locations.
4204
4205 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
4206 states of enablement:
4207
4208 @itemize @bullet
4209 @item
4210 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4211 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4212 @item
4213 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4214 @item
4215 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4216 disabled.
4217 @item
4218 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4219 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4220 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4221 @end itemize
4222
4223 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4224 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4225
4226 @table @code
4227 @kindex disable
4228 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4229 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4230 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4231 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4232 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4233 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4234 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4235
4236 @kindex enable
4237 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4238 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4239 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4240
4241 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4242 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4243 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4244
4245 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4246 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4247 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4248 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4249 @end table
4250
4251 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4252 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4253 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4254 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4255 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4256 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4257 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4258 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4259 Stepping}.)
4260
4261 @node Conditions
4262 @subsection Break Conditions
4263 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4264 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4265
4266 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4267 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4268 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4269 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4270 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4271 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4272 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4273 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4274
4275 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4276 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4277 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4278 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4279 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4280
4281 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4282 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4283 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4284 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4285 one.
4286
4287 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4288 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4289 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4290 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4291 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4292 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4293 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4294 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4295 conditions for the
4296 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4297 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4298
4299 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4300 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4301 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4302 with the @code{condition} command.
4303
4304 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4305 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4306 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4307 catchpoint.
4308
4309 @table @code
4310 @kindex condition
4311 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4312 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4313 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4314 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4315 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4316 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4317 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4318 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4319 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4320 prints an error message:
4321
4322 @smallexample
4323 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4324 @end smallexample
4325
4326 @noindent
4327 @value{GDBN} does
4328 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4329 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4330 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4331
4332 @item condition @var{bnum}
4333 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4334 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4335 @end table
4336
4337 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4338 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4339 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4340 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4341 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4342 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4343 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4344 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4345 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4346 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4347 your program reaches it.
4348
4349 @table @code
4350 @kindex ignore
4351 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4352 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4353 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4354 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4355 takes no action.
4356
4357 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4358 a count of zero.
4359
4360 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4361 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4362 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4363 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4364
4365 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4366 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4367 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4368
4369 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4370 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4371 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4372 Variables}.
4373 @end table
4374
4375 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4376
4377
4378 @node Break Commands
4379 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4380
4381 @cindex breakpoint commands
4382 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4383 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4384 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4385 enable other breakpoints.
4386
4387 @table @code
4388 @kindex commands
4389 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4390 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4391 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4392 @itemx end
4393 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4394 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4395 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4396
4397 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4398 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4399
4400 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4401 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4402 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4403 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4404 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4405 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4406 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4407 Expressions}).
4408 @end table
4409
4410 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4411 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4412
4413 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4414 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4415 that resumes execution.
4416
4417 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4418 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4419 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4420 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4421 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4422
4423 @kindex silent
4424 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4425 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4426 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4427 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4428 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4429 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4430
4431 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4432 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4433 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4434
4435 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4436 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4437
4438 @smallexample
4439 break foo if x>0
4440 commands
4441 silent
4442 printf "x is %d\n",x
4443 cont
4444 end
4445 @end smallexample
4446
4447 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4448 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4449 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4450 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4451 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4452 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4453 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4454
4455 @smallexample
4456 break 403
4457 commands
4458 silent
4459 set x = y + 4
4460 cont
4461 end
4462 @end smallexample
4463
4464 @node Save Breakpoints
4465 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4466
4467 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4468 breakpoints}} command.
4469
4470 @table @code
4471 @kindex save breakpoints
4472 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4473 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4474 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4475 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4476 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4477 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4478 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4479 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4480 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4481 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4482 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4483 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4484 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4485 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4486 that can no longer be recreated.
4487 @end table
4488
4489 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4490 @node Error in Breakpoints
4491 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4492
4493 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4494 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4495
4496 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4497 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4498 @smallexample
4499 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4500 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4501 @end smallexample
4502
4503 @noindent
4504 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4505 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4506 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4507
4508 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4509 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4510
4511 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4512 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4513 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4514
4515 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4516 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4517 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4518 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4519
4520 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4521 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4522 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4523 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4524 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4525 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4526 first in the bundle.
4527
4528 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4529 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4530 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4531 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4532 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4533 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4534 is hit.
4535
4536 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4537 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4538
4539 @smallexample
4540 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
4541 @end smallexample
4542
4543 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
4544 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
4545 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
4546 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
4547 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
4548 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
4549 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
4550 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4551
4552 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4553 adjusted breakpoints:
4554
4555 @smallexample
4556 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4557 to 0x00010410.
4558 @end smallexample
4559
4560 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4561 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4562 frequently than expected.
4563
4564 @node Continuing and Stepping
4565 @section Continuing and Stepping
4566
4567 @cindex stepping
4568 @cindex continuing
4569 @cindex resuming execution
4570 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4571 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4572 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4573 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4574 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4575 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4576 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4577 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4578
4579 @table @code
4580 @kindex continue
4581 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4582 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4583 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4584 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4585 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4586 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4587 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4588 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4589 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4590 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4591
4592 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4593 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4594 @code{continue} is ignored.
4595
4596 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4597 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4598 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4599 @code{continue}.
4600 @end table
4601
4602 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4603 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4604 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4605 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4606
4607 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4608 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4609 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4610 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4611 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4612 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4613
4614 @table @code
4615 @kindex step
4616 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4617 @item step
4618 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4619 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4620 abbreviated @code{s}.
4621
4622 @quotation
4623 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4624 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4625 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4626 @c distinction here.
4627 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4628 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4629 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4630 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4631 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4632 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4633 below.
4634 @end quotation
4635
4636 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4637 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4638 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4639 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4640 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4641 called within the line.
4642
4643 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4644 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4645 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4646 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4647 was any debugging information about the routine.
4648
4649 @item step @var{count}
4650 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4651 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4652 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4653
4654 @kindex next
4655 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4656 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4657 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4658 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4659 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4660 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4661 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4662 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4663
4664 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4665
4666
4667 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4668 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4669 @c
4670 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4671 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4672 @c function are executed without stopping.
4673
4674 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4675 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4676 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4677
4678 @kindex set step-mode
4679 @item set step-mode
4680 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4681 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4682 @itemx set step-mode on
4683 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4684 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4685 information rather than stepping over it.
4686
4687 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4688 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4689 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4690
4691 @item set step-mode off
4692 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4693 debug information. This is the default.
4694
4695 @item show step-mode
4696 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4697 source line debug information.
4698
4699 @kindex finish
4700 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
4701 @item finish
4702 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4703 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
4704 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
4705
4706 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4707 ,Returning from a Function}).
4708
4709 @kindex until
4710 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4711 @cindex run until specified location
4712 @item until
4713 @itemx u
4714 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4715 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4716 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4717 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4718 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4719 than the address of the jump.
4720
4721 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4722 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4723 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4724 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4725 through the next iteration.
4726
4727 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4728 stack frame.
4729
4730 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4731 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4732 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4733 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4734 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4735
4736 @smallexample
4737 (@value{GDBP}) f
4738 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4739 206 expand_input();
4740 (@value{GDBP}) until
4741 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4742 @end smallexample
4743
4744 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4745 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4746 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4747 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4748 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4749 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4750 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4751
4752 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4753 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4754 argument.
4755
4756 @item until @var{location}
4757 @itemx u @var{location}
4758 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4759 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4760 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4761 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4762 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4763 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4764 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4765 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4766 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4767 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4768 invocations have returned.
4769
4770 @smallexample
4771 94 int factorial (int value)
4772 95 @{
4773 96 if (value > 1) @{
4774 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4775 98 @}
4776 99 return (value);
4777 100 @}
4778 @end smallexample
4779
4780
4781 @kindex advance @var{location}
4782 @itemx advance @var{location}
4783 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4784 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4785 @ref{Specify Location}.
4786 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4787 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4788 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4789 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4790
4791
4792 @kindex stepi
4793 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4794 @item stepi
4795 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4796 @itemx si
4797 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4798
4799 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4800 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4801 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4802 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4803
4804 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4805
4806 @need 750
4807 @kindex nexti
4808 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4809 @item nexti
4810 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4811 @itemx ni
4812 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4813 proceed until the function returns.
4814
4815 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4816 @end table
4817
4818 @node Signals
4819 @section Signals
4820 @cindex signals
4821
4822 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4823 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4824 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4825 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4826 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4827 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4828 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4829 requested an alarm).
4830
4831 @cindex fatal signals
4832 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4833 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4834 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4835 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4836 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4837 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4838
4839 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4840 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4841 signal.
4842
4843 @cindex handling signals
4844 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4845 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4846 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4847 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4848 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4849
4850 @table @code
4851 @kindex info signals
4852 @kindex info handle
4853 @item info signals
4854 @itemx info handle
4855 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4856 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4857 the defined types of signals.
4858
4859 @item info signals @var{sig}
4860 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4861
4862 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4863
4864 @kindex handle
4865 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4866 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4867 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4868 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4869 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4870 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4871 say what change to make.
4872 @end table
4873
4874 @c @group
4875 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4876 Their full names are:
4877
4878 @table @code
4879 @item nostop
4880 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4881 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4882
4883 @item stop
4884 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4885 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4886
4887 @item print
4888 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4889
4890 @item noprint
4891 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4892 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4893
4894 @item pass
4895 @itemx noignore
4896 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4897 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4898 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4899
4900 @item nopass
4901 @itemx ignore
4902 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4903 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4904 @end table
4905 @c @end group
4906
4907 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4908 program until you
4909 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4910 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4911 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4912 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4913 program sees that signal when you continue.
4914
4915 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4916 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4917 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4918 erroneous signals.
4919
4920 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4921 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4922 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4923 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4924 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4925 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4926 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4927 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4928 Program a Signal}.
4929
4930 @cindex extra signal information
4931 @anchor{extra signal information}
4932
4933 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
4934 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
4935 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
4936 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
4937 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
4938 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
4939 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
4940 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
4941 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
4942 system header.
4943
4944 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
4945 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
4946
4947 @smallexample
4948 @group
4949 (@value{GDBP}) continue
4950 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
4951 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
4952 69 *(int *)p = 0;
4953 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
4954 type = struct @{
4955 int si_signo;
4956 int si_errno;
4957 int si_code;
4958 union @{
4959 int _pad[28];
4960 struct @{...@} _kill;
4961 struct @{...@} _timer;
4962 struct @{...@} _rt;
4963 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
4964 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
4965 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
4966 @} _sifields;
4967 @}
4968 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
4969 type = struct @{
4970 void *si_addr;
4971 @}
4972 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
4973 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
4974 @end group
4975 @end smallexample
4976
4977 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
4978
4979 @node Thread Stops
4980 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4981
4982 @cindex stopped threads
4983 @cindex threads, stopped
4984
4985 @cindex continuing threads
4986 @cindex threads, continuing
4987
4988 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
4989 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
4990 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
4991 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
4992 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
4993 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
4994 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
4995 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
4996 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
4997
4998 @menu
4999 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5000 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5001 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5002 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5003 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5004 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5005 @end menu
5006
5007 @node All-Stop Mode
5008 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5009
5010 @cindex all-stop mode
5011
5012 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5013 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5014 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5015 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5016 underfoot.
5017
5018 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5019 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5020 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5021
5022 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5023 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5024 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5025 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5026 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5027 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5028 stops.
5029
5030 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5031 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5032 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5033 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5034
5035 @cindex automatic thread selection
5036 @cindex switching threads automatically
5037 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5038 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5039 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5040 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5041 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5042 thread.
5043
5044 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5045 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5046
5047 @table @code
5048 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5049 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5050 @cindex lock scheduler
5051 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5052 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5053 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5054 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5055 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5056 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5057 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
5058 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
5059 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
5060 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5061 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5062 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5063
5064 @item show scheduler-locking
5065 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5066 @end table
5067
5068 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5069 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5070 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5071 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5072 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5073 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5074 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5075 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5076 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5077 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5078 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5079 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5080 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5081 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5082
5083 @table @code
5084 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5085 @item set schedule-multiple
5086 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5087 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5088 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5089 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5090 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5091 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5092
5093 @item show schedule-multiple
5094 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5095 multiple processes.
5096 @end table
5097
5098 @node Non-Stop Mode
5099 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5100
5101 @cindex non-stop mode
5102
5103 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5104 @c with more details.
5105
5106 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5107 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5108 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5109 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5110 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5111 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5112
5113 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5114 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5115 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5116 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5117 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5118 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5119 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5120 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5121 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5122 independently and simultaneously.
5123
5124 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5125 or attach to your program:
5126
5127 @smallexample
5128 # Enable the async interface.
5129 set target-async 1
5130
5131 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5132 set pagination off
5133
5134 # Finally, turn it on!
5135 set non-stop on
5136 @end smallexample
5137
5138 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5139
5140 @table @code
5141 @kindex set non-stop
5142 @item set non-stop on
5143 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5144 @item set non-stop off
5145 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5146 @kindex show non-stop
5147 @item show non-stop
5148 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5149 @end table
5150
5151 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5152 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5153 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5154 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5155 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5156 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5157 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5158 default.
5159
5160 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5161 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5162 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5163
5164 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5165 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5166 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5167 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5168 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5169
5170 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5171 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5172 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5173 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5174 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5175
5176 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5177
5178 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5179 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5180 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5181 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5182 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5183 previously current thread.
5184
5185 @node Background Execution
5186 @subsection Background Execution
5187
5188 @cindex foreground execution
5189 @cindex background execution
5190 @cindex asynchronous execution
5191 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5192
5193 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5194 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5195 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5196 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5197 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5198 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5199
5200 You need to explicitly enable asynchronous mode before you can use
5201 background execution commands. You can use these commands to
5202 manipulate the asynchronous mode setting:
5203
5204 @table @code
5205 @kindex set target-async
5206 @item set target-async on
5207 Enable asynchronous mode.
5208 @item set target-async off
5209 Disable asynchronous mode.
5210 @kindex show target-async
5211 @item show target-async
5212 Show the current target-async setting.
5213 @end table
5214
5215 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5216 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5217
5218 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5219 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5220 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5221 are:
5222
5223 @table @code
5224 @kindex run&
5225 @item run
5226 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5227
5228 @item attach
5229 @kindex attach&
5230 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5231
5232 @item step
5233 @kindex step&
5234 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5235
5236 @item stepi
5237 @kindex stepi&
5238 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5239
5240 @item next
5241 @kindex next&
5242 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5243
5244 @item nexti
5245 @kindex nexti&
5246 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
5247
5248 @item continue
5249 @kindex continue&
5250 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
5251
5252 @item finish
5253 @kindex finish&
5254 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
5255
5256 @item until
5257 @kindex until&
5258 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
5259
5260 @end table
5261
5262 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
5263 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
5264 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
5265 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
5266 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
5267 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
5268
5269 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
5270 using the @code{interrupt} command.
5271
5272 @table @code
5273 @kindex interrupt
5274 @item interrupt
5275 @itemx interrupt -a
5276
5277 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
5278 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
5279 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
5280 use @code{interrupt -a}.
5281 @end table
5282
5283 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5284 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5285
5286 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
5287 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
5288 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
5289
5290 @table @code
5291 @cindex breakpoints and threads
5292 @cindex thread breakpoints
5293 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
5294 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
5295 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
5296 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
5297 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
5298 specify some source line.
5299
5300 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
5301 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
5302 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
5303 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
5304 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
5305
5306 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
5307 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
5308 program.
5309
5310 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
5311 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
5312 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
5313
5314 @smallexample
5315 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
5316 @end smallexample
5317
5318 @end table
5319
5320 @node Interrupted System Calls
5321 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
5322
5323 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
5324 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
5325 @cindex premature return from system calls
5326 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
5327 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
5328 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
5329 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
5330 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
5331 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
5332 stop execution.
5333
5334 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
5335 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
5336 style anyways.
5337
5338 For example, do not write code like this:
5339
5340 @smallexample
5341 sleep (10);
5342 @end smallexample
5343
5344 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
5345 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
5346
5347 Instead, write this:
5348
5349 @smallexample
5350 int unslept = 10;
5351 while (unslept > 0)
5352 unslept = sleep (unslept);
5353 @end smallexample
5354
5355 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
5356 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
5357 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
5358 @value{GDBN}.
5359
5360 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
5361 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
5362 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
5363 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
5364
5365 @node Observer Mode
5366 @subsection Observer Mode
5367
5368 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
5369 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
5370 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
5371 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
5372 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
5373
5374 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
5375 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
5376 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
5377 mode.
5378
5379 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
5380 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
5381 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
5382 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
5383 stream will still not be able to be placed.
5384
5385 @table @code
5386
5387 @kindex observer
5388 @item set observer on
5389 @itemx set observer off
5390 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
5391 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
5392 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
5393 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
5394
5395 @item show observer
5396 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
5397
5398 @kindex may-write-registers
5399 @item set may-write-registers on
5400 @itemx set may-write-registers off
5401 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
5402 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
5403 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
5404
5405 @item show may-write-registers
5406 Show the current permission to write registers.
5407
5408 @kindex may-write-memory
5409 @item set may-write-memory on
5410 @itemx set may-write-memory off
5411 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
5412 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
5413 defaults to @code{on}.
5414
5415 @item show may-write-memory
5416 Show the current permission to write memory.
5417
5418 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
5419 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
5420 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
5421 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
5422 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
5423 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5424
5425 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
5426 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
5427
5428 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
5429 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
5430 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
5431 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
5432 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
5433 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
5434 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5435
5436 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
5437 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
5438
5439 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
5440 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
5441 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
5442 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
5443 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
5444 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
5445 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5446
5447 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
5448 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
5449
5450 @kindex may-interrupt
5451 @item set may-interrupt on
5452 @itemx set may-interrupt off
5453 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
5454 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
5455 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
5456 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5457
5458 @item show may-interrupt
5459 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
5460
5461 @end table
5462
5463 @node Reverse Execution
5464 @chapter Running programs backward
5465 @cindex reverse execution
5466 @cindex running programs backward
5467
5468 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
5469 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
5470 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
5471 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
5472
5473 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
5474 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
5475 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
5476 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
5477 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
5478 all target environments can support reverse execution.
5479
5480 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
5481 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
5482 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
5483 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
5484 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
5485 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
5486 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
5487 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
5488 prior values@footnote{
5489 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
5490 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
5491 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
5492
5493 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
5494 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
5495 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
5496 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
5497 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
5498 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
5499 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
5500 }.
5501
5502 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
5503 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
5504
5505 @table @code
5506 @kindex reverse-continue
5507 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
5508 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5509 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5510 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
5511 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
5512 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
5513 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
5514
5515 @kindex reverse-step
5516 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
5517 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5518 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
5519 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
5520
5521 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
5522 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
5523 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
5524 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
5525 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
5526 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
5527
5528 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
5529 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
5530
5531 @kindex reverse-stepi
5532 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
5533 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5534 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
5535 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
5536 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
5537 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
5538 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
5539
5540 @kindex reverse-next
5541 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
5542 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5543 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
5544 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
5545 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
5546 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
5547 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
5548 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
5549 line of a function back to its return to its caller
5550 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
5551
5552 @kindex reverse-nexti
5553 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
5554 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5555 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
5556 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
5557 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
5558 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
5559 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
5560 frame) is reached.
5561
5562 @kindex reverse-finish
5563 @item reverse-finish
5564 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
5565 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
5566 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
5567 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
5568
5569 @kindex set exec-direction
5570 @item set exec-direction
5571 Set the direction of target execution.
5572 @itemx set exec-direction reverse
5573 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
5574 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
5575 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
5576 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
5577 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
5578 @item set exec-direction forward
5579 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
5580 This is the default.
5581 @end table
5582
5583
5584 @node Process Record and Replay
5585 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
5586 @cindex process record and replay
5587 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
5588
5589 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
5590 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
5591 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
5592
5593 @cindex replay mode
5594 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
5595 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
5596 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
5597 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
5598 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
5599 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
5600 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
5601 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
5602 execution log.
5603
5604 @cindex record mode
5605 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
5606 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
5607 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
5608 for future replay.
5609
5610 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
5611 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
5612 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
5613 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
5614 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
5615 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
5616
5617 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
5618 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
5619 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
5620 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
5621
5622 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
5623 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
5624
5625 @table @code
5626 @kindex target record
5627 @kindex record
5628 @kindex rec
5629 @item target record
5630 This command starts the process record and replay target. The process
5631 record and replay target can only debug a process that is already
5632 running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with the
5633 @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording with
5634 the @kbd{target record} command.
5635
5636 Both @code{record} and @code{rec} are aliases of @code{target record}.
5637
5638 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
5639 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
5640 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
5641 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
5642 doesn't support displaced stepping.
5643
5644 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
5645 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
5646 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
5647 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), the
5648 process record and replay target cannot be started because it doesn't
5649 support these two modes.
5650
5651 @kindex record stop
5652 @kindex rec s
5653 @item record stop
5654 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
5655 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
5656 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
5657
5658 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
5659 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
5660 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
5661 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
5662 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
5663
5664 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
5665 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
5666 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
5667 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
5668 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
5669
5670 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
5671 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
5672
5673 @kindex record save
5674 @item record save @var{filename}
5675 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
5676 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
5677 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
5678
5679 @kindex record restore
5680 @item record restore @var{filename}
5681 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
5682 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
5683
5684 @kindex set record insn-number-max
5685 @item set record insn-number-max @var{limit}
5686 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded. Default value is 200000.
5687
5688 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
5689 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
5690 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
5691 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
5692 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
5693 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
5694 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
5695 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
5696
5697 If @var{limit} is zero, @value{GDBN} will never delete recorded
5698 instructions from the execution log. The number of recorded
5699 instructions is unlimited in this case.
5700
5701 @kindex show record insn-number-max
5702 @item show record insn-number-max
5703 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded.
5704
5705 @kindex set record stop-at-limit
5706 @item set record stop-at-limit
5707 Control the behavior when the number of recorded instructions reaches
5708 the limit. If ON (the default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit
5709 is reached for the first time and ask you whether you want to stop the
5710 inferior or continue running it and recording the execution log. If
5711 you decide to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will
5712 cause the oldest one to be deleted.
5713
5714 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
5715 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
5716
5717 @kindex show record stop-at-limit
5718 @item show record stop-at-limit
5719 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
5720
5721 @kindex set record memory-query
5722 @item set record memory-query
5723 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
5724 changes caused by an instruction. If ON, @value{GDBN} will query
5725 whether to stop the inferior in that case.
5726
5727 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
5728 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
5729 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
5730 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
5731 results.
5732
5733 @kindex show record memory-query
5734 @item show record memory-query
5735 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
5736
5737 @kindex info record
5738 @item info record
5739 Show various statistics about the state of process record and its
5740 in-memory execution log buffer, including:
5741
5742 @itemize @bullet
5743 @item
5744 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
5745 @item
5746 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
5747 @item
5748 Highest recorded instruction number.
5749 @item
5750 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
5751 @item
5752 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
5753 @item
5754 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
5755 @end itemize
5756
5757 @kindex record delete
5758 @kindex rec del
5759 @item record delete
5760 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
5761 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
5762 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
5763 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
5764 @end table
5765
5766
5767 @node Stack
5768 @chapter Examining the Stack
5769
5770 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
5771 stopped and how it got there.
5772
5773 @cindex call stack
5774 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
5775 is generated.
5776 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
5777 the arguments of the call,
5778 and the local variables of the function being called.
5779 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
5780 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
5781 stack}.
5782
5783 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
5784 stack allow you to see all of this information.
5785
5786 @cindex selected frame
5787 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
5788 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
5789 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
5790 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
5791 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
5792 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5793
5794 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5795 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
5796 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
5797
5798 @menu
5799 * Frames:: Stack frames
5800 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
5801 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
5802 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
5803
5804 @end menu
5805
5806 @node Frames
5807 @section Stack Frames
5808
5809 @cindex frame, definition
5810 @cindex stack frame
5811 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
5812 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
5813 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
5814 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
5815 which the function is executing.
5816
5817 @cindex initial frame
5818 @cindex outermost frame
5819 @cindex innermost frame
5820 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
5821 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
5822 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
5823 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
5824 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
5825 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
5826 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
5827 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
5828
5829 @cindex frame pointer
5830 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
5831 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
5832 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
5833 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
5834 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
5835 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
5836
5837 @cindex frame number
5838 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
5839 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
5840 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
5841 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
5842 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
5843
5844 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
5845 @c underflow problems.
5846 @cindex frameless execution
5847 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
5848 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
5849 @smallexample
5850 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
5851 @end smallexample
5852 generates functions without a frame.)
5853 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
5854 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
5855 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
5856 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
5857 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
5858 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
5859 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
5860
5861 @table @code
5862 @kindex frame@r{, command}
5863 @cindex current stack frame
5864 @item frame @var{args}
5865 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
5866 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5867 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
5868 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
5869
5870 @kindex select-frame
5871 @cindex selecting frame silently
5872 @item select-frame
5873 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
5874 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
5875 @code{frame}.
5876 @end table
5877
5878 @node Backtrace
5879 @section Backtraces
5880
5881 @cindex traceback
5882 @cindex call stack traces
5883 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
5884 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
5885 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
5886 stack.
5887
5888 @table @code
5889 @kindex backtrace
5890 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
5891 @item backtrace
5892 @itemx bt
5893 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
5894 frames in the stack.
5895
5896 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
5897 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
5898
5899 @item backtrace @var{n}
5900 @itemx bt @var{n}
5901 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
5902
5903 @item backtrace -@var{n}
5904 @itemx bt -@var{n}
5905 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
5906
5907 @item backtrace full
5908 @itemx bt full
5909 @itemx bt full @var{n}
5910 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
5911 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
5912 number of frames to print, as described above.
5913 @end table
5914
5915 @kindex where
5916 @kindex info stack
5917 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
5918 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
5919
5920 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
5921 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
5922 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
5923 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
5924 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
5925 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
5926 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
5927 multi-threaded program.
5928
5929 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
5930 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
5931 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
5932 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
5933 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
5934 line number.
5935
5936 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
5937 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
5938
5939 @smallexample
5940 @group
5941 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5942 at builtin.c:993
5943 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
5944 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
5945 at macro.c:71
5946 (More stack frames follow...)
5947 @end group
5948 @end smallexample
5949
5950 @noindent
5951 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
5952 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
5953 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
5954
5955 @noindent
5956 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
5957 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
5958 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
5959 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
5960 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
5961
5962 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
5963 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
5964 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
5965 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
5966 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
5967 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
5968 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
5969 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
5970 such a backtrace might look like:
5971
5972 @smallexample
5973 @group
5974 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5975 at builtin.c:993
5976 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
5977 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
5978 at macro.c:71
5979 (More stack frames follow...)
5980 @end group
5981 @end smallexample
5982
5983 @noindent
5984 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
5985 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
5986
5987 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
5988 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
5989 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
5990
5991 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
5992 @cindex program entry point
5993 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
5994 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
5995 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
5996 @code{main}@footnote{
5997 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
5998 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
5999 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
6000 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
6001 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
6002 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
6003
6004 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
6005 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
6006
6007 @table @code
6008 @item set backtrace past-main
6009 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
6010 @kindex set backtrace
6011 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
6012
6013 @item set backtrace past-main off
6014 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
6015 default.
6016
6017 @item show backtrace past-main
6018 @kindex show backtrace
6019 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
6020
6021 @item set backtrace past-entry
6022 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
6023 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
6024 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
6025 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
6026
6027 @item set backtrace past-entry off
6028 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
6029 application. This is the default.
6030
6031 @item show backtrace past-entry
6032 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
6033
6034 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
6035 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
6036 @cindex backtrace limit
6037 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
6038 unlimited.
6039
6040 @item show backtrace limit
6041 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
6042 @end table
6043
6044 @node Selection
6045 @section Selecting a Frame
6046
6047 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
6048 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
6049 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
6050 of the stack frame just selected.
6051
6052 @table @code
6053 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
6054 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
6055 @item frame @var{n}
6056 @itemx f @var{n}
6057 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
6058 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
6059 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
6060 @code{main}.
6061
6062 @item frame @var{addr}
6063 @itemx f @var{addr}
6064 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
6065 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
6066 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
6067 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
6068 switches between them.
6069
6070 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
6071 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
6072
6073 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
6074 pointer and a program counter.
6075
6076 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
6077 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
6078
6079 @kindex up
6080 @item up @var{n}
6081 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
6082 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
6083 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
6084
6085 @kindex down
6086 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
6087 @item down @var{n}
6088 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
6089 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
6090 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
6091 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
6092 @end table
6093
6094 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
6095 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
6096 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
6097 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
6098
6099 @need 1000
6100 For example:
6101
6102 @smallexample
6103 @group
6104 (@value{GDBP}) up
6105 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
6106 at env.c:10
6107 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
6108 @end group
6109 @end smallexample
6110
6111 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
6112 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
6113 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
6114 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
6115 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
6116 for details.
6117
6118 @table @code
6119 @kindex down-silently
6120 @kindex up-silently
6121 @item up-silently @var{n}
6122 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
6123 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
6124 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
6125 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
6126 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
6127 distracting.
6128 @end table
6129
6130 @node Frame Info
6131 @section Information About a Frame
6132
6133 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
6134 stack frame.
6135
6136 @table @code
6137 @item frame
6138 @itemx f
6139 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
6140 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
6141 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
6142 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
6143 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6144
6145 @kindex info frame
6146 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
6147 @item info frame
6148 @itemx info f
6149 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
6150 including:
6151
6152 @itemize @bullet
6153 @item
6154 the address of the frame
6155 @item
6156 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
6157 @item
6158 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
6159 @item
6160 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
6161 @item
6162 the address of the frame's arguments
6163 @item
6164 the address of the frame's local variables
6165 @item
6166 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
6167 @item
6168 which registers were saved in the frame
6169 @end itemize
6170
6171 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
6172 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
6173 the usual conventions.
6174
6175 @item info frame @var{addr}
6176 @itemx info f @var{addr}
6177 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
6178 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
6179 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
6180 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
6181 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6182
6183 @kindex info args
6184 @item info args
6185 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
6186
6187 @item info locals
6188 @kindex info locals
6189 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
6190 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
6191 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
6192
6193 @kindex info catch
6194 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
6195 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
6196 @item info catch
6197 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
6198 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
6199 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
6200 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
6201 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
6202
6203 @end table
6204
6205
6206 @node Source
6207 @chapter Examining Source Files
6208
6209 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
6210 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
6211 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
6212 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
6213 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
6214 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
6215 source files by explicit command.
6216
6217 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
6218 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
6219 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
6220
6221 @menu
6222 * List:: Printing source lines
6223 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
6224 * Edit:: Editing source files
6225 * Search:: Searching source files
6226 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
6227 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
6228 @end menu
6229
6230 @node List
6231 @section Printing Source Lines
6232
6233 @kindex list
6234 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
6235 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
6236 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
6237 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
6238 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
6239
6240 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
6241
6242 @table @code
6243 @item list @var{linenum}
6244 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
6245 current source file.
6246
6247 @item list @var{function}
6248 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
6249 @var{function}.
6250
6251 @item list
6252 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
6253 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
6254 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
6255 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
6256 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
6257
6258 @item list -
6259 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
6260 @end table
6261
6262 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
6263 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
6264 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
6265
6266 @table @code
6267 @kindex set listsize
6268 @item set listsize @var{count}
6269 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
6270 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
6271
6272 @kindex show listsize
6273 @item show listsize
6274 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
6275 @end table
6276
6277 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
6278 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
6279 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
6280 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
6281 each repetition moves up in the source file.
6282
6283 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
6284 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
6285 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
6286 to specify some source line.
6287
6288 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
6289
6290 @table @code
6291 @item list @var{linespec}
6292 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
6293
6294 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
6295 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
6296 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
6297 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
6298 the same source file as the first linespec.
6299
6300 @item list ,@var{last}
6301 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
6302
6303 @item list @var{first},
6304 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
6305
6306 @item list +
6307 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
6308
6309 @item list -
6310 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
6311
6312 @item list
6313 As described in the preceding table.
6314 @end table
6315
6316 @node Specify Location
6317 @section Specifying a Location
6318 @cindex specifying location
6319 @cindex linespec
6320
6321 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
6322 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
6323 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
6324 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
6325
6326 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
6327 @value{GDBN} understands:
6328
6329 @table @code
6330 @item @var{linenum}
6331 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
6332
6333 @item -@var{offset}
6334 @itemx +@var{offset}
6335 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
6336 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
6337 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
6338 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
6339 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
6340 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
6341 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
6342 linespec.
6343
6344 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
6345 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
6346
6347 @item @var{function}
6348 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
6349 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
6350
6351 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
6352 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
6353 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
6354 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
6355 functions in different source files.
6356
6357 @item @var{label}
6358 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
6359 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
6360 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
6361 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
6362 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
6363
6364 @item *@var{address}
6365 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
6366 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
6367 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
6368 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
6369 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
6370 source files.
6371
6372 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
6373 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
6374 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
6375 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
6376 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
6377 of @var{address}:
6378
6379 @table @code
6380 @item @var{expression}
6381 Any expression valid in the current working language.
6382
6383 @item @var{funcaddr}
6384 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
6385 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
6386 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
6387 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
6388 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
6389 (although the Pascal form also works).
6390
6391 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
6392 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
6393
6394 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
6395 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
6396 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
6397 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
6398 functions with identical names in different source files.
6399 @end table
6400
6401 @end table
6402
6403
6404 @node Edit
6405 @section Editing Source Files
6406 @cindex editing source files
6407
6408 @kindex edit
6409 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
6410 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
6411 The editing program of your choice
6412 is invoked with the current line set to
6413 the active line in the program.
6414 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
6415 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
6416
6417 @table @code
6418 @item edit @var{location}
6419 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
6420 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
6421 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
6422 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
6423 command most commonly used:
6424
6425 @table @code
6426 @item edit @var{number}
6427 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
6428
6429 @item edit @var{function}
6430 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
6431 @end table
6432
6433 @end table
6434
6435 @subsection Choosing your Editor
6436 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
6437 @footnote{
6438 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
6439 following command-line syntax:
6440 @smallexample
6441 ex +@var{number} file
6442 @end smallexample
6443 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
6444 the file where to start editing.}.
6445 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
6446 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
6447 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
6448 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
6449 @smallexample
6450 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
6451 export EDITOR
6452 gdb @dots{}
6453 @end smallexample
6454 or in the @code{csh} shell,
6455 @smallexample
6456 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
6457 gdb @dots{}
6458 @end smallexample
6459
6460 @node Search
6461 @section Searching Source Files
6462 @cindex searching source files
6463
6464 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
6465 regular expression.
6466
6467 @table @code
6468 @kindex search
6469 @kindex forward-search
6470 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
6471 @itemx search @var{regexp}
6472 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
6473 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
6474 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
6475 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
6476 @code{fo}.
6477
6478 @kindex reverse-search
6479 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
6480 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
6481 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
6482 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
6483 this command as @code{rev}.
6484 @end table
6485
6486 @node Source Path
6487 @section Specifying Source Directories
6488
6489 @cindex source path
6490 @cindex directories for source files
6491 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
6492 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
6493 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
6494 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
6495 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
6496 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
6497 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
6498
6499 For example, suppose an executable references the file
6500 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
6501 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
6502 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
6503 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
6504 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
6505 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
6506 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
6507 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
6508 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
6509 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
6510
6511 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
6512 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
6513 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
6514 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
6515 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
6516 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
6517
6518 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
6519 source files.
6520
6521 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
6522 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
6523 each line is in the file.
6524
6525 @kindex directory
6526 @kindex dir
6527 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
6528 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
6529 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
6530
6531 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
6532 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
6533
6534 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
6535 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
6536 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
6537 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
6538 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
6539 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
6540 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
6541 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
6542 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
6543 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
6544 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
6545 name to look up the sources.
6546
6547 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
6548 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
6549 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
6550 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
6551 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
6552 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
6553 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
6554 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
6555
6556 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
6557 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
6558 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
6559 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
6560 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
6561 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
6562 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
6563
6564 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
6565 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
6566 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
6567 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
6568 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
6569 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
6570 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
6571 command.
6572
6573 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
6574 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
6575 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
6576 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
6577 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
6578 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
6579 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
6580
6581 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
6582 @cindex default source path substitution
6583 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
6584 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
6585 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
6586 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
6587 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
6588 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
6589 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
6590 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
6591 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
6592 together.
6593
6594 @table @code
6595 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
6596 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
6597 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
6598 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
6599 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
6600 part of absolute file names) or
6601 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
6602 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
6603
6604 @kindex cdir
6605 @kindex cwd
6606 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
6607 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
6608 @cindex compilation directory
6609 @cindex current directory
6610 @cindex working directory
6611 @cindex directory, current
6612 @cindex directory, compilation
6613 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
6614 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
6615 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
6616 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
6617 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
6618 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
6619
6620 @item directory
6621 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
6622
6623 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
6624 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
6625
6626 @item set directories @var{path-list}
6627 @kindex set directories
6628 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
6629 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
6630
6631 @item show directories
6632 @kindex show directories
6633 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
6634
6635 @anchor{set substitute-path}
6636 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
6637 @kindex set substitute-path
6638 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
6639 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
6640 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
6641
6642 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
6643 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
6644
6645 @smallexample
6646 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
6647 @end smallexample
6648
6649 @noindent
6650 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
6651 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
6652 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
6653
6654 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
6655 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
6656 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
6657 the substitution.
6658
6659 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
6660
6661 @smallexample
6662 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
6663 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
6664 @end smallexample
6665
6666 @noindent
6667 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
6668 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
6669 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
6670 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
6671
6672
6673 @item unset substitute-path [path]
6674 @kindex unset substitute-path
6675 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
6676 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
6677 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
6678
6679 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
6680
6681 @item show substitute-path [path]
6682 @kindex show substitute-path
6683 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
6684 which would rewrite that path, if any.
6685
6686 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
6687 rules.
6688
6689 @end table
6690
6691 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
6692 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
6693 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
6694
6695 @enumerate
6696 @item
6697 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
6698
6699 @item
6700 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
6701 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
6702 directories in one command.
6703 @end enumerate
6704
6705 @node Machine Code
6706 @section Source and Machine Code
6707 @cindex source line and its code address
6708
6709 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
6710 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
6711 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
6712 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
6713 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6714 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
6715 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
6716 well as hex.
6717
6718 @table @code
6719 @kindex info line
6720 @item info line @var{linespec}
6721 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
6722 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
6723 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
6724 @end table
6725
6726 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
6727 the object code for the first line of function
6728 @code{m4_changequote}:
6729
6730 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
6731 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
6732 @smallexample
6733 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
6734 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
6735 @end smallexample
6736
6737 @noindent
6738 @cindex code address and its source line
6739 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
6740 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
6741 @smallexample
6742 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
6743 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
6744 @end smallexample
6745
6746 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
6747 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
6748 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
6749 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
6750 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
6751 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
6752 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
6753 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6754 Variables}).
6755
6756 @table @code
6757 @kindex disassemble
6758 @cindex assembly instructions
6759 @cindex instructions, assembly
6760 @cindex machine instructions
6761 @cindex listing machine instructions
6762 @item disassemble
6763 @itemx disassemble /m
6764 @itemx disassemble /r
6765 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
6766 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
6767 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
6768 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
6769 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
6770 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
6771 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
6772 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
6773 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
6774 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
6775
6776 @table @code
6777 @item @var{start},@var{end}
6778 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
6779 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
6780 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
6781 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
6782 @end table
6783
6784 @noindent
6785 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
6786 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
6787
6788 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
6789 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
6790
6791 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
6792 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
6793 @end table
6794
6795 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
6796 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
6797
6798 @smallexample
6799 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
6800 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
6801 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
6802 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
6803 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6804 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
6805 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
6806 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
6807 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
6808 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6809 End of assembler dump.
6810 @end smallexample
6811
6812 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
6813 program is stopped just after function prologue:
6814
6815 @smallexample
6816 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
6817 Dump of assembler code for function main:
6818 5 @{
6819 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
6820 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
6821 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
6822 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
6823 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
6824
6825 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
6826 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
6827 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
6828
6829 7 return 0;
6830 8 @}
6831 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
6832 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
6833 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
6834
6835 End of assembler dump.
6836 @end smallexample
6837
6838 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
6839
6840 @smallexample
6841 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
6842 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
6843 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
6844 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
6845 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
6846 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
6847 End of assembler dump.
6848 @end smallexample
6849
6850 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
6851 mnemonics or other syntax.
6852
6853 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
6854 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
6855 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
6856 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
6857 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
6858
6859 @table @code
6860 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
6861 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
6862 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
6863 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
6864 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
6865 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
6866
6867 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
6868 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
6869 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
6870 assemblers for x86-based targets.
6871
6872 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
6873 @item show disassembly-flavor
6874 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
6875 @end table
6876
6877 @table @code
6878 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
6879 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
6880 @item set disassemble-next-line
6881 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
6882 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
6883 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
6884 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
6885 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
6886 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
6887 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
6888 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
6889 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
6890 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
6891 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
6892 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
6893 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
6894 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
6895 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
6896 instruction.
6897 @end table
6898
6899
6900 @node Data
6901 @chapter Examining Data
6902
6903 @cindex printing data
6904 @cindex examining data
6905 @kindex print
6906 @kindex inspect
6907 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
6908 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
6909 @c different window or something like that.
6910 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
6911 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
6912 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
6913 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
6914 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
6915 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
6916
6917 @table @code
6918 @item print @var{expr}
6919 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
6920 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
6921 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
6922 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
6923 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
6924 Formats}.
6925
6926 @item print
6927 @itemx print /@var{f}
6928 @cindex reprint the last value
6929 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
6930 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
6931 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
6932 @end table
6933
6934 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
6935 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
6936 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6937
6938 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
6939 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
6940 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
6941 Table}.
6942
6943 @menu
6944 * Expressions:: Expressions
6945 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
6946 * Variables:: Program variables
6947 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
6948 * Output Formats:: Output formats
6949 * Memory:: Examining memory
6950 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
6951 * Print Settings:: Print settings
6952 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
6953 * Value History:: Value history
6954 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
6955 * Registers:: Registers
6956 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
6957 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
6958 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
6959 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
6960 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
6961 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
6962 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
6963 character set than GDB does
6964 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
6965 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
6966 @end menu
6967
6968 @node Expressions
6969 @section Expressions
6970
6971 @cindex expressions
6972 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
6973 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
6974 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
6975 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
6976 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
6977 you compiled your program to include this information; see
6978 @ref{Compilation}.
6979
6980 @cindex arrays in expressions
6981 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
6982 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
6983 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
6984 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
6985 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
6986 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
6987
6988 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
6989 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
6990 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
6991 languages.
6992
6993 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
6994 expressions regardless of your programming language.
6995
6996 @cindex casts, in expressions
6997 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
6998 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
6999 at that address in memory.
7000 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
7001
7002 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
7003 to programming languages:
7004
7005 @table @code
7006 @item @@
7007 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
7008 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
7009
7010 @item ::
7011 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
7012 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
7013
7014 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
7015 @cindex type casting memory
7016 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
7017 @cindex casts, to view memory
7018 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
7019 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
7020 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
7021 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
7022 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
7023 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
7024 @end table
7025
7026 @node Ambiguous Expressions
7027 @section Ambiguous Expressions
7028 @cindex ambiguous expressions
7029
7030 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
7031 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
7032 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
7033 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
7034 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
7035 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
7036 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
7037
7038 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
7039 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
7040 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
7041 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
7042 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
7043 as well.
7044
7045 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
7046 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
7047 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
7048 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
7049 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
7050 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
7051 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
7052 choices.
7053
7054 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
7055 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
7056 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
7057
7058 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
7059 @smallexample
7060 @group
7061 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
7062 [0] cancel
7063 [1] all
7064 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
7065 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
7066 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
7067 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
7068 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
7069 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
7070 > 2 4 6
7071 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
7072 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
7073 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
7074 Multiple breakpoints were set.
7075 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
7076 breakpoints.
7077 (@value{GDBP})
7078 @end group
7079 @end smallexample
7080
7081 @table @code
7082 @kindex set multiple-symbols
7083 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
7084 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
7085
7086 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
7087 is ambiguous.
7088
7089 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
7090 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
7091 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
7092 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
7093 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
7094 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
7095 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
7096 in the use of the menu.
7097
7098 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
7099 when an ambiguity is detected.
7100
7101 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
7102 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
7103
7104 @kindex show multiple-symbols
7105 @item show multiple-symbols
7106 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
7107 @end table
7108
7109 @node Variables
7110 @section Program Variables
7111
7112 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
7113 in your program.
7114
7115 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
7116 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
7117
7118 @itemize @bullet
7119 @item
7120 global (or file-static)
7121 @end itemize
7122
7123 @noindent or
7124
7125 @itemize @bullet
7126 @item
7127 visible according to the scope rules of the
7128 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
7129 @end itemize
7130
7131 @noindent This means that in the function
7132
7133 @smallexample
7134 foo (a)
7135 int a;
7136 @{
7137 bar (a);
7138 @{
7139 int b = test ();
7140 bar (b);
7141 @}
7142 @}
7143 @end smallexample
7144
7145 @noindent
7146 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
7147 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
7148 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
7149 the block where @code{b} is declared.
7150
7151 @cindex variable name conflict
7152 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
7153 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
7154 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
7155 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
7156 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
7157 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
7158 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
7159
7160 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
7161 @ifnotinfo
7162 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
7163 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
7164 @end ifnotinfo
7165 @smallexample
7166 @var{file}::@var{variable}
7167 @var{function}::@var{variable}
7168 @end smallexample
7169
7170 @noindent
7171 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
7172 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
7173 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
7174 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
7175
7176 @smallexample
7177 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
7178 @end smallexample
7179
7180 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
7181 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
7182 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
7183 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
7184 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
7185 @c conflict?? --mew
7186
7187 @cindex wrong values
7188 @cindex variable values, wrong
7189 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
7190 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
7191 @quotation
7192 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
7193 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
7194 scope, and just before exit.
7195 @end quotation
7196 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
7197 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
7198 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
7199 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
7200 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
7201 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
7202 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
7203 variable definitions may be gone.
7204
7205 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
7206 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
7207 when compiling.
7208
7209 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
7210 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
7211 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
7212 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
7213 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
7214 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
7215 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
7216
7217 @smallexample
7218 No symbol "foo" in current context.
7219 @end smallexample
7220
7221 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
7222 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
7223 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
7224 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
7225 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
7226 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
7227 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
7228 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
7229 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
7230 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
7231 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
7232
7233 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
7234 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
7235 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
7236 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
7237
7238 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
7239 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
7240 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
7241 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
7242 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
7243 For program code
7244
7245 @smallexample
7246 char var0[] = "A";
7247 signed char var1[] = "A";
7248 @end smallexample
7249
7250 You get during debugging
7251 @smallexample
7252 (gdb) print var0
7253 $1 = "A"
7254 (gdb) print var1
7255 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
7256 @end smallexample
7257
7258 @node Arrays
7259 @section Artificial Arrays
7260
7261 @cindex artificial array
7262 @cindex arrays
7263 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
7264 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
7265 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
7266 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
7267 program.
7268
7269 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
7270 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
7271 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
7272 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
7273 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
7274 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
7275 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
7276 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
7277 example. If a program says
7278
7279 @smallexample
7280 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
7281 @end smallexample
7282
7283 @noindent
7284 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
7285
7286 @smallexample
7287 p *array@@len
7288 @end smallexample
7289
7290 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
7291 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
7292 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
7293 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
7294 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
7295
7296 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
7297 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
7298 The value need not be in memory:
7299 @smallexample
7300 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
7301 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
7302 @end smallexample
7303
7304 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
7305 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
7306 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
7307 @smallexample
7308 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
7309 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
7310 @end smallexample
7311
7312 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
7313 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
7314 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
7315 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
7316 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7317 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
7318 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
7319 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
7320 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
7321 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
7322
7323 @smallexample
7324 set $i = 0
7325 p dtab[$i++]->fv
7326 @key{RET}
7327 @key{RET}
7328 @dots{}
7329 @end smallexample
7330
7331 @node Output Formats
7332 @section Output Formats
7333
7334 @cindex formatted output
7335 @cindex output formats
7336 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
7337 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
7338 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
7339 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
7340 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
7341
7342 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
7343 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
7344 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
7345 letters supported are:
7346
7347 @table @code
7348 @item x
7349 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
7350 hexadecimal.
7351
7352 @item d
7353 Print as integer in signed decimal.
7354
7355 @item u
7356 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
7357
7358 @item o
7359 Print as integer in octal.
7360
7361 @item t
7362 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
7363 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
7364 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
7365 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
7366
7367 @item a
7368 @cindex unknown address, locating
7369 @cindex locate address
7370 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
7371 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
7372 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
7373
7374 @smallexample
7375 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
7376 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
7377 @end smallexample
7378
7379 @noindent
7380 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
7381 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
7382
7383 @item c
7384 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
7385 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
7386 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
7387 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
7388
7389 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
7390 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
7391 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
7392 data.
7393
7394 @item f
7395 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
7396 using typical floating point syntax.
7397
7398 @item s
7399 @cindex printing strings
7400 @cindex printing byte arrays
7401 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
7402 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
7403 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
7404 natural types.
7405
7406 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
7407 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
7408 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
7409 array.
7410
7411 @item r
7412 @cindex raw printing
7413 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
7414 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
7415 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
7416 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
7417 pretty-printer which might exist.
7418 @end table
7419
7420 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
7421
7422 @smallexample
7423 p/x $pc
7424 @end smallexample
7425
7426 @noindent
7427 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
7428 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
7429
7430 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
7431 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
7432 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
7433
7434 @node Memory
7435 @section Examining Memory
7436
7437 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
7438 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
7439
7440 @cindex examining memory
7441 @table @code
7442 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
7443 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
7444 @itemx x @var{addr}
7445 @itemx x
7446 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
7447 @end table
7448
7449 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
7450 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
7451 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
7452 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
7453 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
7454
7455 @table @r
7456 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
7457 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
7458 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
7459 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
7460 @c 4.1.2.
7461
7462 @item @var{f}, the display format
7463 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
7464 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
7465 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
7466 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
7467 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
7468
7469 @item @var{u}, the unit size
7470 The unit size is any of
7471
7472 @table @code
7473 @item b
7474 Bytes.
7475 @item h
7476 Halfwords (two bytes).
7477 @item w
7478 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
7479 @item g
7480 Giant words (eight bytes).
7481 @end table
7482
7483 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
7484 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
7485 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
7486 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
7487 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
7488 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
7489 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
7490 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
7491 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
7492 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
7493 be altered.
7494
7495 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
7496 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
7497 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
7498 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
7499 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
7500 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
7501 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
7502 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
7503 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
7504 a value from memory).
7505 @end table
7506
7507 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
7508 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
7509 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
7510 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
7511 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
7512
7513 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
7514 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
7515 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
7516 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
7517 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
7518
7519 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
7520 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
7521 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
7522 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
7523 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
7524 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
7525 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
7526 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
7527 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
7528
7529 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
7530 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
7531 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
7532 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
7533 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
7534 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
7535 for successive uses of @code{x}.
7536
7537 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
7538 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
7539
7540 @smallexample
7541 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
7542 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
7543 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
7544 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
7545 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
7546 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
7547 @end smallexample
7548
7549 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
7550 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
7551 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
7552 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
7553 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
7554 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
7555 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
7556 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
7557 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
7558
7559 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
7560 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
7561 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
7562
7563 @cindex remote memory comparison
7564 @cindex verify remote memory image
7565 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
7566 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
7567 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
7568 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
7569 situations.
7570
7571 @table @code
7572 @kindex compare-sections
7573 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
7574 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
7575 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
7576 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
7577 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
7578 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
7579 remote request.
7580 @end table
7581
7582 @node Auto Display
7583 @section Automatic Display
7584 @cindex automatic display
7585 @cindex display of expressions
7586
7587 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
7588 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
7589 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
7590 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
7591 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
7592 The automatic display looks like this:
7593
7594 @smallexample
7595 2: foo = 38
7596 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
7597 @end smallexample
7598
7599 @noindent
7600 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
7601 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
7602 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
7603 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
7604 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
7605 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
7606
7607 @table @code
7608 @kindex display
7609 @item display @var{expr}
7610 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
7611 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
7612
7613 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
7614
7615 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
7616 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
7617 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
7618 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
7619 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
7620
7621 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
7622 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
7623 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
7624 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
7625 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
7626 @end table
7627
7628 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
7629 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
7630 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
7631
7632 @table @code
7633 @kindex delete display
7634 @kindex undisplay
7635 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
7636 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7637 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
7638
7639 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
7640 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
7641
7642 @kindex disable display
7643 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7644 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
7645 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
7646 enabled again later.
7647
7648 @kindex enable display
7649 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7650 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
7651 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
7652
7653 @item display
7654 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
7655 done when your program stops.
7656
7657 @kindex info display
7658 @item info display
7659 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
7660 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
7661 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
7662 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
7663 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
7664 @end table
7665
7666 @cindex display disabled out of scope
7667 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
7668 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
7669 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
7670 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
7671 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
7672 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
7673 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
7674 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
7675 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
7676 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
7677
7678 @node Print Settings
7679 @section Print Settings
7680
7681 @cindex format options
7682 @cindex print settings
7683 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
7684 and symbols are printed.
7685
7686 @noindent
7687 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
7688
7689 @table @code
7690 @kindex set print
7691 @item set print address
7692 @itemx set print address on
7693 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
7694 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
7695 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
7696 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
7697 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
7698 @code{set print address on}:
7699
7700 @smallexample
7701 @group
7702 (@value{GDBP}) f
7703 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
7704 at input.c:530
7705 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7706 @end group
7707 @end smallexample
7708
7709 @item set print address off
7710 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
7711 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
7712
7713 @smallexample
7714 @group
7715 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
7716 (@value{GDBP}) f
7717 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
7718 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7719 @end group
7720 @end smallexample
7721
7722 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
7723 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
7724 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
7725 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
7726
7727 @kindex show print
7728 @item show print address
7729 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
7730 @end table
7731
7732 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
7733 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
7734 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
7735 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
7736 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
7737 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
7738 it prints a symbolic address:
7739
7740 @table @code
7741 @item set print symbol-filename on
7742 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
7743 @cindex symbol, source file and line
7744 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
7745 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7746
7747 @item set print symbol-filename off
7748 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
7749 default.
7750
7751 @item show print symbol-filename
7752 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
7753 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7754 @end table
7755
7756 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
7757 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
7758 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
7759
7760 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
7761 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
7762
7763 @table @code
7764 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
7765 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
7766 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
7767 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
7768 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
7769 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
7770
7771 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
7772 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
7773 symbolic address.
7774 @end table
7775
7776 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
7777 @cindex pointer, finding referent
7778 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
7779 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
7780 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
7781 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
7782 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
7783 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
7784
7785 @smallexample
7786 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
7787 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
7788 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
7789 @end smallexample
7790
7791 @quotation
7792 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
7793 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
7794 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
7795 @end quotation
7796
7797 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
7798
7799 @table @code
7800 @item set print array
7801 @itemx set print array on
7802 @cindex pretty print arrays
7803 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
7804 but uses more space. The default is off.
7805
7806 @item set print array off
7807 Return to compressed format for arrays.
7808
7809 @item show print array
7810 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
7811 arrays.
7812
7813 @cindex print array indexes
7814 @item set print array-indexes
7815 @itemx set print array-indexes on
7816 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
7817 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
7818 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
7819
7820 @item set print array-indexes off
7821 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
7822
7823 @item show print array-indexes
7824 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
7825 arrays.
7826
7827 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
7828 @cindex number of array elements to print
7829 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
7830 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
7831 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
7832 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
7833 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
7834 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
7835 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
7836
7837 @item show print elements
7838 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
7839 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
7840
7841 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
7842 @kindex set print frame-arguments
7843 @cindex printing frame argument values
7844 @cindex print all frame argument values
7845 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
7846 @cindex do not print frame argument values
7847 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
7848 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
7849 values are:
7850
7851 @table @code
7852 @item all
7853 The values of all arguments are printed.
7854
7855 @item scalars
7856 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
7857 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
7858 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
7859 only scalar arguments are shown:
7860
7861 @smallexample
7862 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
7863 at frame-args.c:23
7864 @end smallexample
7865
7866 @item none
7867 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
7868 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
7869
7870 @smallexample
7871 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
7872 at frame-args.c:23
7873 @end smallexample
7874 @end table
7875
7876 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
7877 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
7878 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
7879 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
7880 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
7881 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
7882 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
7883 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
7884 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
7885 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
7886
7887 @item show print frame-arguments
7888 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
7889
7890 @item set print repeats
7891 @cindex repeated array elements
7892 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
7893 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
7894 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
7895 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
7896 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
7897 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
7898 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
7899
7900 @item show print repeats
7901 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
7902 elements.
7903
7904 @item set print null-stop
7905 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
7906 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
7907 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
7908 contain only short strings.
7909 The default is off.
7910
7911 @item show print null-stop
7912 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
7913 @sc{null} character.
7914
7915 @item set print pretty on
7916 @cindex print structures in indented form
7917 @cindex indentation in structure display
7918 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
7919 per line, like this:
7920
7921 @smallexample
7922 @group
7923 $1 = @{
7924 next = 0x0,
7925 flags = @{
7926 sweet = 1,
7927 sour = 1
7928 @},
7929 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
7930 @}
7931 @end group
7932 @end smallexample
7933
7934 @item set print pretty off
7935 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
7936
7937 @smallexample
7938 @group
7939 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
7940 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
7941 @end group
7942 @end smallexample
7943
7944 @noindent
7945 This is the default format.
7946
7947 @item show print pretty
7948 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
7949
7950 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
7951 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
7952 @cindex octal escapes in strings
7953 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
7954 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
7955 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
7956 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
7957 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
7958
7959 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
7960 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
7961 international character sets, and is the default.
7962
7963 @item show print sevenbit-strings
7964 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
7965
7966 @item set print union on
7967 @cindex unions in structures, printing
7968 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
7969 and other unions. This is the default setting.
7970
7971 @item set print union off
7972 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
7973 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
7974 instead.
7975
7976 @item show print union
7977 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
7978 structures and other unions.
7979
7980 For example, given the declarations
7981
7982 @smallexample
7983 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
7984 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
7985 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
7986 Bug_forms;
7987
7988 struct thing @{
7989 Species it;
7990 union @{
7991 Tree_forms tree;
7992 Bug_forms bug;
7993 @} form;
7994 @};
7995
7996 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
7997 @end smallexample
7998
7999 @noindent
8000 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
8001
8002 @smallexample
8003 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
8004 @end smallexample
8005
8006 @noindent
8007 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
8008
8009 @smallexample
8010 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
8011 @end smallexample
8012
8013 @noindent
8014 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
8015 and in Pascal.
8016 @end table
8017
8018 @need 1000
8019 @noindent
8020 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
8021
8022 @table @code
8023 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
8024 @item set print demangle
8025 @itemx set print demangle on
8026 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
8027 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
8028 linkage. The default is on.
8029
8030 @item show print demangle
8031 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
8032
8033 @item set print asm-demangle
8034 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
8035 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
8036 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
8037 The default is off.
8038
8039 @item show print asm-demangle
8040 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
8041 or demangled form.
8042
8043 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
8044 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
8045 @kindex set demangle-style
8046 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
8047 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
8048 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
8049
8050 @table @code
8051 @item auto
8052 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
8053
8054 @item gnu
8055 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
8056 This is the default.
8057
8058 @item hp
8059 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
8060
8061 @item lucid
8062 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
8063
8064 @item arm
8065 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
8066 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
8067 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
8068 require further enhancement to permit that.
8069
8070 @end table
8071 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
8072
8073 @item show demangle-style
8074 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
8075
8076 @item set print object
8077 @itemx set print object on
8078 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
8079 @cindex display derived types
8080 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
8081 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
8082 the virtual function table.
8083
8084 @item set print object off
8085 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
8086 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
8087
8088 @item show print object
8089 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
8090
8091 @item set print static-members
8092 @itemx set print static-members on
8093 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
8094 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
8095
8096 @item set print static-members off
8097 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
8098
8099 @item show print static-members
8100 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
8101
8102 @item set print pascal_static-members
8103 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
8104 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
8105 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
8106 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
8107
8108 @item set print pascal_static-members off
8109 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
8110
8111 @item show print pascal_static-members
8112 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
8113
8114 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
8115 @item set print vtbl
8116 @itemx set print vtbl on
8117 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
8118 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
8119 @cindex VTBL display
8120 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
8121 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
8122 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
8123
8124 @item set print vtbl off
8125 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
8126
8127 @item show print vtbl
8128 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
8129 @end table
8130
8131 @node Pretty Printing
8132 @section Pretty Printing
8133
8134 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
8135 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
8136 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
8137
8138 @menu
8139 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
8140 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
8141 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
8142 @end menu
8143
8144 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
8145 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
8146
8147 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
8148 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
8149 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
8150
8151 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
8152 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
8153 pretty-printers with their names.
8154 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
8155 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
8156 Each such subprinter has its own name.
8157 The format of the name is @var{printer-name}:@var{subprinter-name}.
8158
8159 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
8160 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
8161 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
8162 do anything special.
8163
8164 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
8165
8166 @itemize @bullet
8167 @item
8168 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
8169 all inferiors.
8170
8171 @item
8172 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
8173 when debugging that program.
8174 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
8175
8176 @item
8177 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
8178 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
8179 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
8180 @end itemize
8181
8182 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
8183 pretty-printers are selected,
8184
8185 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
8186 for new types.
8187
8188 @node Pretty-Printer Example
8189 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
8190
8191 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
8192
8193 @smallexample
8194 (@value{GDBP}) print s
8195 $1 = @{
8196 static npos = 4294967295,
8197 _M_dataplus = @{
8198 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
8199 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
8200 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
8201 @},
8202 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
8203 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
8204 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
8205 @}
8206 @}
8207 @end smallexample
8208
8209 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
8210
8211 @smallexample
8212 (@value{GDBP}) print s
8213 $2 = "abcd"
8214 @end smallexample
8215
8216 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
8217 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
8218 @cindex pretty-printer commands
8219
8220 @table @code
8221 @kindex info pretty-printer
8222 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
8223 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
8224 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
8225
8226 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
8227 whose pretty-printers to list.
8228 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
8229 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
8230 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
8231 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
8232 looks up a printer from these three objects.
8233
8234 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
8235 to list.
8236
8237 @kindex disable pretty-printer
8238 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
8239 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
8240 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
8241
8242 @kindex enable pretty-printer
8243 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
8244 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
8245 @end table
8246
8247 Example:
8248
8249 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
8250 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
8251 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
8252 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
8253
8254 @smallexample
8255 (gdb) info pretty-printer
8256 library1.so:
8257 foo
8258 library2.so:
8259 bar
8260 bar1
8261 bar2
8262 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
8263 library2.so:
8264 bar
8265 bar1
8266 bar2
8267 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
8268 1 printer disabled
8269 2 of 3 printers enabled
8270 (gdb) info pretty-printer
8271 library1.so:
8272 foo [disabled]
8273 library2.so:
8274 bar
8275 bar1
8276 bar2
8277 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
8278 1 printer disabled
8279 1 of 3 printers enabled
8280 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
8281 library1.so:
8282 foo [disabled]
8283 library2.so:
8284 bar
8285 bar1 [disabled]
8286 bar2
8287 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
8288 1 printer disabled
8289 0 of 3 printers enabled
8290 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
8291 library1.so:
8292 foo [disabled]
8293 library2.so:
8294 bar [disabled]
8295 bar1 [disabled]
8296 bar2
8297 @end smallexample
8298
8299 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
8300 as can each individual subprinter.
8301
8302 @node Value History
8303 @section Value History
8304
8305 @cindex value history
8306 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
8307 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
8308 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
8309 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
8310 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
8311 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
8312 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
8313 symbol table.
8314
8315 @cindex @code{$}
8316 @cindex @code{$$}
8317 @cindex history number
8318 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
8319 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
8320 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
8321 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
8322 history number.
8323
8324 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
8325 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
8326 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
8327 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
8328 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
8329 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
8330 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
8331
8332 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
8333 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
8334
8335 @smallexample
8336 p *$
8337 @end smallexample
8338
8339 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
8340 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
8341
8342 @smallexample
8343 p *$.next
8344 @end smallexample
8345
8346 @noindent
8347 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
8348 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
8349
8350 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
8351 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
8352
8353 @smallexample
8354 print x
8355 set x=5
8356 @end smallexample
8357
8358 @noindent
8359 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
8360 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
8361
8362 @table @code
8363 @kindex show values
8364 @item show values
8365 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
8366 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
8367 values} does not change the history.
8368
8369 @item show values @var{n}
8370 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
8371
8372 @item show values +
8373 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
8374 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
8375 @end table
8376
8377 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
8378 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
8379
8380 @node Convenience Vars
8381 @section Convenience Variables
8382
8383 @cindex convenience variables
8384 @cindex user-defined variables
8385 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
8386 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
8387 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
8388 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
8389 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
8390
8391 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
8392 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
8393 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
8394 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
8395 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
8396
8397 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
8398 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
8399 For example:
8400
8401 @smallexample
8402 set $foo = *object_ptr
8403 @end smallexample
8404
8405 @noindent
8406 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
8407 @code{object_ptr}.
8408
8409 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
8410 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
8411 value with another assignment at any time.
8412
8413 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
8414 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
8415 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
8416 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
8417
8418 @table @code
8419 @kindex show convenience
8420 @cindex show all user variables
8421 @item show convenience
8422 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
8423 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
8424
8425 @kindex init-if-undefined
8426 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
8427 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
8428 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
8429 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
8430 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
8431 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
8432 override default values used in a command script.
8433
8434 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
8435 any side-effects do not occur.
8436 @end table
8437
8438 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
8439 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
8440 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
8441
8442 @smallexample
8443 set $i = 0
8444 print bar[$i++]->contents
8445 @end smallexample
8446
8447 @noindent
8448 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
8449
8450 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
8451 values likely to be useful.
8452
8453 @table @code
8454 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
8455 @item $_
8456 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
8457 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
8458 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
8459 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
8460 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
8461 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
8462 to the type of @code{$__}.
8463
8464 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
8465 @item $__
8466 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
8467 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
8468 to match the format in which the data was printed.
8469
8470 @item $_exitcode
8471 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
8472 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
8473 the program being debugged terminates.
8474
8475 @item $_sdata
8476 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
8477 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
8478 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
8479 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
8480 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
8481
8482 @item $_siginfo
8483 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
8484 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
8485 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
8486 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
8487 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
8488
8489 @item $_tlb
8490 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
8491 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
8492 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
8493 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
8494 @xref{General Query Packets}.
8495 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
8496
8497 @end table
8498
8499 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
8500 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
8501 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
8502
8503 @cindex convenience functions
8504 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
8505 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
8506 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
8507 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
8508 @value{GDBN}.
8509
8510 @table @code
8511 @item help function
8512 @kindex help function
8513 @cindex show all convenience functions
8514 Print a list of all convenience functions.
8515 @end table
8516
8517 @node Registers
8518 @section Registers
8519
8520 @cindex registers
8521 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
8522 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
8523 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
8524 your machine.
8525
8526 @table @code
8527 @kindex info registers
8528 @item info registers
8529 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
8530 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
8531
8532 @kindex info all-registers
8533 @cindex floating point registers
8534 @item info all-registers
8535 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
8536 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
8537
8538 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
8539 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
8540 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
8541 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
8542 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
8543 @end table
8544
8545 @cindex stack pointer register
8546 @cindex program counter register
8547 @cindex process status register
8548 @cindex frame pointer register
8549 @cindex standard registers
8550 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
8551 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
8552 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
8553 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
8554 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
8555 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
8556 register that contains the processor status. For example,
8557 you could print the program counter in hex with
8558
8559 @smallexample
8560 p/x $pc
8561 @end smallexample
8562
8563 @noindent
8564 or print the instruction to be executed next with
8565
8566 @smallexample
8567 x/i $pc
8568 @end smallexample
8569
8570 @noindent
8571 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
8572 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
8573 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
8574 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
8575 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
8576 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
8577 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
8578
8579 @smallexample
8580 set $sp += 4
8581 @end smallexample
8582
8583 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
8584 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
8585 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
8586 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
8587 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
8588 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
8589 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
8590
8591 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
8592 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
8593 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
8594 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
8595 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
8596 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
8597 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
8598
8599 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
8600 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
8601 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
8602 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
8603 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
8604 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
8605 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
8606 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
8607 prints the data in both formats.
8608
8609 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
8610 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
8611 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
8612 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
8613 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
8614 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
8615 registers in @code{struct} notation:
8616
8617 @smallexample
8618 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
8619 $1 = @{
8620 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
8621 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
8622 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
8623 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
8624 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
8625 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
8626 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
8627 @}
8628 @end smallexample
8629
8630 @noindent
8631 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
8632 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
8633 value to a @code{struct} member:
8634
8635 @smallexample
8636 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
8637 @end smallexample
8638
8639 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
8640 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
8641 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
8642 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
8643 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
8644 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
8645
8646 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
8647 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
8648 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
8649 frame makes no difference.
8650
8651 @node Floating Point Hardware
8652 @section Floating Point Hardware
8653 @cindex floating point
8654
8655 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
8656 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
8657
8658 @table @code
8659 @kindex info float
8660 @item info float
8661 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
8662 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
8663 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
8664 the ARM and x86 machines.
8665 @end table
8666
8667 @node Vector Unit
8668 @section Vector Unit
8669 @cindex vector unit
8670
8671 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
8672 more information about the status of the vector unit.
8673
8674 @table @code
8675 @kindex info vector
8676 @item info vector
8677 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
8678 layout vary depending on the hardware.
8679 @end table
8680
8681 @node OS Information
8682 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
8683 @cindex OS information
8684
8685 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
8686 you debug your program.
8687
8688 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
8689 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
8690 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
8691 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
8692 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
8693 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
8694 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
8695 structure.
8696
8697 @table @code
8698 @item info udot
8699 @kindex info udot
8700 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
8701 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
8702 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
8703 the @code{examine} command.
8704 @end table
8705
8706 @cindex auxiliary vector
8707 @cindex vector, auxiliary
8708 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
8709 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
8710 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
8711 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
8712 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
8713 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
8714 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
8715 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
8716 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
8717 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
8718 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
8719
8720 @table @code
8721 @kindex info auxv
8722 @item info auxv
8723 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
8724 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
8725 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
8726 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
8727 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
8728 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
8729 an unrecognized tag.
8730 @end table
8731
8732 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating-system-specific information
8733 and display it to user, without interpretation. For remote targets,
8734 this functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
8735 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
8736
8737 @table @code
8738 @kindex info os
8739 @item info os
8740 List the types of OS information available for the target. If the
8741 target does not return a list of possible types, this command will
8742 report an error.
8743
8744 @kindex info os processes
8745 @item info os processes
8746 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
8747 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, and
8748 the command corresponding to the process.
8749 @end table
8750
8751 @node Memory Region Attributes
8752 @section Memory Region Attributes
8753 @cindex memory region attributes
8754
8755 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
8756 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
8757 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
8758 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
8759 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
8760 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
8761 user can override the fetched regions.
8762
8763 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
8764 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
8765 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
8766 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
8767 all memory.
8768
8769 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
8770 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
8771
8772 @table @code
8773 @kindex mem
8774 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
8775 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
8776 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
8777 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
8778 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
8779 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
8780
8781 @item mem auto
8782 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
8783 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
8784
8785 @kindex delete mem
8786 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8787 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
8788 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
8789
8790 @kindex disable mem
8791 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8792 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
8793 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
8794 It may be enabled again later.
8795
8796 @kindex enable mem
8797 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
8798 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
8799
8800 @kindex info mem
8801 @item info mem
8802 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
8803 for each region:
8804
8805 @table @emph
8806 @item Memory Region Number
8807 @item Enabled or Disabled.
8808 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
8809 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
8810
8811 @item Lo Address
8812 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
8813
8814 @item Hi Address
8815 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
8816
8817 @item Attributes
8818 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
8819 @end table
8820 @end table
8821
8822
8823 @subsection Attributes
8824
8825 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
8826 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
8827 write accesses to a memory region.
8828
8829 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
8830 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
8831 etc.@: from accessing memory.
8832
8833 @table @code
8834 @item ro
8835 Memory is read only.
8836 @item wo
8837 Memory is write only.
8838 @item rw
8839 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
8840 @end table
8841
8842 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
8843 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
8844 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
8845 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
8846 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
8847
8848 @table @code
8849 @item 8
8850 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
8851 @item 16
8852 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
8853 @item 32
8854 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
8855 @item 64
8856 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
8857 @end table
8858
8859 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
8860 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
8861 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
8862 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
8863 @c
8864 @c @table @code
8865 @c @item hwbreak
8866 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
8867 @c @item swbreak (default)
8868 @c @end table
8869
8870 @subsubsection Data Cache
8871 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
8872 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
8873 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
8874 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
8875 registers.
8876
8877 @table @code
8878 @item cache
8879 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
8880 @item nocache
8881 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
8882 @end table
8883
8884 @subsection Memory Access Checking
8885 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
8886 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
8887 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
8888 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
8889
8890 @table @code
8891 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
8892 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
8893 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
8894 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
8895 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
8896 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
8897 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
8898 The default value is @code{on}.
8899 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
8900 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
8901 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
8902 @end table
8903
8904
8905 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
8906 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
8907 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
8908 @c
8909 @c @table @code
8910 @c @item verify
8911 @c @item noverify (default)
8912 @c @end table
8913
8914 @node Dump/Restore Files
8915 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
8916 @cindex dump/restore files
8917 @cindex append data to a file
8918 @cindex dump data to a file
8919 @cindex restore data from a file
8920
8921 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
8922 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
8923 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
8924 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
8925 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
8926 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
8927 files.
8928
8929 @table @code
8930
8931 @kindex dump
8932 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
8933 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
8934 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
8935 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
8936
8937 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
8938 @table @code
8939 @item binary
8940 Raw binary form.
8941 @item ihex
8942 Intel hex format.
8943 @item srec
8944 Motorola S-record format.
8945 @item tekhex
8946 Tektronix Hex format.
8947 @end table
8948
8949 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
8950 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
8951 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
8952 form.
8953
8954 @kindex append
8955 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
8956 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
8957 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
8958 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
8959 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
8960
8961 @kindex restore
8962 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
8963 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
8964 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
8965 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
8966 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
8967
8968 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
8969 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
8970 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
8971 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
8972 from that location.
8973
8974 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
8975 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
8976 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
8977 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
8978
8979 @end table
8980
8981 @node Core File Generation
8982 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
8983 @cindex dump core from inferior
8984
8985 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
8986 image of a running process and its process status (register values
8987 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
8988 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
8989 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
8990 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
8991 the post-mortem debugging mode.
8992
8993 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
8994 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
8995 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
8996
8997 @table @code
8998 @kindex gcore
8999 @kindex generate-core-file
9000 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
9001 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
9002 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
9003 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
9004 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
9005 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
9006
9007 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
9008 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
9009 @end table
9010
9011 @node Character Sets
9012 @section Character Sets
9013 @cindex character sets
9014 @cindex charset
9015 @cindex translating between character sets
9016 @cindex host character set
9017 @cindex target character set
9018
9019 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
9020 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
9021 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
9022 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
9023 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
9024 @dfn{target character set}.
9025
9026 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
9027 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
9028 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
9029 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
9030 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
9031 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
9032 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
9033 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
9034 character and string literals in expressions.
9035
9036 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
9037 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
9038 target-charset} command, described below.
9039
9040 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
9041 support:
9042
9043 @table @code
9044 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
9045 @kindex set target-charset
9046 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
9047 list of supported target character sets, type
9048 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
9049
9050 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
9051 @kindex set host-charset
9052 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
9053
9054 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
9055 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
9056 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
9057 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
9058 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
9059
9060 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
9061 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
9062 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
9063
9064 @item set charset @var{charset}
9065 @kindex set charset
9066 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
9067 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
9068 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
9069 for both host and target.
9070
9071 @item show charset
9072 @kindex show charset
9073 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
9074
9075 @item show host-charset
9076 @kindex show host-charset
9077 Show the name of the current host character set.
9078
9079 @item show target-charset
9080 @kindex show target-charset
9081 Show the name of the current target character set.
9082
9083 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
9084 @kindex set target-wide-charset
9085 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
9086 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
9087 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
9088 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
9089
9090 @item show target-wide-charset
9091 @kindex show target-wide-charset
9092 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
9093 @end table
9094
9095 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
9096 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
9097 @file{charset-test.c}:
9098
9099 @smallexample
9100 #include <stdio.h>
9101
9102 char ascii_hello[]
9103 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
9104 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
9105 char ibm1047_hello[]
9106 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
9107 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
9108
9109 main ()
9110 @{
9111 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9112 @}
9113 @end smallexample
9114
9115 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
9116 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
9117 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
9118
9119 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
9120
9121 @smallexample
9122 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
9123 $ gdb -nw charset-test
9124 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
9125 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
9126 @dots{}
9127 (@value{GDBP})
9128 @end smallexample
9129
9130 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
9131 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
9132 strings:
9133
9134 @smallexample
9135 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
9136 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
9137 (@value{GDBP})
9138 @end smallexample
9139
9140 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
9141 initial character set:
9142 @smallexample
9143 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
9144 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
9145 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
9146 (@value{GDBP})
9147 @end smallexample
9148
9149 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
9150 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
9151 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
9152 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
9153 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
9154
9155 @smallexample
9156 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
9157 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
9158 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
9159 $2 = 72 'H'
9160 (@value{GDBP})
9161 @end smallexample
9162
9163 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
9164 literals you use in expressions:
9165
9166 @smallexample
9167 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
9168 $3 = 43 '+'
9169 (@value{GDBP})
9170 @end smallexample
9171
9172 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
9173 character.
9174
9175 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
9176 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
9177 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
9178
9179 @smallexample
9180 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
9181 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
9182 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
9183 $5 = 200 '\310'
9184 (@value{GDBP})
9185 @end smallexample
9186
9187 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
9188 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
9189
9190 @smallexample
9191 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
9192 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
9193 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
9194 @end smallexample
9195
9196 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
9197 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
9198 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
9199 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
9200 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
9201
9202 @smallexample
9203 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
9204 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
9205 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
9206 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
9207 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
9208 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
9209 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
9210 $7 = 72 '\110'
9211 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
9212 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
9213 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
9214 $9 = 200 'H'
9215 (@value{GDBP})
9216 @end smallexample
9217
9218 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
9219 string literals you use in expressions:
9220
9221 @smallexample
9222 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
9223 $10 = 78 '+'
9224 (@value{GDBP})
9225 @end smallexample
9226
9227 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
9228 character.
9229
9230 @node Caching Remote Data
9231 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
9232 @cindex caching data of remote targets
9233
9234 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a
9235 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
9236 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
9237 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately, simply
9238 caching everything would lead to incorrect results, since @value{GDBN}
9239 does not necessarily know anything about volatile values, memory-mapped I/O
9240 addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode})
9241 memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command is executing.
9242 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
9243 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
9244 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
9245 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
9246 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.}.
9247 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
9248 cacheable; see @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
9249
9250 @table @code
9251 @kindex set remotecache
9252 @item set remotecache on
9253 @itemx set remotecache off
9254 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
9255 with old scripts.
9256
9257 @kindex show remotecache
9258 @item show remotecache
9259 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
9260
9261 @kindex set stack-cache
9262 @item set stack-cache on
9263 @itemx set stack-cache off
9264 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{ON}, use
9265 caching. By default, this option is @code{ON}.
9266
9267 @kindex show stack-cache
9268 @item show stack-cache
9269 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
9270
9271 @kindex info dcache
9272 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
9273 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
9274 information displayed includes the dcache width and depth, and for
9275 each cache line, its number, address, and how many times it was
9276 referenced. This command is useful for debugging the data cache
9277 operation.
9278
9279 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
9280 printed in hex.
9281 @end table
9282
9283 @node Searching Memory
9284 @section Search Memory
9285 @cindex searching memory
9286
9287 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
9288 @code{find} command.
9289
9290 @table @code
9291 @kindex find
9292 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
9293 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
9294 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
9295 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
9296 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
9297 @end table
9298
9299 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
9300 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
9301
9302 @table @r
9303 @item @var{s}, search query size
9304 The size of each search query value.
9305
9306 @table @code
9307 @item b
9308 bytes
9309 @item h
9310 halfwords (two bytes)
9311 @item w
9312 words (four bytes)
9313 @item g
9314 giant words (eight bytes)
9315 @end table
9316
9317 All values are interpreted in the current language.
9318 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
9319 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
9320
9321 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
9322 value's type in the current language.
9323 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
9324 pattern as a mixture of types.
9325 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
9326 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
9327 which is typically four bytes.
9328
9329 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
9330 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
9331 @end table
9332
9333 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
9334 (@code{"}).
9335 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
9336 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
9337
9338 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
9339 number of matches found.
9340
9341 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
9342 @samp{$_}.
9343 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
9344
9345 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
9346
9347 @smallexample
9348 void
9349 hello ()
9350 @{
9351 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
9352 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
9353 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
9354 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
9355 printf ("%s\n", hello);
9356 @}
9357 @end smallexample
9358
9359 @noindent
9360 you get during debugging:
9361
9362 @smallexample
9363 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
9364 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
9365 1 pattern found
9366 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
9367 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
9368 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
9369 2 patterns found
9370 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
9371 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
9372 1 pattern found
9373 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
9374 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
9375 1 pattern found
9376 (gdb) print $numfound
9377 $1 = 1
9378 (gdb) print $_
9379 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
9380 @end smallexample
9381
9382 @node Optimized Code
9383 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
9384 @cindex optimized code, debugging
9385 @cindex debugging optimized code
9386
9387 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
9388 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
9389 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
9390 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
9391 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
9392 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
9393 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
9394
9395 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
9396 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
9397 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
9398 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
9399
9400 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
9401 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
9402 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
9403 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
9404 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
9405 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
9406
9407 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
9408 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
9409 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
9410 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
9411 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
9412
9413 @menu
9414 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
9415 @end menu
9416
9417 @node Inline Functions
9418 @section Inline Functions
9419 @cindex inline functions, debugging
9420
9421 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
9422 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
9423 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
9424 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
9425 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
9426 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
9427 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
9428 @code{info frame} command.
9429
9430 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
9431 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
9432 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
9433 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
9434 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
9435 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
9436 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
9437 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
9438 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
9439 local variables in the caller.
9440
9441 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
9442 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
9443 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
9444 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
9445 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
9446 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
9447 instructions are executed.
9448
9449 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
9450 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
9451 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
9452 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
9453
9454 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
9455 function calls are the same as normal calls:
9456
9457 @itemize @bullet
9458 @item
9459 You cannot set breakpoints on inlined functions. @value{GDBN}
9460 either reports that there is no symbol with that name, or else sets the
9461 breakpoint only on non-inlined copies of the function. This limitation
9462 will be removed in a future version of @value{GDBN}; until then,
9463 set a breakpoint by line number on the first line of the inlined
9464 function instead.
9465
9466 @item
9467 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
9468 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
9469 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
9470 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
9471 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
9472 or inside the inlined function instead.
9473
9474 @item
9475 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
9476 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
9477 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
9478 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
9479
9480 @end itemize
9481
9482
9483 @node Macros
9484 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
9485
9486 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
9487 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
9488 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
9489 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
9490 where it was defined.
9491
9492 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
9493 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
9494 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
9495 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
9496
9497 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
9498 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
9499 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
9500 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
9501 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
9502 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
9503 see @ref{List}.
9504
9505 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
9506 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
9507 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
9508
9509 @table @code
9510
9511 @kindex macro expand
9512 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
9513 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
9514 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
9515 @item macro expand @var{expression}
9516 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
9517 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
9518 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
9519 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
9520 it can be any string of tokens.
9521
9522 @kindex macro exp1
9523 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
9524 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
9525 @cindex expand macro once
9526 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
9527 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
9528 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
9529 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
9530 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
9531 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
9532 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
9533 can be any string of tokens.
9534
9535 @kindex info macro
9536 @cindex macro definition, showing
9537 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
9538 @item info macro @var{macro}
9539 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
9540 source location or compiler command-line where that definition was established.
9541
9542 @kindex macro define
9543 @cindex user-defined macros
9544 @cindex defining macros interactively
9545 @cindex macros, user-defined
9546 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
9547 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
9548 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
9549 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
9550 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
9551 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
9552 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
9553 @var{arglist}.
9554
9555 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
9556 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
9557 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
9558 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
9559 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
9560
9561 @kindex macro undef
9562 @item macro undef @var{macro}
9563 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
9564 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
9565 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
9566 in the program being debugged.
9567
9568 @kindex macro list
9569 @item macro list
9570 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
9571 @end table
9572
9573 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
9574 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
9575 show our source files:
9576
9577 @smallexample
9578 $ cat sample.c
9579 #include <stdio.h>
9580 #include "sample.h"
9581
9582 #define M 42
9583 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
9584
9585 main ()
9586 @{
9587 #define N 28
9588 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9589 #undef N
9590 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9591 #define N 1729
9592 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
9593 @}
9594 $ cat sample.h
9595 #define Q <
9596 $
9597 @end smallexample
9598
9599 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
9600 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
9601 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
9602 information.
9603
9604 @smallexample
9605 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
9606 $
9607 @end smallexample
9608
9609 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
9610
9611 @smallexample
9612 $ gdb -nw sample
9613 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
9614 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
9615 GDB is free software, @dots{}
9616 (@value{GDBP})
9617 @end smallexample
9618
9619 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
9620 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
9621 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
9622
9623 @smallexample
9624 (@value{GDBP}) list main
9625 3
9626 4 #define M 42
9627 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
9628 6
9629 7 main ()
9630 8 @{
9631 9 #define N 28
9632 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9633 11 #undef N
9634 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9635 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
9636 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
9637 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
9638 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
9639 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
9640 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
9641 #define Q <
9642 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
9643 expands to: (42 + 1)
9644 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
9645 expands to: once (M + 1)
9646 (@value{GDBP})
9647 @end smallexample
9648
9649 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
9650 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
9651 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
9652 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
9653
9654 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
9655 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
9656
9657 @smallexample
9658 (@value{GDBP}) break main
9659 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
9660 (@value{GDBP}) run
9661 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
9662
9663 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
9664 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9665 (@value{GDBP})
9666 @end smallexample
9667
9668 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
9669
9670 @smallexample
9671 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9672 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
9673 #define N 28
9674 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
9675 expands to: 28 < 42
9676 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
9677 $1 = 1
9678 (@value{GDBP})
9679 @end smallexample
9680
9681 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
9682 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
9683 thereof) in force at each point:
9684
9685 @smallexample
9686 (@value{GDBP}) next
9687 Hello, world!
9688 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
9689 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9690 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
9691 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
9692 (@value{GDBP}) next
9693 We're so creative.
9694 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
9695 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
9696 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
9697 #define N 1729
9698 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
9699 expands to: 1729 < 42
9700 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
9701 $2 = 0
9702 (@value{GDBP})
9703 @end smallexample
9704
9705 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
9706 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
9707 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
9708 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
9709
9710 @smallexample
9711 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
9712 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
9713 -D__STDC__=1
9714 (@value{GDBP})
9715 @end smallexample
9716
9717
9718 @node Tracepoints
9719 @chapter Tracepoints
9720 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
9721 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
9722
9723 @cindex tracepoints
9724 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
9725 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
9726 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
9727 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
9728 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
9729 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
9730 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
9731
9732 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
9733 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
9734 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
9735 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
9736 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
9737 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
9738 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
9739 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
9740 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
9741 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
9742 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
9743
9744 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
9745 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
9746 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
9747 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
9748 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
9749 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
9750 Packets}.
9751
9752 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
9753 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
9754 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
9755
9756 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
9757
9758 @menu
9759 * Set Tracepoints::
9760 * Analyze Collected Data::
9761 * Tracepoint Variables::
9762 * Trace Files::
9763 @end menu
9764
9765 @node Set Tracepoints
9766 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
9767
9768 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
9769 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
9770 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
9771 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
9772 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
9773 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
9774 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
9775
9776 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
9777 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
9778 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
9779 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
9780 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
9781 tracepoint was hit.
9782
9783 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
9784 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
9785 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
9786 either.
9787
9788 @cindex fast tracepoints
9789 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
9790 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
9791 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
9792
9793 @cindex static tracepoints
9794 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
9795 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
9796 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
9797 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
9798 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
9799 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
9800 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
9801 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
9802 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
9803 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
9804 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
9805 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
9806 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
9807 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namelly, support for collecting
9808 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
9809 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
9810 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
9811 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
9812 static tracepoint marker.
9813
9814 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
9815 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
9816
9817 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
9818 conditions and actions.
9819
9820 @menu
9821 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
9822 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
9823 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
9824 * Tracepoint Conditions::
9825 * Trace State Variables::
9826 * Tracepoint Actions::
9827 * Listing Tracepoints::
9828 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
9829 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
9830 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
9831 @end menu
9832
9833 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
9834 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
9835
9836 @table @code
9837 @cindex set tracepoint
9838 @kindex trace
9839 @item trace @var{location}
9840 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
9841 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
9842 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
9843 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
9844 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
9845 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
9846 changing its actions doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
9847 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
9848 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts.
9849
9850 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
9851
9852 @smallexample
9853 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
9854
9855 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
9856
9857 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
9858
9859 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
9860
9861 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
9862 @end smallexample
9863
9864 @noindent
9865 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
9866
9867 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
9868 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
9869 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
9870 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
9871 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
9872 information on tracepoint conditions.
9873
9874 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
9875 @cindex set fast tracepoint
9876 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
9877 @kindex ftrace
9878 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
9879 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
9880 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
9881 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
9882 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
9883 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
9884 message.
9885
9886 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
9887 @code{trace}.
9888
9889 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
9890 @cindex set static tracepoint
9891 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
9892 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
9893 @kindex strace
9894 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
9895 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
9896 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
9897 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
9898 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
9899
9900 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
9901 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
9902 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
9903 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
9904 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
9905 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
9906 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
9907 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
9908 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
9909 tracing engine:
9910
9911 @smallexample
9912 main ()
9913 @{
9914 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
9915 @}
9916 @end smallexample
9917
9918 @noindent
9919 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
9920 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
9921
9922 @smallexample
9923 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
9924 Cnt Enb ID Address What
9925 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
9926 Data: "str %s"
9927 [etc...]
9928 @end smallexample
9929
9930 @noindent
9931 so you may probe the marker above with:
9932
9933 @smallexample
9934 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
9935 @end smallexample
9936
9937 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
9938 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
9939 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
9940 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
9941 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
9942 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
9943 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
9944 the @samp{Data:} field.
9945
9946 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
9947 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
9948 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
9949
9950 @vindex $tpnum
9951 @cindex last tracepoint number
9952 @cindex recent tracepoint number
9953 @cindex tracepoint number
9954 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
9955 of the most recently set tracepoint.
9956
9957 @kindex delete tracepoint
9958 @cindex tracepoint deletion
9959 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9960 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
9961 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
9962 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
9963
9964 Examples:
9965
9966 @smallexample
9967 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
9968
9969 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
9970 @end smallexample
9971
9972 @noindent
9973 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
9974 @end table
9975
9976 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
9977 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
9978
9979 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
9980
9981 @table @code
9982 @kindex disable tracepoint
9983 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9984 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
9985 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
9986 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
9987 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
9988
9989 @kindex enable tracepoint
9990 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
9991 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
9992 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
9993 run.
9994 @end table
9995
9996 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
9997 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
9998
9999 @table @code
10000 @kindex passcount
10001 @cindex tracepoint pass count
10002 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
10003 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
10004 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
10005 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
10006 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
10007 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
10008 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
10009 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
10010 user.
10011
10012 Examples:
10013
10014 @smallexample
10015 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
10016 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
10017
10018 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
10019 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
10020 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
10021 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
10022 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
10023 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
10024 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
10025 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
10026 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
10027 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
10028 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
10029 @end smallexample
10030 @end table
10031
10032 @node Tracepoint Conditions
10033 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
10034 @cindex conditional tracepoints
10035 @cindex tracepoint conditions
10036
10037 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
10038 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
10039 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
10040 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
10041 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
10042 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
10043 is true.
10044
10045 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
10046 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
10047 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
10048 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
10049 just as with breakpoints.
10050
10051 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
10052 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
10053 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions}
10054 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
10055 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
10056 accesses, and so forth.
10057
10058 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
10059 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
10060 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
10061 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
10062 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
10063 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
10064 search through.
10065
10066 @smallexample
10067 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
10068 @end smallexample
10069
10070 @node Trace State Variables
10071 @subsection Trace State Variables
10072 @cindex trace state variables
10073
10074 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
10075 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
10076 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
10077 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
10078 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
10079 integers.
10080
10081 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
10082 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
10083 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
10084 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
10085
10086 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
10087 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
10088 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
10089 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
10090 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
10091 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
10092 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
10093 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
10094 variable with the same name.
10095
10096 @table @code
10097
10098 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
10099 @kindex tvariable
10100 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
10101 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
10102 @var{expression}. @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
10103 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
10104 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
10105 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
10106 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
10107 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
10108 value. The default initial value is 0.
10109
10110 @item info tvariables
10111 @kindex info tvariables
10112 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
10113 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
10114 currently running.
10115
10116 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
10117 @kindex delete tvariable
10118 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
10119 are specified.
10120
10121 @end table
10122
10123 @node Tracepoint Actions
10124 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
10125
10126 @table @code
10127 @kindex actions
10128 @cindex tracepoint actions
10129 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
10130 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
10131 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
10132 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
10133 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
10134 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
10135 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
10136 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
10137 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
10138 @code{while-stepping}.
10139
10140 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
10141 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
10142 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
10143
10144 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
10145 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
10146 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
10147
10148 @smallexample
10149 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
10150
10151 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
10152
10153 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
10154 @end smallexample
10155
10156 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
10157 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
10158 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
10159 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
10160 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
10161 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
10162 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
10163 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
10164
10165 @smallexample
10166 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
10167 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
10168 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
10169 > collect bar,baz
10170 > collect $regs
10171 > while-stepping 12
10172 > collect $pc, arr[i]
10173 > end
10174 end
10175 @end smallexample
10176
10177 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
10178 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
10179 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
10180 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
10181 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
10182 special arguments are supported:
10183
10184 @table @code
10185 @item $regs
10186 Collect all registers.
10187
10188 @item $args
10189 Collect all function arguments.
10190
10191 @item $locals
10192 Collect all local variables.
10193
10194 @item $_sdata
10195 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
10196 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
10197 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
10198 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
10199 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
10200 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
10201 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
10202 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
10203 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
10204
10205 @smallexample
10206 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
10207 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
10208 @end smallexample
10209
10210 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
10211 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
10212 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
10213 @value{GDBN}.
10214 @end table
10215
10216 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
10217 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
10218 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
10219
10220 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
10221 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
10222
10223 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
10224 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
10225 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
10226 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
10227 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
10228 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
10229 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
10230 action were used.
10231
10232 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
10233 @item while-stepping @var{n}
10234 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
10235 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
10236 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
10237 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
10238
10239 @smallexample
10240 > while-stepping 12
10241 > collect $regs, myglobal
10242 > end
10243 >
10244 @end smallexample
10245
10246 @noindent
10247 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
10248 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
10249 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
10250 @code{stepping}.
10251
10252 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
10253 @kindex set default-collect
10254 @cindex default collection action
10255 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
10256 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
10257 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
10258 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
10259 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
10260 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
10261
10262 @item show default-collect
10263 @kindex show default-collect
10264 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
10265 tracepoint hit.
10266
10267 @end table
10268
10269 @node Listing Tracepoints
10270 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
10271
10272 @table @code
10273 @kindex info tracepoints
10274 @kindex info tp
10275 @cindex information about tracepoints
10276 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
10277 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
10278 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
10279 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
10280 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
10281 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
10282
10283 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
10284 tracing:
10285
10286 @itemize @bullet
10287 @item
10288 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
10289 @end itemize
10290
10291 @smallexample
10292 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
10293 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
10294 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
10295 while-stepping 20
10296 collect globfoo, $regs
10297 end
10298 collect globfoo2
10299 end
10300 pass count 1200
10301 (@value{GDBP})
10302 @end smallexample
10303
10304 @noindent
10305 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
10306 @end table
10307
10308 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
10309 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
10310
10311 @table @code
10312 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
10313 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
10314 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
10315 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
10316 program.
10317
10318 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
10319
10320 @table @emph
10321 @item Count
10322 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
10323 stable identifier.
10324 @item ID
10325 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
10326 @item Enabled or Disabled
10327 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
10328 that are not enabled.
10329 @item Address
10330 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
10331 @item What
10332 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
10333 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
10334 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
10335 will be left blank.
10336 @end table
10337
10338 @noindent
10339 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
10340
10341 @table @emph
10342 @item Data
10343 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
10344 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
10345 marker call.
10346 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
10347 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
10348 @end table
10349
10350 @smallexample
10351 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
10352 Cnt ID Enb Address What
10353 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
10354 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
10355 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
10356 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
10357 Data: str %s
10358 (@value{GDBP})
10359 @end smallexample
10360 @end table
10361
10362 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
10363 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
10364
10365 @table @code
10366 @kindex tstart
10367 @cindex start a new trace experiment
10368 @cindex collected data discarded
10369 @item tstart
10370 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
10371 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
10372 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
10373 experiment.
10374
10375 @kindex tstop
10376 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
10377 @item tstop
10378 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
10379 stops collecting data.
10380
10381 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
10382 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
10383 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
10384
10385 @kindex tstatus
10386 @cindex status of trace data collection
10387 @cindex trace experiment, status of
10388 @item tstatus
10389 This command displays the status of the current trace data
10390 collection.
10391 @end table
10392
10393 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
10394
10395 @smallexample
10396 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
10397 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
10398 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
10399 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
10400 > while-stepping 11
10401 > collect $regs
10402 > end
10403 > end
10404 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
10405 [time passes @dots{}]
10406 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
10407 @end smallexample
10408
10409 @cindex disconnected tracing
10410 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
10411 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
10412 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
10413 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
10414 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
10415 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
10416 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
10417 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
10418
10419 @table @code
10420 @item set disconnected-tracing on
10421 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
10422 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
10423 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
10424 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
10425 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
10426 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
10427 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
10428
10429 @item show disconnected-tracing
10430 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
10431 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
10432
10433 @end table
10434
10435 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
10436 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
10437 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
10438 it will continue after reconnection.
10439
10440 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
10441 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
10442 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
10443 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
10444 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
10445 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
10446 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
10447 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
10448 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
10449 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
10450
10451 @cindex circular trace buffer
10452 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
10453 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
10454 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
10455 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
10456 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
10457 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
10458 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
10459 @samp{circular_trace_buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
10460 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
10461 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
10462 the next run.
10463
10464 @table @code
10465 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
10466 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
10467 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
10468 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
10469 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
10470 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
10471 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
10472
10473 @item show circular-trace-buffer
10474 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
10475 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
10476 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
10477 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
10478 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
10479
10480 @end table
10481
10482 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
10483 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
10484
10485 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
10486 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
10487 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
10488 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
10489 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
10490 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
10491 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
10492 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
10493 mentioned here.
10494
10495 @itemize @bullet
10496
10497 @item
10498 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
10499 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
10500 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
10501 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
10502 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
10503 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
10504 cannot be collected either.
10505
10506 @item
10507 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
10508 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
10509 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
10510 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
10511 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
10512 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
10513 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
10514 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
10515 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
10516 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
10517
10518 @item
10519 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
10520 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
10521 in a misleading way.
10522
10523 @item
10524 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
10525 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
10526 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
10527 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
10528 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
10529 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
10530 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
10531 by @code{ptr}.
10532
10533 @item
10534 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
10535 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
10536 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*$esp@@300}
10537 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
10538 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
10539 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
10540 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
10541 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
10542 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
10543 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
10544 invalid address.
10545
10546 @item
10547 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
10548 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
10549 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
10550 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
10551 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
10552 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
10553 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
10554 it to zero.
10555
10556 @end itemize
10557
10558 @node Analyze Collected Data
10559 @section Using the Collected Data
10560
10561 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
10562 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
10563 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
10564 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
10565 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
10566 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
10567 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
10568 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
10569 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
10570 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
10571 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
10572 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
10573 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
10574 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
10575 the buffer will fail.
10576
10577 @menu
10578 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
10579 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
10580 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
10581 @end menu
10582
10583 @node tfind
10584 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
10585
10586 @kindex tfind
10587 @cindex select trace snapshot
10588 @cindex find trace snapshot
10589 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
10590 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
10591 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
10592 snapshot is selected.
10593
10594 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
10595
10596 @table @code
10597 @item tfind start
10598 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
10599 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
10600
10601 @item tfind none
10602 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
10603
10604 @item tfind end
10605 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
10606
10607 @item tfind
10608 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
10609
10610 @item tfind -
10611 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
10612 retracing earlier steps.
10613
10614 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
10615 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
10616 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
10617 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
10618 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
10619
10620 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
10621 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
10622 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
10623 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
10624 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
10625
10626 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
10627 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
10628 addresses (exclusive).
10629
10630 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
10631 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
10632 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
10633
10634 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
10635 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
10636 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
10637 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
10638 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
10639 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
10640 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
10641 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
10642 @end table
10643
10644 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
10645 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
10646 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
10647 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
10648 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
10649 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
10650 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
10651 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
10652 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
10653 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
10654 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
10655 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
10656 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
10657 tracepoint as the current one.
10658
10659 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
10660 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
10661 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
10662 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
10663 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
10664
10665 @smallexample
10666 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
10667 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
10668 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
10669 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
10670 > tfind
10671 > end
10672
10673 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
10674 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
10675 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
10676 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
10677 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
10678 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
10679 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
10680 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
10681 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
10682 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
10683 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
10684 @end smallexample
10685
10686 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
10687 the buffer:
10688
10689 @smallexample
10690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
10691 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
10692 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
10693 > tfind line
10694 > end
10695
10696 Frame 0, X = 1
10697 Frame 7, X = 2
10698 Frame 13, X = 255
10699 @end smallexample
10700
10701 @node tdump
10702 @subsection @code{tdump}
10703 @kindex tdump
10704 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
10705 @cindex tracepoint data, display
10706
10707 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
10708 the current trace snapshot.
10709
10710 @smallexample
10711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
10712 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
10713 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
10714 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
10715 > end
10716
10717 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
10718
10719 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
10720 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
10721 at gdb_test.c:444
10722 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
10723
10724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
10725 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
10726 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
10727 d1 0x18 24
10728 d2 0x80 128
10729 d3 0x33 51
10730 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
10731 d5 0x22 34
10732 d6 0xe0 224
10733 d7 0x380035 3670069
10734 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
10735 a1 0x3000668 50333288
10736 a2 0x100 256
10737 a3 0x322000 3284992
10738 a4 0x3000698 50333336
10739 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
10740 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
10741 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
10742 ps 0x0 0
10743 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
10744 fpcontrol 0x0 0
10745 fpstatus 0x0 0
10746 fpiaddr 0x0 0
10747 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
10748 p1 = (void *) 0x11
10749 p2 = (void *) 0x22
10750 p3 = (void *) 0x33
10751 p4 = (void *) 0x44
10752 p5 = (void *) 0x55
10753 p6 = (void *) 0x66
10754 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
10755
10756 (@value{GDBP})
10757 @end smallexample
10758
10759 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
10760 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
10761 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
10762 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
10763
10764 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
10765 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
10766 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
10767 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
10768 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
10769 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
10770 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
10771 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
10772 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
10773 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
10774
10775 @node save tracepoints
10776 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
10777 @kindex save tracepoints
10778 @kindex save-tracepoints
10779 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
10780
10781 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
10782 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
10783 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
10784 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
10785 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
10786 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
10787
10788 @node Tracepoint Variables
10789 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
10790 @cindex tracepoint variables
10791 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
10792
10793 @table @code
10794 @vindex $trace_frame
10795 @item (int) $trace_frame
10796 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
10797 snapshot is selected.
10798
10799 @vindex $tracepoint
10800 @item (int) $tracepoint
10801 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
10802
10803 @vindex $trace_line
10804 @item (int) $trace_line
10805 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
10806
10807 @vindex $trace_file
10808 @item (char []) $trace_file
10809 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
10810
10811 @vindex $trace_func
10812 @item (char []) $trace_func
10813 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
10814 @end table
10815
10816 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
10817 use @code{output} instead.
10818
10819 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
10820 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
10821 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
10822 which are managed by the target.
10823
10824 @smallexample
10825 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
10826
10827 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
10828 > output $trace_file
10829 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
10830 > tfind
10831 > end
10832 @end smallexample
10833
10834 @node Trace Files
10835 @section Using Trace Files
10836 @cindex trace files
10837
10838 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
10839 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
10840 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
10841 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
10842 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
10843
10844 @table @code
10845
10846 @kindex tsave
10847 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
10848 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
10849 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
10850 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
10851 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
10852 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
10853 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
10854 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
10855 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
10856
10857 @kindex target tfile
10858 @kindex tfile
10859 @item target tfile @var{filename}
10860 Use the file named @var{filename} as a source of trace data. Commands
10861 that examine data work as they do with a live target, but it is not
10862 possible to run any new trace experiments. @code{tstatus} will report
10863 the state of the trace run at the moment the data was saved, as well
10864 as the current trace frame you are examining. @var{filename} must be
10865 on a filesystem accessible to the host.
10866
10867 @end table
10868
10869 @node Overlays
10870 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
10871 @cindex overlays
10872
10873 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
10874 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
10875 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
10876 use overlays.
10877
10878 @menu
10879 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
10880 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
10881 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
10882 mapped by asking the inferior.
10883 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
10884 @end menu
10885
10886 @node How Overlays Work
10887 @section How Overlays Work
10888 @cindex mapped overlays
10889 @cindex unmapped overlays
10890 @cindex load address, overlay's
10891 @cindex mapped address
10892 @cindex overlay area
10893
10894 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
10895 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
10896 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
10897 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
10898 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
10899
10900 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
10901 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
10902 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
10903 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
10904 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
10905 largest overlay as well.
10906
10907 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
10908 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
10909 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
10910 there.
10911
10912 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
10913 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
10914 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
10915
10916 @smallexample
10917 @group
10918 Data Instruction Larger
10919 Address Space Address Space Address Space
10920 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
10921 | | | | | |
10922 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
10923 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
10924 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
10925 | and heap | | | | | |
10926 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
10927 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
10928 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
10929 | | | | | |
10930 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
10931 address | | | | | |
10932 | overlay | <-' | | |
10933 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
10934 | | <---. | | load address
10935 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
10936 | | | |
10937 +-----------+ | |
10938 +-----------+
10939 | |
10940 +-----------+
10941
10942 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
10943 @end group
10944 @end smallexample
10945
10946 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
10947 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
10948 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
10949 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
10950 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
10951 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
10952 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
10953 program and the overlay area.
10954
10955 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
10956 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
10957 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
10958 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
10959 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
10960 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
10961 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
10962
10963 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
10964 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
10965 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
10966
10967 @itemize @bullet
10968
10969 @item
10970 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
10971 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
10972 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
10973 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
10974
10975 @item
10976 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
10977 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
10978 your program's performance.
10979
10980 @item
10981 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
10982 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
10983 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
10984 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
10985 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
10986 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
10987 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
10988
10989 @item
10990 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
10991 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
10992 instruction and data spaces.
10993
10994 @end itemize
10995
10996 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
10997 improved in many ways:
10998
10999 @itemize @bullet
11000
11001 @item
11002 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
11003 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
11004 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
11005 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
11006 area in the usual way.
11007
11008 @item
11009 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
11010 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
11011
11012 @item
11013 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
11014 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
11015 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
11016 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
11017 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
11018 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
11019 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
11020
11021 @end itemize
11022
11023
11024 @node Overlay Commands
11025 @section Overlay Commands
11026
11027 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
11028 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
11029 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
11030 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
11031 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
11032 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
11033
11034 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
11035 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
11036
11037 @table @code
11038 @item overlay off
11039 @kindex overlay
11040 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
11041 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
11042 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
11043 overlay support is disabled.
11044
11045 @item overlay manual
11046 @cindex manual overlay debugging
11047 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
11048 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
11049 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
11050 commands described below.
11051
11052 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
11053 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
11054 @cindex map an overlay
11055 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
11056 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
11057 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
11058 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
11059 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
11060 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
11061
11062 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
11063 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
11064 @cindex unmap an overlay
11065 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
11066 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
11067 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
11068 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
11069
11070 @item overlay auto
11071 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
11072 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
11073 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
11074 Overlay Debugging}.
11075
11076 @item overlay load-target
11077 @itemx overlay load
11078 @cindex reloading the overlay table
11079 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
11080 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
11081 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
11082 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
11083 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
11084
11085 @item overlay list-overlays
11086 @itemx overlay list
11087 @cindex listing mapped overlays
11088 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
11089 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
11090
11091 @end table
11092
11093 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
11094 of the function the address falls in:
11095
11096 @smallexample
11097 (@value{GDBP}) print main
11098 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
11099 @end smallexample
11100 @noindent
11101 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
11102 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
11103 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
11104 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
11105
11106 @smallexample
11107 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
11108 No sections are mapped.
11109 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
11110 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
11111 @end smallexample
11112 @noindent
11113 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
11114 name normally:
11115
11116 @smallexample
11117 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
11118 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
11119 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
11120 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
11121 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
11122 @end smallexample
11123
11124 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
11125 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
11126 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
11127 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
11128 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
11129
11130 @itemize @bullet
11131 @item
11132 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
11133 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
11134 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
11135 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
11136 @item
11137 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
11138 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
11139 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
11140 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
11141 breakpoints properly.
11142 @end itemize
11143
11144
11145 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
11146 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
11147 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
11148
11149 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
11150 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
11151 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
11152 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
11153 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
11154 current state of the overlays.
11155
11156 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
11157 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
11158
11159 @table @asis
11160
11161 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
11162 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
11163
11164 @smallexample
11165 struct
11166 @{
11167 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
11168 unsigned long vma;
11169
11170 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
11171 unsigned long size;
11172
11173 /* The overlay's load address. */
11174 unsigned long lma;
11175
11176 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
11177 zero otherwise. */
11178 unsigned long mapped;
11179 @}
11180 @end smallexample
11181
11182 @item @code{_novlys}:
11183 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
11184 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
11185
11186 @end table
11187
11188 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
11189 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
11190 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
11191 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
11192 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
11193 currently mapped.
11194
11195 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
11196 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
11197 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
11198 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
11199 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
11200 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
11201 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
11202 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
11203 are not being executed.
11204
11205 @node Overlay Sample Program
11206 @section Overlay Sample Program
11207 @cindex overlay example program
11208
11209 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
11210 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
11211 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
11212 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
11213 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
11214 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
11215 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
11216
11217 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
11218 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
11219 suite. The program consists of the following files from
11220 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
11221
11222 @table @file
11223 @item overlays.c
11224 The main program file.
11225 @item ovlymgr.c
11226 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
11227 @item foo.c
11228 @itemx bar.c
11229 @itemx baz.c
11230 @itemx grbx.c
11231 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
11232 @item d10v.ld
11233 @itemx m32r.ld
11234 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
11235 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
11236 @end table
11237
11238 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
11239 cross-compiler like this:
11240
11241 @smallexample
11242 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
11243 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
11244 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
11245 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
11246 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
11247 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
11248 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
11249 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
11250 @end smallexample
11251
11252 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
11253 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
11254 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
11255
11256
11257 @node Languages
11258 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
11259 @cindex languages
11260
11261 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
11262 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
11263 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
11264 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
11265 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
11266 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
11267
11268 @cindex working language
11269 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
11270 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
11271 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
11272 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
11273 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
11274 language}.
11275
11276 @menu
11277 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
11278 * Show:: Displaying the language
11279 * Checks:: Type and range checks
11280 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
11281 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
11282 @end menu
11283
11284 @node Setting
11285 @section Switching Between Source Languages
11286
11287 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
11288 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
11289 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
11290 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
11291 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
11292 are printed, etc.
11293
11294 In addition to the working language, every source file that
11295 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
11296 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
11297 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
11298 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
11299 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
11300 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
11301 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
11302 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
11303 Displaying the Language}.
11304
11305 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
11306 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
11307 another language. In that case, make the
11308 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
11309 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
11310 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
11311
11312 @menu
11313 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
11314 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
11315 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
11316 @end menu
11317
11318 @node Filenames
11319 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
11320
11321 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
11322 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
11323
11324 @table @file
11325 @item .ada
11326 @itemx .ads
11327 @itemx .adb
11328 @itemx .a
11329 Ada source file.
11330
11331 @item .c
11332 C source file
11333
11334 @item .C
11335 @itemx .cc
11336 @itemx .cp
11337 @itemx .cpp
11338 @itemx .cxx
11339 @itemx .c++
11340 C@t{++} source file
11341
11342 @item .d
11343 D source file
11344
11345 @item .m
11346 Objective-C source file
11347
11348 @item .f
11349 @itemx .F
11350 Fortran source file
11351
11352 @item .mod
11353 Modula-2 source file
11354
11355 @item .s
11356 @itemx .S
11357 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
11358 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
11359 @end table
11360
11361 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
11362 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
11363
11364 @node Manually
11365 @subsection Setting the Working Language
11366
11367 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
11368 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
11369 your program.
11370
11371 @kindex set language
11372 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
11373 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
11374 a language, such as
11375 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
11376 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
11377
11378 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
11379 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
11380 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
11381 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
11382 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
11383 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
11384 command such as:
11385
11386 @smallexample
11387 print a = b + c
11388 @end smallexample
11389
11390 @noindent
11391 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
11392 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
11393 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
11394 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
11395
11396 @node Automatically
11397 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
11398
11399 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
11400 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
11401 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
11402 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
11403 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
11404 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
11405 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
11406 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
11407 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
11408
11409 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
11410 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
11411 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
11412 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
11413 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
11414
11415 @node Show
11416 @section Displaying the Language
11417
11418 The following commands help you find out which language is the
11419 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
11420
11421 @table @code
11422 @item show language
11423 @kindex show language
11424 Display the current working language. This is the
11425 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
11426 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
11427
11428 @item info frame
11429 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
11430 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
11431 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
11432 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
11433 information listed here.
11434
11435 @item info source
11436 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
11437 Display the source language of this source file.
11438 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
11439 information listed here.
11440 @end table
11441
11442 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
11443 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
11444 with a language explicitly:
11445
11446 @table @code
11447 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
11448 @kindex set extension-language
11449 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
11450 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
11451
11452 @item info extensions
11453 @kindex info extensions
11454 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
11455 @end table
11456
11457 @node Checks
11458 @section Type and Range Checking
11459
11460 @quotation
11461 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
11462 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
11463 section documents the intended facilities.
11464 @end quotation
11465 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
11466
11467 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
11468 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
11469 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
11470 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
11471 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
11472 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
11473 errors when your program is running.
11474
11475 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
11476 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
11477 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
11478 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
11479 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
11480 automatically based on your program's source language.
11481 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
11482 settings of supported languages.
11483
11484 @menu
11485 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
11486 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
11487 @end menu
11488
11489 @cindex type checking
11490 @cindex checks, type
11491 @node Type Checking
11492 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
11493
11494 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
11495 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
11496 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
11497 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
11498
11499 @smallexample
11500 1 + 2 @result{} 3
11501 @exdent but
11502 @error{} 1 + 2.3
11503 @end smallexample
11504
11505 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
11506 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
11507
11508 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
11509 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
11510 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
11511 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
11512 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
11513 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
11514 also issues a warning.
11515
11516 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
11517 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
11518 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
11519 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
11520 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
11521 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
11522
11523 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
11524 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
11525 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
11526 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
11527 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
11528 details on specific languages.
11529
11530 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
11531
11532 @kindex set check type
11533 @kindex show check type
11534 @table @code
11535 @item set check type auto
11536 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
11537 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
11538 each language.
11539
11540 @item set check type on
11541 @itemx set check type off
11542 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
11543 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
11544 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
11545 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
11546 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
11547
11548 @item set check type warn
11549 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
11550 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
11551 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
11552 numbers and structures.
11553
11554 @item show type
11555 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
11556 is setting it automatically.
11557 @end table
11558
11559 @cindex range checking
11560 @cindex checks, range
11561 @node Range Checking
11562 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
11563
11564 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
11565 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
11566 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
11567 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
11568 not exceed the bounds of the array.
11569
11570 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
11571 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
11572 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
11573 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
11574
11575 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
11576 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
11577 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
11578 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
11579 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
11580 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
11581
11582 @smallexample
11583 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
11584 @end smallexample
11585
11586 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
11587 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
11588 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
11589
11590 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
11591
11592 @kindex set check range
11593 @kindex show check range
11594 @table @code
11595 @item set check range auto
11596 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
11597 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
11598 each language.
11599
11600 @item set check range on
11601 @itemx set check range off
11602 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
11603 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
11604 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
11605 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
11606
11607 @item set check range warn
11608 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
11609 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
11610 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
11611 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
11612 systems).
11613
11614 @item show range
11615 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
11616 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
11617 @end table
11618
11619 @node Supported Languages
11620 @section Supported Languages
11621
11622 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, OpenCL C, Pascal,
11623 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
11624 @c This is false ...
11625 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
11626 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
11627 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
11628 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
11629 language.
11630
11631 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
11632 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
11633 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
11634 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
11635 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
11636 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
11637 language reference or tutorial.
11638
11639 @menu
11640 * C:: C and C@t{++}
11641 * D:: D
11642 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
11643 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
11644 * Fortran:: Fortran
11645 * Pascal:: Pascal
11646 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
11647 * Ada:: Ada
11648 @end menu
11649
11650 @node C
11651 @subsection C and C@t{++}
11652
11653 @cindex C and C@t{++}
11654 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
11655
11656 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
11657 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
11658 together.
11659
11660 @cindex C@t{++}
11661 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
11662 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
11663 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
11664 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
11665 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
11666 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
11667 compiler (@code{aCC}).
11668
11669 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
11670 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
11671 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
11672 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
11673 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
11674 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
11675
11676 @menu
11677 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
11678 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
11679 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
11680 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
11681 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
11682 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
11683 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
11684 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
11685 @end menu
11686
11687 @node C Operators
11688 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
11689
11690 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
11691
11692 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
11693 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
11694 often defined on groups of types.
11695
11696 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
11697
11698 @itemize @bullet
11699
11700 @item
11701 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
11702 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
11703
11704 @item
11705 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
11706 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
11707
11708 @item
11709 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
11710
11711 @item
11712 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
11713
11714 @end itemize
11715
11716 @noindent
11717 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
11718 in order of increasing precedence:
11719
11720 @table @code
11721 @item ,
11722 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
11723 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
11724 expression being the last expression evaluated.
11725
11726 @item =
11727 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
11728 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
11729
11730 @item @var{op}=
11731 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
11732 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
11733 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
11734 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
11735 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
11736
11737 @item ?:
11738 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
11739 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
11740 integral type.
11741
11742 @item ||
11743 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
11744
11745 @item &&
11746 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
11747
11748 @item |
11749 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
11750
11751 @item ^
11752 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
11753
11754 @item &
11755 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
11756
11757 @item ==@r{, }!=
11758 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
11759 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
11760
11761 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
11762 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
11763 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
11764 and non-zero for true.
11765
11766 @item <<@r{, }>>
11767 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
11768
11769 @item @@
11770 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
11771
11772 @item +@r{, }-
11773 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
11774 pointer types.
11775
11776 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
11777 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
11778 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
11779 integral types.
11780
11781 @item ++@r{, }--
11782 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
11783 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
11784 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
11785 operation takes place.
11786
11787 @item *
11788 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
11789 @code{++}.
11790
11791 @item &
11792 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
11793
11794 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
11795 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
11796 to examine the address
11797 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
11798 stored.
11799
11800 @item -
11801 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
11802 precedence as @code{++}.
11803
11804 @item !
11805 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
11806 @code{++}.
11807
11808 @item ~
11809 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
11810 @code{++}.
11811
11812
11813 @item .@r{, }->
11814 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
11815 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
11816 pointer based on the stored type information.
11817 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
11818
11819 @item .*@r{, }->*
11820 Dereferences of pointers to members.
11821
11822 @item []
11823 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
11824 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
11825
11826 @item ()
11827 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
11828
11829 @item ::
11830 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
11831 and @code{class} types.
11832
11833 @item ::
11834 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
11835 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
11836 above.
11837 @end table
11838
11839 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
11840 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
11841 predefined meaning.
11842
11843 @node C Constants
11844 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
11845
11846 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
11847
11848 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
11849 following ways:
11850
11851 @itemize @bullet
11852 @item
11853 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
11854 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
11855 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
11856 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
11857 @code{long} value.
11858
11859 @item
11860 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
11861 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
11862 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
11863 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
11864 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
11865 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
11866 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
11867 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
11868 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
11869 constant.
11870
11871 @item
11872 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
11873 integral equivalents.
11874
11875 @item
11876 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
11877 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
11878 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
11879 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
11880 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
11881 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
11882 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
11883 @samp{\n} for newline.
11884
11885 @item
11886 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
11887 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
11888 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
11889 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
11890 characters.
11891
11892 @item
11893 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
11894 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
11895
11896 @item
11897 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
11898 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
11899 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
11900 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
11901 @end itemize
11902
11903 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
11904 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
11905
11906 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
11907 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
11908
11909 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
11910 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
11911 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
11912 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
11913 @quotation
11914 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
11915 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
11916 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
11917 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
11918 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
11919 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
11920 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
11921 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
11922 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
11923 C@t{++} code.
11924 @end quotation
11925
11926 @enumerate
11927
11928 @cindex member functions
11929 @item
11930 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
11931
11932 @smallexample
11933 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
11934 @end smallexample
11935
11936 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
11937 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
11938 @item
11939 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
11940 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
11941 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
11942 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
11943
11944 @cindex call overloaded functions
11945 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
11946 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
11947 @item
11948 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
11949 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
11950 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
11951 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
11952 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
11953 default arguments.
11954
11955 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
11956 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
11957 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
11958 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
11959 number of function arguments.
11960
11961 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
11962 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
11963 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
11964
11965 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
11966 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
11967 @smallexample
11968 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
11969 @end smallexample
11970
11971 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
11972 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
11973
11974 @cindex reference declarations
11975 @item
11976 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
11977 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
11978 dereferenced.
11979
11980 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
11981 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
11982 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
11983 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
11984 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
11985
11986 @item
11987 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
11988 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
11989 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
11990 necessary, for example in an expression like
11991 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
11992 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
11993 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
11994 @end enumerate
11995
11996 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
11997 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
11998 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
11999 invoking user-defined operators.
12000
12001 @node C Defaults
12002 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
12003
12004 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
12005
12006 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
12007 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
12008 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
12009 selects the working language.
12010
12011 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
12012 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
12013 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
12014 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
12015 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
12016 for further details.
12017
12018 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
12019 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
12020 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
12021
12022 @node C Checks
12023 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
12024
12025 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
12026
12027 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
12028 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
12029 considers two variables type equivalent if:
12030
12031 @itemize @bullet
12032 @item
12033 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
12034 enumerated tag.
12035
12036 @item
12037 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
12038 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
12039
12040 @ignore
12041 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
12042 @c FIXME--beers?
12043 @item
12044 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
12045 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
12046 compilers.)
12047 @end ignore
12048 @end itemize
12049
12050 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
12051 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
12052 that is not itself an array.
12053
12054 @node Debugging C
12055 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
12056
12057 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
12058 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
12059 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
12060 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
12061
12062 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
12063 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
12064 ,Expressions}.
12065
12066 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
12067 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
12068
12069 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
12070
12071 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
12072 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
12073
12074 @table @code
12075 @cindex break in overloaded functions
12076 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
12077 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
12078 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
12079 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
12080 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
12081
12082 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
12083 @item rbreak @var{regex}
12084 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
12085 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
12086 classes.
12087 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
12088
12089 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
12090 @item catch throw
12091 @itemx catch catch
12092 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
12093 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
12094
12095 @cindex inheritance
12096 @item ptype @var{typename}
12097 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
12098 @var{typename}.
12099 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
12100
12101 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
12102 @item set print demangle
12103 @itemx show print demangle
12104 @itemx set print asm-demangle
12105 @itemx show print asm-demangle
12106 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
12107 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
12108 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
12109
12110 @item set print object
12111 @itemx show print object
12112 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
12113 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
12114
12115 @item set print vtbl
12116 @itemx show print vtbl
12117 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
12118 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
12119 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
12120 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
12121
12122 @kindex set overload-resolution
12123 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
12124 @item set overload-resolution on
12125 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
12126 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
12127 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
12128 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
12129 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
12130 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
12131
12132 @item set overload-resolution off
12133 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
12134 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
12135 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
12136 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
12137 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
12138 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
12139 argument types.
12140
12141 @kindex show overload-resolution
12142 @item show overload-resolution
12143 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
12144
12145 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
12146 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
12147 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
12148 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
12149 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
12150 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
12151 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
12152 @end table
12153
12154 @node Decimal Floating Point
12155 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
12156 @cindex decimal floating point format
12157
12158 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
12159 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
12160 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
12161 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
12162
12163 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
12164 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
12165 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
12166 target.
12167
12168 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
12169 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
12170 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
12171
12172 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
12173 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
12174 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
12175
12176 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
12177 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
12178 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
12179
12180 @node D
12181 @subsection D
12182
12183 @cindex D
12184 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
12185 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
12186 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
12187
12188 @node Objective-C
12189 @subsection Objective-C
12190
12191 @cindex Objective-C
12192 This section provides information about some commands and command
12193 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
12194 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
12195 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
12196
12197 @menu
12198 * Method Names in Commands::
12199 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
12200 @end menu
12201
12202 @node Method Names in Commands
12203 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
12204
12205 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
12206 names as line specifications:
12207
12208 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
12209 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
12210 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
12211 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
12212 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
12213 @itemize
12214 @item @code{clear}
12215 @item @code{break}
12216 @item @code{info line}
12217 @item @code{jump}
12218 @item @code{list}
12219 @end itemize
12220
12221 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
12222
12223 @smallexample
12224 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
12225 @end smallexample
12226
12227 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
12228 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
12229 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
12230 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
12231 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
12232 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
12233 debugged, enter:
12234
12235 @smallexample
12236 break -[Fruit create]
12237 @end smallexample
12238
12239 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
12240 enter:
12241
12242 @smallexample
12243 list +[NSText initialize]
12244 @end smallexample
12245
12246 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
12247 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
12248 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
12249 is also possible to specify just a method name:
12250
12251 @smallexample
12252 break create
12253 @end smallexample
12254
12255 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
12256 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
12257 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
12258 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
12259 none apply.
12260
12261 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
12262 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
12263
12264 @smallexample
12265 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
12266 @end smallexample
12267
12268 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
12269 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
12270 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
12271 @kindex print-object
12272 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
12273
12274 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
12275
12276 @smallexample
12277 print -[@var{object} hash]
12278 @end smallexample
12279
12280 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
12281 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
12282 @noindent
12283 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
12284 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
12285 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
12286 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
12287 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
12288 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
12289
12290 @node OpenCL C
12291 @subsection OpenCL C
12292
12293 @cindex OpenCL C
12294 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
12295
12296 @menu
12297 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
12298 * OpenCL C Expressions::
12299 * OpenCL C Operators::
12300 @end menu
12301
12302 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
12303 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
12304
12305 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
12306 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
12307 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
12308 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
12309 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
12310
12311 @node OpenCL C Expressions
12312 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
12313
12314 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
12315 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
12316 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
12317 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
12318
12319 @node OpenCL C Operators
12320 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
12321
12322 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
12323 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
12324 vector data types.
12325
12326 @node Fortran
12327 @subsection Fortran
12328 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
12329
12330 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
12331 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
12332
12333 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
12334 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
12335 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
12336 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
12337 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
12338 underscore.
12339
12340 @menu
12341 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
12342 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
12343 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
12344 @end menu
12345
12346 @node Fortran Operators
12347 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
12348
12349 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
12350
12351 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
12352 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
12353 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
12354
12355 @table @code
12356 @item **
12357 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
12358 of the second one.
12359
12360 @item :
12361 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
12362 represent a section of array.
12363
12364 @item %
12365 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
12366 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
12367 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
12368 union type.
12369 @end table
12370
12371 @node Fortran Defaults
12372 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
12373
12374 @cindex Fortran Defaults
12375
12376 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
12377 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
12378 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
12379 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
12380
12381 @node Special Fortran Commands
12382 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
12383
12384 @cindex Special Fortran commands
12385
12386 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
12387 such as displaying common blocks.
12388
12389 @table @code
12390 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
12391 @kindex info common
12392 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
12393 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
12394 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
12395 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
12396 printed.
12397 @end table
12398
12399 @node Pascal
12400 @subsection Pascal
12401
12402 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
12403 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
12404 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
12405 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
12406 syntax.
12407
12408 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
12409 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
12410 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
12411
12412 @node Modula-2
12413 @subsection Modula-2
12414
12415 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
12416
12417 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
12418 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
12419 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
12420 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
12421 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
12422 table.
12423
12424 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
12425 @menu
12426 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
12427 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
12428 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
12429 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
12430 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
12431 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
12432 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
12433 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
12434 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
12435 @end menu
12436
12437 @node M2 Operators
12438 @subsubsection Operators
12439 @cindex Modula-2 operators
12440
12441 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
12442 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
12443 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
12444 following definitions hold:
12445
12446 @itemize @bullet
12447
12448 @item
12449 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
12450 their subranges.
12451
12452 @item
12453 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
12454
12455 @item
12456 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
12457
12458 @item
12459 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
12460 @var{type}}.
12461
12462 @item
12463 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
12464
12465 @item
12466 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
12467
12468 @item
12469 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
12470 @end itemize
12471
12472 @noindent
12473 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
12474 increasing precedence:
12475
12476 @table @code
12477 @item ,
12478 Function argument or array index separator.
12479
12480 @item :=
12481 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
12482 @var{value}.
12483
12484 @item <@r{, }>
12485 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
12486 types.
12487
12488 @item <=@r{, }>=
12489 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
12490 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
12491 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
12492
12493 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
12494 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
12495 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
12496 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
12497 comment character.
12498
12499 @item IN
12500 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
12501 Same precedence as @code{<}.
12502
12503 @item OR
12504 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
12505
12506 @item AND@r{, }&
12507 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
12508
12509 @item @@
12510 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
12511
12512 @item +@r{, }-
12513 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
12514 and difference on set types.
12515
12516 @item *
12517 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
12518 on set types.
12519
12520 @item /
12521 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
12522 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
12523
12524 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
12525 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
12526 precedence as @code{*}.
12527
12528 @item -
12529 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
12530
12531 @item ^
12532 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
12533
12534 @item NOT
12535 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
12536 @code{^}.
12537
12538 @item .
12539 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
12540 precedence as @code{^}.
12541
12542 @item []
12543 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
12544
12545 @item ()
12546 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
12547 as @code{^}.
12548
12549 @item ::@r{, }.
12550 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
12551 @end table
12552
12553 @quotation
12554 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
12555 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
12556 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
12557 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
12558 @end quotation
12559
12560
12561 @node Built-In Func/Proc
12562 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
12563 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
12564
12565 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
12566 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
12567
12568 @table @var
12569
12570 @item a
12571 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
12572
12573 @item c
12574 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
12575
12576 @item i
12577 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
12578
12579 @item m
12580 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
12581 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
12582 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
12583
12584 @item n
12585 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
12586
12587 @item r
12588 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
12589
12590 @item t
12591 represents a type.
12592
12593 @item v
12594 represents a variable.
12595
12596 @item x
12597 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
12598 explanation of the function for details.
12599 @end table
12600
12601 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
12602
12603 @table @code
12604 @item ABS(@var{n})
12605 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
12606
12607 @item CAP(@var{c})
12608 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
12609 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
12610
12611 @item CHR(@var{i})
12612 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
12613
12614 @item DEC(@var{v})
12615 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
12616
12617 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
12618 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
12619 new value.
12620
12621 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
12622 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
12623 set.
12624
12625 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
12626 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
12627
12628 @item HIGH(@var{a})
12629 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
12630
12631 @item INC(@var{v})
12632 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
12633
12634 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
12635 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
12636 new value.
12637
12638 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
12639 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
12640 there. Returns the new set.
12641
12642 @item MAX(@var{t})
12643 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
12644
12645 @item MIN(@var{t})
12646 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
12647
12648 @item ODD(@var{i})
12649 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
12650
12651 @item ORD(@var{x})
12652 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
12653 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
12654 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
12655 integral, character and enumerated types.
12656
12657 @item SIZE(@var{x})
12658 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
12659
12660 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
12661 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
12662
12663 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
12664 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
12665
12666 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
12667 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
12668 @end table
12669
12670 @quotation
12671 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
12672 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
12673 an error.
12674 @end quotation
12675
12676 @cindex Modula-2 constants
12677 @node M2 Constants
12678 @subsubsection Constants
12679
12680 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
12681 ways:
12682
12683 @itemize @bullet
12684
12685 @item
12686 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
12687 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
12688 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
12689 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
12690
12691 @item
12692 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
12693 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
12694 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
12695 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
12696 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
12697 digits.
12698
12699 @item
12700 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
12701 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
12702 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
12703 followed by a @samp{C}.
12704
12705 @item
12706 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
12707 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
12708 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
12709 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
12710 sequences.
12711
12712 @item
12713 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
12714
12715 @item
12716 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
12717 @code{FALSE}.
12718
12719 @item
12720 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
12721
12722 @item
12723 Set constants are not yet supported.
12724 @end itemize
12725
12726 @node M2 Types
12727 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
12728 @cindex Modula-2 types
12729
12730 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
12731 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
12732 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
12733 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
12734 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
12735 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
12736
12737 The first example contains the following section of code:
12738
12739 @smallexample
12740 VAR
12741 s: SET OF CHAR ;
12742 r: [20..40] ;
12743 @end smallexample
12744
12745 @noindent
12746 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
12747 @code{r} and @code{s}.
12748
12749 @smallexample
12750 (@value{GDBP}) print s
12751 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
12752 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12753 SET OF CHAR
12754 (@value{GDBP}) print r
12755 21
12756 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
12757 [20..40]
12758 @end smallexample
12759
12760 @noindent
12761 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
12762
12763 @smallexample
12764 VAR
12765 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
12766 @end smallexample
12767
12768 @noindent
12769 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
12770
12771 @smallexample
12772 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12773 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
12774 @end smallexample
12775
12776 @noindent
12777 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
12778 expressions using the debugger.
12779
12780 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
12781 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
12782
12783 @smallexample
12784 VAR
12785 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
12786 @end smallexample
12787
12788 @smallexample
12789 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12790 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
12791 @end smallexample
12792
12793 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
12794 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
12795 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
12796 above.
12797
12798 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
12799
12800 @smallexample
12801 TYPE
12802 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
12803 t = [blue..yellow] ;
12804 VAR
12805 s: t ;
12806 BEGIN
12807 s := blue ;
12808 @end smallexample
12809
12810 @noindent
12811 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
12812 and value of a variable.
12813
12814 @smallexample
12815 (@value{GDBP}) print s
12816 $1 = blue
12817 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
12818 type = [blue..yellow]
12819 @end smallexample
12820
12821 @noindent
12822 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
12823 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
12824 their @code{C} counterparts.
12825
12826 @smallexample
12827 VAR
12828 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
12829 BEGIN
12830 s[1] := 1 ;
12831 @end smallexample
12832
12833 @smallexample
12834 (@value{GDBP}) print s
12835 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
12836 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12837 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
12838 @end smallexample
12839
12840 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
12841 pointer types as shown in this example:
12842
12843 @smallexample
12844 VAR
12845 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
12846 BEGIN
12847 NEW(s) ;
12848 s^[1] := 1 ;
12849 @end smallexample
12850
12851 @noindent
12852 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
12853
12854 @smallexample
12855 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12856 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
12857 @end smallexample
12858
12859 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
12860 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
12861 types:
12862
12863 @smallexample
12864 TYPE
12865 foo = RECORD
12866 f1: CARDINAL ;
12867 f2: CHAR ;
12868 f3: myarray ;
12869 END ;
12870
12871 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
12872 myrange = [-2..2] ;
12873 VAR
12874 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
12875 @end smallexample
12876
12877 @noindent
12878 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
12879 below.
12880
12881 @smallexample
12882 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
12883 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
12884 f1 : CARDINAL;
12885 f2 : CHAR;
12886 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
12887 END
12888 @end smallexample
12889
12890 @node M2 Defaults
12891 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
12892 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
12893
12894 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
12895 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
12896 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
12897 selected the working language.
12898
12899 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
12900 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
12901 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
12902 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
12903
12904 @node Deviations
12905 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
12906 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
12907
12908 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
12909 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
12910
12911 @itemize @bullet
12912 @item
12913 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
12914 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
12915 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
12916 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
12917 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
12918 returned a pointer.)
12919
12920 @item
12921 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
12922 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
12923 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
12924 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
12925
12926 @item
12927 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
12928 argument.
12929
12930 @item
12931 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
12932 @end itemize
12933
12934 @node M2 Checks
12935 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
12936 @cindex Modula-2 checks
12937
12938 @quotation
12939 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
12940 range checking.
12941 @end quotation
12942 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
12943
12944 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
12945
12946 @itemize @bullet
12947 @item
12948 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
12949 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
12950
12951 @item
12952 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
12953 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
12954 @end itemize
12955
12956 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
12957 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
12958
12959 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
12960 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
12961
12962 @node M2 Scope
12963 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
12964 @cindex scope
12965 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
12966 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
12967 @ifinfo
12968 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
12969 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
12970 @end ifinfo
12971 @ifnotinfo
12972 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
12973 @end ifnotinfo
12974
12975 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
12976 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
12977 similar syntax:
12978
12979 @smallexample
12980
12981 @var{module} . @var{id}
12982 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
12983 @end smallexample
12984
12985 @noindent
12986 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
12987 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
12988 identifier within your program, except another module.
12989
12990 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
12991 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
12992 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
12993 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
12994
12995 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
12996 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
12997 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
12998 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
12999 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
13000 @var{module}.
13001
13002 @node GDB/M2
13003 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
13004
13005 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
13006 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
13007 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
13008 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
13009 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
13010 analogue in Modula-2.
13011
13012 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
13013 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
13014 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
13015 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
13016 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
13017 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
13018
13019 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
13020 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
13021 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
13022
13023 @node Ada
13024 @subsection Ada
13025 @cindex Ada
13026
13027 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
13028 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
13029 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
13030 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
13031 to be difficult.
13032
13033
13034 @cindex expressions in Ada
13035 @menu
13036 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
13037 and semantics supported by Ada mode
13038 in @value{GDBN}.
13039 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
13040 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
13041 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
13042 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
13043 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
13044 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
13045 Profile
13046 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
13047 @end menu
13048
13049 @node Ada Mode Intro
13050 @subsubsection Introduction
13051 @cindex Ada mode, general
13052
13053 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
13054 syntax, with some extensions.
13055 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
13056
13057 @itemize @bullet
13058 @item
13059 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
13060 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
13061 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
13062 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
13063
13064 @item
13065 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
13066 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
13067
13068 @item
13069 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
13070 @end itemize
13071
13072 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
13073 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
13074 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
13075 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
13076 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
13077
13078 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
13079 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
13080 was translated from an Ada source file.
13081
13082 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
13083 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
13084 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
13085 middle (to allow based literals).
13086
13087 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
13088 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
13089 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
13090 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
13091 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
13092 functions to procedures elsewhere.
13093
13094 @node Omissions from Ada
13095 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
13096 @cindex Ada, omissions from
13097
13098 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
13099
13100 @itemize @bullet
13101 @item
13102 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
13103
13104 @itemize @minus
13105 @item
13106 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
13107 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
13108
13109 @item
13110 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
13111
13112 @item
13113 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
13114
13115 @item
13116 @t{'Tag}.
13117
13118 @item
13119 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
13120 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
13121
13122 @item
13123 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
13124 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
13125
13126 @item
13127 @t{'Address}.
13128 @end itemize
13129
13130 @item
13131 The names in
13132 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
13133 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
13134 not currently available.
13135
13136 @item
13137 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
13138 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
13139 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
13140 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
13141 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
13142 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
13143 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
13144 indeterminate values.
13145
13146 @item
13147 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
13148 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
13149 are not implemented.
13150
13151 @item
13152 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
13153 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
13154 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
13155 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
13156 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
13157
13158 @smallexample
13159 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
13160 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
13161 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
13162 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
13163 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
13164 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
13165 @end smallexample
13166
13167 Changing a
13168 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
13169 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
13170 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
13171 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
13172 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
13173 declared to have a type such as:
13174
13175 @smallexample
13176 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
13177 Id : Integer;
13178 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
13179 end record;
13180 @end smallexample
13181
13182 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
13183 assignments:
13184
13185 @smallexample
13186 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
13187 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
13188 @end smallexample
13189
13190 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
13191 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
13192 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
13193 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
13194 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
13195 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
13196 redundant component associations, although which component values are
13197 assigned in such cases is not defined.
13198
13199 @item
13200 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
13201
13202 @item
13203 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
13204 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
13205 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
13206 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
13207 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
13208 the proper resolution.
13209
13210 @item
13211 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
13212
13213 @item
13214 Entry calls are not implemented.
13215
13216 @item
13217 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
13218 formats are not supported.
13219
13220 @item
13221 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
13222
13223 @item
13224 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
13225 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
13226 context.
13227 Should your program
13228 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
13229 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
13230 @end itemize
13231
13232 @node Additions to Ada
13233 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
13234 @cindex Ada, deviations from
13235
13236 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
13237 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
13238
13239 @itemize @bullet
13240 @item
13241 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
13242 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
13243 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
13244 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
13245 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
13246 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
13247 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
13248 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
13249
13250 @item
13251 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
13252 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
13253 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
13254
13255 @item
13256 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
13257 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
13258
13259 @item
13260 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
13261 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
13262 @end itemize
13263
13264 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
13265 additions specific to Ada:
13266
13267 @itemize @bullet
13268 @item
13269 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
13270 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
13271
13272 @smallexample
13273 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
13274 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
13275 @end smallexample
13276
13277 @item
13278 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
13279 the value of its right-hand operand.
13280 This allows, for example,
13281 complex conditional breaks:
13282
13283 @smallexample
13284 (@value{GDBP}) break f
13285 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
13286 @end smallexample
13287
13288 @item
13289 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
13290 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
13291 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
13292 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
13293 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
13294 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
13295 in strings. For example,
13296 @smallexample
13297 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
13298 @end smallexample
13299 @noindent
13300 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
13301 after each period.
13302
13303 @item
13304 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
13305 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
13306 to write
13307
13308 @smallexample
13309 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
13310 @end smallexample
13311
13312 @item
13313 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
13314 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
13315 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
13316 of 3 might print as
13317
13318 @smallexample
13319 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
13320 @end smallexample
13321
13322 @noindent
13323 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
13324 clause.
13325
13326 @item
13327 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
13328 multi-character subsequence of
13329 their names (an exact match gets preference).
13330 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
13331 in place of @t{a'length}.
13332
13333 @item
13334 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
13335 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
13336 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
13337 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
13338 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
13339 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
13340 For example,
13341 @smallexample
13342 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
13343 @end smallexample
13344
13345 @item
13346 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
13347 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
13348 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
13349 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
13350 object.
13351
13352 @end itemize
13353
13354 @node Stopping Before Main Program
13355 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
13356
13357 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
13358 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
13359 before reaching the main procedure.
13360 As defined in the Ada Reference
13361 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
13362 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
13363 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
13364 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
13365
13366 @node Ada Tasks
13367 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
13368 @cindex Ada, tasking
13369
13370 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
13371 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
13372
13373 @table @code
13374 @kindex info tasks
13375 @item info tasks
13376 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
13377
13378
13379 @smallexample
13380 @iftex
13381 @leftskip=0.5cm
13382 @end iftex
13383 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13384 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13385 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13386 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
13387 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
13388 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
13389
13390 @end smallexample
13391
13392 @noindent
13393 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
13394 task currently being inspected.
13395
13396 @table @asis
13397 @item ID
13398 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
13399
13400 @item TID
13401 The Ada task ID.
13402
13403 @item P-ID
13404 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
13405
13406 @item Pri
13407 The base priority of the task.
13408
13409 @item State
13410 Current state of the task.
13411
13412 @table @code
13413 @item Unactivated
13414 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
13415 executing.
13416
13417 @item Runnable
13418 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
13419 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
13420
13421 @item Terminated
13422 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
13423 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
13424 terminated themselves.
13425
13426 @item Child Activation Wait
13427 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
13428
13429 @item Accept Statement
13430 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
13431
13432 @item Waiting on entry call
13433 The task is waiting on an entry call.
13434
13435 @item Async Select Wait
13436 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
13437 select statement.
13438
13439 @item Delay Sleep
13440 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
13441 alternative open.
13442
13443 @item Child Termination Wait
13444 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
13445 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
13446 waiting on a terminate Phase.
13447
13448 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
13449 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
13450 finish terminating.
13451
13452 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
13453 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
13454 @end table
13455
13456 @item Name
13457 Name of the task in the program.
13458
13459 @end table
13460
13461 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
13462 @item info task @var{taskno}
13463 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
13464 the following example:
13465 @smallexample
13466 @iftex
13467 @leftskip=0.5cm
13468 @end iftex
13469 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13470 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13471 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13472 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
13473 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
13474 Ada Task: 0x807c468
13475 Name: task_1
13476 Thread: 0x807f378
13477 Parent: 1 (main_task)
13478 Base Priority: 15
13479 State: Runnable
13480 @end smallexample
13481
13482 @item task
13483 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
13484 @cindex current Ada task ID
13485 This command prints the ID of the current task.
13486
13487 @smallexample
13488 @iftex
13489 @leftskip=0.5cm
13490 @end iftex
13491 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13492 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13493 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13494 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
13495 (@value{GDBP}) task
13496 [Current task is 2]
13497 @end smallexample
13498
13499 @item task @var{taskno}
13500 @cindex Ada task switching
13501 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
13502 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
13503 from the current task to the given task.
13504
13505 @smallexample
13506 @iftex
13507 @leftskip=0.5cm
13508 @end iftex
13509 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13510 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13511 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13512 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
13513 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
13514 [Switching to task 1]
13515 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
13516 (@value{GDBP}) bt
13517 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
13518 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
13519 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
13520 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
13521 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
13522 @end smallexample
13523
13524 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
13525 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
13526 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
13527 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
13528 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
13529 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
13530 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}).
13531 @var{linespec} specifies source lines, as described
13532 in @ref{Specify Location}.
13533
13534 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
13535 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
13536 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. @var{taskno} is one of the
13537 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
13538 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
13539
13540 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
13541 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
13542 program.
13543
13544 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
13545 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
13546 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
13547
13548 For example,
13549
13550 @smallexample
13551 @iftex
13552 @leftskip=0.5cm
13553 @end iftex
13554 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13555 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13556 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13557 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
13558 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
13559 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
13560 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
13561 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
13562 (@value{GDBP}) cont
13563 Continuing.
13564 task # 1 running
13565 task # 2 running
13566
13567 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
13568 15 flush;
13569 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13570 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13571 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13572 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
13573 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
13574 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
13575 @end smallexample
13576 @end table
13577
13578 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
13579 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
13580 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
13581
13582 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
13583 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
13584 the platform being used.
13585 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
13586 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
13587 as usual.
13588
13589 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
13590 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
13591 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
13592 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
13593 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
13594 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
13595
13596 @node Ravenscar Profile
13597 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
13598 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
13599
13600 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
13601 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
13602 requirements.
13603
13604 @table @code
13605 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
13606 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
13607 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
13608 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
13609 Profile. This is the default.
13610
13611 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
13612 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
13613 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
13614 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
13615 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
13616 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
13617 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
13618
13619 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
13620 @item show ravenscar task-switching
13621 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
13622 using the Ravenscar Profile.
13623
13624 @end table
13625
13626 @node Ada Glitches
13627 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
13628 @cindex Ada, problems
13629
13630 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
13631 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
13632 @value{GDBN},
13633 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
13634 and the GNU Ada compiler.
13635
13636 @itemize @bullet
13637 @item
13638 Currently, the debugger
13639 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
13640 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
13641 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
13642 to get it printed properly.
13643
13644 @item
13645 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
13646 storage are invisible to the debugger.
13647
13648 @item
13649 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
13650 argument lists are treated as positional).
13651
13652 @item
13653 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
13654
13655 @item
13656 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
13657 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
13658 the host machine.
13659
13660 @item
13661 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
13662 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
13663 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
13664 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
13665 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
13666 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
13667 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
13668 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
13669 you can usually resolve the confusion
13670 by qualifying the problematic names with package
13671 @code{Standard} explicitly.
13672 @end itemize
13673
13674 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
13675 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
13676 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
13677 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
13678 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
13679 enabled.
13680
13681 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
13682 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
13683 @table @code
13684
13685 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
13686 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
13687 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
13688 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
13689 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
13690 This is the default.
13691
13692 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
13693 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
13694 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
13695 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
13696 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
13697 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
13698 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
13699
13700 @end table
13701
13702 @node Unsupported Languages
13703 @section Unsupported Languages
13704
13705 @cindex unsupported languages
13706 @cindex minimal language
13707 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
13708 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
13709 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
13710 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
13711 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
13712 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
13713
13714 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
13715 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
13716 language.
13717
13718 @node Symbols
13719 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
13720
13721 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
13722 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
13723 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
13724 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
13725 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
13726 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
13727 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
13728
13729 @cindex symbol names
13730 @cindex names of symbols
13731 @cindex quoting names
13732 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
13733 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
13734 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
13735 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
13736 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
13737 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
13738 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
13739 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
13740
13741 @smallexample
13742 p 'foo.c'::x
13743 @end smallexample
13744
13745 @noindent
13746 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
13747
13748 @table @code
13749 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
13750 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
13751 @kindex set case-sensitive
13752 @item set case-sensitive on
13753 @itemx set case-sensitive off
13754 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
13755 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
13756 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
13757 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
13758 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
13759 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
13760 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
13761 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
13762 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
13763 case-insensitive matches.
13764
13765 @kindex show case-sensitive
13766 @item show case-sensitive
13767 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
13768 lookups.
13769
13770 @kindex info address
13771 @cindex address of a symbol
13772 @item info address @var{symbol}
13773 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
13774 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
13775 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
13776 is always stored.
13777
13778 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
13779 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
13780 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
13781
13782 @kindex info symbol
13783 @cindex symbol from address
13784 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
13785 @item info symbol @var{addr}
13786 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
13787 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
13788 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
13789
13790 @smallexample
13791 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
13792 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
13793 @end smallexample
13794
13795 @noindent
13796 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
13797 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
13798
13799 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
13800 library containing the symbol is also printed:
13801
13802 @smallexample
13803 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
13804 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
13805 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
13806 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
13807 @end smallexample
13808
13809 @kindex whatis
13810 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
13811 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
13812 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
13813 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
13814 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
13815 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
13816 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
13817 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
13818 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
13819 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
13820 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
13821
13822 @kindex ptype
13823 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
13824 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
13825 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
13826 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
13827
13828 For example, for this variable declaration:
13829
13830 @smallexample
13831 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
13832 @end smallexample
13833
13834 @noindent
13835 the two commands give this output:
13836
13837 @smallexample
13838 @group
13839 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
13840 type = struct complex
13841 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
13842 type = struct complex @{
13843 double real;
13844 double imag;
13845 @}
13846 @end group
13847 @end smallexample
13848
13849 @noindent
13850 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
13851 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
13852
13853 @cindex incomplete type
13854 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
13855 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
13856 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
13857 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
13858 given these declarations:
13859
13860 @smallexample
13861 struct foo;
13862 struct foo *fooptr;
13863 @end smallexample
13864
13865 @noindent
13866 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
13867
13868 @smallexample
13869 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
13870 $1 = <incomplete type>
13871 @end smallexample
13872
13873 @noindent
13874 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
13875 completely specified.
13876
13877 @kindex info types
13878 @item info types @var{regexp}
13879 @itemx info types
13880 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
13881 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
13882 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
13883 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
13884 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
13885 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
13886 name is @code{value}.
13887
13888 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
13889 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
13890 lists all source files where a type is defined.
13891
13892 @kindex info scope
13893 @cindex local variables
13894 @item info scope @var{location}
13895 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
13896 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
13897 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
13898 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
13899 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
13900
13901 @smallexample
13902 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
13903 Scope for command_line_handler:
13904 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
13905 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
13906 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
13907 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
13908 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
13909 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
13910 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
13911 @end smallexample
13912
13913 @noindent
13914 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
13915 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
13916 collect}.
13917
13918 @kindex info source
13919 @item info source
13920 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
13921 the function containing the current point of execution:
13922 @itemize @bullet
13923 @item
13924 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
13925 @item
13926 the directory it was compiled in,
13927 @item
13928 its length, in lines,
13929 @item
13930 which programming language it is written in,
13931 @item
13932 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
13933 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
13934 @item
13935 whether the debugging information includes information about
13936 preprocessor macros.
13937 @end itemize
13938
13939
13940 @kindex info sources
13941 @item info sources
13942 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
13943 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
13944 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
13945
13946 @kindex info functions
13947 @item info functions
13948 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
13949
13950 @item info functions @var{regexp}
13951 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
13952 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
13953 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
13954 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
13955 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
13956 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
13957 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
13958
13959 @kindex info variables
13960 @item info variables
13961 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
13962 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
13963
13964 @item info variables @var{regexp}
13965 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
13966 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
13967 @var{regexp}.
13968
13969 @kindex info classes
13970 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
13971 @item info classes
13972 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
13973 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
13974 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
13975 expression.
13976
13977 @kindex info selectors
13978 @item info selectors
13979 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
13980 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
13981 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
13982 expression.
13983
13984 @ignore
13985 This was never implemented.
13986 @kindex info methods
13987 @item info methods
13988 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
13989 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
13990 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
13991 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
13992 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
13993 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
13994 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
13995 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
13996 @end ignore
13997
13998 @cindex reloading symbols
13999 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
14000 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
14001 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
14002 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
14003 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
14004
14005 @table @code
14006 @kindex set symbol-reloading
14007 @item set symbol-reloading on
14008 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
14009 object file with a particular name is seen again.
14010
14011 @item set symbol-reloading off
14012 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
14013 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
14014 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
14015 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
14016 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
14017 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
14018 name.
14019
14020 @kindex show symbol-reloading
14021 @item show symbol-reloading
14022 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
14023 @end table
14024
14025 @cindex opaque data types
14026 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
14027 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
14028 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
14029 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
14030 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
14031 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
14032 another source file. The default is on.
14033
14034 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
14035 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
14036
14037 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
14038 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
14039 is printed as follows:
14040 @smallexample
14041 @{<no data fields>@}
14042 @end smallexample
14043
14044 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
14045 @item show opaque-type-resolution
14046 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
14047
14048 @kindex maint print symbols
14049 @cindex symbol dump
14050 @kindex maint print psymbols
14051 @cindex partial symbol dump
14052 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
14053 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
14054 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
14055 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
14056 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
14057 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
14058 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
14059 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
14060 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
14061 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
14062 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
14063 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
14064 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
14065 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
14066 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
14067 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
14068 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
14069
14070 @kindex maint info symtabs
14071 @kindex maint info psymtabs
14072 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
14073 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
14074 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
14075 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
14076 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
14077 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
14078
14079 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
14080 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
14081 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
14082 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
14083 structure in more detail. For example:
14084
14085 @smallexample
14086 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
14087 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
14088 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
14089 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
14090 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
14091 readin no
14092 fullname (null)
14093 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
14094 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
14095 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
14096 dependencies (none)
14097 @}
14098 @}
14099 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
14100 (@value{GDBP})
14101 @end smallexample
14102 @noindent
14103 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
14104 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
14105 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
14106 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
14107 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
14108
14109 @smallexample
14110 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
14111 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
14112 line 1574.
14113 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
14114 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
14115 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
14116 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
14117 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
14118 dirname (null)
14119 fullname (null)
14120 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
14121 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
14122 debugformat DWARF 2
14123 @}
14124 @}
14125 (@value{GDBP})
14126 @end smallexample
14127 @end table
14128
14129
14130 @node Altering
14131 @chapter Altering Execution
14132
14133 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
14134 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
14135 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
14136 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
14137 program.
14138
14139 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
14140 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
14141 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
14142
14143 @menu
14144 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
14145 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
14146 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
14147 * Returning:: Returning from a function
14148 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
14149 * Patching:: Patching your program
14150 @end menu
14151
14152 @node Assignment
14153 @section Assignment to Variables
14154
14155 @cindex assignment
14156 @cindex setting variables
14157 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
14158 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
14159
14160 @smallexample
14161 print x=4
14162 @end smallexample
14163
14164 @noindent
14165 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
14166 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
14167 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
14168 information on operators in supported languages.
14169
14170 @kindex set variable
14171 @cindex variables, setting
14172 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
14173 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
14174 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
14175 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
14176 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
14177
14178 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
14179 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
14180 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
14181 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
14182 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
14183 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
14184 command @code{set width}:
14185
14186 @smallexample
14187 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
14188 type = double
14189 (@value{GDBP}) p width
14190 $4 = 13
14191 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
14192 Invalid syntax in expression.
14193 @end smallexample
14194
14195 @noindent
14196 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
14197 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
14198
14199 @smallexample
14200 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
14201 @end smallexample
14202
14203 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
14204 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
14205 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
14206 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
14207 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
14208 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
14209
14210 @smallexample
14211 @group
14212 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
14213 type = double
14214 (@value{GDBP}) p g
14215 $1 = 1
14216 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
14217 (@value{GDBP}) p g
14218 $2 = 1
14219 (@value{GDBP}) r
14220 The program being debugged has been started already.
14221 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
14222 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
14223 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
14224 Invalid bfd target.
14225 (@value{GDBP}) show g
14226 The current BFD target is "=4".
14227 @end group
14228 @end smallexample
14229
14230 @noindent
14231 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
14232 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
14233 @code{g}, use
14234
14235 @smallexample
14236 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
14237 @end smallexample
14238
14239 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
14240 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
14241 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
14242 same length or shorter.
14243 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
14244 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
14245
14246 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
14247 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
14248 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
14249 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
14250 and representation in memory), and
14251
14252 @smallexample
14253 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
14254 @end smallexample
14255
14256 @noindent
14257 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
14258
14259 @node Jumping
14260 @section Continuing at a Different Address
14261
14262 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
14263 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
14264 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
14265
14266 @table @code
14267 @kindex jump
14268 @item jump @var{linespec}
14269 @itemx jump @var{location}
14270 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
14271 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
14272 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
14273 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
14274 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
14275 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14276
14277 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
14278 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
14279 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
14280 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
14281 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
14282 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
14283 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
14284 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
14285 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
14286 @end table
14287
14288 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
14289 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
14290 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
14291 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
14292 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
14293 example,
14294
14295 @smallexample
14296 set $pc = 0x485
14297 @end smallexample
14298
14299 @noindent
14300 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
14301 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
14302 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
14303
14304 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
14305 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
14306 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
14307 detail.
14308
14309 @c @group
14310 @node Signaling
14311 @section Giving your Program a Signal
14312 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
14313
14314 @table @code
14315 @kindex signal
14316 @item signal @var{signal}
14317 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
14318 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
14319 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
14320 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
14321
14322 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
14323 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
14324 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
14325 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
14326 signal.
14327
14328 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
14329 after executing the command.
14330 @end table
14331 @c @end group
14332
14333 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
14334 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
14335 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
14336 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
14337 passes the signal directly to your program.
14338
14339
14340 @node Returning
14341 @section Returning from a Function
14342
14343 @table @code
14344 @cindex returning from a function
14345 @kindex return
14346 @item return
14347 @itemx return @var{expression}
14348 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
14349 command. If you give an
14350 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
14351 value.
14352 @end table
14353
14354 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
14355 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
14356 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
14357 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
14358
14359 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
14360 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
14361 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
14362 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
14363 of functions.
14364
14365 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
14366 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
14367 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
14368 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
14369 selected stack frame returns naturally.
14370
14371 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
14372 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
14373 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
14374 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
14375 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
14376 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
14377 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
14378 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
14379 assignment into the right register(s).
14380
14381 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
14382 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
14383 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
14384 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
14385 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
14386 into a @code{long long int}:
14387
14388 @smallexample
14389 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
14390 29 return 31;
14391 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
14392 Make func return now? (y or n) y
14393 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
14394 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
14395 (@value{GDBP})
14396 @end smallexample
14397
14398 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
14399 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
14400 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
14401 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
14402 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
14403 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
14404 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
14405 an appropriate cast explicitly:
14406
14407 @smallexample
14408 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
14409 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
14410 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
14411 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
14412 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
14413 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
14414 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
14415 (@value{GDBP})
14416 @end smallexample
14417
14418 @node Calling
14419 @section Calling Program Functions
14420
14421 @table @code
14422 @cindex calling functions
14423 @cindex inferior functions, calling
14424 @item print @var{expr}
14425 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
14426 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
14427 debugged.
14428
14429 @kindex call
14430 @item call @var{expr}
14431 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
14432 returned values.
14433
14434 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
14435 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
14436 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
14437 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
14438 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
14439 value history.
14440 @end table
14441
14442 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
14443 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
14444 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
14445 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
14446
14447 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
14448 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
14449 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
14450 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
14451 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
14452 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
14453 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
14454 in that case is controlled by the
14455 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
14456
14457 @table @code
14458 @item set unwindonsignal
14459 @kindex set unwindonsignal
14460 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
14461 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
14462 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
14463 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
14464 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
14465 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
14466 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
14467 received.
14468
14469 @item show unwindonsignal
14470 @kindex show unwindonsignal
14471 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
14472 @value{GDBN}.
14473
14474 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
14475 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
14476 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
14477 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
14478 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
14479 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
14480 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
14481 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
14482 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
14483 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
14484
14485 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
14486 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
14487 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
14488 @value{GDBN}.
14489
14490 @end table
14491
14492 @cindex weak alias functions
14493 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
14494 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
14495 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
14496 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
14497 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
14498 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
14499 function instead.
14500
14501 @node Patching
14502 @section Patching Programs
14503
14504 @cindex patching binaries
14505 @cindex writing into executables
14506 @cindex writing into corefiles
14507
14508 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
14509 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
14510 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
14511 patching your program's binary.
14512
14513 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
14514 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
14515 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
14516 repairs.
14517
14518 @table @code
14519 @kindex set write
14520 @item set write on
14521 @itemx set write off
14522 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
14523 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
14524 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
14525
14526 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
14527 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
14528 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
14529
14530 @item show write
14531 @kindex show write
14532 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
14533 as well as reading.
14534 @end table
14535
14536 @node GDB Files
14537 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
14538
14539 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
14540 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
14541 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
14542 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
14543
14544 @menu
14545 * Files:: Commands to specify files
14546 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
14547 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
14548 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
14549 * Data Files:: GDB data files
14550 @end menu
14551
14552 @node Files
14553 @section Commands to Specify Files
14554
14555 @cindex symbol table
14556 @cindex core dump file
14557
14558 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
14559 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
14560 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
14561 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
14562
14563 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
14564 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
14565 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
14566 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
14567 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
14568 new files are useful.
14569
14570 @table @code
14571 @cindex executable file
14572 @kindex file
14573 @item file @var{filename}
14574 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
14575 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
14576 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
14577 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
14578 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
14579 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
14580 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
14581 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
14582
14583 @cindex unlinked object files
14584 @cindex patching object files
14585 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
14586 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
14587 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
14588 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
14589 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
14590 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
14591 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
14592 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
14593
14594 @item file
14595 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
14596 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
14597
14598 @kindex exec-file
14599 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
14600 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
14601 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
14602 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
14603 discard information on the executable file.
14604
14605 @kindex symbol-file
14606 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
14607 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
14608 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
14609 table and program to run from the same file.
14610
14611 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
14612 program's symbol table.
14613
14614 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
14615 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
14616 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
14617 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
14618 @value{GDBN}.
14619
14620 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
14621 executing it once.
14622
14623 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
14624 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
14625 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
14626 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
14627 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
14628 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
14629 optimized code.
14630
14631 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
14632 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
14633 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
14634 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
14635 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
14636
14637 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
14638 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
14639 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
14640 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
14641 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
14642 Warnings and Messages}.)
14643
14644 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
14645 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
14646 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
14647 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
14648 in stabs format.
14649
14650 @kindex readnow
14651 @cindex reading symbols immediately
14652 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
14653 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
14654 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
14655 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
14656 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
14657 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
14658 entire symbol table available.
14659
14660 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
14661 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
14662 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
14663 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
14664 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
14665 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
14666 @c files.
14667
14668 @kindex core-file
14669 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
14670 @itemx core
14671 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
14672 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
14673 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
14674 executable file itself for other parts.
14675
14676 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
14677 to be used.
14678
14679 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
14680 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
14681 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
14682 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
14683 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
14684
14685 @kindex add-symbol-file
14686 @cindex dynamic linking
14687 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
14688 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
14689 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
14690 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
14691 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
14692 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
14693 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
14694 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
14695 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
14696 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
14697 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
14698 @var{address} as an expression.
14699
14700 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
14701 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
14702 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
14703 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
14704 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
14705
14706 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
14707 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
14708 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
14709 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
14710 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
14711 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
14712 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
14713 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
14714 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
14715
14716 @itemize @bullet
14717 @item
14718 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
14719 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
14720 @item
14721 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
14722 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
14723 @item
14724 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
14725 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
14726 @end itemize
14727
14728 @noindent
14729 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
14730 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
14731 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
14732 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
14733 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
14734 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
14735 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
14736 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
14737 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
14738 way.
14739
14740 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
14741
14742 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
14743 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
14744 @cindex load symbols from memory
14745 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
14746 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
14747 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
14748 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
14749 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
14750 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
14751 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
14752 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
14753 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
14754
14755 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
14756 @kindex assf
14757 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
14758 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
14759 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
14760 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
14761 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
14762 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
14763 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
14764 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
14765 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
14766 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
14767
14768 @kindex section
14769 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
14770 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
14771 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
14772 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
14773 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
14774 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
14775 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
14776 their addresses.
14777
14778 @kindex info files
14779 @kindex info target
14780 @item info files
14781 @itemx info target
14782 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
14783 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
14784 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
14785 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
14786 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
14787 current ones.
14788
14789 @kindex maint info sections
14790 @item maint info sections
14791 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
14792 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
14793 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
14794 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
14795 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
14796 may be arbitrarily combined):
14797
14798 @table @code
14799 @item ALLOBJ
14800 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
14801 @item @var{sections}
14802 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
14803 @item @var{section-flags}
14804 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
14805 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
14806 @table @code
14807 @item ALLOC
14808 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
14809 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
14810 @item LOAD
14811 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
14812 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
14813 @item RELOC
14814 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
14815 @item READONLY
14816 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
14817 @item CODE
14818 Section contains executable code only.
14819 @item DATA
14820 Section contains data only (no executable code).
14821 @item ROM
14822 Section will reside in ROM.
14823 @item CONSTRUCTOR
14824 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
14825 @item HAS_CONTENTS
14826 Section is not empty.
14827 @item NEVER_LOAD
14828 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
14829 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
14830 A notification to the linker that the section contains
14831 COFF shared library information.
14832 @item IS_COMMON
14833 Section contains common symbols.
14834 @end table
14835 @end table
14836 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
14837 @cindex read-only sections
14838 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
14839 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
14840 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
14841 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
14842 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
14843 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
14844 enhancement to debugging performance.
14845
14846 The default is off.
14847
14848 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
14849 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
14850 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
14851 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
14852
14853 @item show trust-readonly-sections
14854 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
14855 @end table
14856
14857 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
14858 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
14859 name and remembers it that way.
14860
14861 @cindex shared libraries
14862 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
14863 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
14864 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
14865
14866 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
14867 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
14868
14869 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
14870 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
14871 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
14872 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
14873 debugging a core file).
14874
14875 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
14876 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
14877
14878 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
14879 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
14880 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
14881
14882 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
14883 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
14884 particularly large or there are many of them.
14885
14886 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
14887 commands:
14888
14889 @table @code
14890 @kindex set auto-solib-add
14891 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
14892 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
14893 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
14894 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
14895 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
14896 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
14897 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
14898
14899 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
14900 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
14901 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
14902 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
14903 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
14904 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
14905 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
14906 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
14907 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
14908
14909 @kindex show auto-solib-add
14910 @item show auto-solib-add
14911 Display the current autoloading mode.
14912 @end table
14913
14914 @cindex load shared library
14915 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
14916 command:
14917
14918 @table @code
14919 @kindex info sharedlibrary
14920 @kindex info share
14921 @item info share @var{regex}
14922 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
14923 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
14924 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
14925 all shared libraries that are loaded.
14926
14927 @kindex sharedlibrary
14928 @kindex share
14929 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
14930 @itemx share @var{regex}
14931 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
14932 Unix regular expression.
14933 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
14934 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
14935 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
14936 loaded.
14937
14938 @item nosharedlibrary
14939 @kindex nosharedlibrary
14940 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
14941 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
14942 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
14943 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
14944 discarded.
14945 @end table
14946
14947 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
14948 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
14949 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
14950
14951 @table @code
14952 @item set stop-on-solib-events
14953 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
14954 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
14955 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
14956 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
14957 shared library.
14958
14959 @item show stop-on-solib-events
14960 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
14961 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
14962 library events happen.
14963 @end table
14964
14965 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
14966 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
14967 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
14968 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
14969 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
14970 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
14971 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
14972 not.
14973
14974 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
14975 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
14976 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
14977 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
14978 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
14979
14980 @table @code
14981 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
14982 @cindex system root, alternate
14983 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
14984 @kindex set sysroot
14985 @item set sysroot @var{path}
14986 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
14987 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
14988 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
14989 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
14990 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
14991 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
14992 under @var{path}.
14993
14994 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
14995 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
14996 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
14997 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
14998 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
14999 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
15000 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
15001 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
15002 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
15003
15004 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
15005 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
15006 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
15007 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
15008 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
15009
15010 @smallexample
15011 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
15012 @end smallexample
15013
15014 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
15015 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
15016 system:
15017
15018 @smallexample
15019 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
15020 @end smallexample
15021
15022 If that does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries removing
15023 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
15024 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
15025 colons:
15026
15027 @smallexample
15028 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
15029 @end smallexample
15030
15031 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
15032 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
15033 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
15034 @samp{z}):
15035
15036 @smallexample
15037 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
15038 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
15039 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
15040 @end smallexample
15041
15042 @noindent
15043 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
15044 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
15045 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
15046
15047 If that still does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries
15048 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
15049
15050 @smallexample
15051 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
15052 @end smallexample
15053
15054 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
15055 if you don't want or need to.
15056
15057 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
15058 sysroot}.
15059
15060 @cindex default system root
15061 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
15062 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
15063 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
15064 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
15065 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
15066 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
15067 location.
15068
15069 @kindex show sysroot
15070 @item show sysroot
15071 Display the current shared library prefix.
15072
15073 @kindex set solib-search-path
15074 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
15075 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
15076 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
15077 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
15078 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
15079 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
15080 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
15081 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
15082 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
15083 of shared library symbols.
15084
15085 @kindex show solib-search-path
15086 @item show solib-search-path
15087 Display the current shared library search path.
15088
15089 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
15090 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
15091 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
15092 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
15093 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
15094
15095 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
15096 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
15097 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
15098 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
15099 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
15100 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
15101 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
15102 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
15103 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
15104 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
15105 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
15106 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
15107 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
15108 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
15109 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
15110 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
15111 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
15112 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
15113 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
15114 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
15115 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
15116 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
15117
15118 @table @code
15119 @item unix
15120 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
15121 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
15122 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
15123 the forward slash.
15124
15125 @item dos-based
15126 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
15127 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
15128 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
15129 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
15130 considered directory separators.
15131
15132 @item auto
15133 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
15134 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
15135 This is the default.
15136 @end table
15137 @end table
15138
15139
15140 @node Separate Debug Files
15141 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
15142 @cindex separate debugging information files
15143 @cindex debugging information in separate files
15144 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
15145 @cindex debugging information directory, global
15146 @cindex global debugging information directory
15147 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
15148 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
15149
15150 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
15151 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
15152 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
15153 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
15154 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
15155 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
15156 install only when they need to debug a problem.
15157
15158 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
15159 file:
15160
15161 @itemize @bullet
15162 @item
15163 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
15164 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
15165 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
15166 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
15167 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
15168 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
15169 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
15170 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
15171
15172 @item
15173 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
15174 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
15175 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
15176 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
15177 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
15178 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
15179 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
15180 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
15181 below.
15182 @end itemize
15183
15184 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
15185 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
15186
15187 @itemize @bullet
15188 @item
15189 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
15190 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
15191 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
15192 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
15193 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
15194
15195 @item
15196 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
15197 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
15198 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
15199 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
15200 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
15201 hex characters, not 10.)
15202 @end itemize
15203
15204 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
15205 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
15206 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
15207 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
15208 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
15209 debug information files, in the indicated order:
15210
15211 @itemize @minus
15212 @item
15213 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
15214 @item
15215 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
15216 @item
15217 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
15218 @item
15219 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
15220 @end itemize
15221
15222 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
15223 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
15224
15225 @table @code
15226
15227 @kindex set debug-file-directory
15228 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
15229 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
15230 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple directory components can be set
15231 concatenating them by a directory separator.
15232
15233 @kindex show debug-file-directory
15234 @item show debug-file-directory
15235 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
15236 information files.
15237
15238 @end table
15239
15240 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
15241 @cindex debug link sections
15242 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
15243 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
15244
15245 @itemize
15246 @item
15247 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
15248 a zero byte,
15249 @item
15250 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
15251 boundary within the section, and
15252 @item
15253 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
15254 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
15255 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
15256 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
15257 @end itemize
15258
15259 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
15260 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
15261 described above.
15262
15263 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
15264 @cindex build ID sections
15265 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
15266 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
15267 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
15268 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
15269 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
15270 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
15271 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
15272 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
15273 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
15274
15275 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
15276 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
15277 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
15278 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
15279 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
15280 in an ordinary executable.
15281
15282 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
15283 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
15284 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
15285 following commands:
15286
15287 @smallexample
15288 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
15289 @kbd{strip -g foo}
15290 @end smallexample
15291
15292 @noindent
15293 These commands remove the debugging
15294 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
15295 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
15296 two files:
15297
15298 @itemize @bullet
15299 @item
15300 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
15301 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
15302
15303 @smallexample
15304 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
15305 @end smallexample
15306
15307 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
15308 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
15309 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
15310 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
15311
15312 @item
15313 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
15314 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
15315 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
15316 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
15317 @end itemize
15318
15319 @noindent
15320
15321 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
15322 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
15323 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
15324
15325 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
15326 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
15327 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
15328 @c different ways!
15329 @ifhtml
15330 @display
15331 @html
15332 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
15333 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
15334 @end html
15335 @end display
15336 @end ifhtml
15337 @ifnothtml
15338 @display
15339 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
15340 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
15341 @end display
15342 @end ifnothtml
15343
15344 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
15345 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
15346 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
15347 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
15348 CRC.
15349
15350 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
15351 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{Remote Protocol,
15352 , @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol}). However in the
15353 case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed @emph{most}
15354 significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so trailing
15355 zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
15356
15357 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
15358 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
15359 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
15360 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
15361 @code{0xffffffff}.
15362
15363 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
15364 @smallexample
15365 unsigned long
15366 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
15367 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
15368 @{
15369 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
15370 @{
15371 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
15372 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
15373 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
15374 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
15375 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
15376 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
15377 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
15378 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
15379 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
15380 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
15381 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
15382 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
15383 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
15384 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
15385 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
15386 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
15387 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
15388 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
15389 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
15390 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
15391 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
15392 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
15393 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
15394 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
15395 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
15396 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
15397 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
15398 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
15399 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
15400 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
15401 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
15402 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
15403 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
15404 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
15405 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
15406 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
15407 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
15408 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
15409 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
15410 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
15411 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
15412 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
15413 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
15414 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
15415 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
15416 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
15417 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
15418 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
15419 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
15420 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
15421 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
15422 0x2d02ef8d
15423 @};
15424 unsigned char *end;
15425
15426 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
15427 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
15428 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
15429 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
15430 @}
15431 @end smallexample
15432
15433 @noindent
15434 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
15435
15436
15437 @node Index Files
15438 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
15439 @cindex index files
15440 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
15441
15442 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
15443 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
15444 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
15445 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
15446 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
15447 startup.
15448
15449 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
15450 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
15451 using @command{objcopy}.
15452
15453 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
15454
15455 @table @code
15456 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
15457 @kindex save gdb-index
15458 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
15459 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
15460 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
15461 @var{directory}.
15462 @end table
15463
15464 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
15465 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
15466
15467 @smallexample
15468 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
15469 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
15470 @end smallexample
15471
15472 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
15473 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
15474 currently work for programs using Ada.
15475
15476 @node Symbol Errors
15477 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
15478
15479 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
15480 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
15481 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
15482 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
15483 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
15484 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
15485 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
15486 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
15487 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
15488 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
15489 Messages}).
15490
15491 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
15492
15493 @table @code
15494 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
15495
15496 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
15497 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
15498 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
15499 in its outer scope blocks.
15500
15501 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
15502 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
15503 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
15504 function.
15505
15506 @item block at @var{address} out of order
15507
15508 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
15509 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
15510 do so.
15511
15512 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
15513 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
15514 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
15515 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
15516 Messages}.)
15517
15518 @item bad block start address patched
15519
15520 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
15521 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
15522 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
15523
15524 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
15525 starting on the previous source line.
15526
15527 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
15528
15529 @cindex foo
15530 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
15531 larger than the size of the string table.
15532
15533 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
15534 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
15535 with this name.
15536
15537 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
15538
15539 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
15540 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
15541 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
15542
15543 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
15544 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
15545 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
15546 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
15547 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
15548 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
15549
15550 @item stub type has NULL name
15551
15552 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
15553
15554 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
15555 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
15556 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
15557 it.
15558
15559 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
15560
15561 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
15562
15563 @end table
15564
15565 @node Data Files
15566 @section GDB Data Files
15567
15568 @cindex prefix for data files
15569 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
15570 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
15571
15572 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
15573 is currently using.
15574
15575 @table @code
15576 @kindex set data-directory
15577 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
15578 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
15579 to @var{directory}.
15580
15581 @kindex show data-directory
15582 @item show data-directory
15583 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
15584 @end table
15585
15586 @cindex default data directory
15587 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
15588 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
15589 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
15590 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
15591 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
15592 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
15593 location.
15594
15595 @node Targets
15596 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
15597
15598 @cindex debugging target
15599 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
15600
15601 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
15602 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
15603 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
15604 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
15605 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
15606 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
15607 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
15608 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
15609
15610 @cindex target architecture
15611 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
15612 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
15613 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
15614 command.
15615
15616 @table @code
15617 @kindex set architecture
15618 @kindex show architecture
15619 @item set architecture @var{arch}
15620 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
15621 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
15622 supported architectures.
15623
15624 @item show architecture
15625 Show the current target architecture.
15626
15627 @item set processor
15628 @itemx processor
15629 @kindex set processor
15630 @kindex show processor
15631 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
15632 and @code{show architecture}.
15633 @end table
15634
15635 @menu
15636 * Active Targets:: Active targets
15637 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
15638 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
15639 @end menu
15640
15641 @node Active Targets
15642 @section Active Targets
15643
15644 @cindex stacking targets
15645 @cindex active targets
15646 @cindex multiple targets
15647
15648 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
15649 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
15650 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
15651 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
15652 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
15653 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
15654 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
15655 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
15656 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
15657
15658 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
15659 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
15660 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
15661 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
15662
15663 @node Target Commands
15664 @section Commands for Managing Targets
15665
15666 @table @code
15667 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
15668 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
15669 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
15670 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
15671 protocol of the target machine.
15672
15673 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
15674 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
15675 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
15676
15677 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
15678 after executing the command.
15679
15680 @kindex help target
15681 @item help target
15682 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
15683 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
15684 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
15685
15686 @item help target @var{name}
15687 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
15688 select it.
15689
15690 @kindex set gnutarget
15691 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
15692 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
15693 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
15694 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
15695 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
15696 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
15697
15698 @quotation
15699 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
15700 you must know the actual BFD name.
15701 @end quotation
15702
15703 @noindent
15704 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
15705
15706 @kindex show gnutarget
15707 @item show gnutarget
15708 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
15709 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
15710 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
15711 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
15712 @end table
15713
15714 @cindex common targets
15715 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
15716 configuration):
15717
15718 @table @code
15719 @kindex target
15720 @item target exec @var{program}
15721 @cindex executable file target
15722 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
15723 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
15724
15725 @item target core @var{filename}
15726 @cindex core dump file target
15727 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
15728 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
15729
15730 @item target remote @var{medium}
15731 @cindex remote target
15732 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
15733 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
15734 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
15735
15736 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
15737 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
15738
15739 @smallexample
15740 target remote /dev/ttya
15741 @end smallexample
15742
15743 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
15744 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
15745 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
15746 clobbered by the download.
15747
15748 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
15749 @cindex built-in simulator target
15750 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
15751 In general,
15752 @smallexample
15753 target sim
15754 load
15755 run
15756 @end smallexample
15757 @noindent
15758 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
15759 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
15760 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
15761 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
15762 Processors}.
15763
15764 @end table
15765
15766 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
15767
15768 @table @code
15769
15770 @item target nrom @var{dev}
15771 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
15772 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
15773
15774 @end table
15775
15776 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
15777 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
15778
15779 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
15780 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
15781 various aspects of this process.
15782
15783 @table @code
15784
15785 @item set hash
15786 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
15787 @cindex hash mark while downloading
15788 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
15789 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
15790 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
15791 monitor.
15792
15793 @item show hash
15794 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
15795 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
15796
15797 @item set debug monitor
15798 @kindex set debug monitor
15799 @cindex display remote monitor communications
15800 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
15801 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
15802
15803 @item show debug monitor
15804 @kindex show debug monitor
15805 Show the current status of displaying communications between
15806 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
15807 @end table
15808
15809 @table @code
15810
15811 @kindex load @var{filename}
15812 @item load @var{filename}
15813 @anchor{load}
15814 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
15815 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
15816 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
15817 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
15818 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
15819 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
15820
15821 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
15822 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
15823 target is @dots{}}''
15824
15825 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
15826 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
15827 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
15828 specifies a fixed address.
15829 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
15830
15831 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
15832 load programs into flash memory.
15833
15834 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
15835 @end table
15836
15837 @node Byte Order
15838 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
15839
15840 @cindex choosing target byte order
15841 @cindex target byte order
15842
15843 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
15844 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
15845 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
15846 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
15847 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
15848 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
15849
15850 @table @code
15851 @kindex set endian
15852 @item set endian big
15853 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
15854
15855 @item set endian little
15856 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
15857
15858 @item set endian auto
15859 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
15860 executable.
15861
15862 @item show endian
15863 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
15864
15865 @end table
15866
15867 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
15868 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
15869 target system.
15870
15871
15872 @node Remote Debugging
15873 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
15874 @cindex remote debugging
15875
15876 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
15877 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
15878 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
15879 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
15880 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
15881
15882 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
15883 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
15884 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
15885 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
15886 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
15887 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
15888
15889 Other remote targets may be available in your
15890 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
15891
15892 @menu
15893 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
15894 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
15895 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
15896 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
15897 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
15898 @end menu
15899
15900 @node Connecting
15901 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
15902
15903 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
15904 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
15905 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
15906 program as the first argument.
15907
15908 @cindex @code{target remote}
15909 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
15910 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
15911 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
15912 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
15913 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
15914 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
15915
15916 @table @code
15917
15918 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
15919 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
15920 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
15921 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
15922
15923 @smallexample
15924 target remote /dev/ttyb
15925 @end smallexample
15926
15927 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
15928 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
15929 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
15930 @code{target} command.
15931
15932 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
15933 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
15934 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
15935 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
15936 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
15937 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
15938 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
15939 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
15940 target.
15941
15942 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
15943 @code{manyfarms}:
15944
15945 @smallexample
15946 target remote manyfarms:2828
15947 @end smallexample
15948
15949 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
15950 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
15951 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
15952 port 1234 on your local machine:
15953
15954 @smallexample
15955 target remote :1234
15956 @end smallexample
15957 @noindent
15958
15959 Note that the colon is still required here.
15960
15961 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
15962 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
15963 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
15964 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
15965
15966 @smallexample
15967 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
15968 @end smallexample
15969
15970 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
15971 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
15972 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
15973 cause havoc with your debugging session.
15974
15975 @item target remote | @var{command}
15976 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
15977 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
15978 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
15979 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
15980 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
15981 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
15982 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
15983 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
15984
15985 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
15986 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
15987 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
15988
15989 @end table
15990
15991 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
15992 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
15993 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
15994 need to use @kbd{run}.
15995
15996 @cindex interrupting remote programs
15997 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
15998 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
15999 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
16000 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
16001 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
16002 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
16003
16004 @smallexample
16005 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
16006 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
16007 @end smallexample
16008
16009 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
16010 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
16011 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
16012 goes back to waiting.
16013
16014 @table @code
16015 @kindex detach (remote)
16016 @item detach
16017 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
16018 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
16019 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
16020 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
16021 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
16022
16023 @kindex disconnect
16024 @item disconnect
16025 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
16026 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
16027 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
16028 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
16029 another target.
16030
16031 @cindex send command to remote monitor
16032 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
16033 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
16034 @kindex monitor
16035 @item monitor @var{cmd}
16036 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
16037 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
16038 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
16039 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
16040 and implement.
16041 @end table
16042
16043 @node File Transfer
16044 @section Sending files to a remote system
16045 @cindex remote target, file transfer
16046 @cindex file transfer
16047 @cindex sending files to remote systems
16048
16049 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
16050 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
16051 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
16052 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
16053 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
16054 the only way to upload or download files.
16055
16056 Not all remote targets support these commands.
16057
16058 @table @code
16059 @kindex remote put
16060 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
16061 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
16062 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
16063
16064 @kindex remote get
16065 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
16066 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
16067 on the host system.
16068
16069 @kindex remote delete
16070 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
16071 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
16072
16073 @end table
16074
16075 @node Server
16076 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
16077
16078 @kindex gdbserver
16079 @cindex remote connection without stubs
16080 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
16081 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
16082 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
16083
16084 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
16085 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
16086 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
16087 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
16088 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
16089 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
16090 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
16091 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
16092 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
16093 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
16094 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
16095 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
16096 choice for debugging.
16097
16098 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
16099 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
16100 protocol.
16101
16102 @quotation
16103 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
16104 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
16105 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
16106 target system with the same privileges as the user running
16107 @code{gdbserver}.
16108 @end quotation
16109
16110 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
16111 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
16112
16113 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
16114 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
16115 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
16116 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
16117 system does all the symbol handling.
16118
16119 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
16120 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
16121 syntax is:
16122
16123 @smallexample
16124 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
16125 @end smallexample
16126
16127 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
16128 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
16129 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
16130 @file{/dev/com1}:
16131
16132 @smallexample
16133 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
16134 @end smallexample
16135
16136 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
16137 with it.
16138
16139 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
16140
16141 @smallexample
16142 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
16143 @end smallexample
16144
16145 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
16146 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
16147 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
16148 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
16149 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
16150 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
16151 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
16152 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
16153 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
16154 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
16155 @code{target remote} command.
16156
16157 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
16158
16159 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
16160 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
16161
16162 @smallexample
16163 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
16164 @end smallexample
16165
16166 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
16167 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
16168
16169 @pindex pidof
16170 @cindex attach to a program by name
16171 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
16172 @code{pidof} utility:
16173
16174 @smallexample
16175 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
16176 @end smallexample
16177
16178 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
16179 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
16180 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
16181
16182 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
16183 @cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
16184 @cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
16185
16186 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
16187 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
16188 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
16189 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
16190
16191 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
16192 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
16193 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
16194 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
16195 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
16196 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
16197 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
16198 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
16199 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
16200
16201 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
16202 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
16203 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
16204 the program you want to debug.
16205
16206 @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
16207 You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
16208 (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
16209
16210 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
16211
16212 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
16213 status information about the debugging process. The
16214 @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
16215 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
16216 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
16217
16218 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
16219 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
16220 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
16221 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
16222
16223 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
16224 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
16225 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
16226 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
16227
16228 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
16229 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
16230 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
16231 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
16232
16233 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
16234 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
16235 environment:
16236
16237 @smallexample
16238 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
16239 @end smallexample
16240
16241 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
16242
16243 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
16244
16245 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
16246 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
16247 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
16248 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
16249
16250 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
16251 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
16252 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
16253 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
16254 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
16255 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
16256 programs.
16257
16258 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
16259 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
16260 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
16261 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
16262 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
16263 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
16264 already on the target.
16265
16266 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
16267 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
16268 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
16269
16270 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
16271 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
16272 Here are the available commands.
16273
16274 @table @code
16275 @item monitor help
16276 List the available monitor commands.
16277
16278 @item monitor set debug 0
16279 @itemx monitor set debug 1
16280 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
16281
16282 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
16283 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
16284 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
16285 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
16286
16287 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
16288 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
16289 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
16290 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
16291 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
16292 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to an empty list.
16293
16294 @item monitor exit
16295 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
16296 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
16297 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
16298 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
16299 of a multi-process mode debug session.
16300
16301 @end table
16302
16303 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
16304 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
16305
16306 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
16307 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
16308
16309 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
16310 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
16311 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
16312 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
16313 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
16314 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
16315 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
16316 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
16317 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
16318 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
16319 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
16320 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
16321
16322 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
16323
16324 @table @code
16325 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
16326
16327 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
16328 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
16329 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
16330
16331 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
16332
16333 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
16334 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
16335 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
16336 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
16337 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
16338 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
16339
16340 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
16341
16342 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
16343 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
16344 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
16345 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
16346 command for that. For example:
16347
16348 @smallexample
16349 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
16350 @end smallexample
16351
16352 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
16353 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
16354 @end table
16355
16356 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
16357 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
16358 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
16359 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
16360 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
16361 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
16362 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
16363 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
16364 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
16365 @code{gdbserver} like so:
16366
16367 @smallexample
16368 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
16369 @end smallexample
16370
16371 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
16372
16373 @smallexample
16374 $ gdb myprogram
16375 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
16376 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
16377 (@value{GDBP}) b main
16378 (@value{GDBP}) continue
16379 @end smallexample
16380
16381 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
16382 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
16383 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
16384 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
16385 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
16386 tracing.
16387
16388 @node Remote Configuration
16389 @section Remote Configuration
16390
16391 @kindex set remote
16392 @kindex show remote
16393 This section documents the configuration options available when
16394 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
16395 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
16396 system-call-allowed}.
16397
16398 @table @code
16399 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
16400 @cindex address size for remote targets
16401 @cindex bits in remote address
16402 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
16403 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
16404 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
16405 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
16406
16407 @item show remoteaddresssize
16408 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
16409
16410 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
16411 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
16412 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
16413 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
16414 remote targets.
16415
16416 @item show remotebaud
16417 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
16418
16419 @item set remotebreak
16420 @cindex interrupt remote programs
16421 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
16422 @anchor{set remotebreak}
16423 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
16424 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
16425 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
16426 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
16427 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
16428
16429 @item show remotebreak
16430 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
16431 interrupt the remote program.
16432
16433 @item set remoteflow on
16434 @itemx set remoteflow off
16435 @kindex set remoteflow
16436 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
16437 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
16438
16439 @item show remoteflow
16440 @kindex show remoteflow
16441 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
16442
16443 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
16444 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
16445 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
16446 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
16447 @code{ascii}.
16448
16449 @item show remotelogbase
16450 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
16451 protocol.
16452
16453 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
16454 @cindex record serial communications on file
16455 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
16456 default is not to record at all.
16457
16458 @item show remotelogfile.
16459 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
16460 serial communications.
16461
16462 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
16463 @cindex timeout for serial communications
16464 @cindex remote timeout
16465 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
16466 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
16467
16468 @item show remotetimeout
16469 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
16470 responses.
16471
16472 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
16473 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
16474 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
16475 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
16476 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
16477 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
16478 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
16479 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
16480
16481 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
16482 @itemx show remote exec-file
16483 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
16484 @cindex executable file, for remote target
16485 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
16486 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
16487 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
16488 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
16489
16490 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
16491 @cindex interrupt remote programs
16492 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
16493 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
16494 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
16495 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
16496 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
16497 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
16498 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
16499 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
16500
16501 @item show interrupt-sequence
16502 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
16503 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
16504 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
16505 also known as Magic SysRq g.
16506
16507 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
16508 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
16509 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
16510 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
16511 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
16512 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
16513
16514 @item show interrupt-on-connect
16515 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
16516 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
16517
16518 @kindex set tcp
16519 @kindex show tcp
16520 @item set tcp auto-retry on
16521 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
16522 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
16523 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
16524 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
16525 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
16526 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
16527 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
16528 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
16529
16530 @item set tcp auto-retry off
16531 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
16532
16533 @item show tcp auto-retry
16534 Show the current auto-retry setting.
16535
16536 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
16537 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
16538 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
16539 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
16540 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
16541 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
16542 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
16543 value.
16544
16545 @item show tcp connect-timeout
16546 Show the current connection timeout setting.
16547 @end table
16548
16549 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
16550 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
16551 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
16552 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
16553 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
16554 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
16555 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
16556 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
16557 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
16558
16559 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
16560 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
16561 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
16562 @value{GDBN} developers.
16563
16564 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
16565 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
16566 are:
16567
16568 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
16569 @item Command Name
16570 @tab Remote Packet
16571 @tab Related Features
16572
16573 @item @code{fetch-register}
16574 @tab @code{p}
16575 @tab @code{info registers}
16576
16577 @item @code{set-register}
16578 @tab @code{P}
16579 @tab @code{set}
16580
16581 @item @code{binary-download}
16582 @tab @code{X}
16583 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
16584
16585 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
16586 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
16587 @tab @code{info auxv}
16588
16589 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
16590 @tab @code{qSymbol}
16591 @tab Detecting multiple threads
16592
16593 @item @code{attach}
16594 @tab @code{vAttach}
16595 @tab @code{attach}
16596
16597 @item @code{verbose-resume}
16598 @tab @code{vCont}
16599 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
16600
16601 @item @code{run}
16602 @tab @code{vRun}
16603 @tab @code{run}
16604
16605 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
16606 @tab @code{Z0}
16607 @tab @code{break}
16608
16609 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
16610 @tab @code{Z1}
16611 @tab @code{hbreak}
16612
16613 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
16614 @tab @code{Z2}
16615 @tab @code{watch}
16616
16617 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
16618 @tab @code{Z3}
16619 @tab @code{rwatch}
16620
16621 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
16622 @tab @code{Z4}
16623 @tab @code{awatch}
16624
16625 @item @code{target-features}
16626 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
16627 @tab @code{set architecture}
16628
16629 @item @code{library-info}
16630 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
16631 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
16632
16633 @item @code{memory-map}
16634 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
16635 @tab @code{info mem}
16636
16637 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
16638 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
16639 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
16640
16641 @item @code{read-spu-object}
16642 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
16643 @tab @code{info spu}
16644
16645 @item @code{write-spu-object}
16646 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
16647 @tab @code{info spu}
16648
16649 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
16650 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
16651 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
16652
16653 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
16654 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
16655 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
16656
16657 @item @code{threads}
16658 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
16659 @tab @code{info threads}
16660
16661 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
16662 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
16663 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
16664
16665 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
16666 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
16667 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
16668
16669 @item @code{search-memory}
16670 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
16671 @tab @code{find}
16672
16673 @item @code{supported-packets}
16674 @tab @code{qSupported}
16675 @tab Remote communications parameters
16676
16677 @item @code{pass-signals}
16678 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
16679 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
16680
16681 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
16682 @tab @code{vFile:close}
16683 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
16684
16685 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
16686 @tab @code{vFile:open}
16687 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
16688
16689 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
16690 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
16691 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
16692
16693 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
16694 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
16695 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
16696
16697 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
16698 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
16699 @tab @code{remote delete}
16700
16701 @item @code{noack-packet}
16702 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
16703 @tab Packet acknowledgment
16704
16705 @item @code{osdata}
16706 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
16707 @tab @code{info os}
16708
16709 @item @code{query-attached}
16710 @tab @code{qAttached}
16711 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
16712 @end multitable
16713
16714 @node Remote Stub
16715 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
16716
16717 @cindex debugging stub, example
16718 @cindex remote stub, example
16719 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
16720 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
16721 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
16722 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
16723 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
16724 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
16725 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
16726 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
16727
16728 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
16729 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
16730 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
16731 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
16732 program, you need:
16733
16734 @enumerate
16735 @item
16736 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
16737 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
16738 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
16739
16740 @item
16741 A C subroutine library to support your program's
16742 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
16743
16744 @item
16745 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
16746 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
16747 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
16748 documentation.
16749 @end enumerate
16750
16751 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
16752 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
16753 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
16754
16755 @table @emph
16756 @item On the host,
16757 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
16758 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
16759 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16760
16761 @item On the target,
16762 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
16763 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
16764 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
16765
16766 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
16767 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
16768 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
16769 @end table
16770
16771 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
16772 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
16773 @sc{sparc} boards.
16774
16775 @cindex remote serial stub list
16776 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
16777
16778 @table @code
16779
16780 @item i386-stub.c
16781 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
16782 @cindex Intel
16783 @cindex i386
16784 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
16785
16786 @item m68k-stub.c
16787 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
16788 @cindex Motorola 680x0
16789 @cindex m680x0
16790 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
16791
16792 @item sh-stub.c
16793 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
16794 @cindex Renesas
16795 @cindex SH
16796 For Renesas SH architectures.
16797
16798 @item sparc-stub.c
16799 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
16800 @cindex Sparc
16801 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
16802
16803 @item sparcl-stub.c
16804 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
16805 @cindex Fujitsu
16806 @cindex SparcLite
16807 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
16808
16809 @end table
16810
16811 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
16812 recently added stubs.
16813
16814 @menu
16815 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
16816 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
16817 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
16818 @end menu
16819
16820 @node Stub Contents
16821 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
16822
16823 @cindex remote serial stub
16824 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
16825 subroutines:
16826
16827 @table @code
16828 @item set_debug_traps
16829 @findex set_debug_traps
16830 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
16831 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
16832 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
16833 beginning of your program.
16834
16835 @item handle_exception
16836 @findex handle_exception
16837 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
16838 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
16839 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
16840 run when a trap is triggered.
16841
16842 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
16843 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
16844 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
16845 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
16846 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
16847 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
16848 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
16849 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
16850 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
16851 machine.
16852
16853 @item breakpoint
16854 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
16855 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
16856 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
16857 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
16858 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
16859 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
16860 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
16861 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
16862 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
16863 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
16864 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
16865
16866 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
16867 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
16868 start of your debugging session.
16869 @end table
16870
16871 @node Bootstrapping
16872 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
16873
16874 @cindex remote stub, support routines
16875 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
16876 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
16877 debugging target machine.
16878
16879 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
16880 serial port.
16881
16882 @table @code
16883 @item int getDebugChar()
16884 @findex getDebugChar
16885 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
16886 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
16887 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
16888
16889 @item void putDebugChar(int)
16890 @findex putDebugChar
16891 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
16892 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
16893 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
16894 @end table
16895
16896 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
16897 @cindex interrupting remote targets
16898 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
16899 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
16900 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
16901 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
16902 remote system to stop.
16903
16904 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
16905 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
16906 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
16907 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
16908
16909 Other routines you need to supply are:
16910
16911 @table @code
16912 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
16913 @findex exceptionHandler
16914 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
16915 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
16916 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
16917 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
16918 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
16919 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
16920 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
16921 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
16922 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
16923 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
16924 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
16925 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
16926 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
16927
16928 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
16929 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
16930 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
16931 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
16932 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
16933
16934 @item void flush_i_cache()
16935 @findex flush_i_cache
16936 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
16937 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
16938 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
16939
16940 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
16941 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
16942 @end table
16943
16944 @noindent
16945 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
16946
16947 @table @code
16948 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
16949 @findex memset
16950 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
16951 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
16952 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
16953 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
16954 @end table
16955
16956 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
16957 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
16958 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
16959 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
16960
16961
16962 @node Debug Session
16963 @subsection Putting it All Together
16964
16965 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
16966 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
16967 steps.
16968
16969 @enumerate
16970 @item
16971 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
16972 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
16973 @display
16974 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
16975 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
16976 @end display
16977
16978 @item
16979 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
16980
16981 @smallexample
16982 set_debug_traps();
16983 breakpoint();
16984 @end smallexample
16985
16986 @item
16987 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
16988 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
16989
16990 @smallexample
16991 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
16992 @end smallexample
16993
16994 @noindent
16995 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
16996 function in your program, that function is called when
16997 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
16998 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
16999 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
17000
17001 @item
17002 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
17003 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
17004
17005 @item
17006 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
17007 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
17008
17009 @item
17010 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
17011 @c document that. FIXME.
17012 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
17013 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
17014
17015 @item
17016 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
17017 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
17018
17019 @end enumerate
17020
17021 @node Configurations
17022 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
17023
17024 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
17025 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
17026 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
17027
17028 There are three major categories of configurations: native
17029 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
17030 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
17031 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
17032 are quite different from each other.
17033
17034 @menu
17035 * Native::
17036 * Embedded OS::
17037 * Embedded Processors::
17038 * Architectures::
17039 @end menu
17040
17041 @node Native
17042 @section Native
17043
17044 This section describes details specific to particular native
17045 configurations.
17046
17047 @menu
17048 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
17049 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
17050 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
17051 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
17052 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
17053 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
17054 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
17055 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
17056 @end menu
17057
17058 @node HP-UX
17059 @subsection HP-UX
17060
17061 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
17062 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
17063 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
17064
17065
17066 @node BSD libkvm Interface
17067 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
17068
17069 @cindex libkvm
17070 @cindex kernel memory image
17071 @cindex kernel crash dump
17072
17073 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
17074 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
17075 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
17076 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
17077 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
17078 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
17079 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
17080 @code{kvm} target:
17081
17082 @smallexample
17083 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
17084 @end smallexample
17085
17086 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
17087 argument:
17088
17089 @smallexample
17090 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
17091 @end smallexample
17092
17093 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
17094 available:
17095
17096 @table @code
17097 @kindex kvm
17098 @item kvm pcb
17099 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
17100
17101 @item kvm proc
17102 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
17103 modern FreeBSD systems.
17104 @end table
17105
17106 @node SVR4 Process Information
17107 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
17108 @cindex /proc
17109 @cindex examine process image
17110 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
17111
17112 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
17113 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
17114 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
17115 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
17116 proc} is available to report information about the process running
17117 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
17118 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
17119 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
17120 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
17121
17122 @table @code
17123 @kindex info proc
17124 @cindex process ID
17125 @item info proc
17126 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
17127 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
17128 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
17129 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
17130 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
17131 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
17132 executable file's absolute file name.
17133
17134 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
17135 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
17136 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
17137 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
17138 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
17139 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
17140
17141 @item info proc mappings
17142 @cindex memory address space mappings
17143 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
17144 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
17145 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
17146 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
17147 memory access rights to that range.
17148
17149 @item info proc stat
17150 @itemx info proc status
17151 @cindex process detailed status information
17152 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
17153 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
17154 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
17155 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
17156 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
17157 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
17158 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
17159
17160 @item info proc all
17161 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
17162 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
17163
17164 @ignore
17165 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
17166 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
17167 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
17168 @kindex info proc times
17169 @item info proc times
17170 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
17171 its children.
17172
17173 @kindex info proc id
17174 @item info proc id
17175 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
17176 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
17177 @end ignore
17178
17179 @item set procfs-trace
17180 @kindex set procfs-trace
17181 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
17182 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
17183
17184 @item show procfs-trace
17185 @kindex show procfs-trace
17186 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
17187
17188 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
17189 @kindex set procfs-file
17190 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
17191 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
17192 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
17193 standard output.
17194
17195 @item show procfs-file
17196 @kindex show procfs-file
17197 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
17198
17199 @item proc-trace-entry
17200 @itemx proc-trace-exit
17201 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
17202 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
17203 @kindex proc-trace-entry
17204 @kindex proc-trace-exit
17205 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
17206 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
17207 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
17208 from the @code{syscall} interface.
17209
17210 @item info pidlist
17211 @kindex info pidlist
17212 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
17213 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
17214 processes and all the threads within each process.
17215
17216 @item info meminfo
17217 @kindex info meminfo
17218 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
17219 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
17220 @end table
17221
17222 @node DJGPP Native
17223 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
17224 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
17225 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
17226 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
17227
17228 @cindex DPMI
17229 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
17230 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
17231 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
17232 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
17233
17234 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
17235 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
17236 subsection describes those commands.
17237
17238 @table @code
17239 @kindex info dos
17240 @item info dos
17241 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
17242 information about the target system and important OS structures.
17243
17244 @kindex sysinfo
17245 @cindex MS-DOS system info
17246 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
17247 @item info dos sysinfo
17248 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
17249 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
17250 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
17251
17252 @cindex GDT
17253 @cindex LDT
17254 @cindex IDT
17255 @cindex segment descriptor tables
17256 @cindex descriptor tables display
17257 @item info dos gdt
17258 @itemx info dos ldt
17259 @itemx info dos idt
17260 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
17261 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
17262 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
17263 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
17264 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
17265 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
17266 rights.
17267
17268 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
17269 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
17270 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
17271 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
17272 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
17273
17274 @cindex garbled pointers
17275 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
17276 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
17277 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
17278 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
17279 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
17280 debugged program's data segment:
17281
17282 @smallexample
17283 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
17284 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
17285 @end smallexample
17286
17287 @noindent
17288 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
17289 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
17290
17291 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
17292 @item info dos pde
17293 @itemx info dos pte
17294 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
17295 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
17296 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
17297 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
17298 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
17299 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
17300 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
17301 that is currently in use.
17302
17303 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
17304 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
17305 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
17306 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
17307 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
17308 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
17309 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
17310
17311 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
17312 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
17313 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
17314 controller.
17315
17316 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
17317
17318 @cindex physical address from linear address
17319 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
17320 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
17321 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
17322 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
17323 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
17324 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
17325 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
17326
17327 @smallexample
17328 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
17329 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
17330 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
17331 @end smallexample
17332
17333 @noindent
17334 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
17335 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
17336 attributes of that page.
17337
17338 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
17339 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
17340 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
17341 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
17342 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
17343 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
17344
17345 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
17346 transfer buffer:
17347
17348 @smallexample
17349 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
17350 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
17351 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
17352 @end smallexample
17353
17354 @noindent
17355 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
17356 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
17357 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
17358 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
17359 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
17360
17361 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
17362 @end table
17363
17364 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
17365 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
17366 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
17367 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
17368
17369 @table @code
17370 @kindex set com1base
17371 @kindex set com1irq
17372 @kindex set com2base
17373 @kindex set com2irq
17374 @kindex set com3base
17375 @kindex set com3irq
17376 @kindex set com4base
17377 @kindex set com4irq
17378 @item set com1base @var{addr}
17379 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
17380 port.
17381
17382 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
17383 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
17384 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
17385
17386 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
17387 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
17388 other 3 COM ports.
17389
17390 @kindex show com1base
17391 @kindex show com1irq
17392 @kindex show com2base
17393 @kindex show com2irq
17394 @kindex show com3base
17395 @kindex show com3irq
17396 @kindex show com4base
17397 @kindex show com4irq
17398 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
17399 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
17400 lines used by the COM ports.
17401
17402 @item info serial
17403 @kindex info serial
17404 @cindex DOS serial port status
17405 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
17406 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
17407 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
17408 counts of various errors encountered so far.
17409 @end table
17410
17411
17412 @node Cygwin Native
17413 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
17414 @cindex MS Windows debugging
17415 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
17416 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
17417
17418 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
17419 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
17420
17421 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
17422 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
17423 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
17424 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
17425 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
17426 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
17427 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
17428 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
17429
17430 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
17431 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
17432 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
17433
17434 @table @code
17435 @kindex info w32
17436 @item info w32
17437 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
17438 information about the target system and important OS structures.
17439
17440 @item info w32 selector
17441 This command displays information returned by
17442 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
17443 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
17444 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
17445 Without argument, this command displays information
17446 about the six segment registers.
17447
17448 @item info w32 thread-information-block
17449 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
17450 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
17451 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
17452
17453 @kindex info dll
17454 @item info dll
17455 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
17456
17457 @kindex dll-symbols
17458 @item dll-symbols
17459 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
17460 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
17461
17462 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
17463 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
17464 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
17465 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
17466 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
17467 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
17468 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
17469 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
17470 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
17471 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
17472 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
17473
17474 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
17475 @item show cygwin-exceptions
17476 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
17477 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
17478
17479 @kindex set new-console
17480 @item set new-console @var{mode}
17481 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
17482 be started in a new console on next start.
17483 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
17484 be started in the same console as the debugger.
17485
17486 @kindex show new-console
17487 @item show new-console
17488 Displays whether a new console is used
17489 when the debuggee is started.
17490
17491 @kindex set new-group
17492 @item set new-group @var{mode}
17493 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
17494 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
17495 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
17496 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
17497
17498 @kindex show new-group
17499 @item show new-group
17500 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
17501
17502 @kindex set debugevents
17503 @item set debugevents
17504 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
17505 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
17506 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
17507 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
17508 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
17509
17510 @kindex set debugexec
17511 @item set debugexec
17512 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
17513 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
17514
17515 @kindex set debugexceptions
17516 @item set debugexceptions
17517 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
17518 debuggee seen by the debugger.
17519
17520 @kindex set debugmemory
17521 @item set debugmemory
17522 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
17523 and writes by the debugger.
17524
17525 @kindex set shell
17526 @item set shell
17527 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
17528 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
17529
17530 @kindex show shell
17531 @item show shell
17532 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
17533
17534 @end table
17535
17536 @menu
17537 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
17538 @end menu
17539
17540 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
17541 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
17542 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
17543 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
17544
17545 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
17546 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
17547 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
17548 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
17549 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
17550 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
17551 ``minimal symbols''.
17552
17553 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
17554 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
17555 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
17556 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
17557 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
17558 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
17559 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
17560 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
17561 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
17562 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
17563
17564 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
17565
17566 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
17567 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
17568 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
17569 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
17570 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
17571 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
17572 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
17573 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
17574 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
17575
17576 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
17577 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
17578 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
17579 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
17580 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
17581 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
17582
17583 @smallexample
17584 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
17585 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
17586
17587 Non-debugging symbols:
17588 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
17589 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
17590 @end smallexample
17591
17592 @smallexample
17593 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
17594 All functions matching regular expression "!":
17595
17596 Non-debugging symbols:
17597 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
17598 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
17599 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
17600 [etc...]
17601 @end smallexample
17602
17603 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
17604
17605 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
17606 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
17607 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
17608 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
17609 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
17610 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
17611 a function within a DLL without a running program.
17612
17613 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
17614 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
17615 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
17616 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
17617 problem:
17618
17619 @smallexample
17620 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
17621 $1 = 268572168
17622 @end smallexample
17623
17624 @smallexample
17625 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
17626 0x10021610: "\230y\""
17627 @end smallexample
17628
17629 And two possible solutions:
17630
17631 @smallexample
17632 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
17633 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
17634 @end smallexample
17635
17636 @smallexample
17637 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
17638 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
17639 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
17640 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
17641 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
17642 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
17643 @end smallexample
17644
17645 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
17646 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
17647 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
17648 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
17649 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
17650
17651 @smallexample
17652 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
17653 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
17654 @end smallexample
17655
17656 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
17657 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
17658 safe.
17659
17660 @node Hurd Native
17661 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
17662 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
17663
17664 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
17665 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
17666
17667 @table @code
17668 @item set signals
17669 @itemx set sigs
17670 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
17671 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
17672 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
17673 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
17674 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
17675 @code{signals}.
17676
17677 @item show signals
17678 @itemx show sigs
17679 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
17680 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
17681 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
17682
17683 @item set signal-thread
17684 @itemx set sigthread
17685 @kindex set signal-thread
17686 @kindex set sigthread
17687 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
17688 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
17689 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
17690 signal-thread}.
17691
17692 @item show signal-thread
17693 @itemx show sigthread
17694 @kindex show signal-thread
17695 @kindex show sigthread
17696 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
17697 delivered a signal.
17698
17699 @item set stopped
17700 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
17701 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
17702 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
17703 continued by delivering a signal to it.
17704
17705 @item show stopped
17706 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
17707 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
17708 stopped.
17709
17710 @item set exceptions
17711 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
17712 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
17713 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
17714 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
17715 trapping on.
17716
17717 @item show exceptions
17718 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
17719 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
17720
17721 @item set task pause
17722 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
17723 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
17724 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
17725 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
17726 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
17727 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
17728 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
17729 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
17730 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
17731
17732 @item show task pause
17733 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
17734 Show the current state of task suspension.
17735
17736 @item set task detach-suspend-count
17737 @cindex task suspend count
17738 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17739 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
17740 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
17741
17742 @item show task detach-suspend-count
17743 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
17744
17745 @item set task exception-port
17746 @itemx set task excp
17747 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17748 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
17749 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
17750 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
17751
17752 @item set noninvasive
17753 @cindex noninvasive task options
17754 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
17755 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
17756 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
17757 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
17758
17759 @item info send-rights
17760 @itemx info receive-rights
17761 @itemx info port-rights
17762 @itemx info port-sets
17763 @itemx info dead-names
17764 @itemx info ports
17765 @itemx info psets
17766 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17767 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17768 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17769 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17770 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17771 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
17772 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
17773 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
17774 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
17775
17776 @item set thread pause
17777 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
17778 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17779 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
17780 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
17781 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
17782 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
17783 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
17784 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
17785 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
17786 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
17787 only the current thread.
17788
17789 @item show thread pause
17790 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
17791 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
17792
17793 @item set thread run
17794 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
17795
17796 @item show thread run
17797 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
17798
17799 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
17800 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17801 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17802 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
17803 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
17804 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
17805 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
17806
17807 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
17808 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
17809 detaching.
17810
17811 @item set thread exception-port
17812 @itemx set thread excp
17813 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
17814 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
17815 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
17816
17817 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
17818 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
17819 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
17820 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
17821
17822 @item set thread default
17823 @itemx show thread default
17824 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
17825 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
17826 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
17827 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
17828 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
17829 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
17830 the non-default commands.
17831 @end table
17832
17833
17834 @node Neutrino
17835 @subsection QNX Neutrino
17836 @cindex QNX Neutrino
17837
17838 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
17839 Neutrino target:
17840
17841 @table @code
17842 @item set debug nto-debug
17843 @kindex set debug nto-debug
17844 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
17845 Neutrino support.
17846
17847 @item show debug nto-debug
17848 @kindex show debug nto-debug
17849 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
17850 @end table
17851
17852 @node Darwin
17853 @subsection Darwin
17854 @cindex Darwin
17855
17856 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
17857
17858 @table @code
17859 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
17860 @kindex set debug darwin
17861 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
17862 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
17863
17864 @item show debug darwin
17865 @kindex show debug darwin
17866 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
17867
17868 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
17869 @kindex set debug mach-o
17870 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
17871 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
17872 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
17873 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
17874 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
17875 usage.
17876
17877 @item show debug mach-o
17878 @kindex show debug mach-o
17879 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
17880
17881 @item set mach-exceptions on
17882 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
17883 @kindex set mach-exceptions
17884 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
17885 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
17886 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
17887 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
17888
17889 @item show mach-exceptions
17890 @kindex show mach-exceptions
17891 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
17892 @end table
17893
17894
17895 @node Embedded OS
17896 @section Embedded Operating Systems
17897
17898 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
17899 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
17900 architectures.
17901
17902 @menu
17903 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
17904 @end menu
17905
17906 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
17907 various real-time operating systems.
17908
17909 @node VxWorks
17910 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
17911
17912 @cindex VxWorks
17913
17914 @table @code
17915
17916 @kindex target vxworks
17917 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
17918 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
17919 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
17920
17921 @end table
17922
17923 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
17924 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
17925
17926 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
17927 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
17928 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
17929 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
17930 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
17931 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
17932 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
17933
17934 @table @code
17935 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
17936 @kindex vxworks-timeout
17937 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
17938 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
17939 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
17940 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
17941 of a thin network line.
17942 @end table
17943
17944 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
17945 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
17946 procedures.
17947
17948 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
17949 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
17950 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
17951 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
17952 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
17953 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
17954 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
17955 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
17956 manual.
17957 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
17958
17959 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
17960 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
17961 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
17962 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
17963
17964 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
17965
17966 @smallexample
17967 (vxgdb)
17968 @end smallexample
17969
17970 @menu
17971 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
17972 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
17973 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
17974 @end menu
17975
17976 @node VxWorks Connection
17977 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
17978
17979 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
17980 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
17981
17982 @smallexample
17983 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
17984 @end smallexample
17985
17986 @need 750
17987 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
17988
17989 @smallexample
17990 Attaching remote machine across net...
17991 Connected to tt.
17992 @end smallexample
17993
17994 @need 1000
17995 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
17996 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
17997 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
17998 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
17999 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
18000
18001 @smallexample
18002 prog.o: No such file or directory.
18003 @end smallexample
18004
18005 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
18006 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
18007 command again.
18008
18009 @node VxWorks Download
18010 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
18011
18012 @cindex download to VxWorks
18013 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
18014 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
18015 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
18016 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
18017 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
18018 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
18019 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
18020 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
18021 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
18022 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
18023 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
18024 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
18025 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
18026 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
18027 program, type this on VxWorks:
18028
18029 @smallexample
18030 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
18031 @end smallexample
18032
18033 @noindent
18034 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
18035
18036 @smallexample
18037 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
18038 (vxgdb) load prog.o
18039 @end smallexample
18040
18041 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
18042
18043 @smallexample
18044 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
18045 @end smallexample
18046
18047 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
18048 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
18049 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
18050 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
18051 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
18052 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
18053 table.)
18054
18055 @node VxWorks Attach
18056 @subsubsection Running Tasks
18057
18058 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
18059 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
18060 follows:
18061
18062 @smallexample
18063 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
18064 @end smallexample
18065
18066 @noindent
18067 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
18068 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
18069 the time of attachment.
18070
18071 @node Embedded Processors
18072 @section Embedded Processors
18073
18074 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
18075 configurations.
18076
18077 @cindex send command to simulator
18078 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
18079 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
18080
18081 @table @code
18082 @item sim @var{command}
18083 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
18084 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
18085 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
18086 acceptable commands.
18087 @end table
18088
18089
18090 @menu
18091 * ARM:: ARM RDI
18092 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
18093 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
18094 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
18095 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
18096 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
18097 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
18098 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
18099 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
18100 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
18101 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
18102 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
18103 * CRIS:: CRIS
18104 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
18105 @end menu
18106
18107 @node ARM
18108 @subsection ARM
18109 @cindex ARM RDI
18110
18111 @table @code
18112 @kindex target rdi
18113 @item target rdi @var{dev}
18114 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
18115 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
18116 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
18117
18118 @kindex target rdp
18119 @item target rdp @var{dev}
18120 ARM Demon monitor.
18121
18122 @end table
18123
18124 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
18125
18126 @table @code
18127 @item set arm disassembler
18128 @kindex set arm
18129 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
18130 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
18131
18132 @item show arm disassembler
18133 @kindex show arm
18134 Show the current disassembly style.
18135
18136 @item set arm apcs32
18137 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
18138 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
18139
18140 @item show arm apcs32
18141 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
18142
18143 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
18144 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
18145 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
18146
18147 @table @code
18148 @item auto
18149 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
18150 @item softfpa
18151 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
18152 processors.
18153 @item fpa
18154 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
18155 @item softvfp
18156 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
18157 @item vfp
18158 VFP co-processor.
18159 @end table
18160
18161 @item show arm fpu
18162 Show the current type of the FPU.
18163
18164 @item set arm abi
18165 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
18166
18167 @item show arm abi
18168 Show the currently used ABI.
18169
18170 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
18171 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
18172 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
18173 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
18174 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
18175 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
18176 register).
18177
18178 @item show arm fallback-mode
18179 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
18180
18181 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
18182 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
18183 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
18184 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
18185 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
18186
18187 @item show arm force-mode
18188 Show the current forced instruction mode.
18189
18190 @item set debug arm
18191 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
18192 target support subsystem.
18193
18194 @item show debug arm
18195 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
18196 @end table
18197
18198 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
18199 using the RDI interface:
18200
18201 @table @code
18202 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
18203 @kindex rdilogfile
18204 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
18205 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
18206 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
18207 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
18208 @file{rdi.log}.
18209
18210 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
18211 @kindex rdilogenable
18212 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
18213 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
18214 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
18215 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
18216 are logged to a file.
18217
18218 @item set rdiromatzero
18219 @kindex set rdiromatzero
18220 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
18221 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
18222 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
18223 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
18224 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
18225
18226 @item show rdiromatzero
18227 @kindex show rdiromatzero
18228 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
18229
18230 @item set rdiheartbeat
18231 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
18232 @cindex RDI heartbeat
18233 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
18234 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
18235 well as the Angel monitor.
18236
18237 @item show rdiheartbeat
18238 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
18239 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
18240 @end table
18241
18242 @table @code
18243 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
18244 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
18245
18246 @table @code
18247 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
18248 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support.
18249 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
18250 The default value is @code{all}.
18251
18252 @table @code
18253 @item none
18254 @item demon
18255 @item angel
18256 @item redboot
18257 @item all
18258 @end table
18259 @end table
18260 @end table
18261
18262 @node M32R/D
18263 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
18264
18265 @table @code
18266 @kindex target m32r
18267 @item target m32r @var{dev}
18268 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
18269
18270 @kindex target m32rsdi
18271 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
18272 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
18273 @end table
18274
18275 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
18276
18277 @table @code
18278 @item set download-path @var{path}
18279 @kindex set download-path
18280 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
18281 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
18282
18283 @item show download-path
18284 @kindex show download-path
18285 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
18286
18287 @item set board-address @var{addr}
18288 @kindex set board-address
18289 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
18290 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
18291
18292 @item show board-address
18293 @kindex show board-address
18294 Show the current IP address of the target board.
18295
18296 @item set server-address @var{addr}
18297 @kindex set server-address
18298 @cindex download server address (M32R)
18299 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
18300 host machine.
18301
18302 @item show server-address
18303 @kindex show server-address
18304 Display the IP address of the download server.
18305
18306 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
18307 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
18308 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
18309 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
18310 executable file is uploaded.
18311
18312 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
18313 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
18314 Test the @code{upload} command.
18315 @end table
18316
18317 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
18318
18319 @table @code
18320 @item sdireset
18321 @kindex sdireset
18322 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
18323 This command resets the SDI connection.
18324
18325 @item sdistatus
18326 @kindex sdistatus
18327 This command shows the SDI connection status.
18328
18329 @item debug_chaos
18330 @kindex debug_chaos
18331 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
18332 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
18333
18334 @item use_debug_dma
18335 @kindex use_debug_dma
18336 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
18337
18338 @item use_mon_code
18339 @kindex use_mon_code
18340 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
18341
18342 @item use_ib_break
18343 @kindex use_ib_break
18344 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
18345
18346 @item use_dbt_break
18347 @kindex use_dbt_break
18348 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
18349 @end table
18350
18351 @node M68K
18352 @subsection M68k
18353
18354 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
18355 target command for the following ROM monitor.
18356
18357 @table @code
18358
18359 @kindex target dbug
18360 @item target dbug @var{dev}
18361 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
18362
18363 @end table
18364
18365 @node MicroBlaze
18366 @subsection MicroBlaze
18367 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
18368 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
18369
18370 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
18371 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
18372 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
18373 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
18374 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
18375 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
18376 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
18377 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
18378 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
18379 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
18380 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
18381
18382 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
18383
18384 @table @code
18385 @item target remote :1234
18386 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
18387 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
18388
18389 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
18390 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
18391 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
18392
18393 @item load
18394 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
18395
18396 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
18397 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
18398
18399 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
18400 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
18401 @end table
18402
18403 @node MIPS Embedded
18404 @subsection MIPS Embedded
18405
18406 @cindex MIPS boards
18407 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
18408 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
18409 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
18410
18411 @need 1000
18412 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
18413
18414 @table @code
18415 @item target mips @var{port}
18416 @kindex target mips @var{port}
18417 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
18418 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
18419 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
18420 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
18421 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
18422 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
18423
18424 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
18425 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
18426 debugger:
18427
18428 @smallexample
18429 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
18430 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
18431 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
18432 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
18433 (@value{GDBP}) run
18434 @end smallexample
18435
18436 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
18437 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
18438 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
18439 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
18440 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
18441
18442 @item target pmon @var{port}
18443 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
18444 PMON ROM monitor.
18445
18446 @item target ddb @var{port}
18447 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
18448 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
18449
18450 @item target lsi @var{port}
18451 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
18452 LSI variant of PMON.
18453
18454 @kindex target r3900
18455 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
18456 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
18457
18458 @kindex target array
18459 @item target array @var{dev}
18460 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
18461
18462 @end table
18463
18464
18465 @noindent
18466 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
18467
18468 @table @code
18469 @item set mipsfpu double
18470 @itemx set mipsfpu single
18471 @itemx set mipsfpu none
18472 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
18473 @itemx show mipsfpu
18474 @kindex set mipsfpu
18475 @kindex show mipsfpu
18476 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
18477 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
18478 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
18479 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
18480 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
18481 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
18482 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
18483 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
18484 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
18485 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
18486 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
18487 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
18488 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
18489
18490 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
18491 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
18492 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
18493
18494 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
18495 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
18496
18497 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
18498 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
18499 @itemx show timeout
18500 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
18501 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
18502 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
18503 @kindex set timeout
18504 @kindex show timeout
18505 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
18506 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
18507 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
18508 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
18509 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
18510 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
18511 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
18512 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
18513 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
18514 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
18515
18516 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
18517 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
18518 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
18519 to run before stopping.
18520
18521 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
18522 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
18523 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
18524 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
18525 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
18526 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
18527
18528 @item show syn-garbage-limit
18529 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
18530 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
18531 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
18532
18533 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
18534 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
18535 @cindex remote monitor prompt
18536 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
18537 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
18538 @table @asis
18539 @item pmon target
18540 @samp{PMON}
18541 @item ddb target
18542 @samp{NEC010}
18543 @item lsi target
18544 @samp{PMON>}
18545 @end table
18546
18547 @item show monitor-prompt
18548 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
18549 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
18550 remote monitor.
18551
18552 @item set monitor-warnings
18553 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
18554 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
18555 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
18556 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
18557 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
18558
18559 @item show monitor-warnings
18560 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
18561 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
18562
18563 @item pmon @var{command}
18564 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
18565 @cindex send PMON command
18566 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
18567 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
18568 @end table
18569
18570 @node OpenRISC 1000
18571 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
18572 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
18573
18574 @cindex or1k boards
18575 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
18576 about platform and commands.
18577
18578 @table @code
18579
18580 @kindex target jtag
18581 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
18582
18583 Connects to remote JTAG server.
18584 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
18585 connected via parallel port to the board.
18586
18587 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
18588
18589 @kindex or1ksim
18590 @item or1ksim @var{command}
18591 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
18592 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
18593
18594 @kindex info or1k spr
18595 @item info or1k spr
18596 Displays spr groups.
18597
18598 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
18599 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
18600 Displays register names in selected group.
18601
18602 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
18603 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
18604 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
18605 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
18606 Shows information about specified spr register.
18607
18608 @kindex spr
18609 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
18610 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
18611 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
18612 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
18613 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
18614 @end table
18615
18616 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
18617 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
18618 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
18619 triggers can be set using:
18620 @table @code
18621 @item $LEA/$LDATA
18622 Load effective address/data
18623 @item $SEA/$SDATA
18624 Store effective address/data
18625 @item $AEA/$ADATA
18626 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
18627 @item $FETCH
18628 Fetch data
18629 @end table
18630
18631 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
18632 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
18633
18634 @code{htrace} commands:
18635 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
18636 @table @code
18637 @kindex hwatch
18638 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
18639 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
18640 or Data. For example:
18641
18642 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
18643
18644 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
18645
18646 @kindex htrace
18647 @item htrace info
18648 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
18649
18650 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
18651 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
18652
18653 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
18654 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
18655
18656 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
18657 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
18658
18659 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
18660 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
18661 triggered.
18662
18663 @item htrace enable
18664 @itemx htrace disable
18665 Enables/disables the HW trace.
18666
18667 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
18668 Clears currently recorded trace data.
18669
18670 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
18671 will be written there.
18672
18673 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
18674 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
18675
18676 @item htrace mode continuous
18677 Set continuous trace mode.
18678
18679 @item htrace mode suspend
18680 Set suspend trace mode.
18681
18682 @end table
18683
18684 @node PowerPC Embedded
18685 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
18686
18687 @cindex DVC register
18688 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
18689 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
18690
18691 @smallexample
18692 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
18693 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
18694 @end smallexample
18695
18696 The DVC register will be automatically used whenever @value{GDBN} detects
18697 such pattern in a condition expression. This feature is available in native
18698 @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34 or newer.
18699
18700 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
18701
18702 @table @code
18703 @kindex set powerpc
18704 @item set powerpc soft-float
18705 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
18706 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
18707 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
18708 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
18709
18710 @item set powerpc vector-abi
18711 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
18712 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
18713 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
18714 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
18715 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
18716 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
18717 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
18718
18719 @kindex target dink32
18720 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
18721 DINK32 ROM monitor.
18722
18723 @kindex target ppcbug
18724 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
18725 @kindex target ppcbug1
18726 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
18727 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
18728
18729 @kindex target sds
18730 @item target sds @var{dev}
18731 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
18732 @end table
18733
18734 @cindex SDS protocol
18735 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
18736 by @value{GDBN}:
18737
18738 @table @code
18739 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
18740 @kindex set sdstimeout
18741 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
18742 default is 2 seconds.
18743
18744 @item show sdstimeout
18745 @kindex show sdstimeout
18746 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
18747
18748 @item sds @var{command}
18749 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
18750 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
18751 @end table
18752
18753
18754 @node PA
18755 @subsection HP PA Embedded
18756
18757 @table @code
18758
18759 @kindex target op50n
18760 @item target op50n @var{dev}
18761 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
18762
18763 @kindex target w89k
18764 @item target w89k @var{dev}
18765 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
18766
18767 @end table
18768
18769 @node Sparclet
18770 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
18771
18772 @cindex Sparclet
18773
18774 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
18775 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
18776 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
18777 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
18778 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
18779
18780 @table @code
18781 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
18782 @kindex remotetimeout
18783 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
18784 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
18785 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
18786 @end table
18787
18788 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
18789 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
18790 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
18791 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
18792 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
18793
18794 @smallexample
18795 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
18796 @end smallexample
18797
18798 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
18799
18800 @smallexample
18801 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
18802 @end smallexample
18803
18804 @cindex running, on Sparclet
18805 Once you have set
18806 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
18807 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
18808 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
18809
18810 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
18811
18812 @smallexample
18813 (gdbslet)
18814 @end smallexample
18815
18816 @menu
18817 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
18818 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
18819 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
18820 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
18821 @end menu
18822
18823 @node Sparclet File
18824 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
18825
18826 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
18827
18828 @smallexample
18829 (gdbslet) file prog
18830 @end smallexample
18831
18832 @need 1000
18833 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
18834 @value{GDBN} locates
18835 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
18836 path.
18837 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
18838 files will be searched as well.
18839 @value{GDBN} locates
18840 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
18841 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
18842 If it fails
18843 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
18844
18845 @smallexample
18846 prog: No such file or directory.
18847 @end smallexample
18848
18849 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
18850 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
18851 @code{target} command again.
18852
18853 @node Sparclet Connection
18854 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
18855
18856 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
18857 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
18858
18859 @smallexample
18860 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
18861 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
18862 main () at ../prog.c:3
18863 @end smallexample
18864
18865 @need 750
18866 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
18867
18868 @smallexample
18869 Connected to ttya.
18870 @end smallexample
18871
18872 @node Sparclet Download
18873 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
18874
18875 @cindex download to Sparclet
18876 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
18877 you can use the @value{GDBN}
18878 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
18879 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
18880 command.
18881 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
18882 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
18883 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
18884 of each of the file's sections.
18885 For instance, if the program
18886 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
18887 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
18888
18889 @smallexample
18890 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
18891 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
18892 @end smallexample
18893
18894 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
18895 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
18896 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
18897
18898 @node Sparclet Execution
18899 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
18900
18901 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
18902 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
18903 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
18904 manual for the list of commands.
18905
18906 @smallexample
18907 (gdbslet) b main
18908 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
18909 (gdbslet) run
18910 Starting program: prog
18911 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
18912 3 char *symarg = 0;
18913 (gdbslet) step
18914 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
18915 (gdbslet)
18916 @end smallexample
18917
18918 @node Sparclite
18919 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
18920
18921 @table @code
18922
18923 @kindex target sparclite
18924 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
18925 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
18926 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
18927 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
18928 remote protocol.
18929
18930 @end table
18931
18932 @node Z8000
18933 @subsection Zilog Z8000
18934
18935 @cindex Z8000
18936 @cindex simulator, Z8000
18937 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
18938
18939 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
18940 a Z8000 simulator.
18941
18942 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
18943 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
18944 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
18945 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
18946
18947 @table @code
18948 @item target sim @var{args}
18949 @kindex sim
18950 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
18951 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
18952 options, specify them via @var{args}.
18953 @end table
18954
18955 @noindent
18956 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
18957 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
18958 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
18959 to run your program, and so on.
18960
18961 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
18962 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
18963 additional items of information as specially named registers:
18964
18965 @table @code
18966
18967 @item cycles
18968 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
18969
18970 @item insts
18971 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
18972
18973 @item time
18974 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
18975
18976 @end table
18977
18978 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
18979 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
18980 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
18981 simulated clock ticks.
18982
18983 @node AVR
18984 @subsection Atmel AVR
18985 @cindex AVR
18986
18987 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
18988 following AVR-specific commands:
18989
18990 @table @code
18991 @item info io_registers
18992 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
18993 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
18994 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
18995 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
18996 @end table
18997
18998 @node CRIS
18999 @subsection CRIS
19000 @cindex CRIS
19001
19002 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
19003 following CRIS-specific commands:
19004
19005 @table @code
19006 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
19007 @cindex CRIS version
19008 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
19009 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
19010 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
19011
19012 @item show cris-version
19013 Show the current CRIS version.
19014
19015 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
19016 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
19017 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
19018 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
19019 @code{R59}.
19020
19021 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
19022 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
19023
19024 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
19025 @cindex CRIS mode
19026 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
19027 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
19028 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
19029
19030 @item show cris-mode
19031 Show the current CRIS mode.
19032 @end table
19033
19034 @node Super-H
19035 @subsection Renesas Super-H
19036 @cindex Super-H
19037
19038 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
19039 commands:
19040
19041 @table @code
19042 @item regs
19043 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
19044 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
19045
19046 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
19047 @kindex set sh calling-convention
19048 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
19049 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
19050 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
19051 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
19052 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
19053 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
19054 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
19055 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
19056 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
19057 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
19058
19059 @item show sh calling-convention
19060 @kindex show sh calling-convention
19061 Show the current calling convention setting.
19062
19063 @end table
19064
19065
19066 @node Architectures
19067 @section Architectures
19068
19069 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
19070 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
19071
19072 @menu
19073 * i386::
19074 * A29K::
19075 * Alpha::
19076 * MIPS::
19077 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
19078 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
19079 * PowerPC::
19080 @end menu
19081
19082 @node i386
19083 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
19084
19085 @table @code
19086 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
19087 @kindex set struct-convention
19088 @cindex struct return convention
19089 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
19090 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
19091 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
19092 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
19093 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
19094 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
19095 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
19096 be returned in a register.
19097
19098 @item show struct-convention
19099 @kindex show struct-convention
19100 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
19101 from functions.
19102 @end table
19103
19104 @node A29K
19105 @subsection A29K
19106
19107 @table @code
19108
19109 @kindex set rstack_high_address
19110 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
19111 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
19112 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
19113 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
19114 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
19115 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
19116 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
19117 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
19118 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
19119 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
19120 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
19121 hexadecimal.
19122
19123 @kindex show rstack_high_address
19124 @item show rstack_high_address
19125 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
19126 processors.
19127
19128 @end table
19129
19130 @node Alpha
19131 @subsection Alpha
19132
19133 See the following section.
19134
19135 @node MIPS
19136 @subsection MIPS
19137
19138 @cindex stack on Alpha
19139 @cindex stack on MIPS
19140 @cindex Alpha stack
19141 @cindex MIPS stack
19142 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
19143 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
19144 find the beginning of a function.
19145
19146 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
19147 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
19148 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
19149 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
19150 commands:
19151
19152 @table @code
19153 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
19154 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
19155 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
19156 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
19157 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
19158 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
19159 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
19160 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
19161
19162 @item show heuristic-fence-post
19163 Display the current limit.
19164 @end table
19165
19166 @noindent
19167 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
19168 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
19169
19170 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
19171 programs:
19172
19173 @table @code
19174 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
19175 @kindex set mips abi
19176 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
19177 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
19178 values of @var{arg} are:
19179
19180 @table @samp
19181 @item auto
19182 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
19183 default).
19184 @item o32
19185 @item o64
19186 @item n32
19187 @item n64
19188 @item eabi32
19189 @item eabi64
19190 @item auto
19191 @end table
19192
19193 @item show mips abi
19194 @kindex show mips abi
19195 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
19196
19197 @item set mipsfpu
19198 @itemx show mipsfpu
19199 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
19200
19201 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
19202 @kindex set mips mask-address
19203 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
19204 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
19205 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
19206 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
19207 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
19208
19209 @item show mips mask-address
19210 @kindex show mips mask-address
19211 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
19212 not.
19213
19214 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19215 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19216 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
19217 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
19218 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
19219 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
19220
19221 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19222 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19223 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
19224
19225 @item set debug mips
19226 @kindex set debug mips
19227 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
19228 target code in @value{GDBN}.
19229
19230 @item show debug mips
19231 @kindex show debug mips
19232 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
19233 @end table
19234
19235
19236 @node HPPA
19237 @subsection HPPA
19238 @cindex HPPA support
19239
19240 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
19241 following special commands:
19242
19243 @table @code
19244 @item set debug hppa
19245 @kindex set debug hppa
19246 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
19247 messages are to be displayed.
19248
19249 @item show debug hppa
19250 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
19251
19252 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
19253 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
19254 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
19255 given @var{address}.
19256
19257 @end table
19258
19259
19260 @node SPU
19261 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
19262 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
19263 @cindex SPU
19264
19265 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
19266 it provides the following special commands:
19267
19268 @table @code
19269 @item info spu event
19270 @kindex info spu
19271 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
19272 and pending event status.
19273
19274 @item info spu signal
19275 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
19276 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
19277 notification channels.
19278
19279 @item info spu mailbox
19280 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
19281 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
19282 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
19283
19284 @item info spu dma
19285 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
19286 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
19287 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
19288
19289 @item info spu proxydma
19290 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
19291 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
19292 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
19293
19294 @end table
19295
19296 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
19297 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
19298 special commands:
19299
19300 @table @code
19301 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
19302 @kindex set spu
19303 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
19304 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
19305 function. The default is @code{off}.
19306
19307 @item show spu stop-on-load
19308 @kindex show spu
19309 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
19310
19311 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
19312 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
19313 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
19314 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
19315 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
19316 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
19317
19318 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
19319 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
19320
19321 @end table
19322
19323 @node PowerPC
19324 @subsection PowerPC
19325 @cindex PowerPC architecture
19326
19327 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
19328 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
19329 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
19330 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
19331 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
19332
19333 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
19334 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
19335 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
19336
19337 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
19338 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
19339
19340
19341 @node Controlling GDB
19342 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
19343
19344 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
19345 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
19346 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
19347 described here.
19348
19349 @menu
19350 * Prompt:: Prompt
19351 * Editing:: Command editing
19352 * Command History:: Command history
19353 * Screen Size:: Screen size
19354 * Numbers:: Numbers
19355 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
19356 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
19357 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
19358 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
19359 @end menu
19360
19361 @node Prompt
19362 @section Prompt
19363
19364 @cindex prompt
19365
19366 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
19367 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
19368 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
19369 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
19370 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
19371 which one you are talking to.
19372
19373 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
19374 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
19375 or a prompt that does not.
19376
19377 @table @code
19378 @kindex set prompt
19379 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
19380 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
19381
19382 @kindex show prompt
19383 @item show prompt
19384 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
19385 @end table
19386
19387 @node Editing
19388 @section Command Editing
19389 @cindex readline
19390 @cindex command line editing
19391
19392 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
19393 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
19394 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
19395 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
19396 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
19397 debugging sessions.
19398
19399 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
19400 command @code{set}.
19401
19402 @table @code
19403 @kindex set editing
19404 @cindex editing
19405 @item set editing
19406 @itemx set editing on
19407 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
19408
19409 @item set editing off
19410 Disable command line editing.
19411
19412 @kindex show editing
19413 @item show editing
19414 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
19415 @end table
19416
19417 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
19418 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
19419 encouraged to read that chapter.
19420
19421 @node Command History
19422 @section Command History
19423 @cindex command history
19424
19425 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
19426 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
19427 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
19428 history facility.
19429
19430 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
19431 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
19432 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
19433
19434 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
19435 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
19436 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
19437 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
19438 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
19439 pressed on a line by itself.
19440
19441 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
19442 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
19443 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
19444 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
19445
19446 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
19447 history.
19448
19449 @table @code
19450 @cindex history substitution
19451 @cindex history file
19452 @kindex set history filename
19453 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
19454 @item set history filename @var{fname}
19455 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
19456 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
19457 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
19458 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
19459 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
19460 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
19461 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
19462 is not set.
19463
19464 @cindex save command history
19465 @kindex set history save
19466 @item set history save
19467 @itemx set history save on
19468 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
19469 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
19470
19471 @item set history save off
19472 Stop recording command history in a file.
19473
19474 @cindex history size
19475 @kindex set history size
19476 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
19477 @item set history size @var{size}
19478 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
19479 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
19480 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
19481 @end table
19482
19483 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
19484 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
19485
19486 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
19487 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
19488 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
19489 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
19490 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
19491 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
19492 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
19493 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
19494
19495 The commands to control history expansion are:
19496
19497 @table @code
19498 @item set history expansion on
19499 @itemx set history expansion
19500 @kindex set history expansion
19501 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
19502
19503 @item set history expansion off
19504 Disable history expansion.
19505
19506 @c @group
19507 @kindex show history
19508 @item show history
19509 @itemx show history filename
19510 @itemx show history save
19511 @itemx show history size
19512 @itemx show history expansion
19513 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
19514 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
19515 @c @end group
19516 @end table
19517
19518 @table @code
19519 @kindex show commands
19520 @cindex show last commands
19521 @cindex display command history
19522 @item show commands
19523 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
19524
19525 @item show commands @var{n}
19526 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
19527
19528 @item show commands +
19529 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
19530 @end table
19531
19532 @node Screen Size
19533 @section Screen Size
19534 @cindex size of screen
19535 @cindex pauses in output
19536
19537 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
19538 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
19539 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
19540 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
19541 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
19542 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
19543 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
19544 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
19545
19546 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
19547 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
19548 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
19549 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
19550 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
19551 width} commands:
19552
19553 @table @code
19554 @kindex set height
19555 @kindex set width
19556 @kindex show width
19557 @kindex show height
19558 @item set height @var{lpp}
19559 @itemx show height
19560 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
19561 @itemx show width
19562 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
19563 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
19564 commands display the current settings.
19565
19566 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
19567 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
19568 file or to an editor buffer.
19569
19570 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
19571 from wrapping its output.
19572
19573 @item set pagination on
19574 @itemx set pagination off
19575 @kindex set pagination
19576 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
19577 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}. Note that
19578 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
19579 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
19580
19581 @item show pagination
19582 @kindex show pagination
19583 Show the current pagination mode.
19584 @end table
19585
19586 @node Numbers
19587 @section Numbers
19588 @cindex number representation
19589 @cindex entering numbers
19590
19591 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
19592 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
19593 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
19594 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
19595 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
19596 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
19597 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
19598 both input and output with the commands described below.
19599
19600 @table @code
19601 @kindex set input-radix
19602 @item set input-radix @var{base}
19603 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
19604 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
19605 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
19606 example, any of
19607
19608 @smallexample
19609 set input-radix 012
19610 set input-radix 10.
19611 set input-radix 0xa
19612 @end smallexample
19613
19614 @noindent
19615 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
19616 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
19617 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
19618 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
19619 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
19620 change the radix.
19621
19622 @kindex set output-radix
19623 @item set output-radix @var{base}
19624 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
19625 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
19626 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
19627
19628 @kindex show input-radix
19629 @item show input-radix
19630 Display the current default base for numeric input.
19631
19632 @kindex show output-radix
19633 @item show output-radix
19634 Display the current default base for numeric display.
19635
19636 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
19637 @itemx show radix
19638 @kindex set radix
19639 @kindex show radix
19640 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
19641 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
19642 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
19643 default value of 10.
19644
19645 @end table
19646
19647 @node ABI
19648 @section Configuring the Current ABI
19649
19650 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
19651 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
19652 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
19653 current ABI.
19654
19655 @cindex OS ABI
19656 @kindex set osabi
19657 @kindex show osabi
19658
19659 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
19660 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
19661 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
19662 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
19663 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
19664 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
19665 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
19666 platform provides.
19667
19668 @table @code
19669 @item show osabi
19670 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
19671
19672 @item set osabi
19673 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
19674
19675 @item set osabi @var{abi}
19676 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
19677 @end table
19678
19679 @cindex float promotion
19680
19681 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
19682 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
19683 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
19684 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
19685 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
19686 @code{double} and then passed.
19687
19688 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
19689 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
19690 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
19691
19692 @table @code
19693 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
19694 @item set coerce-float-to-double
19695 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
19696 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
19697 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
19698
19699 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
19700 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
19701 functions.
19702
19703 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
19704 @item show coerce-float-to-double
19705 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
19706 @end table
19707
19708 @kindex set cp-abi
19709 @kindex show cp-abi
19710 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
19711 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
19712 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
19713 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
19714 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
19715 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
19716 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
19717 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
19718 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
19719 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
19720 ``auto''.
19721
19722 @table @code
19723 @item show cp-abi
19724 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
19725
19726 @item set cp-abi
19727 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
19728
19729 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
19730 @itemx set cp-abi auto
19731 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
19732 @end table
19733
19734 @node Messages/Warnings
19735 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
19736
19737 @cindex verbose operation
19738 @cindex optional warnings
19739 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
19740 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
19741 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
19742 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
19743
19744 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
19745 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
19746 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
19747
19748 @table @code
19749 @kindex set verbose
19750 @item set verbose on
19751 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
19752
19753 @item set verbose off
19754 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
19755
19756 @kindex show verbose
19757 @item show verbose
19758 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
19759 @end table
19760
19761 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
19762 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
19763 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
19764 Symbol Files}).
19765
19766 @table @code
19767
19768 @kindex set complaints
19769 @item set complaints @var{limit}
19770 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
19771 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
19772 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
19773 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
19774
19775 @kindex show complaints
19776 @item show complaints
19777 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
19778
19779 @end table
19780
19781 @anchor{confirmation requests}
19782 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
19783 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
19784 you try to run a program which is already running:
19785
19786 @smallexample
19787 (@value{GDBP}) run
19788 The program being debugged has been started already.
19789 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
19790 @end smallexample
19791
19792 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
19793 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
19794
19795 @table @code
19796
19797 @kindex set confirm
19798 @cindex flinching
19799 @cindex confirmation
19800 @cindex stupid questions
19801 @item set confirm off
19802 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
19803 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
19804 automatically disables confirmation requests.
19805
19806 @item set confirm on
19807 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
19808
19809 @kindex show confirm
19810 @item show confirm
19811 Displays state of confirmation requests.
19812
19813 @end table
19814
19815 @cindex command tracing
19816 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
19817 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
19818 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
19819 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
19820
19821 @table @code
19822 @kindex set trace-commands
19823 @cindex command scripts, debugging
19824 @item set trace-commands on
19825 Enable command tracing.
19826 @item set trace-commands off
19827 Disable command tracing.
19828 @item show trace-commands
19829 Display the current state of command tracing.
19830 @end table
19831
19832 @node Debugging Output
19833 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
19834 @cindex optional debugging messages
19835
19836 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
19837 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
19838 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
19839 section documents those commands.
19840
19841 @table @code
19842 @kindex set exec-done-display
19843 @item set exec-done-display
19844 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
19845 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
19846 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
19847 @kindex show exec-done-display
19848 @item show exec-done-display
19849 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
19850 notification.
19851 @kindex set debug
19852 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
19853 @cindex architecture debugging info
19854 @item set debug arch
19855 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
19856 @kindex show debug
19857 @item show debug arch
19858 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
19859 @item set debug aix-thread
19860 @cindex AIX threads
19861 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
19862 module.
19863 @item show debug aix-thread
19864 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
19865 @item set debug dwarf2-die
19866 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
19867 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
19868 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
19869 A value of zero turns off the display.
19870 @item show debug dwarf2-die
19871 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
19872 @item set debug displaced
19873 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
19874 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
19875 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
19876 @item show debug displaced
19877 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
19878 related to displaced stepping.
19879 @item set debug event
19880 @cindex event debugging info
19881 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
19882 default is off.
19883 @item show debug event
19884 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
19885 info.
19886 @item set debug expression
19887 @cindex expression debugging info
19888 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
19889 expression parsing. The default is off.
19890 @item show debug expression
19891 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
19892 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
19893 @item set debug frame
19894 @cindex frame debugging info
19895 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
19896 default is off.
19897 @item show debug frame
19898 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
19899 info.
19900 @item set debug gnu-nat
19901 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
19902 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
19903 @item show debug gnu-nat
19904 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
19905 @item set debug infrun
19906 @cindex inferior debugging info
19907 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
19908 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
19909 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
19910 @item show debug infrun
19911 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
19912 @item set debug lin-lwp
19913 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
19914 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
19915 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
19916 @item show debug lin-lwp
19917 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
19918 @item set debug lin-lwp-async
19919 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages
19920 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
19921 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support.
19922 @item show debug lin-lwp-async
19923 Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages.
19924 @item set debug observer
19925 @cindex observer debugging info
19926 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
19927 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
19928 @item show debug observer
19929 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
19930 @item set debug overload
19931 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
19932 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
19933 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
19934 is off.
19935 @item show debug overload
19936 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
19937 debugging info.
19938 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
19939 @cindex debug expression parser
19940 @item set debug parser
19941 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
19942 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
19943 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
19944 details. The default is off.
19945 @item show debug parser
19946 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
19947 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
19948 @cindex serial connections, debugging
19949 @cindex debug remote protocol
19950 @cindex remote protocol debugging
19951 @cindex display remote packets
19952 @item set debug remote
19953 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
19954 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
19955 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
19956 @item show debug remote
19957 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
19958 @item set debug serial
19959 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
19960 default is off.
19961 @item show debug serial
19962 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
19963 info.
19964 @item set debug solib-frv
19965 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
19966 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
19967 @item show debug solib-frv
19968 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
19969 messages.
19970 @item set debug target
19971 @cindex target debugging info
19972 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
19973 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
19974 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
19975 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
19976 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
19977 @item show debug target
19978 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
19979 info.
19980 @item set debug timestamp
19981 @cindex timestampping debugging info
19982 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
19983 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
19984 message.
19985 @item show debug timestamp
19986 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
19987 debugging info.
19988 @item set debugvarobj
19989 @cindex variable object debugging info
19990 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
19991 info. The default is off.
19992 @item show debugvarobj
19993 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
19994 debugging info.
19995 @item set debug xml
19996 @cindex XML parser debugging
19997 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
19998 @item show debug xml
19999 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
20000 @end table
20001
20002 @node Other Misc Settings
20003 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
20004 @cindex miscellaneous settings
20005
20006 @table @code
20007 @kindex set interactive-mode
20008 @item set interactive-mode
20009 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate interactively.
20010 If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate non-interactively,
20011 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} guesses which mode to use,
20012 based on whether the debugger was started in a terminal or not.
20013
20014 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
20015 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
20016 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
20017 inside a cygwin window.
20018
20019 @kindex show interactive-mode
20020 @item show interactive-mode
20021 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
20022 @end table
20023
20024 @node Extending GDB
20025 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
20026 @cindex extending GDB
20027
20028 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for extension. The first is based
20029 on composition of @value{GDBN} commands, and the second is based on the
20030 Python scripting language.
20031
20032 To facilitate the use of these extensions, @value{GDBN} is capable
20033 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
20034 can recognize which scripting language is being used by looking at
20035 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
20036 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
20037 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
20038
20039 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
20040 setting:
20041
20042 @table @code
20043 @kindex set script-extension
20044 @kindex show script-extension
20045 @item set script-extension off
20046 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
20047
20048 @item set script-extension soft
20049 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
20050 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
20051 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
20052 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
20053
20054 @item set script-extension strict
20055 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
20056 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
20057 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
20058
20059 @item show script-extension
20060 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
20061
20062 @end table
20063
20064 @menu
20065 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands
20066 * Python:: Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
20067 @end menu
20068
20069 @node Sequences
20070 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
20071
20072 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
20073 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
20074 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
20075 files.
20076
20077 @menu
20078 * Define:: How to define your own commands
20079 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
20080 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
20081 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
20082 @end menu
20083
20084 @node Define
20085 @subsection User-defined Commands
20086
20087 @cindex user-defined command
20088 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
20089 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
20090 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
20091 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
20092 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
20093 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
20094
20095 @smallexample
20096 define adder
20097 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
20098 end
20099 @end smallexample
20100
20101 @noindent
20102 To execute the command use:
20103
20104 @smallexample
20105 adder 1 2 3
20106 @end smallexample
20107
20108 @noindent
20109 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
20110 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
20111 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
20112 functions calls.
20113
20114 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
20115 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
20116 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
20117 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
20118
20119 @smallexample
20120 define adder
20121 if $argc == 2
20122 print $arg0 + $arg1
20123 end
20124 if $argc == 3
20125 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
20126 end
20127 end
20128 @end smallexample
20129
20130 @table @code
20131
20132 @kindex define
20133 @item define @var{commandname}
20134 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
20135 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
20136 @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
20137 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
20138 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
20139 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
20140
20141 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
20142 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
20143 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
20144
20145 @kindex document
20146 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
20147 @item document @var{commandname}
20148 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
20149 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
20150 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
20151 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
20152 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
20153 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
20154
20155 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
20156 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
20157 does not change the documentation.
20158
20159 @kindex dont-repeat
20160 @cindex don't repeat command
20161 @item dont-repeat
20162 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
20163 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
20164 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
20165
20166 @kindex help user-defined
20167 @item help user-defined
20168 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
20169 (if any) for each.
20170
20171 @kindex show user
20172 @item show user
20173 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
20174 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
20175 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
20176 definitions for all user-defined commands.
20177
20178 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
20179 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
20180 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
20181 @item show max-user-call-depth
20182 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
20183 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
20184 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
20185 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
20186 @end table
20187
20188 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
20189 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
20190
20191 When user-defined commands are executed, the
20192 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
20193 stops execution of the user-defined command.
20194
20195 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
20196 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
20197 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
20198 messages when used in a user-defined command.
20199
20200 @node Hooks
20201 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
20202 @cindex command hooks
20203 @cindex hooks, for commands
20204 @cindex hooks, pre-command
20205
20206 @kindex hook
20207 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
20208 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
20209 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
20210 before that command.
20211
20212 @cindex hooks, post-command
20213 @kindex hookpost
20214 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
20215 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
20216 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
20217 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
20218 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
20219
20220 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
20221 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
20222
20223 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
20224 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
20225
20226 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
20227 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
20228 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
20229 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
20230 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
20231
20232 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
20233 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
20234 you could define:
20235
20236 @smallexample
20237 define hook-stop
20238 handle SIGALRM nopass
20239 end
20240
20241 define hook-run
20242 handle SIGALRM pass
20243 end
20244
20245 define hook-continue
20246 handle SIGALRM pass
20247 end
20248 @end smallexample
20249
20250 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
20251 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
20252 you could define:
20253
20254 @smallexample
20255 define hook-echo
20256 echo <<<---
20257 end
20258
20259 define hookpost-echo
20260 echo --->>>\n
20261 end
20262
20263 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
20264 <<<---Hello World--->>>
20265 (@value{GDBP})
20266
20267 @end smallexample
20268
20269 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
20270 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
20271 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
20272 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
20273 @c or not?
20274 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
20275 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
20276 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
20277
20278 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
20279 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
20280 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
20281
20282 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
20283 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
20284
20285 @node Command Files
20286 @subsection Command Files
20287
20288 @cindex command files
20289 @cindex scripting commands
20290 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
20291 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
20292 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
20293 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
20294 terminal.
20295
20296 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
20297 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
20298 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
20299 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
20300 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
20301
20302 @table @code
20303 @kindex source
20304 @cindex execute commands from a file
20305 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
20306 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
20307 @end table
20308
20309 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
20310 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
20311 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
20312 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
20313 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
20314
20315 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
20316 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
20317 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
20318 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
20319 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
20320 is not relevant to scripts.
20321
20322 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
20323 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
20324 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
20325 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
20326 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
20327 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
20328 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
20329 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
20330 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
20331 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
20332 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
20333 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
20334 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
20335 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
20336
20337 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
20338 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
20339 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
20340
20341 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
20342 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
20343 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
20344 when called from command files.
20345
20346 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
20347 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
20348 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
20349 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
20350 the next command.
20351
20352 @smallexample
20353 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
20354 @end smallexample
20355
20356 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
20357 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
20358 would be directed to @file{log}.
20359
20360 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
20361 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
20362 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
20363 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
20364 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
20365 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
20366 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
20367 conditionally, etc.
20368
20369 @table @code
20370 @kindex if
20371 @kindex else
20372 @item if
20373 @itemx else
20374 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
20375 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
20376 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
20377 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
20378 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
20379 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
20380 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
20381
20382 @kindex while
20383 @item while
20384 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
20385 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
20386 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
20387 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
20388 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
20389 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
20390
20391 @kindex loop_break
20392 @item loop_break
20393 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
20394 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
20395 line.
20396
20397 @kindex loop_continue
20398 @item loop_continue
20399 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
20400 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
20401 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
20402 the controlling expression.
20403
20404 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
20405 @item end
20406 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
20407 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
20408 @end table
20409
20410
20411 @node Output
20412 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
20413
20414 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
20415 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
20416 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
20417 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
20418 want.
20419
20420 @table @code
20421 @kindex echo
20422 @item echo @var{text}
20423 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
20424 @c because it is not in ANSI.
20425 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
20426 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
20427 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
20428 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
20429 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
20430 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
20431 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
20432 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
20433 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
20434
20435 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
20436 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
20437
20438 @smallexample
20439 echo This is some text\n\
20440 which is continued\n\
20441 onto several lines.\n
20442 @end smallexample
20443
20444 produces the same output as
20445
20446 @smallexample
20447 echo This is some text\n
20448 echo which is continued\n
20449 echo onto several lines.\n
20450 @end smallexample
20451
20452 @kindex output
20453 @item output @var{expression}
20454 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
20455 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
20456 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
20457 on expressions.
20458
20459 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
20460 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
20461 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
20462 Formats}, for more information.
20463
20464 @kindex printf
20465 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
20466 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
20467 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
20468 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
20469 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
20470 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
20471 executing the code below:
20472
20473 @smallexample
20474 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
20475 @end smallexample
20476
20477 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
20478 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
20479 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
20480 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
20481 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
20482 printed.
20483
20484 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
20485
20486 @smallexample
20487 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
20488 @end smallexample
20489
20490 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
20491 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
20492 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
20493
20494 @itemize @bullet
20495 @item
20496 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
20497
20498 @item
20499 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
20500 width.
20501
20502 @item
20503 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
20504 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
20505
20506 @item
20507 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
20508 supported.
20509
20510 @item
20511 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
20512
20513 @item
20514 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
20515 @end itemize
20516
20517 @noindent
20518 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
20519 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
20520 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
20521 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
20522
20523 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
20524 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
20525 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
20526 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
20527 supported.
20528
20529 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
20530 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
20531 together with a floating point specifier.
20532 letters:
20533
20534 @itemize @bullet
20535 @item
20536 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
20537
20538 @item
20539 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
20540
20541 @item
20542 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
20543 @end itemize
20544
20545 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
20546 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
20547 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
20548
20549 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
20550 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
20551
20552 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
20553 @smallexample
20554 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
20555 @end smallexample
20556
20557 @kindex eval
20558 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
20559 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
20560 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
20561
20562 @end table
20563
20564 @node Python
20565 @section Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
20566 @cindex python scripting
20567 @cindex scripting with python
20568
20569 You can script @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/,
20570 Python programming language}. This feature is available only if
20571 @value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}.
20572
20573 @cindex python directory
20574 Python scripts used by @value{GDBN} should be installed in
20575 @file{@var{data-directory}/python}, where @var{data-directory} is
20576 the data directory as determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}).
20577 This directory, known as the @dfn{python directory},
20578 is automatically added to the Python Search Path in order to allow
20579 the Python interpreter to locate all scripts installed at this location.
20580
20581 @menu
20582 * Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}.
20583 * Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python.
20584 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading Python code.
20585 * Python modules:: Python modules provided by @value{GDBN}.
20586 @end menu
20587
20588 @node Python Commands
20589 @subsection Python Commands
20590 @cindex python commands
20591 @cindex commands to access python
20592
20593 @value{GDBN} provides one command for accessing the Python interpreter,
20594 and one related setting:
20595
20596 @table @code
20597 @kindex python
20598 @item python @r{[}@var{code}@r{]}
20599 The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code.
20600
20601 If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the
20602 argument as a Python command. For example:
20603
20604 @smallexample
20605 (@value{GDBP}) python print 23
20606 23
20607 @end smallexample
20608
20609 If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a
20610 multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python
20611 script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the
20612 @code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line
20613 containing @code{end}. For example:
20614
20615 @smallexample
20616 (@value{GDBP}) python
20617 Type python script
20618 End with a line saying just "end".
20619 >print 23
20620 >end
20621 23
20622 @end smallexample
20623
20624 @kindex maint set python print-stack
20625 @item maint set python print-stack
20626 By default, @value{GDBN} will print a stack trace when an error occurs
20627 in a Python script. This can be controlled using @code{maint set
20628 python print-stack}: if @code{on}, the default, then Python stack
20629 printing is enabled; if @code{off}, then Python stack printing is
20630 disabled.
20631 @end table
20632
20633 It is also possible to execute a Python script from the @value{GDBN}
20634 interpreter:
20635
20636 @table @code
20637 @item source @file{script-name}
20638 The script name must end with @samp{.py} and @value{GDBN} must be configured
20639 to recognize the script language based on filename extension using
20640 the @code{script-extension} setting. @xref{Extending GDB, ,Extending GDB}.
20641
20642 @item python execfile ("script-name")
20643 This method is based on the @code{execfile} Python built-in function,
20644 and thus is always available.
20645 @end table
20646
20647 @node Python API
20648 @subsection Python API
20649 @cindex python api
20650 @cindex programming in python
20651
20652 @cindex python stdout
20653 @cindex python pagination
20654 At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and
20655 @code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams.
20656 A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its
20657 output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this
20658 situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown.
20659
20660 @menu
20661 * Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions.
20662 * Exception Handling::
20663 * Values From Inferior::
20664 * Types In Python:: Python representation of types.
20665 * Pretty Printing API:: Pretty-printing values.
20666 * Selecting Pretty-Printers:: How GDB chooses a pretty-printer.
20667 * Writing a Pretty-Printer:: Writing a Pretty-Printer.
20668 * Inferiors In Python:: Python representation of inferiors (processes)
20669 * Threads In Python:: Accessing inferior threads from Python.
20670 * Commands In Python:: Implementing new commands in Python.
20671 * Parameters In Python:: Adding new @value{GDBN} parameters.
20672 * Functions In Python:: Writing new convenience functions.
20673 * Progspaces In Python:: Program spaces.
20674 * Objfiles In Python:: Object files.
20675 * Frames In Python:: Accessing inferior stack frames from Python.
20676 * Blocks In Python:: Accessing frame blocks from Python.
20677 * Symbols In Python:: Python representation of symbols.
20678 * Symbol Tables In Python:: Python representation of symbol tables.
20679 * Lazy Strings In Python:: Python representation of lazy strings.
20680 * Breakpoints In Python:: Manipulating breakpoints using Python.
20681 @end menu
20682
20683 @node Basic Python
20684 @subsubsection Basic Python
20685
20686 @cindex python functions
20687 @cindex python module
20688 @cindex gdb module
20689 @value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All
20690 methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module.
20691 @value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for
20692 use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command.
20693
20694 @findex gdb.PYTHONDIR
20695 @defvar PYTHONDIR
20696 A string containing the python directory (@pxref{Python}).
20697 @end defvar
20698
20699 @findex gdb.execute
20700 @defun execute command [from_tty] [to_string]
20701 Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command.
20702 If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is
20703 translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}.
20704
20705 @var{from_tty} specifies whether @value{GDBN} ought to consider this
20706 command as having originated from the user invoking it interactively.
20707 It must be a boolean value. If omitted, it defaults to @code{False}.
20708
20709 By default, any output produced by @var{command} is sent to
20710 @value{GDBN}'s standard output. If the @var{to_string} parameter is
20711 @code{True}, then output will be collected by @code{gdb.execute} and
20712 returned as a string. The default is @code{False}, in which case the
20713 return value is @code{None}. If @var{to_string} is @code{True}, the
20714 @value{GDBN} virtual terminal will be temporarily set to unlimited width
20715 and height, and its pagination will be disabled; @pxref{Screen Size}.
20716 @end defun
20717
20718 @findex gdb.breakpoints
20719 @defun breakpoints
20720 Return a sequence holding all of @value{GDBN}'s breakpoints.
20721 @xref{Breakpoints In Python}, for more information.
20722 @end defun
20723
20724 @findex gdb.parameter
20725 @defun parameter parameter
20726 Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a
20727 string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain
20728 spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example,
20729 @samp{print object} is a valid parameter name.
20730
20731 If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a
20732 @code{gdb.error} (@pxref{Exception Handling}). Otherwise, the
20733 parameter's value is converted to a Python value of the appropriate
20734 type, and returned.
20735 @end defun
20736
20737 @findex gdb.history
20738 @defun history number
20739 Return a value from @value{GDBN}'s value history (@pxref{Value
20740 History}). @var{number} indicates which history element to return.
20741 If @var{number} is negative, then @value{GDBN} will take its absolute value
20742 and count backward from the last element (i.e., the most recent element) to
20743 find the value to return. If @var{number} is zero, then @value{GDBN} will
20744 return the most recent element. If the element specified by @var{number}
20745 doesn't exist in the value history, a @code{gdb.error} exception will be
20746 raised.
20747
20748 If no exception is raised, the return value is always an instance of
20749 @code{gdb.Value} (@pxref{Values From Inferior}).
20750 @end defun
20751
20752 @findex gdb.parse_and_eval
20753 @defun parse_and_eval expression
20754 Parse @var{expression} as an expression in the current language,
20755 evaluate it, and return the result as a @code{gdb.Value}.
20756 @var{expression} must be a string.
20757
20758 This function can be useful when implementing a new command
20759 (@pxref{Commands In Python}), as it provides a way to parse the
20760 command's argument as an expression. It is also useful simply to
20761 compute values, for example, it is the only way to get the value of a
20762 convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) as a @code{gdb.Value}.
20763 @end defun
20764
20765 @findex gdb.post_event
20766 @defun post_event event
20767 Put @var{event}, a callable object taking no arguments, into
20768 @value{GDBN}'s internal event queue. This callable will be invoked at
20769 some later point, during @value{GDBN}'s event processing. Events
20770 posted using @code{post_event} will be run in the order in which they
20771 were posted; however, there is no way to know when they will be
20772 processed relative to other events inside @value{GDBN}.
20773
20774 @value{GDBN} is not thread-safe. If your Python program uses multiple
20775 threads, you must be careful to only call @value{GDBN}-specific
20776 functions in the main @value{GDBN} thread. @code{post_event} ensures
20777 this. For example:
20778
20779 @smallexample
20780 (@value{GDBP}) python
20781 >import threading
20782 >
20783 >class Writer():
20784 > def __init__(self, message):
20785 > self.message = message;
20786 > def __call__(self):
20787 > gdb.write(self.message)
20788 >
20789 >class MyThread1 (threading.Thread):
20790 > def run (self):
20791 > gdb.post_event(Writer("Hello "))
20792 >
20793 >class MyThread2 (threading.Thread):
20794 > def run (self):
20795 > gdb.post_event(Writer("World\n"))
20796 >
20797 >MyThread1().start()
20798 >MyThread2().start()
20799 >end
20800 (@value{GDBP}) Hello World
20801 @end smallexample
20802 @end defun
20803
20804 @findex gdb.write
20805 @defun write string
20806 Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream.
20807 Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
20808 call this function.
20809 @end defun
20810
20811 @findex gdb.flush
20812 @defun flush
20813 Flush @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream. Flushing
20814 @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically call this
20815 function.
20816 @end defun
20817
20818 @findex gdb.target_charset
20819 @defun target_charset
20820 Return the name of the current target character set (@pxref{Character
20821 Sets}). This differs from @code{gdb.parameter('target-charset')} in
20822 that @samp{auto} is never returned.
20823 @end defun
20824
20825 @findex gdb.target_wide_charset
20826 @defun target_wide_charset
20827 Return the name of the current target wide character set
20828 (@pxref{Character Sets}). This differs from
20829 @code{gdb.parameter('target-wide-charset')} in that @samp{auto} is
20830 never returned.
20831 @end defun
20832
20833 @findex gdb.solib_name
20834 @defun solib_name address
20835 Return the name of the shared library holding the given @var{address}
20836 as a string, or @code{None}.
20837 @end defun
20838
20839 @findex gdb.decode_line
20840 @defun decode_line @r{[}expression@r{]}
20841 Return locations of the line specified by @var{expression}, or of the
20842 current line if no argument was given. This function returns a Python
20843 tuple containing two elements. The first element contains a string
20844 holding any unparsed section of @var{expression} (or @code{None} if
20845 the expression has been fully parsed). The second element contains
20846 either @code{None} or another tuple that contains all the locations
20847 that match the expression represented as @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line}
20848 objects (@pxref{Symbol Tables In Python}). If @var{expression} is
20849 provided, it is decoded the way that @value{GDBN}'s inbuilt
20850 @code{break} or @code{edit} commands do (@pxref{Specify Location}).
20851 @end defun
20852
20853 @node Exception Handling
20854 @subsubsection Exception Handling
20855 @cindex python exceptions
20856 @cindex exceptions, python
20857
20858 When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions
20859 uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to
20860 @value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
20861 @code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will
20862 terminate it and print an error message containing the Python
20863 exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack
20864 backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example:
20865
20866 @smallexample
20867 (@value{GDBP}) python print foo
20868 Traceback (most recent call last):
20869 File "<string>", line 1, in <module>
20870 NameError: name 'foo' is not defined
20871 @end smallexample
20872
20873 @value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by
20874 Python code are converted to Python exceptions. The type of the
20875 Python exception depends on the error.
20876
20877 @ftable @code
20878 @item gdb.error
20879 This is the base class for most exceptions generated by @value{GDBN}.
20880 It is derived from @code{RuntimeError}, for compatibility with earlier
20881 versions of @value{GDBN}.
20882
20883 If an error occurring in @value{GDBN} does not fit into some more
20884 specific category, then the generated exception will have this type.
20885
20886 @item gdb.MemoryError
20887 This is a subclass of @code{gdb.error} which is thrown when an
20888 operation tried to access invalid memory in the inferior.
20889
20890 @item KeyboardInterrupt
20891 User interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination
20892 prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception.
20893 @end ftable
20894
20895 In all cases, your exception handler will see the @value{GDBN} error
20896 message as its value and the Python call stack backtrace at the Python
20897 statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the
20898 traceback.
20899
20900 @findex gdb.GdbError
20901 When implementing @value{GDBN} commands in Python via @code{gdb.Command},
20902 it is useful to be able to throw an exception that doesn't cause a
20903 traceback to be printed. For example, the user may have invoked the
20904 command incorrectly. Use the @code{gdb.GdbError} exception
20905 to handle this case. Example:
20906
20907 @smallexample
20908 (gdb) python
20909 >class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
20910 > """Greet the whole world."""
20911 > def __init__ (self):
20912 > super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
20913 > def invoke (self, args, from_tty):
20914 > argv = gdb.string_to_argv (args)
20915 > if len (argv) != 0:
20916 > raise gdb.GdbError ("hello-world takes no arguments")
20917 > print "Hello, World!"
20918 >HelloWorld ()
20919 >end
20920 (gdb) hello-world 42
20921 hello-world takes no arguments
20922 @end smallexample
20923
20924 @node Values From Inferior
20925 @subsubsection Values From Inferior
20926 @cindex values from inferior, with Python
20927 @cindex python, working with values from inferior
20928
20929 @cindex @code{gdb.Value}
20930 @value{GDBN} provides values it obtains from the inferior program in
20931 an object of type @code{gdb.Value}. @value{GDBN} uses this object
20932 for its internal bookkeeping of the inferior's values, and for
20933 fetching values when necessary.
20934
20935 Inferior values that are simple scalars can be used directly in
20936 Python expressions that are valid for the value's data type. Here's
20937 an example for an integer or floating-point value @code{some_val}:
20938
20939 @smallexample
20940 bar = some_val + 2
20941 @end smallexample
20942
20943 @noindent
20944 As result of this, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object
20945 whose values are of the same type as those of @code{some_val}.
20946
20947 Inferior values that are structures or instances of some class can
20948 be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}. For example, if
20949 @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance holding a structure, you
20950 can access its @code{foo} element with:
20951
20952 @smallexample
20953 bar = some_val['foo']
20954 @end smallexample
20955
20956 Again, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object.
20957
20958 A @code{gdb.Value} that represents a function can be executed via
20959 inferior function call. Any arguments provided to the call must match
20960 the function's prototype, and must be provided in the order specified
20961 by that prototype.
20962
20963 For example, @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance
20964 representing a function that takes two integers as arguments. To
20965 execute this function, call it like so:
20966
20967 @smallexample
20968 result = some_val (10,20)
20969 @end smallexample
20970
20971 Any values returned from a function call will be stored as a
20972 @code{gdb.Value}.
20973
20974 The following attributes are provided:
20975
20976 @table @code
20977 @defivar Value address
20978 If this object is addressable, this read-only attribute holds a
20979 @code{gdb.Value} object representing the address. Otherwise,
20980 this attribute holds @code{None}.
20981 @end defivar
20982
20983 @cindex optimized out value in Python
20984 @defivar Value is_optimized_out
20985 This read-only boolean attribute is true if the compiler optimized out
20986 this value, thus it is not available for fetching from the inferior.
20987 @end defivar
20988
20989 @defivar Value type
20990 The type of this @code{gdb.Value}. The value of this attribute is a
20991 @code{gdb.Type} object (@pxref{Types In Python}).
20992 @end defivar
20993
20994 @defivar Value dynamic_type
20995 The dynamic type of this @code{gdb.Value}. This uses C@t{++} run-time
20996 type information (@acronym{RTTI}) to determine the dynamic type of the
20997 value. If this value is of class type, it will return the class in
20998 which the value is embedded, if any. If this value is of pointer or
20999 reference to a class type, it will compute the dynamic type of the
21000 referenced object, and return a pointer or reference to that type,
21001 respectively. In all other cases, it will return the value's static
21002 type.
21003
21004 Note that this feature will only work when debugging a C@t{++} program
21005 that includes @acronym{RTTI} for the object in question. Otherwise,
21006 it will just return the static type of the value as in @kbd{ptype foo}
21007 (@pxref{Symbols, ptype}).
21008 @end defivar
21009 @end table
21010
21011 The following methods are provided:
21012
21013 @table @code
21014 @defmethod Value __init__ @var{val}
21015 Many Python values can be converted directly to a @code{gdb.Value} via
21016 this object initializer. Specifically:
21017
21018 @table @asis
21019 @item Python boolean
21020 A Python boolean is converted to the boolean type from the current
21021 language.
21022
21023 @item Python integer
21024 A Python integer is converted to the C @code{long} type for the
21025 current architecture.
21026
21027 @item Python long
21028 A Python long is converted to the C @code{long long} type for the
21029 current architecture.
21030
21031 @item Python float
21032 A Python float is converted to the C @code{double} type for the
21033 current architecture.
21034
21035 @item Python string
21036 A Python string is converted to a target string, using the current
21037 target encoding.
21038
21039 @item @code{gdb.Value}
21040 If @code{val} is a @code{gdb.Value}, then a copy of the value is made.
21041
21042 @item @code{gdb.LazyString}
21043 If @code{val} is a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings In
21044 Python}), then the lazy string's @code{value} method is called, and
21045 its result is used.
21046 @end table
21047 @end defmethod
21048
21049 @defmethod Value cast type
21050 Return a new instance of @code{gdb.Value} that is the result of
21051 casting this instance to the type described by @var{type}, which must
21052 be a @code{gdb.Type} object. If the cast cannot be performed for some
21053 reason, this method throws an exception.
21054 @end defmethod
21055
21056 @defmethod Value dereference
21057 For pointer data types, this method returns a new @code{gdb.Value} object
21058 whose contents is the object pointed to by the pointer. For example, if
21059 @code{foo} is a C pointer to an @code{int}, declared in your C program as
21060
21061 @smallexample
21062 int *foo;
21063 @end smallexample
21064
21065 @noindent
21066 then you can use the corresponding @code{gdb.Value} to access what
21067 @code{foo} points to like this:
21068
21069 @smallexample
21070 bar = foo.dereference ()
21071 @end smallexample
21072
21073 The result @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Value} object holding the
21074 value pointed to by @code{foo}.
21075 @end defmethod
21076
21077 @defmethod Value dynamic_cast type
21078 Like @code{Value.cast}, but works as if the C@t{++} @code{dynamic_cast}
21079 operator were used. Consult a C@t{++} reference for details.
21080 @end defmethod
21081
21082 @defmethod Value reinterpret_cast type
21083 Like @code{Value.cast}, but works as if the C@t{++} @code{reinterpret_cast}
21084 operator were used. Consult a C@t{++} reference for details.
21085 @end defmethod
21086
21087 @defmethod Value string @r{[}encoding@r{]} @r{[}errors@r{]} @r{[}length@r{]}
21088 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
21089 converts the contents to a Python string. Otherwise, this method will
21090 throw an exception.
21091
21092 Strings are recognized in a language-specific way; whether a given
21093 @code{gdb.Value} represents a string is determined by the current
21094 language.
21095
21096 For C-like languages, a value is a string if it is a pointer to or an
21097 array of characters or ints. The string is assumed to be terminated
21098 by a zero of the appropriate width. However if the optional length
21099 argument is given, the string will be converted to that given length,
21100 ignoring any embedded zeros that the string may contain.
21101
21102 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
21103 naming the encoding of the string in the @code{gdb.Value}, such as
21104 @code{"ascii"}, @code{"iso-8859-6"} or @code{"utf-8"}. It accepts
21105 the same encodings as the corresponding argument to Python's
21106 @code{string.decode} method, and the Python codec machinery will be used
21107 to convert the string. If @var{encoding} is not given, or if
21108 @var{encoding} is the empty string, then either the @code{target-charset}
21109 (@pxref{Character Sets}) will be used, or a language-specific encoding
21110 will be used, if the current language is able to supply one.
21111
21112 The optional @var{errors} argument is the same as the corresponding
21113 argument to Python's @code{string.decode} method.
21114
21115 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
21116 fetched and converted to the given length.
21117 @end defmethod
21118
21119 @defmethod Value lazy_string @r{[}encoding@r{]} @r{[}length@r{]}
21120 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
21121 converts the contents to a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings
21122 In Python}). Otherwise, this method will throw an exception.
21123
21124 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
21125 naming the encoding of the @code{gdb.LazyString}. Some examples are:
21126 @samp{ascii}, @samp{iso-8859-6} or @samp{utf-8}. If the
21127 @var{encoding} argument is an encoding that @value{GDBN} does
21128 recognize, @value{GDBN} will raise an error.
21129
21130 When a lazy string is printed, the @value{GDBN} encoding machinery is
21131 used to convert the string during printing. If the optional
21132 @var{encoding} argument is not provided, or is an empty string,
21133 @value{GDBN} will automatically select the encoding most suitable for
21134 the string type. For further information on encoding in @value{GDBN}
21135 please see @ref{Character Sets}.
21136
21137 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
21138 fetched and encoded to the length of characters specified. If
21139 the @var{length} argument is not provided, the string will be fetched
21140 and encoded until a null of appropriate width is found.
21141 @end defmethod
21142 @end table
21143
21144 @node Types In Python
21145 @subsubsection Types In Python
21146 @cindex types in Python
21147 @cindex Python, working with types
21148
21149 @tindex gdb.Type
21150 @value{GDBN} represents types from the inferior using the class
21151 @code{gdb.Type}.
21152
21153 The following type-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
21154 module:
21155
21156 @findex gdb.lookup_type
21157 @defun lookup_type name [block]
21158 This function looks up a type by name. @var{name} is the name of the
21159 type to look up. It must be a string.
21160
21161 If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope.
21162 Otherwise, it is searched for globally.
21163
21164 Ordinarily, this function will return an instance of @code{gdb.Type}.
21165 If the named type cannot be found, it will throw an exception.
21166 @end defun
21167
21168 An instance of @code{Type} has the following attributes:
21169
21170 @table @code
21171 @defivar Type code
21172 The type code for this type. The type code will be one of the
21173 @code{TYPE_CODE_} constants defined below.
21174 @end defivar
21175
21176 @defivar Type sizeof
21177 The size of this type, in target @code{char} units. Usually, a
21178 target's @code{char} type will be an 8-bit byte. However, on some
21179 unusual platforms, this type may have a different size.
21180 @end defivar
21181
21182 @defivar Type tag
21183 The tag name for this type. The tag name is the name after
21184 @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} in C and C@t{++}; not all
21185 languages have this concept. If this type has no tag name, then
21186 @code{None} is returned.
21187 @end defivar
21188 @end table
21189
21190 The following methods are provided:
21191
21192 @table @code
21193 @defmethod Type fields
21194 For structure and union types, this method returns the fields. Range
21195 types have two fields, the minimum and maximum values. Enum types
21196 have one field per enum constant. Function and method types have one
21197 field per parameter. The base types of C@t{++} classes are also
21198 represented as fields. If the type has no fields, or does not fit
21199 into one of these categories, an empty sequence will be returned.
21200
21201 Each field is an object, with some pre-defined attributes:
21202 @table @code
21203 @item bitpos
21204 This attribute is not available for @code{static} fields (as in
21205 C@t{++} or Java). For non-@code{static} fields, the value is the bit
21206 position of the field.
21207
21208 @item name
21209 The name of the field, or @code{None} for anonymous fields.
21210
21211 @item artificial
21212 This is @code{True} if the field is artificial, usually meaning that
21213 it was provided by the compiler and not the user. This attribute is
21214 always provided, and is @code{False} if the field is not artificial.
21215
21216 @item is_base_class
21217 This is @code{True} if the field represents a base class of a C@t{++}
21218 structure. This attribute is always provided, and is @code{False}
21219 if the field is not a base class of the type that is the argument of
21220 @code{fields}, or if that type was not a C@t{++} class.
21221
21222 @item bitsize
21223 If the field is packed, or is a bitfield, then this will have a
21224 non-zero value, which is the size of the field in bits. Otherwise,
21225 this will be zero; in this case the field's size is given by its type.
21226
21227 @item type
21228 The type of the field. This is usually an instance of @code{Type},
21229 but it can be @code{None} in some situations.
21230 @end table
21231 @end defmethod
21232
21233 @defmethod Type array @var{n1} @r{[}@var{n2}@r{]}
21234 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an array of this
21235 type. If one argument is given, it is the inclusive upper bound of
21236 the array; in this case the lower bound is zero. If two arguments are
21237 given, the first argument is the lower bound of the array, and the
21238 second argument is the upper bound of the array. An array's length
21239 must not be negative, but the bounds can be.
21240 @end defmethod
21241
21242 @defmethod Type const
21243 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
21244 @code{const}-qualified variant of this type.
21245 @end defmethod
21246
21247 @defmethod Type volatile
21248 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
21249 @code{volatile}-qualified variant of this type.
21250 @end defmethod
21251
21252 @defmethod Type unqualified
21253 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an unqualified
21254 variant of this type. That is, the result is neither @code{const} nor
21255 @code{volatile}.
21256 @end defmethod
21257
21258 @defmethod Type range
21259 Return a Python @code{Tuple} object that contains two elements: the
21260 low bound of the argument type and the high bound of that type. If
21261 the type does not have a range, @value{GDBN} will raise a
21262 @code{gdb.error} exception (@pxref{Exception Handling}).
21263 @end defmethod
21264
21265 @defmethod Type reference
21266 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a reference to this
21267 type.
21268 @end defmethod
21269
21270 @defmethod Type pointer
21271 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a pointer to this
21272 type.
21273 @end defmethod
21274
21275 @defmethod Type strip_typedefs
21276 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} that represents the real type,
21277 after removing all layers of typedefs.
21278 @end defmethod
21279
21280 @defmethod Type target
21281 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents the target type
21282 of this type.
21283
21284 For a pointer type, the target type is the type of the pointed-to
21285 object. For an array type (meaning C-like arrays), the target type is
21286 the type of the elements of the array. For a function or method type,
21287 the target type is the type of the return value. For a complex type,
21288 the target type is the type of the elements. For a typedef, the
21289 target type is the aliased type.
21290
21291 If the type does not have a target, this method will throw an
21292 exception.
21293 @end defmethod
21294
21295 @defmethod Type template_argument n [block]
21296 If this @code{gdb.Type} is an instantiation of a template, this will
21297 return a new @code{gdb.Type} which represents the type of the
21298 @var{n}th template argument.
21299
21300 If this @code{gdb.Type} is not a template type, this will throw an
21301 exception. Ordinarily, only C@t{++} code will have template types.
21302
21303 If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope.
21304 Otherwise, it is searched for globally.
21305 @end defmethod
21306 @end table
21307
21308
21309 Each type has a code, which indicates what category this type falls
21310 into. The available type categories are represented by constants
21311 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
21312
21313 @table @code
21314 @findex TYPE_CODE_PTR
21315 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_PTR
21316 @item TYPE_CODE_PTR
21317 The type is a pointer.
21318
21319 @findex TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
21320 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
21321 @item TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
21322 The type is an array.
21323
21324 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
21325 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
21326 @item TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
21327 The type is a structure.
21328
21329 @findex TYPE_CODE_UNION
21330 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_UNION
21331 @item TYPE_CODE_UNION
21332 The type is a union.
21333
21334 @findex TYPE_CODE_ENUM
21335 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ENUM
21336 @item TYPE_CODE_ENUM
21337 The type is an enum.
21338
21339 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
21340 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
21341 @item TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
21342 A bit flags type, used for things such as status registers.
21343
21344 @findex TYPE_CODE_FUNC
21345 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FUNC
21346 @item TYPE_CODE_FUNC
21347 The type is a function.
21348
21349 @findex TYPE_CODE_INT
21350 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INT
21351 @item TYPE_CODE_INT
21352 The type is an integer type.
21353
21354 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLT
21355 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLT
21356 @item TYPE_CODE_FLT
21357 A floating point type.
21358
21359 @findex TYPE_CODE_VOID
21360 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_VOID
21361 @item TYPE_CODE_VOID
21362 The special type @code{void}.
21363
21364 @findex TYPE_CODE_SET
21365 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_SET
21366 @item TYPE_CODE_SET
21367 A Pascal set type.
21368
21369 @findex TYPE_CODE_RANGE
21370 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_RANGE
21371 @item TYPE_CODE_RANGE
21372 A range type, that is, an integer type with bounds.
21373
21374 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRING
21375 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRING
21376 @item TYPE_CODE_STRING
21377 A string type. Note that this is only used for certain languages with
21378 language-defined string types; C strings are not represented this way.
21379
21380 @findex TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
21381 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
21382 @item TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
21383 A string of bits.
21384
21385 @findex TYPE_CODE_ERROR
21386 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ERROR
21387 @item TYPE_CODE_ERROR
21388 An unknown or erroneous type.
21389
21390 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHOD
21391 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHOD
21392 @item TYPE_CODE_METHOD
21393 A method type, as found in C@t{++} or Java.
21394
21395 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
21396 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
21397 @item TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
21398 A pointer-to-member-function.
21399
21400 @findex TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
21401 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
21402 @item TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
21403 A pointer-to-member.
21404
21405 @findex TYPE_CODE_REF
21406 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_REF
21407 @item TYPE_CODE_REF
21408 A reference type.
21409
21410 @findex TYPE_CODE_CHAR
21411 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_CHAR
21412 @item TYPE_CODE_CHAR
21413 A character type.
21414
21415 @findex TYPE_CODE_BOOL
21416 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BOOL
21417 @item TYPE_CODE_BOOL
21418 A boolean type.
21419
21420 @findex TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
21421 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
21422 @item TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
21423 A complex float type.
21424
21425 @findex TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
21426 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
21427 @item TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
21428 A typedef to some other type.
21429
21430 @findex TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
21431 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
21432 @item TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
21433 A C@t{++} namespace.
21434
21435 @findex TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
21436 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
21437 @item TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
21438 A decimal floating point type.
21439
21440 @findex TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
21441 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
21442 @item TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
21443 A function internal to @value{GDBN}. This is the type used to represent
21444 convenience functions.
21445 @end table
21446
21447 Further support for types is provided in the @code{gdb.types}
21448 Python module (@pxref{gdb.types}).
21449
21450 @node Pretty Printing API
21451 @subsubsection Pretty Printing API
21452
21453 An example output is provided (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
21454
21455 A pretty-printer is just an object that holds a value and implements a
21456 specific interface, defined here.
21457
21458 @defop Operation {pretty printer} children (self)
21459 @value{GDBN} will call this method on a pretty-printer to compute the
21460 children of the pretty-printer's value.
21461
21462 This method must return an object conforming to the Python iterator
21463 protocol. Each item returned by the iterator must be a tuple holding
21464 two elements. The first element is the ``name'' of the child; the
21465 second element is the child's value. The value can be any Python
21466 object which is convertible to a @value{GDBN} value.
21467
21468 This method is optional. If it does not exist, @value{GDBN} will act
21469 as though the value has no children.
21470 @end defop
21471
21472 @defop Operation {pretty printer} display_hint (self)
21473 The CLI may call this method and use its result to change the
21474 formatting of a value. The result will also be supplied to an MI
21475 consumer as a @samp{displayhint} attribute of the variable being
21476 printed.
21477
21478 This method is optional. If it does exist, this method must return a
21479 string.
21480
21481 Some display hints are predefined by @value{GDBN}:
21482
21483 @table @samp
21484 @item array
21485 Indicate that the object being printed is ``array-like''. The CLI
21486 uses this to respect parameters such as @code{set print elements} and
21487 @code{set print array}.
21488
21489 @item map
21490 Indicate that the object being printed is ``map-like'', and that the
21491 children of this value can be assumed to alternate between keys and
21492 values.
21493
21494 @item string
21495 Indicate that the object being printed is ``string-like''. If the
21496 printer's @code{to_string} method returns a Python string of some
21497 kind, then @value{GDBN} will call its internal language-specific
21498 string-printing function to format the string. For the CLI this means
21499 adding quotation marks, possibly escaping some characters, respecting
21500 @code{set print elements}, and the like.
21501 @end table
21502 @end defop
21503
21504 @defop Operation {pretty printer} to_string (self)
21505 @value{GDBN} will call this method to display the string
21506 representation of the value passed to the object's constructor.
21507
21508 When printing from the CLI, if the @code{to_string} method exists,
21509 then @value{GDBN} will prepend its result to the values returned by
21510 @code{children}. Exactly how this formatting is done is dependent on
21511 the display hint, and may change as more hints are added. Also,
21512 depending on the print settings (@pxref{Print Settings}), the CLI may
21513 print just the result of @code{to_string} in a stack trace, omitting
21514 the result of @code{children}.
21515
21516 If this method returns a string, it is printed verbatim.
21517
21518 Otherwise, if this method returns an instance of @code{gdb.Value},
21519 then @value{GDBN} prints this value. This may result in a call to
21520 another pretty-printer.
21521
21522 If instead the method returns a Python value which is convertible to a
21523 @code{gdb.Value}, then @value{GDBN} performs the conversion and prints
21524 the resulting value. Again, this may result in a call to another
21525 pretty-printer. Python scalars (integers, floats, and booleans) and
21526 strings are convertible to @code{gdb.Value}; other types are not.
21527
21528 Finally, if this method returns @code{None} then no further operations
21529 are peformed in this method and nothing is printed.
21530
21531 If the result is not one of these types, an exception is raised.
21532 @end defop
21533
21534 @value{GDBN} provides a function which can be used to look up the
21535 default pretty-printer for a @code{gdb.Value}:
21536
21537 @findex gdb.default_visualizer
21538 @defun default_visualizer value
21539 This function takes a @code{gdb.Value} object as an argument. If a
21540 pretty-printer for this value exists, then it is returned. If no such
21541 printer exists, then this returns @code{None}.
21542 @end defun
21543
21544 @node Selecting Pretty-Printers
21545 @subsubsection Selecting Pretty-Printers
21546
21547 The Python list @code{gdb.pretty_printers} contains an array of
21548 functions or callable objects that have been registered via addition
21549 as a pretty-printer. Printers in this list are called @code{global}
21550 printers, they're available when debugging all inferiors.
21551 Each @code{gdb.Progspace} contains a @code{pretty_printers} attribute.
21552 Each @code{gdb.Objfile} also contains a @code{pretty_printers}
21553 attribute.
21554
21555 Each function on these lists is passed a single @code{gdb.Value}
21556 argument and should return a pretty-printer object conforming to the
21557 interface definition above (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}). If a function
21558 cannot create a pretty-printer for the value, it should return
21559 @code{None}.
21560
21561 @value{GDBN} first checks the @code{pretty_printers} attribute of each
21562 @code{gdb.Objfile} in the current program space and iteratively calls
21563 each enabled lookup routine in the list for that @code{gdb.Objfile}
21564 until it receives a pretty-printer object.
21565 If no pretty-printer is found in the objfile lists, @value{GDBN} then
21566 searches the pretty-printer list of the current program space,
21567 calling each enabled function until an object is returned.
21568 After these lists have been exhausted, it tries the global
21569 @code{gdb.pretty_printers} list, again calling each enabled function until an
21570 object is returned.
21571
21572 The order in which the objfiles are searched is not specified. For a
21573 given list, functions are always invoked from the head of the list,
21574 and iterated over sequentially until the end of the list, or a printer
21575 object is returned.
21576
21577 For various reasons a pretty-printer may not work.
21578 For example, the underlying data structure may have changed and
21579 the pretty-printer is out of date.
21580
21581 The consequences of a broken pretty-printer are severe enough that
21582 @value{GDBN} provides support for enabling and disabling individual
21583 printers. For example, if @code{print frame-arguments} is on,
21584 a backtrace can become highly illegible if any argument is printed
21585 with a broken printer.
21586
21587 Pretty-printers are enabled and disabled by attaching an @code{enabled}
21588 attribute to the registered function or callable object. If this attribute
21589 is present and its value is @code{False}, the printer is disabled, otherwise
21590 the printer is enabled.
21591
21592 @node Writing a Pretty-Printer
21593 @subsubsection Writing a Pretty-Printer
21594 @cindex writing a pretty-printer
21595
21596 A pretty-printer consists of two parts: a lookup function to detect
21597 if the type is supported, and the printer itself.
21598
21599 Here is an example showing how a @code{std::string} printer might be
21600 written. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for details on the API this class
21601 must provide.
21602
21603 @smallexample
21604 class StdStringPrinter(object):
21605 "Print a std::string"
21606
21607 def __init__(self, val):
21608 self.val = val
21609
21610 def to_string(self):
21611 return self.val['_M_dataplus']['_M_p']
21612
21613 def display_hint(self):
21614 return 'string'
21615 @end smallexample
21616
21617 And here is an example showing how a lookup function for the printer
21618 example above might be written.
21619
21620 @smallexample
21621 def str_lookup_function(val):
21622 lookup_tag = val.type.tag
21623 if lookup_tag == None:
21624 return None
21625 regex = re.compile("^std::basic_string<char,.*>$")
21626 if regex.match(lookup_tag):
21627 return StdStringPrinter(val)
21628 return None
21629 @end smallexample
21630
21631 The example lookup function extracts the value's type, and attempts to
21632 match it to a type that it can pretty-print. If it is a type the
21633 printer can pretty-print, it will return a printer object. If not, it
21634 returns @code{None}.
21635
21636 We recommend that you put your core pretty-printers into a Python
21637 package. If your pretty-printers are for use with a library, we
21638 further recommend embedding a version number into the package name.
21639 This practice will enable @value{GDBN} to load multiple versions of
21640 your pretty-printers at the same time, because they will have
21641 different names.
21642
21643 You should write auto-loaded code (@pxref{Auto-loading}) such that it
21644 can be evaluated multiple times without changing its meaning. An
21645 ideal auto-load file will consist solely of @code{import}s of your
21646 printer modules, followed by a call to a register pretty-printers with
21647 the current objfile.
21648
21649 Taken as a whole, this approach will scale nicely to multiple
21650 inferiors, each potentially using a different library version.
21651 Embedding a version number in the Python package name will ensure that
21652 @value{GDBN} is able to load both sets of printers simultaneously.
21653 Then, because the search for pretty-printers is done by objfile, and
21654 because your auto-loaded code took care to register your library's
21655 printers with a specific objfile, @value{GDBN} will find the correct
21656 printers for the specific version of the library used by each
21657 inferior.
21658
21659 To continue the @code{std::string} example (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}),
21660 this code might appear in @code{gdb.libstdcxx.v6}:
21661
21662 @smallexample
21663 def register_printers(objfile):
21664 objfile.pretty_printers.add(str_lookup_function)
21665 @end smallexample
21666
21667 @noindent
21668 And then the corresponding contents of the auto-load file would be:
21669
21670 @smallexample
21671 import gdb.libstdcxx.v6
21672 gdb.libstdcxx.v6.register_printers(gdb.current_objfile())
21673 @end smallexample
21674
21675 The previous example illustrates a basic pretty-printer.
21676 There are a few things that can be improved on.
21677 The printer doesn't have a name, making it hard to identify in a
21678 list of installed printers. The lookup function has a name, but
21679 lookup functions can have arbitrary, even identical, names.
21680
21681 Second, the printer only handles one type, whereas a library typically has
21682 several types. One could install a lookup function for each desired type
21683 in the library, but one could also have a single lookup function recognize
21684 several types. The latter is the conventional way this is handled.
21685 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
21686 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
21687
21688 The @code{gdb.printing} module provides a formal way of solving these
21689 problems (@pxref{gdb.printing}).
21690 Here is another example that handles multiple types.
21691
21692 These are the types we are going to pretty-print:
21693
21694 @smallexample
21695 struct foo @{ int a, b; @};
21696 struct bar @{ struct foo x, y; @};
21697 @end smallexample
21698
21699 Here are the printers:
21700
21701 @smallexample
21702 class fooPrinter:
21703 """Print a foo object."""
21704
21705 def __init__(self, val):
21706 self.val = val
21707
21708 def to_string(self):
21709 return ("a=<" + str(self.val["a"]) +
21710 "> b=<" + str(self.val["b"]) + ">")
21711
21712 class barPrinter:
21713 """Print a bar object."""
21714
21715 def __init__(self, val):
21716 self.val = val
21717
21718 def to_string(self):
21719 return ("x=<" + str(self.val["x"]) +
21720 "> y=<" + str(self.val["y"]) + ">")
21721 @end smallexample
21722
21723 This example doesn't need a lookup function, that is handled by the
21724 @code{gdb.printing} module. Instead a function is provided to build up
21725 the object that handles the lookup.
21726
21727 @smallexample
21728 import gdb.printing
21729
21730 def build_pretty_printer():
21731 pp = gdb.printing.RegexpCollectionPrettyPrinter(
21732 "my_library")
21733 pp.add_printer('foo', '^foo$', fooPrinter)
21734 pp.add_printer('bar', '^bar$', barPrinter)
21735 return pp
21736 @end smallexample
21737
21738 And here is the autoload support:
21739
21740 @smallexample
21741 import gdb.printing
21742 import my_library
21743 gdb.printing.register_pretty_printer(
21744 gdb.current_objfile(),
21745 my_library.build_pretty_printer())
21746 @end smallexample
21747
21748 Finally, when this printer is loaded into @value{GDBN}, here is the
21749 corresponding output of @samp{info pretty-printer}:
21750
21751 @smallexample
21752 (gdb) info pretty-printer
21753 my_library.so:
21754 my_library
21755 foo
21756 bar
21757 @end smallexample
21758
21759 @node Inferiors In Python
21760 @subsubsection Inferiors In Python
21761 @cindex inferiors in python
21762
21763 @findex gdb.Inferior
21764 Programs which are being run under @value{GDBN} are called inferiors
21765 (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). Python scripts can access
21766 information about and manipulate inferiors controlled by @value{GDBN}
21767 via objects of the @code{gdb.Inferior} class.
21768
21769 The following inferior-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
21770 module:
21771
21772 @defun inferiors
21773 Return a tuple containing all inferior objects.
21774 @end defun
21775
21776 A @code{gdb.Inferior} object has the following attributes:
21777
21778 @table @code
21779 @defivar Inferior num
21780 ID of inferior, as assigned by GDB.
21781 @end defivar
21782
21783 @defivar Inferior pid
21784 Process ID of the inferior, as assigned by the underlying operating
21785 system.
21786 @end defivar
21787
21788 @defivar Inferior was_attached
21789 Boolean signaling whether the inferior was created using `attach', or
21790 started by @value{GDBN} itself.
21791 @end defivar
21792 @end table
21793
21794 A @code{gdb.Inferior} object has the following methods:
21795
21796 @table @code
21797 @defmethod Inferior threads
21798 This method returns a tuple holding all the threads which are valid
21799 when it is called. If there are no valid threads, the method will
21800 return an empty tuple.
21801 @end defmethod
21802
21803 @findex gdb.read_memory
21804 @defmethod Inferior read_memory address length
21805 Read @var{length} bytes of memory from the inferior, starting at
21806 @var{address}. Returns a buffer object, which behaves much like an array
21807 or a string. It can be modified and given to the @code{gdb.write_memory}
21808 function.
21809 @end defmethod
21810
21811 @findex gdb.write_memory
21812 @defmethod Inferior write_memory address buffer @r{[}length@r{]}
21813 Write the contents of @var{buffer} to the inferior, starting at
21814 @var{address}. The @var{buffer} parameter must be a Python object
21815 which supports the buffer protocol, i.e., a string, an array or the
21816 object returned from @code{gdb.read_memory}. If given, @var{length}
21817 determines the number of bytes from @var{buffer} to be written.
21818 @end defmethod
21819
21820 @findex gdb.search_memory
21821 @defmethod Inferior search_memory address length pattern
21822 Search a region of the inferior memory starting at @var{address} with
21823 the given @var{length} using the search pattern supplied in
21824 @var{pattern}. The @var{pattern} parameter must be a Python object
21825 which supports the buffer protocol, i.e., a string, an array or the
21826 object returned from @code{gdb.read_memory}. Returns a Python @code{Long}
21827 containing the address where the pattern was found, or @code{None} if
21828 the pattern could not be found.
21829 @end defmethod
21830 @end table
21831
21832 @node Threads In Python
21833 @subsubsection Threads In Python
21834 @cindex threads in python
21835
21836 @findex gdb.InferiorThread
21837 Python scripts can access information about, and manipulate inferior threads
21838 controlled by @value{GDBN}, via objects of the @code{gdb.InferiorThread} class.
21839
21840 The following thread-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
21841 module:
21842
21843 @findex gdb.selected_thread
21844 @defun selected_thread
21845 This function returns the thread object for the selected thread. If there
21846 is no selected thread, this will return @code{None}.
21847 @end defun
21848
21849 A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object has the following attributes:
21850
21851 @table @code
21852 @defivar InferiorThread num
21853 ID of the thread, as assigned by GDB.
21854 @end defivar
21855
21856 @defivar InferiorThread ptid
21857 ID of the thread, as assigned by the operating system. This attribute is a
21858 tuple containing three integers. The first is the Process ID (PID); the second
21859 is the Lightweight Process ID (LWPID), and the third is the Thread ID (TID).
21860 Either the LWPID or TID may be 0, which indicates that the operating system
21861 does not use that identifier.
21862 @end defivar
21863 @end table
21864
21865 A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object has the following methods:
21866
21867 @table @code
21868 @defmethod InferiorThread switch
21869 This changes @value{GDBN}'s currently selected thread to the one represented
21870 by this object.
21871 @end defmethod
21872
21873 @defmethod InferiorThread is_stopped
21874 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is stopped.
21875 @end defmethod
21876
21877 @defmethod InferiorThread is_running
21878 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is running.
21879 @end defmethod
21880
21881 @defmethod InferiorThread is_exited
21882 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is exited.
21883 @end defmethod
21884 @end table
21885
21886 @node Commands In Python
21887 @subsubsection Commands In Python
21888
21889 @cindex commands in python
21890 @cindex python commands
21891 You can implement new @value{GDBN} CLI commands in Python. A CLI
21892 command is implemented using an instance of the @code{gdb.Command}
21893 class, most commonly using a subclass.
21894
21895 @defmethod Command __init__ name @var{command_class} @r{[}@var{completer_class}@r{]} @r{[}@var{prefix}@r{]}
21896 The object initializer for @code{Command} registers the new command
21897 with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked from the
21898 subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
21899
21900 @var{name} is the name of the command. If @var{name} consists of
21901 multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
21902 commands. In this case, if one of the prefix commands does not exist,
21903 an exception is raised.
21904
21905 There is no support for multi-line commands.
21906
21907 @var{command_class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
21908 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to categorize the
21909 new command in the help system.
21910
21911 @var{completer_class} is an optional argument. If given, it should be
21912 one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined below. This argument
21913 tells @value{GDBN} how to perform completion for this command. If not
21914 given, @value{GDBN} will attempt to complete using the object's
21915 @code{complete} method (see below); if no such method is found, an
21916 error will occur when completion is attempted.
21917
21918 @var{prefix} is an optional argument. If @code{True}, then the new
21919 command is a prefix command; sub-commands of this command may be
21920 registered.
21921
21922 The help text for the new command is taken from the Python
21923 documentation string for the command's class, if there is one. If no
21924 documentation string is provided, the default value ``This command is
21925 not documented.'' is used.
21926 @end defmethod
21927
21928 @cindex don't repeat Python command
21929 @defmethod Command dont_repeat
21930 By default, a @value{GDBN} command is repeated when the user enters a
21931 blank line at the command prompt. A command can suppress this
21932 behavior by invoking the @code{dont_repeat} method. This is similar
21933 to the user command @code{dont-repeat}, see @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
21934 @end defmethod
21935
21936 @defmethod Command invoke argument from_tty
21937 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when this command is invoked.
21938
21939 @var{argument} is a string. It is the argument to the command, after
21940 leading and trailing whitespace has been stripped.
21941
21942 @var{from_tty} is a boolean argument. When true, this means that the
21943 command was entered by the user at the terminal; when false it means
21944 that the command came from elsewhere.
21945
21946 If this method throws an exception, it is turned into a @value{GDBN}
21947 @code{error} call. Otherwise, the return value is ignored.
21948
21949 @findex gdb.string_to_argv
21950 To break @var{argument} up into an argv-like string use
21951 @code{gdb.string_to_argv}. This function behaves identically to
21952 @value{GDBN}'s internal argument lexer @code{buildargv}.
21953 It is recommended to use this for consistency.
21954 Arguments are separated by spaces and may be quoted.
21955 Example:
21956
21957 @smallexample
21958 print gdb.string_to_argv ("1 2\ \\\"3 '4 \"5' \"6 '7\"")
21959 ['1', '2 "3', '4 "5', "6 '7"]
21960 @end smallexample
21961
21962 @end defmethod
21963
21964 @cindex completion of Python commands
21965 @defmethod Command complete text word
21966 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when the user attempts
21967 completion on this command. All forms of completion are handled by
21968 this method, that is, the @key{TAB} and @key{M-?} key bindings
21969 (@pxref{Completion}), and the @code{complete} command (@pxref{Help,
21970 complete}).
21971
21972 The arguments @var{text} and @var{word} are both strings. @var{text}
21973 holds the complete command line up to the cursor's location.
21974 @var{word} holds the last word of the command line; this is computed
21975 using a word-breaking heuristic.
21976
21977 The @code{complete} method can return several values:
21978 @itemize @bullet
21979 @item
21980 If the return value is a sequence, the contents of the sequence are
21981 used as the completions. It is up to @code{complete} to ensure that the
21982 contents actually do complete the word. A zero-length sequence is
21983 allowed, it means that there were no completions available. Only
21984 string elements of the sequence are used; other elements in the
21985 sequence are ignored.
21986
21987 @item
21988 If the return value is one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined
21989 below, then the corresponding @value{GDBN}-internal completion
21990 function is invoked, and its result is used.
21991
21992 @item
21993 All other results are treated as though there were no available
21994 completions.
21995 @end itemize
21996 @end defmethod
21997
21998 When a new command is registered, it must be declared as a member of
21999 some general class of commands. This is used to classify top-level
22000 commands in the on-line help system; note that prefix commands are not
22001 listed under their own category but rather that of their top-level
22002 command. The available classifications are represented by constants
22003 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
22004
22005 @table @code
22006 @findex COMMAND_NONE
22007 @findex gdb.COMMAND_NONE
22008 @item COMMAND_NONE
22009 The command does not belong to any particular class. A command in
22010 this category will not be displayed in any of the help categories.
22011
22012 @findex COMMAND_RUNNING
22013 @findex gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING
22014 @item COMMAND_RUNNING
22015 The command is related to running the inferior. For example,
22016 @code{start}, @code{step}, and @code{continue} are in this category.
22017 Type @kbd{help running} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22018 commands in this category.
22019
22020 @findex COMMAND_DATA
22021 @findex gdb.COMMAND_DATA
22022 @item COMMAND_DATA
22023 The command is related to data or variables. For example,
22024 @code{call}, @code{find}, and @code{print} are in this category. Type
22025 @kbd{help data} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands
22026 in this category.
22027
22028 @findex COMMAND_STACK
22029 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STACK
22030 @item COMMAND_STACK
22031 The command has to do with manipulation of the stack. For example,
22032 @code{backtrace}, @code{frame}, and @code{return} are in this
22033 category. Type @kbd{help stack} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a
22034 list of commands in this category.
22035
22036 @findex COMMAND_FILES
22037 @findex gdb.COMMAND_FILES
22038 @item COMMAND_FILES
22039 This class is used for file-related commands. For example,
22040 @code{file}, @code{list} and @code{section} are in this category.
22041 Type @kbd{help files} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22042 commands in this category.
22043
22044 @findex COMMAND_SUPPORT
22045 @findex gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
22046 @item COMMAND_SUPPORT
22047 This should be used for ``support facilities'', generally meaning
22048 things that are useful to the user when interacting with @value{GDBN},
22049 but not related to the state of the inferior. For example,
22050 @code{help}, @code{make}, and @code{shell} are in this category. Type
22051 @kbd{help support} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22052 commands in this category.
22053
22054 @findex COMMAND_STATUS
22055 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
22056 @item COMMAND_STATUS
22057 The command is an @samp{info}-related command, that is, related to the
22058 state of @value{GDBN} itself. For example, @code{info}, @code{macro},
22059 and @code{show} are in this category. Type @kbd{help status} at the
22060 @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
22061
22062 @findex COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
22063 @findex gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
22064 @item COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
22065 The command has to do with breakpoints. For example, @code{break},
22066 @code{clear}, and @code{delete} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
22067 breakpoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in
22068 this category.
22069
22070 @findex COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
22071 @findex gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
22072 @item COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
22073 The command has to do with tracepoints. For example, @code{trace},
22074 @code{actions}, and @code{tfind} are in this category. Type
22075 @kbd{help tracepoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22076 commands in this category.
22077
22078 @findex COMMAND_OBSCURE
22079 @findex gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
22080 @item COMMAND_OBSCURE
22081 The command is only used in unusual circumstances, or is not of
22082 general interest to users. For example, @code{checkpoint},
22083 @code{fork}, and @code{stop} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
22084 obscure} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this
22085 category.
22086
22087 @findex COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
22088 @findex gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
22089 @item COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
22090 The command is only useful to @value{GDBN} maintainers. The
22091 @code{maintenance} and @code{flushregs} commands are in this category.
22092 Type @kbd{help internals} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
22093 commands in this category.
22094 @end table
22095
22096 A new command can use a predefined completion function, either by
22097 specifying it via an argument at initialization, or by returning it
22098 from the @code{complete} method. These predefined completion
22099 constants are all defined in the @code{gdb} module:
22100
22101 @table @code
22102 @findex COMPLETE_NONE
22103 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
22104 @item COMPLETE_NONE
22105 This constant means that no completion should be done.
22106
22107 @findex COMPLETE_FILENAME
22108 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
22109 @item COMPLETE_FILENAME
22110 This constant means that filename completion should be performed.
22111
22112 @findex COMPLETE_LOCATION
22113 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
22114 @item COMPLETE_LOCATION
22115 This constant means that location completion should be done.
22116 @xref{Specify Location}.
22117
22118 @findex COMPLETE_COMMAND
22119 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
22120 @item COMPLETE_COMMAND
22121 This constant means that completion should examine @value{GDBN}
22122 command names.
22123
22124 @findex COMPLETE_SYMBOL
22125 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
22126 @item COMPLETE_SYMBOL
22127 This constant means that completion should be done using symbol names
22128 as the source.
22129 @end table
22130
22131 The following code snippet shows how a trivial CLI command can be
22132 implemented in Python:
22133
22134 @smallexample
22135 class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
22136 """Greet the whole world."""
22137
22138 def __init__ (self):
22139 super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
22140
22141 def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):
22142 print "Hello, World!"
22143
22144 HelloWorld ()
22145 @end smallexample
22146
22147 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
22148 registration of the command with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
22149 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
22150 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
22151
22152 @node Parameters In Python
22153 @subsubsection Parameters In Python
22154
22155 @cindex parameters in python
22156 @cindex python parameters
22157 @tindex gdb.Parameter
22158 @tindex Parameter
22159 You can implement new @value{GDBN} parameters using Python. A new
22160 parameter is implemented as an instance of the @code{gdb.Parameter}
22161 class.
22162
22163 Parameters are exposed to the user via the @code{set} and
22164 @code{show} commands. @xref{Help}.
22165
22166 There are many parameters that already exist and can be set in
22167 @value{GDBN}. Two examples are: @code{set follow fork} and
22168 @code{set charset}. Setting these parameters influences certain
22169 behavior in @value{GDBN}. Similarly, you can define parameters that
22170 can be used to influence behavior in custom Python scripts and commands.
22171
22172 @defmethod Parameter __init__ name @var{command-class} @var{parameter-class} @r{[}@var{enum-sequence}@r{]}
22173 The object initializer for @code{Parameter} registers the new
22174 parameter with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked
22175 from the subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
22176
22177 @var{name} is the name of the new parameter. If @var{name} consists
22178 of multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
22179 parameters. An example of this can be illustrated with the
22180 @code{set print} set of parameters. If @var{name} is
22181 @code{print foo}, then @code{print} will be searched as the prefix
22182 parameter. In this case the parameter can subsequently be accessed in
22183 @value{GDBN} as @code{set print foo}.
22184
22185 If @var{name} consists of multiple words, and no prefix parameter group
22186 can be found, an exception is raised.
22187
22188 @var{command-class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
22189 (@pxref{Commands In Python}). This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to
22190 categorize the new parameter in the help system.
22191
22192 @var{parameter-class} should be one of the @samp{PARAM_} constants
22193 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} the type of the new
22194 parameter; this information is used for input validation and
22195 completion.
22196
22197 If @var{parameter-class} is @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then
22198 @var{enum-sequence} must be a sequence of strings. These strings
22199 represent the possible values for the parameter.
22200
22201 If @var{parameter-class} is not @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then the presence
22202 of a fourth argument will cause an exception to be thrown.
22203
22204 The help text for the new parameter is taken from the Python
22205 documentation string for the parameter's class, if there is one. If
22206 there is no documentation string, a default value is used.
22207 @end defmethod
22208
22209 @defivar Parameter set_doc
22210 If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as
22211 the help text for this parameter's @code{set} command. The value is
22212 examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes
22213 have no effect.
22214 @end defivar
22215
22216 @defivar Parameter show_doc
22217 If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as
22218 the help text for this parameter's @code{show} command. The value is
22219 examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes
22220 have no effect.
22221 @end defivar
22222
22223 @defivar Parameter value
22224 The @code{value} attribute holds the underlying value of the
22225 parameter. It can be read and assigned to just as any other
22226 attribute. @value{GDBN} does validation when assignments are made.
22227 @end defivar
22228
22229
22230 When a new parameter is defined, its type must be specified. The
22231 available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb}
22232 module:
22233
22234 @table @code
22235 @findex PARAM_BOOLEAN
22236 @findex gdb.PARAM_BOOLEAN
22237 @item PARAM_BOOLEAN
22238 The value is a plain boolean. The Python boolean values, @code{True}
22239 and @code{False} are the only valid values.
22240
22241 @findex PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
22242 @findex gdb.PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
22243 @item PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
22244 The value has three possible states: true, false, and @samp{auto}. In
22245 Python, true and false are represented using boolean constants, and
22246 @samp{auto} is represented using @code{None}.
22247
22248 @findex PARAM_UINTEGER
22249 @findex gdb.PARAM_UINTEGER
22250 @item PARAM_UINTEGER
22251 The value is an unsigned integer. The value of 0 should be
22252 interpreted to mean ``unlimited''.
22253
22254 @findex PARAM_INTEGER
22255 @findex gdb.PARAM_INTEGER
22256 @item PARAM_INTEGER
22257 The value is a signed integer. The value of 0 should be interpreted
22258 to mean ``unlimited''.
22259
22260 @findex PARAM_STRING
22261 @findex gdb.PARAM_STRING
22262 @item PARAM_STRING
22263 The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, any escape
22264 sequences, such as @samp{\t}, @samp{\f}, and octal escapes, are
22265 translated into corresponding characters and encoded into the current
22266 host charset.
22267
22268 @findex PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
22269 @findex gdb.PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
22270 @item PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
22271 The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, escapes are
22272 passed through untranslated.
22273
22274 @findex PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
22275 @findex gdb.PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
22276 @item PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
22277 The value is a either a filename (a string), or @code{None}.
22278
22279 @findex PARAM_FILENAME
22280 @findex gdb.PARAM_FILENAME
22281 @item PARAM_FILENAME
22282 The value is a filename. This is just like
22283 @code{PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE}, but uses file names for completion.
22284
22285 @findex PARAM_ZINTEGER
22286 @findex gdb.PARAM_ZINTEGER
22287 @item PARAM_ZINTEGER
22288 The value is an integer. This is like @code{PARAM_INTEGER}, except 0
22289 is interpreted as itself.
22290
22291 @findex PARAM_ENUM
22292 @findex gdb.PARAM_ENUM
22293 @item PARAM_ENUM
22294 The value is a string, which must be one of a collection string
22295 constants provided when the parameter is created.
22296 @end table
22297
22298 @node Functions In Python
22299 @subsubsection Writing new convenience functions
22300
22301 @cindex writing convenience functions
22302 @cindex convenience functions in python
22303 @cindex python convenience functions
22304 @tindex gdb.Function
22305 @tindex Function
22306 You can implement new convenience functions (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
22307 in Python. A convenience function is an instance of a subclass of the
22308 class @code{gdb.Function}.
22309
22310 @defmethod Function __init__ name
22311 The initializer for @code{Function} registers the new function with
22312 @value{GDBN}. The argument @var{name} is the name of the function,
22313 a string. The function will be visible to the user as a convenience
22314 variable of type @code{internal function}, whose name is the same as
22315 the given @var{name}.
22316
22317 The documentation for the new function is taken from the documentation
22318 string for the new class.
22319 @end defmethod
22320
22321 @defmethod Function invoke @var{*args}
22322 When a convenience function is evaluated, its arguments are converted
22323 to instances of @code{gdb.Value}, and then the function's
22324 @code{invoke} method is called. Note that @value{GDBN} does not
22325 predetermine the arity of convenience functions. Instead, all
22326 available arguments are passed to @code{invoke}, following the
22327 standard Python calling convention. In particular, a convenience
22328 function can have default values for parameters without ill effect.
22329
22330 The return value of this method is used as its value in the enclosing
22331 expression. If an ordinary Python value is returned, it is converted
22332 to a @code{gdb.Value} following the usual rules.
22333 @end defmethod
22334
22335 The following code snippet shows how a trivial convenience function can
22336 be implemented in Python:
22337
22338 @smallexample
22339 class Greet (gdb.Function):
22340 """Return string to greet someone.
22341 Takes a name as argument."""
22342
22343 def __init__ (self):
22344 super (Greet, self).__init__ ("greet")
22345
22346 def invoke (self, name):
22347 return "Hello, %s!" % name.string ()
22348
22349 Greet ()
22350 @end smallexample
22351
22352 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
22353 registration of the function with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
22354 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
22355 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
22356
22357 @node Progspaces In Python
22358 @subsubsection Program Spaces In Python
22359
22360 @cindex progspaces in python
22361 @tindex gdb.Progspace
22362 @tindex Progspace
22363 A program space, or @dfn{progspace}, represents a symbolic view
22364 of an address space.
22365 It consists of all of the objfiles of the program.
22366 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
22367 @xref{Inferiors and Programs, program spaces}, for more details
22368 about program spaces.
22369
22370 The following progspace-related functions are available in the
22371 @code{gdb} module:
22372
22373 @findex gdb.current_progspace
22374 @defun current_progspace
22375 This function returns the program space of the currently selected inferior.
22376 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}.
22377 @end defun
22378
22379 @findex gdb.progspaces
22380 @defun progspaces
22381 Return a sequence of all the progspaces currently known to @value{GDBN}.
22382 @end defun
22383
22384 Each progspace is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Progspace}
22385 class.
22386
22387 @defivar Progspace filename
22388 The file name of the progspace as a string.
22389 @end defivar
22390
22391 @defivar Progspace pretty_printers
22392 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
22393 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
22394 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
22395 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
22396 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more
22397 information.
22398 @end defivar
22399
22400 @node Objfiles In Python
22401 @subsubsection Objfiles In Python
22402
22403 @cindex objfiles in python
22404 @tindex gdb.Objfile
22405 @tindex Objfile
22406 @value{GDBN} loads symbols for an inferior from various
22407 symbol-containing files (@pxref{Files}). These include the primary
22408 executable file, any shared libraries used by the inferior, and any
22409 separate debug info files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}).
22410 @value{GDBN} calls these symbol-containing files @dfn{objfiles}.
22411
22412 The following objfile-related functions are available in the
22413 @code{gdb} module:
22414
22415 @findex gdb.current_objfile
22416 @defun current_objfile
22417 When auto-loading a Python script (@pxref{Auto-loading}), @value{GDBN}
22418 sets the ``current objfile'' to the corresponding objfile. This
22419 function returns the current objfile. If there is no current objfile,
22420 this function returns @code{None}.
22421 @end defun
22422
22423 @findex gdb.objfiles
22424 @defun objfiles
22425 Return a sequence of all the objfiles current known to @value{GDBN}.
22426 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
22427 @end defun
22428
22429 Each objfile is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Objfile}
22430 class.
22431
22432 @defivar Objfile filename
22433 The file name of the objfile as a string.
22434 @end defivar
22435
22436 @defivar Objfile pretty_printers
22437 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
22438 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
22439 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
22440 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
22441 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more
22442 information.
22443 @end defivar
22444
22445 @node Frames In Python
22446 @subsubsection Accessing inferior stack frames from Python.
22447
22448 @cindex frames in python
22449 When the debugged program stops, @value{GDBN} is able to analyze its call
22450 stack (@pxref{Frames,,Stack frames}). The @code{gdb.Frame} class
22451 represents a frame in the stack. A @code{gdb.Frame} object is only valid
22452 while its corresponding frame exists in the inferior's stack. If you try
22453 to use an invalid frame object, @value{GDBN} will throw a @code{gdb.error}
22454 exception (@pxref{Exception Handling}).
22455
22456 Two @code{gdb.Frame} objects can be compared for equality with the @code{==}
22457 operator, like:
22458
22459 @smallexample
22460 (@value{GDBP}) python print gdb.newest_frame() == gdb.selected_frame ()
22461 True
22462 @end smallexample
22463
22464 The following frame-related functions are available in the @code{gdb} module:
22465
22466 @findex gdb.selected_frame
22467 @defun selected_frame
22468 Return the selected frame object. (@pxref{Selection,,Selecting a Frame}).
22469 @end defun
22470
22471 @defun frame_stop_reason_string reason
22472 Return a string explaining the reason why @value{GDBN} stopped unwinding
22473 frames, as expressed by the given @var{reason} code (an integer, see the
22474 @code{unwind_stop_reason} method further down in this section).
22475 @end defun
22476
22477 A @code{gdb.Frame} object has the following methods:
22478
22479 @table @code
22480 @defmethod Frame is_valid
22481 Returns true if the @code{gdb.Frame} object is valid, false if not.
22482 A frame object can become invalid if the frame it refers to doesn't
22483 exist anymore in the inferior. All @code{gdb.Frame} methods will throw
22484 an exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
22485 @end defmethod
22486
22487 @defmethod Frame name
22488 Returns the function name of the frame, or @code{None} if it can't be
22489 obtained.
22490 @end defmethod
22491
22492 @defmethod Frame type
22493 Returns the type of the frame. The value can be one of
22494 @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME}, @code{gdb.DUMMY_FRAME}, @code{gdb.SIGTRAMP_FRAME}
22495 or @code{gdb.SENTINEL_FRAME}.
22496 @end defmethod
22497
22498 @defmethod Frame unwind_stop_reason
22499 Return an integer representing the reason why it's not possible to find
22500 more frames toward the outermost frame. Use
22501 @code{gdb.frame_stop_reason_string} to convert the value returned by this
22502 function to a string.
22503 @end defmethod
22504
22505 @defmethod Frame pc
22506 Returns the frame's resume address.
22507 @end defmethod
22508
22509 @defmethod Frame block
22510 Return the frame's code block. @xref{Blocks In Python}.
22511 @end defmethod
22512
22513 @defmethod Frame function
22514 Return the symbol for the function corresponding to this frame.
22515 @xref{Symbols In Python}.
22516 @end defmethod
22517
22518 @defmethod Frame older
22519 Return the frame that called this frame.
22520 @end defmethod
22521
22522 @defmethod Frame newer
22523 Return the frame called by this frame.
22524 @end defmethod
22525
22526 @defmethod Frame find_sal
22527 Return the frame's symtab and line object.
22528 @xref{Symbol Tables In Python}.
22529 @end defmethod
22530
22531 @defmethod Frame read_var variable @r{[}block@r{]}
22532 Return the value of @var{variable} in this frame. If the optional
22533 argument @var{block} is provided, search for the variable from that
22534 block; otherwise start at the frame's current block (which is
22535 determined by the frame's current program counter). @var{variable}
22536 must be a string or a @code{gdb.Symbol} object. @var{block} must be a
22537 @code{gdb.Block} object.
22538 @end defmethod
22539
22540 @defmethod Frame select
22541 Set this frame to be the selected frame. @xref{Stack, ,Examining the
22542 Stack}.
22543 @end defmethod
22544 @end table
22545
22546 @node Blocks In Python
22547 @subsubsection Accessing frame blocks from Python.
22548
22549 @cindex blocks in python
22550 @tindex gdb.Block
22551
22552 Within each frame, @value{GDBN} maintains information on each block
22553 stored in that frame. These blocks are organized hierarchically, and
22554 are represented individually in Python as a @code{gdb.Block}.
22555 Please see @ref{Frames In Python}, for a more in-depth discussion on
22556 frames. Furthermore, see @ref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}, for more
22557 detailed technical information on @value{GDBN}'s book-keeping of the
22558 stack.
22559
22560 The following block-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
22561 module:
22562
22563 @findex gdb.block_for_pc
22564 @defun block_for_pc pc
22565 Return the @code{gdb.Block} containing the given @var{pc} value. If the
22566 block cannot be found for the @var{pc} value specified, the function
22567 will return @code{None}.
22568 @end defun
22569
22570 A @code{gdb.Block} object has the following attributes:
22571
22572 @table @code
22573 @defivar Block start
22574 The start address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
22575 @end defivar
22576
22577 @defivar Block end
22578 The end address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
22579 @end defivar
22580
22581 @defivar Block function
22582 The name of the block represented as a @code{gdb.Symbol}. If the
22583 block is not named, then this attribute holds @code{None}. This
22584 attribute is not writable.
22585 @end defivar
22586
22587 @defivar Block superblock
22588 The block containing this block. If this parent block does not exist,
22589 this attribute holds @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
22590 @end defivar
22591 @end table
22592
22593 @node Symbols In Python
22594 @subsubsection Python representation of Symbols.
22595
22596 @cindex symbols in python
22597 @tindex gdb.Symbol
22598
22599 @value{GDBN} represents every variable, function and type as an
22600 entry in a symbol table. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
22601 Similarly, Python represents these symbols in @value{GDBN} with the
22602 @code{gdb.Symbol} object.
22603
22604 The following symbol-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
22605 module:
22606
22607 @findex gdb.lookup_symbol
22608 @defun lookup_symbol name [block] [domain]
22609 This function searches for a symbol by name. The search scope can be
22610 restricted to the parameters defined in the optional domain and block
22611 arguments.
22612
22613 @var{name} is the name of the symbol. It must be a string. The
22614 optional @var{block} argument restricts the search to symbols visible
22615 in that @var{block}. The @var{block} argument must be a
22616 @code{gdb.Block} object. The optional @var{domain} argument restricts
22617 the search to the domain type. The @var{domain} argument must be a
22618 domain constant defined in the @code{gdb} module and described later
22619 in this chapter.
22620 @end defun
22621
22622 A @code{gdb.Symbol} object has the following attributes:
22623
22624 @table @code
22625 @defivar Symbol symtab
22626 The symbol table in which the symbol appears. This attribute is
22627 represented as a @code{gdb.Symtab} object. @xref{Symbol Tables In
22628 Python}. This attribute is not writable.
22629 @end defivar
22630
22631 @defivar Symbol name
22632 The name of the symbol as a string. This attribute is not writable.
22633 @end defivar
22634
22635 @defivar Symbol linkage_name
22636 The name of the symbol, as used by the linker (i.e., may be mangled).
22637 This attribute is not writable.
22638 @end defivar
22639
22640 @defivar Symbol print_name
22641 The name of the symbol in a form suitable for output. This is either
22642 @code{name} or @code{linkage_name}, depending on whether the user
22643 asked @value{GDBN} to display demangled or mangled names.
22644 @end defivar
22645
22646 @defivar Symbol addr_class
22647 The address class of the symbol. This classifies how to find the value
22648 of a symbol. Each address class is a constant defined in the
22649 @code{gdb} module and described later in this chapter.
22650 @end defivar
22651
22652 @defivar Symbol is_argument
22653 @code{True} if the symbol is an argument of a function.
22654 @end defivar
22655
22656 @defivar Symbol is_constant
22657 @code{True} if the symbol is a constant.
22658 @end defivar
22659
22660 @defivar Symbol is_function
22661 @code{True} if the symbol is a function or a method.
22662 @end defivar
22663
22664 @defivar Symbol is_variable
22665 @code{True} if the symbol is a variable.
22666 @end defivar
22667 @end table
22668
22669 The available domain categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented
22670 as constants in the @code{gdb} module:
22671
22672 @table @code
22673 @findex SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
22674 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
22675 @item SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
22676 This is used when a domain has not been discovered or none of the
22677 following domains apply. This usually indicates an error either
22678 in the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols.
22679 @findex SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
22680 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
22681 @item SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
22682 This domain contains variables, function names, typedef names and enum
22683 type values.
22684 @findex SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
22685 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
22686 @item SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
22687 This domain holds struct, union and enum type names.
22688 @findex SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
22689 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
22690 @item SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
22691 This domain contains names of labels (for gotos).
22692 @findex SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
22693 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
22694 @item SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
22695 This domain holds a subset of the @code{SYMBOLS_VAR_DOMAIN}; it
22696 contains everything minus functions and types.
22697 @findex SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN
22698 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN
22699 @item SYMBOL_FUNCTION_DOMAIN
22700 This domain contains all functions.
22701 @findex SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
22702 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
22703 @item SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
22704 This domain contains all types.
22705 @end table
22706
22707 The available address class categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented
22708 as constants in the @code{gdb} module:
22709
22710 @table @code
22711 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
22712 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
22713 @item SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
22714 If this is returned by address class, it indicates an error either in
22715 the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols.
22716 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
22717 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
22718 @item SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
22719 Value is constant int.
22720 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
22721 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
22722 @item SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
22723 Value is at a fixed address.
22724 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
22725 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
22726 @item SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
22727 Value is in a register.
22728 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
22729 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
22730 @item SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
22731 Value is an argument. This value is at the offset stored within the
22732 symbol inside the frame's argument list.
22733 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
22734 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
22735 @item SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
22736 Value address is stored in the frame's argument list. Just like
22737 @code{LOC_ARG} except that the value's address is stored at the
22738 offset, not the value itself.
22739 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
22740 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
22741 @item SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
22742 Value is a specified register. Just like @code{LOC_REGISTER} except
22743 the register holds the address of the argument instead of the argument
22744 itself.
22745 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
22746 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
22747 @item SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
22748 Value is a local variable.
22749 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
22750 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
22751 @item SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
22752 Value not used. Symbols in the domain @code{SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN} all
22753 have this class.
22754 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
22755 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
22756 @item SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
22757 Value is a block.
22758 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
22759 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
22760 @item SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
22761 Value is a byte-sequence.
22762 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
22763 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
22764 @item SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
22765 Value is at a fixed address, but the address of the variable has to be
22766 determined from the minimal symbol table whenever the variable is
22767 referenced.
22768 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
22769 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
22770 @item SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
22771 The value does not actually exist in the program.
22772 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
22773 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
22774 @item SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
22775 The value's address is a computed location.
22776 @end table
22777
22778 @node Symbol Tables In Python
22779 @subsubsection Symbol table representation in Python.
22780
22781 @cindex symbol tables in python
22782 @tindex gdb.Symtab
22783 @tindex gdb.Symtab_and_line
22784
22785 Access to symbol table data maintained by @value{GDBN} on the inferior
22786 is exposed to Python via two objects: @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} and
22787 @code{gdb.Symtab}. Symbol table and line data for a frame is returned
22788 from the @code{find_sal} method in @code{gdb.Frame} object.
22789 @xref{Frames In Python}.
22790
22791 For more information on @value{GDBN}'s symbol table management, see
22792 @ref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, for more information.
22793
22794 A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object has the following attributes:
22795
22796 @table @code
22797 @defivar Symtab_and_line symtab
22798 The symbol table object (@code{gdb.Symtab}) for this frame.
22799 This attribute is not writable.
22800 @end defivar
22801
22802 @defivar Symtab_and_line pc
22803 Indicates the current program counter address. This attribute is not
22804 writable.
22805 @end defivar
22806
22807 @defivar Symtab_and_line line
22808 Indicates the current line number for this object. This
22809 attribute is not writable.
22810 @end defivar
22811 @end table
22812
22813 A @code{gdb.Symtab} object has the following attributes:
22814
22815 @table @code
22816 @defivar Symtab filename
22817 The symbol table's source filename. This attribute is not writable.
22818 @end defivar
22819
22820 @defivar Symtab objfile
22821 The symbol table's backing object file. @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
22822 This attribute is not writable.
22823 @end defivar
22824 @end table
22825
22826 The following methods are provided:
22827
22828 @table @code
22829 @defmethod Symtab fullname
22830 Return the symbol table's source absolute file name.
22831 @end defmethod
22832 @end table
22833
22834 @node Breakpoints In Python
22835 @subsubsection Manipulating breakpoints using Python
22836
22837 @cindex breakpoints in python
22838 @tindex gdb.Breakpoint
22839
22840 Python code can manipulate breakpoints via the @code{gdb.Breakpoint}
22841 class.
22842
22843 @defmethod Breakpoint __init__ spec @r{[}type@r{]} @r{[}wp_class@r{]} @r{[}internal@r{]}
22844 Create a new breakpoint. @var{spec} is a string naming the
22845 location of the breakpoint, or an expression that defines a
22846 watchpoint. The contents can be any location recognized by the
22847 @code{break} command, or in the case of a watchpoint, by the @code{watch}
22848 command. The optional @var{type} denotes the breakpoint to create
22849 from the types defined later in this chapter. This argument can be
22850 either: @code{BP_BREAKPOINT} or @code{BP_WATCHPOINT}. @var{type}
22851 defaults to @code{BP_BREAKPOINT}. The optional @var{internal} argument
22852 allows the breakpoint to become invisible to the user. The breakpoint
22853 will neither be reported when created, nor will it be listed in the
22854 output from @code{info breakpoints} (but will be listed with the
22855 @code{maint info breakpoints} command). The optional @var{wp_class}
22856 argument defines the class of watchpoint to create, if @var{type} is
22857 @code{BP_WATCHPOINT}. If a watchpoint class is not provided, it is
22858 assumed to be a @var{WP_WRITE} class.
22859 @end defmethod
22860
22861 The available watchpoint types represented by constants are defined in the
22862 @code{gdb} module:
22863
22864 @table @code
22865 @findex WP_READ
22866 @findex gdb.WP_READ
22867 @item WP_READ
22868 Read only watchpoint.
22869
22870 @findex WP_WRITE
22871 @findex gdb.WP_WRITE
22872 @item WP_WRITE
22873 Write only watchpoint.
22874
22875 @findex WP_ACCESS
22876 @findex gdb.WP_ACCESS
22877 @item WP_ACCESS
22878 Read/Write watchpoint.
22879 @end table
22880
22881 @defmethod Breakpoint is_valid
22882 Return @code{True} if this @code{Breakpoint} object is valid,
22883 @code{False} otherwise. A @code{Breakpoint} object can become invalid
22884 if the user deletes the breakpoint. In this case, the object still
22885 exists, but the underlying breakpoint does not. In the cases of
22886 watchpoint scope, the watchpoint remains valid even if execution of the
22887 inferior leaves the scope of that watchpoint.
22888 @end defmethod
22889
22890 @defivar Breakpoint enabled
22891 This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is enabled, and
22892 @code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable.
22893 @end defivar
22894
22895 @defivar Breakpoint silent
22896 This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is silent, and
22897 @code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable.
22898
22899 Note that a breakpoint can also be silent if it has commands and the
22900 first command is @code{silent}. This is not reported by the
22901 @code{silent} attribute.
22902 @end defivar
22903
22904 @defivar Breakpoint thread
22905 If the breakpoint is thread-specific, this attribute holds the thread
22906 id. If the breakpoint is not thread-specific, this attribute is
22907 @code{None}. This attribute is writable.
22908 @end defivar
22909
22910 @defivar Breakpoint task
22911 If the breakpoint is Ada task-specific, this attribute holds the Ada task
22912 id. If the breakpoint is not task-specific (or the underlying
22913 language is not Ada), this attribute is @code{None}. This attribute
22914 is writable.
22915 @end defivar
22916
22917 @defivar Breakpoint ignore_count
22918 This attribute holds the ignore count for the breakpoint, an integer.
22919 This attribute is writable.
22920 @end defivar
22921
22922 @defivar Breakpoint number
22923 This attribute holds the breakpoint's number --- the identifier used by
22924 the user to manipulate the breakpoint. This attribute is not writable.
22925 @end defivar
22926
22927 @defivar Breakpoint type
22928 This attribute holds the breakpoint's type --- the identifier used to
22929 determine the actual breakpoint type or use-case. This attribute is not
22930 writable.
22931 @end defivar
22932
22933 @defivar Breakpoint visible
22934 This attribute tells whether the breakpoint is visible to the user
22935 when set, or when the @samp{info breakpoints} command is run. This
22936 attribute is not writable.
22937 @end defivar
22938
22939 The available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb}
22940 module:
22941
22942 @table @code
22943 @findex BP_BREAKPOINT
22944 @findex gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT
22945 @item BP_BREAKPOINT
22946 Normal code breakpoint.
22947
22948 @findex BP_WATCHPOINT
22949 @findex gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT
22950 @item BP_WATCHPOINT
22951 Watchpoint breakpoint.
22952
22953 @findex BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
22954 @findex gdb.BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
22955 @item BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
22956 Hardware assisted watchpoint.
22957
22958 @findex BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
22959 @findex gdb.BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
22960 @item BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
22961 Hardware assisted read watchpoint.
22962
22963 @findex BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
22964 @findex gdb.BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
22965 @item BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
22966 Hardware assisted access watchpoint.
22967 @end table
22968
22969 @defivar Breakpoint hit_count
22970 This attribute holds the hit count for the breakpoint, an integer.
22971 This attribute is writable, but currently it can only be set to zero.
22972 @end defivar
22973
22974 @defivar Breakpoint location
22975 This attribute holds the location of the breakpoint, as specified by
22976 the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have a location
22977 (that is, it is a watchpoint) the attribute's value is @code{None}. This
22978 attribute is not writable.
22979 @end defivar
22980
22981 @defivar Breakpoint expression
22982 This attribute holds a breakpoint expression, as specified by
22983 the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have an
22984 expression (the breakpoint is not a watchpoint) the attribute's value
22985 is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
22986 @end defivar
22987
22988 @defivar Breakpoint condition
22989 This attribute holds the condition of the breakpoint, as specified by
22990 the user. It is a string. If there is no condition, this attribute's
22991 value is @code{None}. This attribute is writable.
22992 @end defivar
22993
22994 @defivar Breakpoint commands
22995 This attribute holds the commands attached to the breakpoint. If
22996 there are commands, this attribute's value is a string holding all the
22997 commands, separated by newlines. If there are no commands, this
22998 attribute is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
22999 @end defivar
23000
23001 @node Lazy Strings In Python
23002 @subsubsection Python representation of lazy strings.
23003
23004 @cindex lazy strings in python
23005 @tindex gdb.LazyString
23006
23007 A @dfn{lazy string} is a string whose contents is not retrieved or
23008 encoded until it is needed.
23009
23010 A @code{gdb.LazyString} is represented in @value{GDBN} as an
23011 @code{address} that points to a region of memory, an @code{encoding}
23012 that will be used to encode that region of memory, and a @code{length}
23013 to delimit the region of memory that represents the string. The
23014 difference between a @code{gdb.LazyString} and a string wrapped within
23015 a @code{gdb.Value} is that a @code{gdb.LazyString} will be treated
23016 differently by @value{GDBN} when printing. A @code{gdb.LazyString} is
23017 retrieved and encoded during printing, while a @code{gdb.Value}
23018 wrapping a string is immediately retrieved and encoded on creation.
23019
23020 A @code{gdb.LazyString} object has the following functions:
23021
23022 @defmethod LazyString value
23023 Convert the @code{gdb.LazyString} to a @code{gdb.Value}. This value
23024 will point to the string in memory, but will lose all the delayed
23025 retrieval, encoding and handling that @value{GDBN} applies to a
23026 @code{gdb.LazyString}.
23027 @end defmethod
23028
23029 @defivar LazyString address
23030 This attribute holds the address of the string. This attribute is not
23031 writable.
23032 @end defivar
23033
23034 @defivar LazyString length
23035 This attribute holds the length of the string in characters. If the
23036 length is -1, then the string will be fetched and encoded up to the
23037 first null of appropriate width. This attribute is not writable.
23038 @end defivar
23039
23040 @defivar LazyString encoding
23041 This attribute holds the encoding that will be applied to the string
23042 when the string is printed by @value{GDBN}. If the encoding is not
23043 set, or contains an empty string, then @value{GDBN} will select the
23044 most appropriate encoding when the string is printed. This attribute
23045 is not writable.
23046 @end defivar
23047
23048 @defivar LazyString type
23049 This attribute holds the type that is represented by the lazy string's
23050 type. For a lazy string this will always be a pointer type. To
23051 resolve this to the lazy string's character type, use the type's
23052 @code{target} method. @xref{Types In Python}. This attribute is not
23053 writable.
23054 @end defivar
23055
23056 @node Auto-loading
23057 @subsection Auto-loading
23058 @cindex auto-loading, Python
23059
23060 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23061 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
23062 @value{GDBN} will look for Python support scripts in several ways:
23063 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} and @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
23064
23065 @menu
23066 * objfile-gdb.py file:: The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} file
23067 * .debug_gdb_scripts section:: The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23068 * Which flavor to choose?::
23069 @end menu
23070
23071 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
23072 debugging commands and scripts.
23073
23074 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled.
23075
23076 @table @code
23077 @kindex maint set python auto-load
23078 @item maint set python auto-load [yes|no]
23079 Enable or disable the Python auto-loading feature.
23080
23081 @kindex maint show python auto-load
23082 @item maint show python auto-load
23083 Show whether Python auto-loading is enabled or disabled.
23084 @end table
23085
23086 When reading an auto-loaded file, @value{GDBN} sets the
23087 @dfn{current objfile}. This is available via the @code{gdb.current_objfile}
23088 function (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}). This can be useful for
23089 registering objfile-specific pretty-printers.
23090
23091 @node objfile-gdb.py file
23092 @subsubsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} file
23093 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
23094
23095 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for
23096 a file named @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py},
23097 where @var{objfile} is the object file's real name, formed by ensuring
23098 that the file name is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving
23099 @code{.} and @code{..} components. If this file exists and is
23100 readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a Python script.
23101
23102 If this file does not exist, and if the parameter
23103 @code{debug-file-directory} is set (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}),
23104 then @value{GDBN} will look for @var{real-name} in all of the
23105 directories mentioned in the value of @code{debug-file-directory}.
23106
23107 Finally, if this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
23108 a file named @file{@var{data-directory}/python/auto-load/@var{real-name}}, where
23109 @var{data-directory} is @value{GDBN}'s data directory (available via
23110 @code{show data-directory}, @pxref{Data Files}), and @var{real-name}
23111 is the object file's real name, as described above.
23112
23113 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
23114 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
23115 @var{objfile} is opened.
23116 So your @file{-gdb.py} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
23117 is evaluated more than once.
23118
23119 @node .debug_gdb_scripts section
23120 @subsubsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23121 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23122
23123 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
23124 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
23125 it will look for a special section named @samp{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
23126 If this section exists, its contents is a list of names of scripts to load.
23127
23128 @value{GDBN} will look for each specified script file first in the
23129 current directory and then along the source search path
23130 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
23131 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
23132 directory is not relevant to scripts.
23133
23134 Entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
23135 for example, this GCC macro:
23136
23137 @example
23138 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
23139 #define DEFINE_GDB_SCRIPT(script_name) \
23140 asm("\
23141 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
23142 .byte 1\n\
23143 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
23144 .popsection \n\
23145 ");
23146 @end example
23147
23148 @noindent
23149 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
23150
23151 @example
23152 DEFINE_GDB_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
23153 @end example
23154
23155 The script name may include directories if desired.
23156
23157 If the macro is put in a header, any application or library
23158 using this header will get a reference to the specified script.
23159
23160 @node Which flavor to choose?
23161 @subsubsection Which flavor to choose?
23162
23163 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading Python scripts, it might not always
23164 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
23165
23166 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.py} way:
23167
23168 @itemize @bullet
23169 @item
23170 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
23171
23172 @item
23173 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
23174
23175 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
23176 in the source search path.
23177 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
23178 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
23179
23180 @item
23181 Doesn't require source code additions.
23182 @end itemize
23183
23184 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
23185
23186 @itemize @bullet
23187 @item
23188 Works with static linking.
23189
23190 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.py} way require an objfile to
23191 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
23192 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
23193 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's @file{-gdb.py} script.
23194
23195 @item
23196 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
23197
23198 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
23199 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.py} script to.
23200
23201 @item
23202 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
23203
23204 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
23205 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
23206 @file{-gdb.py} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
23207 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
23208 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
23209 top of the source tree to the source search path.
23210 @end itemize
23211
23212 @node Python modules
23213 @subsection Python modules
23214 @cindex python modules
23215
23216 @value{GDBN} comes with a module to assist writing Python code.
23217
23218 @menu
23219 * gdb.printing:: Building and registering pretty-printers.
23220 * gdb.types:: Utilities for working with types.
23221 @end menu
23222
23223 @node gdb.printing
23224 @subsubsection gdb.printing
23225 @cindex gdb.printing
23226
23227 This module provides a collection of utilities for working with
23228 pretty-printers.
23229
23230 @table @code
23231 @item PrettyPrinter (@var{name}, @var{subprinters}=None)
23232 This class specifies the API that makes @samp{info pretty-printer},
23233 @samp{enable pretty-printer} and @samp{disable pretty-printer} work.
23234 Pretty-printers should generally inherit from this class.
23235
23236 @item SubPrettyPrinter (@var{name})
23237 For printers that handle multiple types, this class specifies the
23238 corresponding API for the subprinters.
23239
23240 @item RegexpCollectionPrettyPrinter (@var{name})
23241 Utility class for handling multiple printers, all recognized via
23242 regular expressions.
23243 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for an example.
23244
23245 @item register_pretty_printer (@var{obj}, @var{printer})
23246 Register @var{printer} with the pretty-printer list of @var{obj}.
23247 @end table
23248
23249 @node gdb.types
23250 @subsubsection gdb.types
23251 @cindex gdb.types
23252
23253 This module provides a collection of utilities for working with
23254 @code{gdb.Types} objects.
23255
23256 @table @code
23257 @item get_basic_type (@var{type})
23258 Return @var{type} with const and volatile qualifiers stripped,
23259 and with typedefs and C@t{++} references converted to the underlying type.
23260
23261 C@t{++} example:
23262
23263 @smallexample
23264 typedef const int const_int;
23265 const_int foo (3);
23266 const_int& foo_ref (foo);
23267 int main () @{ return 0; @}
23268 @end smallexample
23269
23270 Then in gdb:
23271
23272 @smallexample
23273 (gdb) start
23274 (gdb) python import gdb.types
23275 (gdb) python foo_ref = gdb.parse_and_eval("foo_ref")
23276 (gdb) python print gdb.types.get_basic_type(foo_ref.type)
23277 int
23278 @end smallexample
23279
23280 @item has_field (@var{type}, @var{field})
23281 Return @code{True} if @var{type}, assumed to be a type with fields
23282 (e.g., a structure or union), has field @var{field}.
23283
23284 @item make_enum_dict (@var{enum_type})
23285 Return a Python @code{dictionary} type produced from @var{enum_type}.
23286 @end table
23287
23288 @node Interpreters
23289 @chapter Command Interpreters
23290 @cindex command interpreters
23291
23292 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
23293 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
23294 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
23295
23296 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
23297 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
23298 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
23299 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
23300
23301 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
23302 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
23303 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
23304 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
23305
23306 @table @code
23307 @item console
23308 @cindex console interpreter
23309 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
23310 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
23311 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
23312
23313 @item mi
23314 @cindex mi interpreter
23315 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
23316 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
23317 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
23318 Interface}.
23319
23320 @item mi2
23321 @cindex mi2 interpreter
23322 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
23323
23324 @item mi1
23325 @cindex mi1 interpreter
23326 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
23327
23328 @end table
23329
23330 @cindex invoke another interpreter
23331 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
23332 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
23333 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
23334 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
23335 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
23336 the IDE inoperable!
23337
23338 @kindex interpreter-exec
23339 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
23340 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
23341 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
23342 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
23343
23344 @smallexample
23345 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
23346 @end smallexample
23347
23348 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
23349 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
23350
23351 @node TUI
23352 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
23353 @cindex TUI
23354 @cindex Text User Interface
23355
23356 @menu
23357 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
23358 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
23359 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
23360 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
23361 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
23362 @end menu
23363
23364 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
23365 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
23366 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
23367 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
23368 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
23369 is available.
23370
23371 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
23372 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
23373 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
23374 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
23375 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
23376 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
23377
23378 @node TUI Overview
23379 @section TUI Overview
23380
23381 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
23382
23383 @table @emph
23384 @item command
23385 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
23386 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
23387 managed using readline.
23388
23389 @item source
23390 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
23391 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
23392
23393 @item assembly
23394 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
23395
23396 @item register
23397 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
23398 when their values change.
23399 @end table
23400
23401 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
23402 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
23403 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
23404 indicates the breakpoint type:
23405
23406 @table @code
23407 @item B
23408 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
23409
23410 @item b
23411 Breakpoint which was never hit.
23412
23413 @item H
23414 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
23415
23416 @item h
23417 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
23418 @end table
23419
23420 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
23421
23422 @table @code
23423 @item +
23424 Breakpoint is enabled.
23425
23426 @item -
23427 Breakpoint is disabled.
23428 @end table
23429
23430 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
23431 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
23432 changes.
23433
23434 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
23435 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
23436 layouts:
23437
23438 @itemize @bullet
23439 @item
23440 source only,
23441
23442 @item
23443 assembly only,
23444
23445 @item
23446 source and assembly,
23447
23448 @item
23449 source and registers, or
23450
23451 @item
23452 assembly and registers.
23453 @end itemize
23454
23455 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
23456
23457 @table @emph
23458 @item target
23459 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
23460 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
23461
23462 @item process
23463 Gives the current process or thread number.
23464 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
23465
23466 @item function
23467 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
23468 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
23469 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
23470 the string @code{??} is displayed.
23471
23472 @item line
23473 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
23474 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
23475
23476 @item pc
23477 Indicates the current program counter address.
23478 @end table
23479
23480 @node TUI Keys
23481 @section TUI Key Bindings
23482 @cindex TUI key bindings
23483
23484 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
23485 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
23486 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
23487
23488 @table @kbd
23489 @kindex C-x C-a
23490 @item C-x C-a
23491 @kindex C-x a
23492 @itemx C-x a
23493 @kindex C-x A
23494 @itemx C-x A
23495 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
23496 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
23497 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
23498 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
23499 The screen is then refreshed.
23500
23501 @kindex C-x 1
23502 @item C-x 1
23503 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
23504 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
23505 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
23506
23507 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
23508
23509 @kindex C-x 2
23510 @item C-x 2
23511 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
23512 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
23513 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
23514 previous layout and the new one.
23515
23516 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
23517
23518 @kindex C-x o
23519 @item C-x o
23520 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
23521 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
23522 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
23523
23524 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
23525
23526 @kindex C-x s
23527 @item C-x s
23528 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
23529 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
23530 @end table
23531
23532 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
23533
23534 @table @asis
23535 @kindex PgUp
23536 @item @key{PgUp}
23537 Scroll the active window one page up.
23538
23539 @kindex PgDn
23540 @item @key{PgDn}
23541 Scroll the active window one page down.
23542
23543 @kindex Up
23544 @item @key{Up}
23545 Scroll the active window one line up.
23546
23547 @kindex Down
23548 @item @key{Down}
23549 Scroll the active window one line down.
23550
23551 @kindex Left
23552 @item @key{Left}
23553 Scroll the active window one column left.
23554
23555 @kindex Right
23556 @item @key{Right}
23557 Scroll the active window one column right.
23558
23559 @kindex C-L
23560 @item @kbd{C-L}
23561 Refresh the screen.
23562 @end table
23563
23564 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
23565 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
23566 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
23567 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
23568 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
23569
23570 @node TUI Single Key Mode
23571 @section TUI Single Key Mode
23572 @cindex TUI single key mode
23573
23574 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
23575 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
23576 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
23577
23578 @table @kbd
23579 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23580 @item c
23581 continue
23582
23583 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23584 @item d
23585 down
23586
23587 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23588 @item f
23589 finish
23590
23591 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23592 @item n
23593 next
23594
23595 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23596 @item q
23597 exit the SingleKey mode.
23598
23599 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23600 @item r
23601 run
23602
23603 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23604 @item s
23605 step
23606
23607 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23608 @item u
23609 up
23610
23611 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23612 @item v
23613 info locals
23614
23615 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
23616 @item w
23617 where
23618 @end table
23619
23620 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
23621 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
23622 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
23623 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
23624 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
23625 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
23626
23627
23628 @node TUI Commands
23629 @section TUI-specific Commands
23630 @cindex TUI commands
23631
23632 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
23633 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
23634 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
23635 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
23636
23637 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
23638 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
23639 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
23640 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
23641 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
23642
23643 @table @code
23644 @item info win
23645 @kindex info win
23646 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
23647
23648 @item layout next
23649 @kindex layout
23650 Display the next layout.
23651
23652 @item layout prev
23653 Display the previous layout.
23654
23655 @item layout src
23656 Display the source window only.
23657
23658 @item layout asm
23659 Display the assembly window only.
23660
23661 @item layout split
23662 Display the source and assembly window.
23663
23664 @item layout regs
23665 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
23666
23667 @item focus next
23668 @kindex focus
23669 Make the next window active for scrolling.
23670
23671 @item focus prev
23672 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
23673
23674 @item focus src
23675 Make the source window active for scrolling.
23676
23677 @item focus asm
23678 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
23679
23680 @item focus regs
23681 Make the register window active for scrolling.
23682
23683 @item focus cmd
23684 Make the command window active for scrolling.
23685
23686 @item refresh
23687 @kindex refresh
23688 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
23689
23690 @item tui reg float
23691 @kindex tui reg
23692 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
23693
23694 @item tui reg general
23695 Show the general registers in the register window.
23696
23697 @item tui reg next
23698 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
23699 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
23700 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
23701 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
23702
23703 @item tui reg system
23704 Show the system registers in the register window.
23705
23706 @item update
23707 @kindex update
23708 Update the source window and the current execution point.
23709
23710 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
23711 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
23712 @kindex winheight
23713 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
23714 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
23715 decrease it.
23716
23717 @item tabset @var{nchars}
23718 @kindex tabset
23719 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
23720 @end table
23721
23722 @node TUI Configuration
23723 @section TUI Configuration Variables
23724 @cindex TUI configuration variables
23725
23726 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
23727
23728 @table @code
23729 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
23730 @kindex set tui border-kind
23731 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
23732 The possible values are the following:
23733 @table @code
23734 @item space
23735 Use a space character to draw the border.
23736
23737 @item ascii
23738 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
23739
23740 @item acs
23741 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
23742 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
23743 @end table
23744
23745 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
23746 @kindex set tui border-mode
23747 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
23748 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
23749 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
23750 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
23751 @table @code
23752 @item normal
23753 Use normal attributes to display the border.
23754
23755 @item standout
23756 Use standout mode.
23757
23758 @item reverse
23759 Use reverse video mode.
23760
23761 @item half
23762 Use half bright mode.
23763
23764 @item half-standout
23765 Use half bright and standout mode.
23766
23767 @item bold
23768 Use extra bright or bold mode.
23769
23770 @item bold-standout
23771 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
23772 @end table
23773 @end table
23774
23775 @node Emacs
23776 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
23777
23778 @cindex Emacs
23779 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
23780 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
23781 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
23782 @value{GDBN}.
23783
23784 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
23785 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
23786 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
23787 created Emacs buffer.
23788 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
23789
23790 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
23791 things:
23792
23793 @itemize @bullet
23794 @item
23795 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
23796 the GUD buffer.
23797
23798 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
23799 and output done by the program you are debugging.
23800
23801 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
23802 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
23803 in this way.
23804
23805 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
23806 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
23807 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
23808 stop.
23809
23810 @item
23811 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
23812
23813 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
23814 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
23815 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
23816 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
23817 and the source.
23818
23819 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
23820 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
23821 @end itemize
23822
23823 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
23824 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
23825 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
23826 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
23827
23828 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
23829 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
23830 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
23831 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
23832 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
23833 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
23834 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
23835 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
23836 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
23837
23838 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
23839 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
23840 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
23841 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23842
23843 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
23844 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
23845 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
23846 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
23847 one you want.
23848
23849 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
23850 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
23851
23852 @table @kbd
23853 @item C-h m
23854 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
23855
23856 @item C-c C-s
23857 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
23858 update the display window to show the current file and location.
23859
23860 @item C-c C-n
23861 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
23862 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
23863 to show the current file and location.
23864
23865 @item C-c C-i
23866 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
23867 display window accordingly.
23868
23869 @item C-c C-f
23870 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
23871 @code{finish} command.
23872
23873 @item C-c C-r
23874 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
23875 command.
23876
23877 @item C-c <
23878 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
23879 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
23880 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
23881
23882 @item C-c >
23883 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
23884 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
23885 @end table
23886
23887 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
23888 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
23889
23890 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
23891 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
23892 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
23893 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
23894 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
23895 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
23896 speedbar displays watch expressions.
23897
23898 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
23899 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
23900 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
23901 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
23902 frame.
23903
23904 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
23905 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
23906 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
23907 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
23908 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
23909 to correspond properly with the code.
23910
23911 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
23912 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
23913 Emacs Manual}).
23914
23915 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
23916 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
23917 @ignore
23918 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
23919 @kindex Epoch
23920 @kindex inspect
23921
23922 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
23923 called the @code{epoch}
23924 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
23925 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
23926 each value is printed in its own window.
23927 @end ignore
23928
23929
23930 @node GDB/MI
23931 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
23932
23933 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
23934
23935 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
23936 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
23937 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
23938 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
23939 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
23940 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
23941
23942 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
23943 in the form of a reference manual.
23944
23945 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
23946 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
23947 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
23948
23949 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
23950
23951 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
23952 This chapter uses the following notation:
23953
23954 @itemize @bullet
23955 @item
23956 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
23957
23958 @item
23959 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
23960 it may or may not be given.
23961
23962 @item
23963 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
23964 may repeat zero or more times.
23965
23966 @item
23967 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
23968 may repeat one or more times.
23969
23970 @item
23971 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
23972 @end itemize
23973
23974 @ignore
23975 @heading Dependencies
23976 @end ignore
23977
23978 @menu
23979 * GDB/MI General Design::
23980 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
23981 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
23982 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
23983 * GDB/MI Output Records::
23984 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
23985 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
23986 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
23987 * GDB/MI Program Context::
23988 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
23989 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
23990 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
23991 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
23992 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
23993 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
23994 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
23995 * GDB/MI File Commands::
23996 @ignore
23997 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
23998 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
23999 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
24000 @end ignore
24001 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
24002 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
24003 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
24004 @end menu
24005
24006 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24007 @node GDB/MI General Design
24008 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
24009 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
24010
24011 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
24012 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
24013 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
24014 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
24015 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
24016 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
24017 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
24018 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
24019 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
24020 a command and reported as part of that command response.
24021
24022 The important examples of notifications are:
24023 @itemize @bullet
24024
24025 @item
24026 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
24027 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
24028 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
24029 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
24030 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
24031 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
24032 command itself was successfully executed.
24033
24034 @item
24035 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
24036 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
24037 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
24038 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
24039 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
24040 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
24041
24042 @item
24043 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
24044 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
24045 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
24046 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
24047 orthogonal frontend design.
24048
24049 @end itemize
24050
24051 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
24052 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
24053 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
24054 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
24055 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
24056 the user interface.
24057
24058
24059 @menu
24060 * Context management::
24061 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
24062 * Thread groups::
24063 @end menu
24064
24065 @node Context management
24066 @subsection Context management
24067
24068 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
24069 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
24070 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
24071 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
24072 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
24073 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
24074 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
24075 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
24076 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
24077
24078 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
24079 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
24080 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
24081 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
24082 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
24083 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
24084 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
24085 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
24086 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
24087 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
24088 for thread and frame to operate on.
24089
24090 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
24091 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
24092 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
24093 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
24094 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
24095 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
24096 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
24097 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
24098 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
24099 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
24100
24101 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
24102 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
24103 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
24104 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
24105 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
24106 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
24107 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
24108 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
24109 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
24110 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
24111 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
24112 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
24113 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
24114 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
24115 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
24116 @samp{--frame} options.
24117
24118 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
24119 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
24120
24121 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
24122 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
24123 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
24124 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
24125 @code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
24126 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
24127 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
24128 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
24129 @code{-list-target-features} command.
24130
24131 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
24132 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
24133 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
24134 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
24135 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
24136 are running.
24137
24138 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
24139 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
24140 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
24141 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
24142 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
24143 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
24144 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
24145 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
24146 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
24147 @samp{--thread} option).
24148
24149 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
24150 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
24151 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
24152 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
24153
24154 @node Thread groups
24155 @subsection Thread groups
24156 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
24157 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
24158 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
24159 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
24160 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
24161
24162 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
24163 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
24164 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
24165 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
24166 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
24167 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
24168 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
24169 into processes.
24170
24171 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
24172 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
24173 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
24174 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
24175 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
24176 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
24177 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
24178 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
24179 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
24180 the members of specific thread group.
24181
24182 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
24183 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
24184 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
24185 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
24186 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
24187 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
24188 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
24189 after attaching to that thread group.
24190
24191 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
24192 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
24193 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
24194 such thread groups.
24195
24196 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24197 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
24198 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
24199
24200 @menu
24201 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
24202 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
24203 @end menu
24204
24205 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
24206 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
24207
24208 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
24209 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
24210 @table @code
24211 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
24212 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
24213
24214 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
24215 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
24216 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
24217
24218 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
24219 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
24220 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
24221
24222 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
24223 "any sequence of digits"
24224
24225 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
24226 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
24227
24228 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
24229 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
24230
24231 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
24232 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
24233
24234 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
24235 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
24236 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
24237
24238 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
24239 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
24240
24241 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
24242 @code{CR | CR-LF}
24243 @end table
24244
24245 @noindent
24246 Notes:
24247
24248 @itemize @bullet
24249 @item
24250 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
24251 output is described below.
24252
24253 @item
24254 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
24255 finishes.
24256
24257 @item
24258 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
24259 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
24260 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
24261 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
24262 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
24263 @end itemize
24264
24265 Pragmatics:
24266
24267 @itemize @bullet
24268 @item
24269 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
24270
24271 @item
24272 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
24273 @end itemize
24274
24275 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
24276 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
24277
24278 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
24279 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
24280 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
24281 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
24282 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
24283 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
24284
24285 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
24286 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
24287 @var{token}.
24288
24289 @table @code
24290 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
24291 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
24292
24293 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
24294 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
24295
24296 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
24297 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
24298
24299 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
24300 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
24301
24302 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
24303 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
24304
24305 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
24306 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
24307
24308 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
24309 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
24310
24311 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
24312 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
24313
24314 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
24315 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
24316
24317 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
24318 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
24319 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
24320
24321 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
24322 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
24323
24324 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
24325 @code{ @var{string} }
24326
24327 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
24328 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
24329
24330 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
24331 @code{@var{c-string}}
24332
24333 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
24334 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
24335
24336 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
24337 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
24338 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
24339
24340 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
24341 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
24342
24343 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
24344 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
24345
24346 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
24347 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
24348
24349 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
24350 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
24351
24352 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
24353 @code{CR | CR-LF}
24354
24355 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
24356 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
24357 @end table
24358
24359 @noindent
24360 Notes:
24361
24362 @itemize @bullet
24363 @item
24364 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
24365
24366 @item
24367 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
24368 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
24369 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
24370 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
24371 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
24372 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
24373 prior command.
24374
24375 @item
24376 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24377 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
24378 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
24379 prefixed by @samp{+}.
24380
24381 @item
24382 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24383 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
24384 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
24385 @samp{*}.
24386
24387 @item
24388 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24389 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
24390 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
24391 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
24392
24393 @item
24394 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24395 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
24396 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
24397 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
24398
24399 @item
24400 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24401 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
24402 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
24403
24404 @item
24405 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24406 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
24407 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
24408 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
24409
24410 @item
24411 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
24412 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
24413 @var{values}.
24414
24415
24416 @end itemize
24417
24418 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
24419 details about the various output records.
24420
24421 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24422 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
24423 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
24424
24425 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
24426 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
24427
24428 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
24429 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
24430 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
24431 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
24432 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
24433 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
24434
24435 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
24436 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
24437 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
24438
24439 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24440 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
24441 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
24442 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
24443
24444 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
24445 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
24446
24447 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
24448 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
24449 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
24450 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
24451 might change.
24452
24453 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
24454 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
24455 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
24456 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
24457
24458 @itemize @bullet
24459 @item
24460 New MI commands may be added.
24461
24462 @item
24463 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
24464
24465 @item
24466 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
24467 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
24468
24469 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
24470 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
24471
24472 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
24473 @c resolve inconsistencies.
24474 @end itemize
24475
24476 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
24477 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
24478 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
24479 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
24480 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
24481
24482 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
24483 @c version?
24484
24485 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
24486 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
24487 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
24488 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
24489 @cindex mailing lists
24490
24491 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24492 @node GDB/MI Output Records
24493 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
24494
24495 @menu
24496 * GDB/MI Result Records::
24497 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
24498 * GDB/MI Async Records::
24499 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
24500 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
24501 @end menu
24502
24503 @node GDB/MI Result Records
24504 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
24505
24506 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
24507 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
24508 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
24509 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
24510
24511 @table @code
24512 @findex ^done
24513 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
24514 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
24515 values.
24516
24517 @item "^running"
24518 @findex ^running
24519 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
24520 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
24521 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
24522 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
24523 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
24524 which threads are resumed.
24525
24526 @item "^connected"
24527 @findex ^connected
24528 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
24529
24530 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
24531 @findex ^error
24532 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
24533 error message.
24534
24535 @item "^exit"
24536 @findex ^exit
24537 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
24538
24539 @end table
24540
24541 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
24542 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
24543
24544 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
24545 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
24546 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
24547 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
24548 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
24549
24550 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
24551 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
24552 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
24553 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
24554 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
24555
24556 @table @code
24557 @item "~" @var{string-output}
24558 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
24559 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
24560
24561 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
24562 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
24563 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
24564 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
24565
24566 @item "&" @var{string-output}
24567 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
24568 internals.
24569 @end table
24570
24571 @node GDB/MI Async Records
24572 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
24573
24574 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
24575 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
24576 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
24577 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
24578 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
24579 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
24580
24581 The following is the list of possible async records:
24582
24583 @table @code
24584
24585 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
24586 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
24587 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
24588 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
24589 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
24590 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
24591 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
24592 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
24593 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
24594 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
24595
24596 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
24597 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
24598 following values:
24599
24600 @table @code
24601 @item breakpoint-hit
24602 A breakpoint was reached.
24603 @item watchpoint-trigger
24604 A watchpoint was triggered.
24605 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
24606 A read watchpoint was triggered.
24607 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
24608 An access watchpoint was triggered.
24609 @item function-finished
24610 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
24611 @item location-reached
24612 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
24613 @item watchpoint-scope
24614 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
24615 @item end-stepping-range
24616 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
24617 similar CLI command was accomplished.
24618 @item exited-signalled
24619 The inferior exited because of a signal.
24620 @item exited
24621 The inferior exited.
24622 @item exited-normally
24623 The inferior exited normally.
24624 @item signal-received
24625 A signal was received by the inferior.
24626 @end table
24627
24628 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
24629 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
24630 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
24631 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
24632 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
24633 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
24634 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
24635 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
24636 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
24637 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
24638 if such information is not available.
24639
24640 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
24641 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
24642 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
24643 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
24644 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
24645 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
24646 cannot be used in any way.
24647
24648 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
24649 A thread group became associated with a running program,
24650 either because the program was just started or the thread group
24651 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
24652 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
24653 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
24654
24655 @itemx =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"
24656 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
24657 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
24658 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
24659 thread group.
24660
24661 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
24662 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
24663 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
24664 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
24665 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
24666
24667 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
24668 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
24669 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
24670 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
24671 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
24672 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
24673 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
24674
24675 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
24676 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
24677 that thread.
24678
24679 @item =library-loaded,...
24680 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
24681 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
24682 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
24683 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
24684 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
24685 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
24686 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
24687 @var{symbols-loaded} field reports if the debug symbols for this
24688 library are loaded. The @var{thread-group} field, if present,
24689 specifies the id of the thread group in whose context the library was loaded.
24690 If the field is absent, it means the library was loaded in the context
24691 of all present thread groups.
24692
24693 @item =library-unloaded,...
24694 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
24695 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
24696 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
24697 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
24698 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
24699 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
24700 thread groups.
24701
24702 @end table
24703
24704 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
24705 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
24706
24707 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
24708 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
24709 fields:
24710
24711 @table @code
24712 @item level
24713 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
24714 zero. This field is always present.
24715
24716 @item func
24717 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
24718 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
24719
24720 @item addr
24721 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
24722
24723 @item file
24724 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
24725 address. This field may be absent.
24726
24727 @item line
24728 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
24729 may be absent.
24730
24731 @item from
24732 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
24733 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
24734
24735 @end table
24736
24737 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
24738 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
24739
24740 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
24741 uses a tuple with the following fields:
24742
24743 @table @code
24744 @item id
24745 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
24746 always present.
24747
24748 @item target-id
24749 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
24750
24751 @item details
24752 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
24753 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
24754 frontend. This field is optional.
24755
24756 @item state
24757 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
24758 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
24759
24760 @item core
24761 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
24762 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
24763 @end table
24764
24765
24766 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24767 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
24768 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
24769 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
24770
24771 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
24772 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
24773 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
24774 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
24775
24776 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
24777 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
24778
24779 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
24780
24781 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
24782 information of the breakpoint.
24783
24784 @smallexample
24785 -> -break-insert main
24786 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
24787 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
24788 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
24789 <- (gdb)
24790 @end smallexample
24791
24792 @subheading Program Execution
24793
24794 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
24795 reason that execution stopped.
24796
24797 @smallexample
24798 -> -exec-run
24799 <- ^running
24800 <- (gdb)
24801 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
24802 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
24803 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
24804 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
24805 <- (gdb)
24806 -> -exec-continue
24807 <- ^running
24808 <- (gdb)
24809 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
24810 <- (gdb)
24811 @end smallexample
24812
24813 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
24814
24815 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
24816
24817 @smallexample
24818 -> (gdb)
24819 <- -gdb-exit
24820 <- ^exit
24821 @end smallexample
24822
24823 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
24824 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
24825 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
24826 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
24827 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
24828 fails to exit in reasonable time.
24829
24830 @subheading A Bad Command
24831
24832 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
24833
24834 @smallexample
24835 -> -rubbish
24836 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
24837 <- (gdb)
24838 @end smallexample
24839
24840
24841 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24842 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
24843 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
24844
24845 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
24846 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
24847
24848 @subheading Motivation
24849
24850 The motivation for this collection of commands.
24851
24852 @subheading Introduction
24853
24854 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
24855
24856 @subheading Commands
24857
24858 For each command in the block, the following is described:
24859
24860 @subsubheading Synopsis
24861
24862 @smallexample
24863 -command @var{args}@dots{}
24864 @end smallexample
24865
24866 @subsubheading Result
24867
24868 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24869
24870 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
24871
24872 @subsubheading Example
24873
24874 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
24875 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
24876
24877
24878 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24879 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
24880 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
24881
24882 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
24883 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
24884 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
24885 breakpoints.
24886
24887 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
24888 @findex -break-after
24889
24890 @subsubheading Synopsis
24891
24892 @smallexample
24893 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
24894 @end smallexample
24895
24896 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
24897 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
24898 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
24899 @samp{-break-list} command below.
24900
24901 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24902
24903 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
24904
24905 @subsubheading Example
24906
24907 @smallexample
24908 (gdb)
24909 -break-insert main
24910 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
24911 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
24912 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
24913 (gdb)
24914 -break-after 1 3
24915 ~
24916 ^done
24917 (gdb)
24918 -break-list
24919 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
24920 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
24921 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
24922 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
24923 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
24924 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
24925 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
24926 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
24927 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
24928 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
24929 (gdb)
24930 @end smallexample
24931
24932 @ignore
24933 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
24934 @findex -break-catch
24935 @end ignore
24936
24937 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
24938 @findex -break-commands
24939
24940 @subsubheading Synopsis
24941
24942 @smallexample
24943 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
24944 @end smallexample
24945
24946 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
24947 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
24948 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
24949 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
24950 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
24951 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
24952
24953 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24954
24955 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
24956
24957 @subsubheading Example
24958
24959 @smallexample
24960 (gdb)
24961 -break-insert main
24962 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
24963 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
24964 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
24965 (gdb)
24966 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
24967 ^done
24968 (gdb)
24969 @end smallexample
24970
24971 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
24972 @findex -break-condition
24973
24974 @subsubheading Synopsis
24975
24976 @smallexample
24977 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
24978 @end smallexample
24979
24980 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
24981 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
24982 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
24983 command below).
24984
24985 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
24986
24987 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
24988
24989 @subsubheading Example
24990
24991 @smallexample
24992 (gdb)
24993 -break-condition 1 1
24994 ^done
24995 (gdb)
24996 -break-list
24997 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
24998 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
24999 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25000 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25001 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25002 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25003 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25004 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25005 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25006 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
25007 (gdb)
25008 @end smallexample
25009
25010 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
25011 @findex -break-delete
25012
25013 @subsubheading Synopsis
25014
25015 @smallexample
25016 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25017 @end smallexample
25018
25019 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
25020 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
25021
25022 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25023
25024 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
25025
25026 @subsubheading Example
25027
25028 @smallexample
25029 (gdb)
25030 -break-delete 1
25031 ^done
25032 (gdb)
25033 -break-list
25034 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
25035 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25036 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25037 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25038 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25039 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25040 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25041 body=[]@}
25042 (gdb)
25043 @end smallexample
25044
25045 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
25046 @findex -break-disable
25047
25048 @subsubheading Synopsis
25049
25050 @smallexample
25051 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25052 @end smallexample
25053
25054 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
25055 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
25056
25057 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25058
25059 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
25060
25061 @subsubheading Example
25062
25063 @smallexample
25064 (gdb)
25065 -break-disable 2
25066 ^done
25067 (gdb)
25068 -break-list
25069 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25070 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25071 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25072 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25073 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25074 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25075 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25076 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
25077 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25078 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
25079 (gdb)
25080 @end smallexample
25081
25082 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
25083 @findex -break-enable
25084
25085 @subsubheading Synopsis
25086
25087 @smallexample
25088 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25089 @end smallexample
25090
25091 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
25092
25093 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25094
25095 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
25096
25097 @subsubheading Example
25098
25099 @smallexample
25100 (gdb)
25101 -break-enable 2
25102 ^done
25103 (gdb)
25104 -break-list
25105 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25106 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25107 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25108 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25109 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25110 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25111 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25112 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25113 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25114 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
25115 (gdb)
25116 @end smallexample
25117
25118 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
25119 @findex -break-info
25120
25121 @subsubheading Synopsis
25122
25123 @smallexample
25124 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
25125 @end smallexample
25126
25127 @c REDUNDANT???
25128 Get information about a single breakpoint.
25129
25130 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25131
25132 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
25133
25134 @subsubheading Example
25135 N.A.
25136
25137 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
25138 @findex -break-insert
25139
25140 @subsubheading Synopsis
25141
25142 @smallexample
25143 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
25144 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
25145 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
25146 @end smallexample
25147
25148 @noindent
25149 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
25150
25151 @itemize @bullet
25152 @item function
25153 @c @item +offset
25154 @c @item -offset
25155 @c @item linenum
25156 @item filename:linenum
25157 @item filename:function
25158 @item *address
25159 @end itemize
25160
25161 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
25162
25163 @table @samp
25164 @item -t
25165 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
25166 @item -h
25167 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
25168 @item -c @var{condition}
25169 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
25170 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
25171 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
25172 @item -f
25173 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
25174 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
25175 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
25176 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
25177 cannot be parsed.
25178 @item -d
25179 Create a disabled breakpoint.
25180 @item -a
25181 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
25182 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
25183 @end table
25184
25185 @subsubheading Result
25186
25187 The result is in the form:
25188
25189 @smallexample
25190 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
25191 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
25192 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
25193 times="@var{times}"@}
25194 @end smallexample
25195
25196 @noindent
25197 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
25198 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
25199 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
25200 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
25201 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
25202 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
25203 which use the same output).
25204
25205 Note: this format is open to change.
25206 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
25207
25208 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25209
25210 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
25211 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
25212
25213 @subsubheading Example
25214
25215 @smallexample
25216 (gdb)
25217 -break-insert main
25218 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
25219 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
25220 (gdb)
25221 -break-insert -t foo
25222 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
25223 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
25224 (gdb)
25225 -break-list
25226 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
25227 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25228 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25229 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25230 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25231 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25232 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25233 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25234 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
25235 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
25236 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
25237 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
25238 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
25239 (gdb)
25240 -break-insert -r foo.*
25241 ~int foo(int, int);
25242 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
25243 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
25244 (gdb)
25245 @end smallexample
25246
25247 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
25248 @findex -break-list
25249
25250 @subsubheading Synopsis
25251
25252 @smallexample
25253 -break-list
25254 @end smallexample
25255
25256 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
25257
25258 @table @samp
25259 @item Number
25260 number of the breakpoint
25261 @item Type
25262 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
25263 @item Disposition
25264 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
25265 or @samp{nokeep}
25266 @item Enabled
25267 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
25268 @item Address
25269 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
25270 @item What
25271 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
25272 name, line number
25273 @item Times
25274 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
25275 @end table
25276
25277 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
25278 @code{body} field is an empty list.
25279
25280 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25281
25282 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
25283
25284 @subsubheading Example
25285
25286 @smallexample
25287 (gdb)
25288 -break-list
25289 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
25290 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25291 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25292 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25293 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25294 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25295 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25296 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25297 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
25298 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25299 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25300 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
25301 (gdb)
25302 @end smallexample
25303
25304 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
25305
25306 @smallexample
25307 (gdb)
25308 -break-list
25309 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
25310 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25311 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25312 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25313 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25314 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25315 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25316 body=[]@}
25317 (gdb)
25318 @end smallexample
25319
25320 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
25321 @findex -break-passcount
25322
25323 @subsubheading Synopsis
25324
25325 @smallexample
25326 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
25327 @end smallexample
25328
25329 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
25330 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
25331 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
25332 command @samp{passcount}.
25333
25334 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
25335 @findex -break-watch
25336
25337 @subsubheading Synopsis
25338
25339 @smallexample
25340 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
25341 @end smallexample
25342
25343 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
25344 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
25345 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
25346 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
25347 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
25348 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
25349 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
25350 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
25351
25352 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
25353 breakpoints inserted.
25354
25355 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25356
25357 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
25358 @samp{rwatch}.
25359
25360 @subsubheading Example
25361
25362 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
25363
25364 @smallexample
25365 (gdb)
25366 -break-watch x
25367 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
25368 (gdb)
25369 -exec-continue
25370 ^running
25371 (gdb)
25372 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
25373 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
25374 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
25375 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
25376 (gdb)
25377 @end smallexample
25378
25379 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
25380 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
25381 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
25382
25383 @smallexample
25384 (gdb)
25385 -break-watch C
25386 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
25387 (gdb)
25388 -exec-continue
25389 ^running
25390 (gdb)
25391 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
25392 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
25393 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
25394 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25395 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
25396 (gdb)
25397 -exec-continue
25398 ^running
25399 (gdb)
25400 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
25401 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
25402 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
25403 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25404 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
25405 (gdb)
25406 @end smallexample
25407
25408 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
25409 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
25410 deleted.
25411
25412 @smallexample
25413 (gdb)
25414 -break-watch C
25415 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
25416 (gdb)
25417 -break-list
25418 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
25419 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25420 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25421 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25422 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25423 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25424 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25425 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25426 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
25427 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25428 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
25429 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
25430 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
25431 (gdb)
25432 -exec-continue
25433 ^running
25434 (gdb)
25435 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
25436 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
25437 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
25438 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25439 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
25440 (gdb)
25441 -break-list
25442 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
25443 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25444 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25445 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25446 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25447 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25448 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25449 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25450 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
25451 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25452 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
25453 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
25454 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
25455 (gdb)
25456 -exec-continue
25457 ^running
25458 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
25459 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
25460 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
25461 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25462 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
25463 (gdb)
25464 -break-list
25465 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25466 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25467 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25468 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25469 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25470 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25471 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25472 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25473 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
25474 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
25475 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
25476 times="1"@}]@}
25477 (gdb)
25478 @end smallexample
25479
25480 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25481 @node GDB/MI Program Context
25482 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
25483
25484 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
25485 @findex -exec-arguments
25486
25487
25488 @subsubheading Synopsis
25489
25490 @smallexample
25491 -exec-arguments @var{args}
25492 @end smallexample
25493
25494 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
25495 @samp{-exec-run}.
25496
25497 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25498
25499 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
25500
25501 @subsubheading Example
25502
25503 @smallexample
25504 (gdb)
25505 -exec-arguments -v word
25506 ^done
25507 (gdb)
25508 @end smallexample
25509
25510
25511 @ignore
25512 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
25513 @findex -exec-show-arguments
25514
25515 @subsubheading Synopsis
25516
25517 @smallexample
25518 -exec-show-arguments
25519 @end smallexample
25520
25521 Print the arguments of the program.
25522
25523 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25524
25525 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
25526
25527 @subsubheading Example
25528 N.A.
25529 @end ignore
25530
25531
25532 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
25533 @findex -environment-cd
25534
25535 @subsubheading Synopsis
25536
25537 @smallexample
25538 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
25539 @end smallexample
25540
25541 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
25542
25543 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25544
25545 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
25546
25547 @subsubheading Example
25548
25549 @smallexample
25550 (gdb)
25551 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
25552 ^done
25553 (gdb)
25554 @end smallexample
25555
25556
25557 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
25558 @findex -environment-directory
25559
25560 @subsubheading Synopsis
25561
25562 @smallexample
25563 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
25564 @end smallexample
25565
25566 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
25567 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
25568 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
25569 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
25570 occurs as normal.
25571 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
25572 multiple directories in a single command
25573 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
25574 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
25575 If blanks are needed as
25576 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
25577 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
25578 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
25579 character must not be used
25580 in any directory name.
25581 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
25582
25583 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25584
25585 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
25586
25587 @subsubheading Example
25588
25589 @smallexample
25590 (gdb)
25591 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
25592 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
25593 (gdb)
25594 -environment-directory ""
25595 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
25596 (gdb)
25597 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
25598 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
25599 (gdb)
25600 -environment-directory -r
25601 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
25602 (gdb)
25603 @end smallexample
25604
25605
25606 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
25607 @findex -environment-path
25608
25609 @subsubheading Synopsis
25610
25611 @smallexample
25612 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
25613 @end smallexample
25614
25615 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
25616 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
25617 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
25618 supplied in addition to the
25619 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
25620 occurs as normal.
25621 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
25622 multiple directories in a single command
25623 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
25624 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
25625 If blanks are needed as
25626 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
25627 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
25628 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
25629 character must not be used
25630 in any directory name.
25631 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
25632
25633
25634 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25635
25636 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
25637
25638 @subsubheading Example
25639
25640 @smallexample
25641 (gdb)
25642 -environment-path
25643 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
25644 (gdb)
25645 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
25646 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
25647 (gdb)
25648 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
25649 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
25650 (gdb)
25651 @end smallexample
25652
25653
25654 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
25655 @findex -environment-pwd
25656
25657 @subsubheading Synopsis
25658
25659 @smallexample
25660 -environment-pwd
25661 @end smallexample
25662
25663 Show the current working directory.
25664
25665 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25666
25667 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
25668
25669 @subsubheading Example
25670
25671 @smallexample
25672 (gdb)
25673 -environment-pwd
25674 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
25675 (gdb)
25676 @end smallexample
25677
25678 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25679 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
25680 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
25681
25682
25683 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
25684 @findex -thread-info
25685
25686 @subsubheading Synopsis
25687
25688 @smallexample
25689 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
25690 @end smallexample
25691
25692 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
25693 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
25694 threads. When printing information about all threads,
25695 also reports the current thread.
25696
25697 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25698
25699 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
25700 about all threads.
25701
25702 @subsubheading Example
25703
25704 @smallexample
25705 -thread-info
25706 ^done,threads=[
25707 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
25708 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
25709 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
25710 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
25711 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}],
25712 current-thread-id="1"
25713 (gdb)
25714 @end smallexample
25715
25716 The @samp{state} field may have the following values:
25717
25718 @table @code
25719 @item stopped
25720 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
25721 threads.
25722
25723 @item running
25724 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
25725 threads.
25726
25727 @end table
25728
25729 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
25730 @findex -thread-list-ids
25731
25732 @subsubheading Synopsis
25733
25734 @smallexample
25735 -thread-list-ids
25736 @end smallexample
25737
25738 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
25739 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
25740
25741 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
25742 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
25743
25744 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25745
25746 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
25747
25748 @subsubheading Example
25749
25750 @smallexample
25751 (gdb)
25752 -thread-list-ids
25753 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
25754 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
25755 (gdb)
25756 @end smallexample
25757
25758
25759 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
25760 @findex -thread-select
25761
25762 @subsubheading Synopsis
25763
25764 @smallexample
25765 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
25766 @end smallexample
25767
25768 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
25769 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
25770
25771 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
25772 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
25773
25774 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25775
25776 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
25777
25778 @subsubheading Example
25779
25780 @smallexample
25781 (gdb)
25782 -exec-next
25783 ^running
25784 (gdb)
25785 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
25786 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
25787 (gdb)
25788 -thread-list-ids
25789 ^done,
25790 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
25791 number-of-threads="3"
25792 (gdb)
25793 -thread-select 3
25794 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
25795 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
25796 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
25797 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
25798 (gdb)
25799 @end smallexample
25800
25801 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25802 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
25803 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
25804
25805 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
25806 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
25807 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
25808 other cases.
25809
25810 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
25811 @findex -exec-continue
25812
25813 @subsubheading Synopsis
25814
25815 @smallexample
25816 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
25817 @end smallexample
25818
25819 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
25820 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
25821 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
25822 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
25823 @itemize @bullet
25824 @item
25825 breakpoints or watchpoints
25826 @item
25827 signals or exceptions
25828 @item
25829 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
25830 @item
25831 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
25832 @end itemize
25833 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
25834 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
25835 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
25836 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
25837 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
25838 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
25839
25840 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25841
25842 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
25843
25844 @subsubheading Example
25845
25846 @smallexample
25847 -exec-continue
25848 ^running
25849 (gdb)
25850 @@Hello world
25851 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
25852 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
25853 line="13"@}
25854 (gdb)
25855 @end smallexample
25856
25857
25858 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
25859 @findex -exec-finish
25860
25861 @subsubheading Synopsis
25862
25863 @smallexample
25864 -exec-finish [--reverse]
25865 @end smallexample
25866
25867 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
25868 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
25869 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
25870 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
25871 function was called.
25872
25873 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25874
25875 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
25876
25877 @subsubheading Example
25878
25879 Function returning @code{void}.
25880
25881 @smallexample
25882 -exec-finish
25883 ^running
25884 (gdb)
25885 @@hello from foo
25886 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
25887 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
25888 (gdb)
25889 @end smallexample
25890
25891 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
25892 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
25893 value itself.
25894
25895 @smallexample
25896 -exec-finish
25897 ^running
25898 (gdb)
25899 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
25900 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
25901 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
25902 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
25903 (gdb)
25904 @end smallexample
25905
25906
25907 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
25908 @findex -exec-interrupt
25909
25910 @subsubheading Synopsis
25911
25912 @smallexample
25913 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
25914 @end smallexample
25915
25916 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
25917 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
25918 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
25919 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
25920 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
25921
25922 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
25923 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
25924 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
25925 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
25926
25927 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
25928 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
25929 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
25930 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
25931
25932 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25933
25934 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
25935
25936 @subsubheading Example
25937
25938 @smallexample
25939 (gdb)
25940 111-exec-continue
25941 111^running
25942
25943 (gdb)
25944 222-exec-interrupt
25945 222^done
25946 (gdb)
25947 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
25948 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
25949 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
25950 (gdb)
25951
25952 (gdb)
25953 -exec-interrupt
25954 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
25955 (gdb)
25956 @end smallexample
25957
25958 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
25959 @findex -exec-jump
25960
25961 @subsubheading Synopsis
25962
25963 @smallexample
25964 -exec-jump @var{location}
25965 @end smallexample
25966
25967 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
25968 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
25969 different forms of @var{location}.
25970
25971 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25972
25973 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
25974
25975 @subsubheading Example
25976
25977 @smallexample
25978 -exec-jump foo.c:10
25979 *running,thread-id="all"
25980 ^running
25981 @end smallexample
25982
25983
25984 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
25985 @findex -exec-next
25986
25987 @subsubheading Synopsis
25988
25989 @smallexample
25990 -exec-next [--reverse]
25991 @end smallexample
25992
25993 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
25994 of the next source line is reached.
25995
25996 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
25997 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
25998 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
25999 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
26000 source line where the function was called.
26001
26002
26003 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26004
26005 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
26006
26007 @subsubheading Example
26008
26009 @smallexample
26010 -exec-next
26011 ^running
26012 (gdb)
26013 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
26014 (gdb)
26015 @end smallexample
26016
26017
26018 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
26019 @findex -exec-next-instruction
26020
26021 @subsubheading Synopsis
26022
26023 @smallexample
26024 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
26025 @end smallexample
26026
26027 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
26028 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
26029 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
26030 printed as well.
26031
26032 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
26033 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
26034 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
26035 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
26036 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
26037
26038 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26039
26040 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
26041
26042 @subsubheading Example
26043
26044 @smallexample
26045 (gdb)
26046 -exec-next-instruction
26047 ^running
26048
26049 (gdb)
26050 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
26051 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
26052 (gdb)
26053 @end smallexample
26054
26055
26056 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
26057 @findex -exec-return
26058
26059 @subsubheading Synopsis
26060
26061 @smallexample
26062 -exec-return
26063 @end smallexample
26064
26065 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
26066 Displays the new current frame.
26067
26068 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26069
26070 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
26071
26072 @subsubheading Example
26073
26074 @smallexample
26075 (gdb)
26076 200-break-insert callee4
26077 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
26078 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
26079 (gdb)
26080 000-exec-run
26081 000^running
26082 (gdb)
26083 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
26084 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26085 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26086 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
26087 (gdb)
26088 205-break-delete
26089 205^done
26090 (gdb)
26091 111-exec-return
26092 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
26093 args=[@{name="strarg",
26094 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26095 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26096 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26097 (gdb)
26098 @end smallexample
26099
26100
26101 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
26102 @findex -exec-run
26103
26104 @subsubheading Synopsis
26105
26106 @smallexample
26107 -exec-run [--all | --thread-group N]
26108 @end smallexample
26109
26110 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
26111 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
26112 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
26113 the program has exited exceptionally.
26114
26115 When no option is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
26116 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
26117 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
26118 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
26119
26120 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26121
26122 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
26123
26124 @subsubheading Examples
26125
26126 @smallexample
26127 (gdb)
26128 -break-insert main
26129 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
26130 (gdb)
26131 -exec-run
26132 ^running
26133 (gdb)
26134 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
26135 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
26136 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
26137 (gdb)
26138 @end smallexample
26139
26140 @noindent
26141 Program exited normally:
26142
26143 @smallexample
26144 (gdb)
26145 -exec-run
26146 ^running
26147 (gdb)
26148 x = 55
26149 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26150 (gdb)
26151 @end smallexample
26152
26153 @noindent
26154 Program exited exceptionally:
26155
26156 @smallexample
26157 (gdb)
26158 -exec-run
26159 ^running
26160 (gdb)
26161 x = 55
26162 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
26163 (gdb)
26164 @end smallexample
26165
26166 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
26167 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
26168
26169 @smallexample
26170 (gdb)
26171 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
26172 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
26173 @end smallexample
26174
26175
26176 @c @subheading -exec-signal
26177
26178
26179 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
26180 @findex -exec-step
26181
26182 @subsubheading Synopsis
26183
26184 @smallexample
26185 -exec-step [--reverse]
26186 @end smallexample
26187
26188 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
26189 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
26190 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
26191 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
26192 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
26193 previously executed source line.
26194
26195 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26196
26197 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
26198
26199 @subsubheading Example
26200
26201 Stepping into a function:
26202
26203 @smallexample
26204 -exec-step
26205 ^running
26206 (gdb)
26207 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
26208 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
26209 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
26210 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
26211 (gdb)
26212 @end smallexample
26213
26214 Regular stepping:
26215
26216 @smallexample
26217 -exec-step
26218 ^running
26219 (gdb)
26220 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
26221 (gdb)
26222 @end smallexample
26223
26224
26225 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
26226 @findex -exec-step-instruction
26227
26228 @subsubheading Synopsis
26229
26230 @smallexample
26231 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
26232 @end smallexample
26233
26234 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
26235 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
26236 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
26237 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
26238 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
26239 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
26240 as well.
26241
26242 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26243
26244 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
26245
26246 @subsubheading Example
26247
26248 @smallexample
26249 (gdb)
26250 -exec-step-instruction
26251 ^running
26252
26253 (gdb)
26254 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
26255 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
26256 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
26257 (gdb)
26258 -exec-step-instruction
26259 ^running
26260
26261 (gdb)
26262 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
26263 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
26264 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
26265 (gdb)
26266 @end smallexample
26267
26268
26269 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
26270 @findex -exec-until
26271
26272 @subsubheading Synopsis
26273
26274 @smallexample
26275 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
26276 @end smallexample
26277
26278 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
26279 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
26280 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
26281 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
26282
26283 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26284
26285 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
26286
26287 @subsubheading Example
26288
26289 @smallexample
26290 (gdb)
26291 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
26292 ^running
26293 (gdb)
26294 x = 55
26295 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
26296 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
26297 (gdb)
26298 @end smallexample
26299
26300 @ignore
26301 @subheading -file-clear
26302 Is this going away????
26303 @end ignore
26304
26305 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26306 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
26307 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
26308
26309
26310 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
26311 @findex -stack-info-frame
26312
26313 @subsubheading Synopsis
26314
26315 @smallexample
26316 -stack-info-frame
26317 @end smallexample
26318
26319 Get info on the selected frame.
26320
26321 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26322
26323 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
26324 (without arguments).
26325
26326 @subsubheading Example
26327
26328 @smallexample
26329 (gdb)
26330 -stack-info-frame
26331 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
26332 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26333 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
26334 (gdb)
26335 @end smallexample
26336
26337 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
26338 @findex -stack-info-depth
26339
26340 @subsubheading Synopsis
26341
26342 @smallexample
26343 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
26344 @end smallexample
26345
26346 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
26347 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
26348
26349 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26350
26351 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
26352
26353 @subsubheading Example
26354
26355 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
26356
26357 @smallexample
26358 (gdb)
26359 -stack-info-depth
26360 ^done,depth="12"
26361 (gdb)
26362 -stack-info-depth 4
26363 ^done,depth="4"
26364 (gdb)
26365 -stack-info-depth 12
26366 ^done,depth="12"
26367 (gdb)
26368 -stack-info-depth 11
26369 ^done,depth="11"
26370 (gdb)
26371 -stack-info-depth 13
26372 ^done,depth="12"
26373 (gdb)
26374 @end smallexample
26375
26376 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
26377 @findex -stack-list-arguments
26378
26379 @subsubheading Synopsis
26380
26381 @smallexample
26382 -stack-list-arguments @var{print-values}
26383 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
26384 @end smallexample
26385
26386 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
26387 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
26388 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
26389 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
26390 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
26391 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
26392 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
26393 which case only existing frames will be returned.
26394
26395 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
26396 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
26397 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
26398 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
26399 structures and unions.
26400
26401 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
26402 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
26403
26404 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26405
26406 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
26407 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
26408 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
26409
26410 @subsubheading Example
26411
26412 @smallexample
26413 (gdb)
26414 -stack-list-frames
26415 ^done,
26416 stack=[
26417 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26418 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26419 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
26420 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
26421 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26422 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
26423 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
26424 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26425 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
26426 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
26427 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26428 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
26429 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
26430 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26431 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
26432 (gdb)
26433 -stack-list-arguments 0
26434 ^done,
26435 stack-args=[
26436 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
26437 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
26438 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
26439 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
26440 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
26441 (gdb)
26442 -stack-list-arguments 1
26443 ^done,
26444 stack-args=[
26445 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
26446 frame=@{level="1",
26447 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
26448 frame=@{level="2",args=[
26449 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
26450 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
26451 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
26452 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
26453 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
26454 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
26455 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
26456 (gdb)
26457 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
26458 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
26459 (gdb)
26460 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
26461 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
26462 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
26463 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
26464 (gdb)
26465 @end smallexample
26466
26467 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
26468
26469
26470 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
26471 @findex -stack-list-frames
26472
26473 @subsubheading Synopsis
26474
26475 @smallexample
26476 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
26477 @end smallexample
26478
26479 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
26480 following info:
26481
26482 @table @samp
26483 @item @var{level}
26484 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
26485 @item @var{addr}
26486 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
26487 @item @var{func}
26488 Function name.
26489 @item @var{file}
26490 File name of the source file where the function lives.
26491 @item @var{fullname}
26492 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
26493 @item @var{line}
26494 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
26495 @item @var{from}
26496 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
26497 if the frame's function is not known.
26498 @end table
26499
26500 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
26501 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
26502 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
26503 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
26504 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
26505 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
26506 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
26507
26508 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26509
26510 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
26511
26512 @subsubheading Example
26513
26514 Full stack backtrace:
26515
26516 @smallexample
26517 (gdb)
26518 -stack-list-frames
26519 ^done,stack=
26520 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
26521 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
26522 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26523 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26524 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26525 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26526 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26527 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26528 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26529 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26530 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26531 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26532 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26533 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26534 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26535 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26536 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26537 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26538 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26539 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26540 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26541 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26542 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
26543 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
26544 (gdb)
26545 @end smallexample
26546
26547 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
26548
26549 @smallexample
26550 (gdb)
26551 -stack-list-frames 3 5
26552 ^done,stack=
26553 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26554 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26555 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26556 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
26557 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26558 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
26559 (gdb)
26560 @end smallexample
26561
26562 Show a single frame:
26563
26564 @smallexample
26565 (gdb)
26566 -stack-list-frames 3 3
26567 ^done,stack=
26568 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
26569 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
26570 (gdb)
26571 @end smallexample
26572
26573
26574 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
26575 @findex -stack-list-locals
26576
26577 @subsubheading Synopsis
26578
26579 @smallexample
26580 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
26581 @end smallexample
26582
26583 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
26584 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
26585 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
26586 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
26587 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
26588 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
26589 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
26590 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
26591 more detail.
26592
26593 This command is deprecated in favor of the
26594 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
26595
26596 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26597
26598 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
26599
26600 @subsubheading Example
26601
26602 @smallexample
26603 (gdb)
26604 -stack-list-locals 0
26605 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
26606 (gdb)
26607 -stack-list-locals --all-values
26608 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
26609 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
26610 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
26611 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
26612 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
26613 (gdb)
26614 @end smallexample
26615
26616 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
26617 @findex -stack-list-variables
26618
26619 @subsubheading Synopsis
26620
26621 @smallexample
26622 -stack-list-variables @var{print-values}
26623 @end smallexample
26624
26625 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
26626 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
26627 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
26628 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
26629 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
26630 structures and unions.
26631
26632 @subsubheading Example
26633
26634 @smallexample
26635 (gdb)
26636 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
26637 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
26638 (gdb)
26639 @end smallexample
26640
26641
26642 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
26643 @findex -stack-select-frame
26644
26645 @subsubheading Synopsis
26646
26647 @smallexample
26648 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
26649 @end smallexample
26650
26651 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
26652 the stack.
26653
26654 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
26655 option to every command.
26656
26657 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26658
26659 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
26660 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
26661
26662 @subsubheading Example
26663
26664 @smallexample
26665 (gdb)
26666 -stack-select-frame 2
26667 ^done
26668 (gdb)
26669 @end smallexample
26670
26671 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26672 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
26673 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
26674
26675 @ignore
26676
26677 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
26678
26679 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
26680 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
26681 used by @code{Insight}.
26682
26683 The two main reasons for that are:
26684
26685 @enumerate 1
26686 @item
26687 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
26688
26689 @item
26690 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
26691 now).
26692 @end enumerate
26693
26694 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
26695 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
26696 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
26697 hints about their use.
26698
26699 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
26700 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
26701 least, the following operations:
26702
26703 @itemize @bullet
26704 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
26705 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
26706 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
26707 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
26708 @end itemize
26709
26710 @end ignore
26711
26712 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
26713
26714 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
26715
26716 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
26717 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
26718 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
26719 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
26720 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
26721 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
26722 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
26723 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
26724 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
26725 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
26726 object, or to change display format.
26727
26728 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
26729 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
26730 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
26731 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
26732 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
26733 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
26734 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
26735 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
26736 child will be created.
26737
26738 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
26739 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
26740 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
26741 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
26742 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
26743
26744 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
26745 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
26746 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
26747 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
26748 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
26749 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
26750 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
26751 variables that frontend has created.
26752
26753 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
26754 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
26755 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
26756 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
26757 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
26758 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
26759 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
26760 implicitly updated.
26761
26762 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
26763 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
26764 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
26765 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
26766 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
26767 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
26768 frame. Consider this example:
26769
26770 @smallexample
26771 void do_work(...)
26772 @{
26773 struct work_state state;
26774
26775 if (...)
26776 do_work(...);
26777 @}
26778 @end smallexample
26779
26780 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
26781 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the the variable
26782 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
26783 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
26784 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
26785
26786 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
26787 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
26788 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
26789 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
26790 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
26791 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
26792
26793 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
26794 access this functionality:
26795
26796 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
26797 @item @strong{Operation}
26798 @tab @strong{Description}
26799
26800 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
26801 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
26802 @item @code{-var-create}
26803 @tab create a variable object
26804 @item @code{-var-delete}
26805 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
26806 @item @code{-var-set-format}
26807 @tab set the display format of this variable
26808 @item @code{-var-show-format}
26809 @tab show the display format of this variable
26810 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
26811 @tab tells how many children this object has
26812 @item @code{-var-list-children}
26813 @tab return a list of the object's children
26814 @item @code{-var-info-type}
26815 @tab show the type of this variable object
26816 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
26817 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
26818 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
26819 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
26820 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
26821 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
26822 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
26823 @tab get the value of this variable
26824 @item @code{-var-assign}
26825 @tab set the value of this variable
26826 @item @code{-var-update}
26827 @tab update the variable and its children
26828 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
26829 @tab set frozeness attribute
26830 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
26831 @tab set range of children to display on update
26832 @end multitable
26833
26834 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
26835 how it can be used.
26836
26837 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
26838
26839 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
26840 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
26841
26842 @smallexample
26843 -enable-pretty-printing
26844 @end smallexample
26845
26846 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
26847 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
26848 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
26849 request that this functionality be enabled.
26850
26851 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
26852
26853 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
26854 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
26855
26856 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
26857 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
26858
26859 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
26860 @findex -var-create
26861
26862 @subsubheading Synopsis
26863
26864 @smallexample
26865 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
26866 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
26867 @end smallexample
26868
26869 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
26870 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
26871 register.
26872
26873 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
26874 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
26875 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
26876 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
26877 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
26878
26879 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
26880 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
26881 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
26882 object must be created.
26883
26884 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
26885 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
26886
26887 @itemize @bullet
26888 @item
26889 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
26890
26891 @item
26892 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
26893
26894 @item
26895 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
26896 @end itemize
26897
26898 @cindex dynamic varobj
26899 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
26900 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
26901 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
26902 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
26903 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
26904 compatibility for existing clients.
26905
26906 @subsubheading Result
26907
26908 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
26909 are:
26910
26911 @table @samp
26912 @item name
26913 The name of the varobj.
26914
26915 @item numchild
26916 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
26917 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
26918 @samp{has_more} attribute.
26919
26920 @item value
26921 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
26922 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
26923 will not be interesting.
26924
26925 @item type
26926 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
26927 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI.
26928
26929 @item thread-id
26930 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
26931 thread's identifier.
26932
26933 @item has_more
26934 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
26935 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
26936
26937 @item dynamic
26938 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
26939 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
26940 then this attribute will not be present.
26941
26942 @item displayhint
26943 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
26944 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
26945 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
26946 @end table
26947
26948 Typical output will look like this:
26949
26950 @smallexample
26951 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
26952 has_more="@var{has_more}"
26953 @end smallexample
26954
26955
26956 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
26957 @findex -var-delete
26958
26959 @subsubheading Synopsis
26960
26961 @smallexample
26962 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
26963 @end smallexample
26964
26965 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
26966 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
26967
26968 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
26969
26970
26971 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
26972 @findex -var-set-format
26973
26974 @subsubheading Synopsis
26975
26976 @smallexample
26977 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
26978 @end smallexample
26979
26980 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
26981 @var{format-spec}.
26982
26983 @anchor{-var-set-format}
26984 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
26985
26986 @smallexample
26987 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
26988 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
26989 @end smallexample
26990
26991 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
26992 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
26993 for pointers, etc.).
26994
26995 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
26996 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
26997
26998 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
26999 @findex -var-show-format
27000
27001 @subsubheading Synopsis
27002
27003 @smallexample
27004 -var-show-format @var{name}
27005 @end smallexample
27006
27007 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
27008
27009 @smallexample
27010 @var{format} @expansion{}
27011 @var{format-spec}
27012 @end smallexample
27013
27014
27015 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
27016 @findex -var-info-num-children
27017
27018 @subsubheading Synopsis
27019
27020 @smallexample
27021 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
27022 @end smallexample
27023
27024 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
27025
27026 @smallexample
27027 numchild=@var{n}
27028 @end smallexample
27029
27030 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
27031 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
27032 be available.
27033
27034
27035 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
27036 @findex -var-list-children
27037
27038 @subsubheading Synopsis
27039
27040 @smallexample
27041 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
27042 @end smallexample
27043 @anchor{-var-list-children}
27044
27045 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
27046 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
27047 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
27048 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
27049 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
27050 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
27051 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
27052 and unions.
27053
27054 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
27055 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
27056 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
27057 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
27058 reported.
27059
27060 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
27061 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
27062 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
27063 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
27064 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
27065 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
27066 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
27067 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
27068 the visible items.
27069
27070 For each child the following results are returned:
27071
27072 @table @var
27073
27074 @item name
27075 Name of the variable object created for this child.
27076
27077 @item exp
27078 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
27079 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
27080
27081 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
27082 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
27083
27084 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
27085 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
27086 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
27087 type and value are not present.
27088
27089 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
27090 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
27091 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
27092
27093 @item numchild
27094 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
27095 0.
27096
27097 @item type
27098 The type of the child.
27099
27100 @item value
27101 If values were requested, this is the value.
27102
27103 @item thread-id
27104 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
27105 Otherwise this result is not present.
27106
27107 @item frozen
27108 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
27109 @end table
27110
27111 The result may have its own attributes:
27112
27113 @table @samp
27114 @item displayhint
27115 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
27116 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
27117 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
27118
27119 @item has_more
27120 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
27121 remaining after the end of the selected range.
27122 @end table
27123
27124 @subsubheading Example
27125
27126 @smallexample
27127 (gdb)
27128 -var-list-children n
27129 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
27130 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
27131 (gdb)
27132 -var-list-children --all-values n
27133 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
27134 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
27135 @end smallexample
27136
27137
27138 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
27139 @findex -var-info-type
27140
27141 @subsubheading Synopsis
27142
27143 @smallexample
27144 -var-info-type @var{name}
27145 @end smallexample
27146
27147 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
27148 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
27149 @value{GDBN} CLI:
27150
27151 @smallexample
27152 type=@var{typename}
27153 @end smallexample
27154
27155
27156 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
27157 @findex -var-info-expression
27158
27159 @subsubheading Synopsis
27160
27161 @smallexample
27162 -var-info-expression @var{name}
27163 @end smallexample
27164
27165 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
27166 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
27167 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
27168
27169 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
27170 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
27171
27172 @smallexample
27173 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
27174 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
27175 @end smallexample
27176
27177 @noindent
27178 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
27179
27180 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
27181 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
27182 is of limited use.
27183
27184 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
27185 @findex -var-info-path-expression
27186
27187 @subsubheading Synopsis
27188
27189 @smallexample
27190 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
27191 @end smallexample
27192
27193 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
27194 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
27195 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
27196 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
27197 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
27198 watchpoint from a variable object.
27199
27200 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
27201 and will give an error when invoked on one.
27202
27203 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
27204 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
27205 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
27206 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
27207 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
27208 @smallexample
27209 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
27210 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
27211 @end smallexample
27212
27213 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
27214 @findex -var-show-attributes
27215
27216 @subsubheading Synopsis
27217
27218 @smallexample
27219 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
27220 @end smallexample
27221
27222 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
27223
27224 @smallexample
27225 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
27226 @end smallexample
27227
27228 @noindent
27229 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
27230
27231 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
27232 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
27233
27234 @subsubheading Synopsis
27235
27236 @smallexample
27237 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
27238 @end smallexample
27239
27240 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
27241 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
27242 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
27243 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
27244 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
27245 the current display format will be used. The current display format
27246 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
27247
27248 @smallexample
27249 value=@var{value}
27250 @end smallexample
27251
27252 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
27253 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
27254
27255 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
27256 @findex -var-assign
27257
27258 @subsubheading Synopsis
27259
27260 @smallexample
27261 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
27262 @end smallexample
27263
27264 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
27265 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
27266 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
27267 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
27268
27269 @subsubheading Example
27270
27271 @smallexample
27272 (gdb)
27273 -var-assign var1 3
27274 ^done,value="3"
27275 (gdb)
27276 -var-update *
27277 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
27278 (gdb)
27279 @end smallexample
27280
27281 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
27282 @findex -var-update
27283
27284 @subsubheading Synopsis
27285
27286 @smallexample
27287 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
27288 @end smallexample
27289
27290 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
27291 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
27292 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
27293 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
27294 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
27295 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
27296 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
27297 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
27298 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
27299 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
27300 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
27301 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
27302 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
27303
27304 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
27305 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
27306 diagnostic.
27307
27308 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
27309 only the selected range of children will be reported.
27310
27311 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
27312 @samp{changelist}.
27313
27314 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
27315
27316 @table @samp
27317 @item name
27318 The name of the varobj.
27319
27320 @item value
27321 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
27322 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
27323
27324 @item in_scope
27325 @anchor{-var-update}
27326 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
27327
27328 @table @code
27329 @item "true"
27330 The variable object's current value is valid.
27331
27332 @item "false"
27333 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
27334 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
27335 scope.
27336
27337 @item "invalid"
27338 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
27339 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
27340 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
27341 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
27342 objects.
27343 @end table
27344
27345 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
27346 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
27347
27348 @item type_changed
27349 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
27350 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
27351 be @samp{false}.
27352
27353 @item new_type
27354 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
27355 hold the new type.
27356
27357 @item new_num_children
27358 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
27359 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
27360
27361 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
27362 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
27363 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
27364 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
27365 children which may be available.
27366
27367 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
27368 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
27369 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
27370 only happen at the end of the update range).
27371
27372 @item displayhint
27373 The display hint, if any.
27374
27375 @item has_more
27376 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
27377 available outside the varobj's update range.
27378
27379 @item dynamic
27380 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
27381 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
27382 then this attribute will not be present.
27383
27384 @item new_children
27385 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
27386 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
27387 be listed in this attribute.
27388 @end table
27389
27390 @subsubheading Example
27391
27392 @smallexample
27393 (gdb)
27394 -var-assign var1 3
27395 ^done,value="3"
27396 (gdb)
27397 -var-update --all-values var1
27398 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
27399 type_changed="false"@}]
27400 (gdb)
27401 @end smallexample
27402
27403 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
27404 @findex -var-set-frozen
27405 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
27406
27407 @subsubheading Synopsis
27408
27409 @smallexample
27410 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
27411 @end smallexample
27412
27413 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
27414 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
27415 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
27416 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
27417 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
27418 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
27419 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
27420 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
27421 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
27422 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
27423 @code{-var-update} does.
27424
27425 @subsubheading Example
27426
27427 @smallexample
27428 (gdb)
27429 -var-set-frozen V 1
27430 ^done
27431 (gdb)
27432 @end smallexample
27433
27434 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
27435 @findex -var-set-update-range
27436 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
27437
27438 @subsubheading Synopsis
27439
27440 @smallexample
27441 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
27442 @end smallexample
27443
27444 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
27445 @code{-var-update}.
27446
27447 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
27448 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
27449 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
27450 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
27451
27452 @subsubheading Example
27453
27454 @smallexample
27455 (gdb)
27456 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
27457 ^done
27458 @end smallexample
27459
27460 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
27461 @findex -var-set-visualizer
27462 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
27463
27464 @subsubheading Synopsis
27465
27466 @smallexample
27467 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
27468 @end smallexample
27469
27470 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
27471
27472 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
27473 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
27474
27475 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
27476 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
27477 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
27478 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
27479 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
27480 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
27481 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
27482
27483 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
27484 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
27485 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
27486 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
27487
27488 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
27489 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands})
27490 can be used to check this.
27491
27492 @subsubheading Example
27493
27494 Resetting the visualizer:
27495
27496 @smallexample
27497 (gdb)
27498 -var-set-visualizer V None
27499 ^done
27500 @end smallexample
27501
27502 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
27503
27504 @smallexample
27505 (gdb)
27506 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
27507 ^done
27508 @end smallexample
27509
27510 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
27511 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
27512
27513 @smallexample
27514 (gdb)
27515 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
27516 ^done
27517 @end smallexample
27518
27519 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27520 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
27521 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
27522
27523 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
27524 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
27525 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
27526 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
27527
27528 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
27529 @c @subheading -data-assign
27530 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
27531 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
27532 @c set variable
27533 @c @subsubheading Example
27534 @c N.A.
27535
27536 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
27537 @findex -data-disassemble
27538
27539 @subsubheading Synopsis
27540
27541 @smallexample
27542 -data-disassemble
27543 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
27544 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
27545 -- @var{mode}
27546 @end smallexample
27547
27548 @noindent
27549 Where:
27550
27551 @table @samp
27552 @item @var{start-addr}
27553 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
27554 @item @var{end-addr}
27555 is the end address
27556 @item @var{filename}
27557 is the name of the file to disassemble
27558 @item @var{linenum}
27559 is the line number to disassemble around
27560 @item @var{lines}
27561 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
27562 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
27563 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
27564 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
27565 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
27566 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
27567 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
27568 are displayed.
27569 @item @var{mode}
27570 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
27571 disassembly).
27572 @end table
27573
27574 @subsubheading Result
27575
27576 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
27577
27578 @itemize @bullet
27579 @item Address
27580 @item Func-name
27581 @item Offset
27582 @item Instruction
27583 @end itemize
27584
27585 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
27586 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
27587
27588 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27589
27590 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
27591
27592 @subsubheading Example
27593
27594 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
27595
27596 @smallexample
27597 (gdb)
27598 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
27599 ^done,
27600 asm_insns=[
27601 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
27602 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
27603 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
27604 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
27605 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
27606 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
27607 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
27608 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
27609 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
27610 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
27611 (gdb)
27612 @end smallexample
27613
27614 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
27615 @code{main}.
27616
27617 @smallexample
27618 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
27619 ^done,asm_insns=[
27620 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
27621 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
27622 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
27623 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
27624 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
27625 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
27626 [@dots{}]
27627 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
27628 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
27629 (gdb)
27630 @end smallexample
27631
27632 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
27633
27634 @smallexample
27635 (gdb)
27636 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
27637 ^done,asm_insns=[
27638 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
27639 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
27640 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
27641 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
27642 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
27643 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
27644 (gdb)
27645 @end smallexample
27646
27647 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
27648
27649 @smallexample
27650 (gdb)
27651 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
27652 ^done,asm_insns=[
27653 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
27654 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
27655 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
27656 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
27657 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
27658 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
27659 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
27660 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
27661 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
27662 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
27663 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
27664 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
27665 (gdb)
27666 @end smallexample
27667
27668
27669 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
27670 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
27671
27672 @subsubheading Synopsis
27673
27674 @smallexample
27675 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
27676 @end smallexample
27677
27678 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
27679 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
27680 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
27681
27682 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27683
27684 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
27685 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
27686 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
27687
27688 @subsubheading Example
27689
27690 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
27691 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
27692 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
27693 output.
27694
27695 @smallexample
27696 211-data-evaluate-expression A
27697 211^done,value="1"
27698 (gdb)
27699 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
27700 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
27701 (gdb)
27702 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
27703 411^done,value="4"
27704 (gdb)
27705 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
27706 511^done,value="4"
27707 (gdb)
27708 @end smallexample
27709
27710
27711 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
27712 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
27713
27714 @subsubheading Synopsis
27715
27716 @smallexample
27717 -data-list-changed-registers
27718 @end smallexample
27719
27720 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
27721
27722 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27723
27724 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
27725 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
27726
27727 @subsubheading Example
27728
27729 On a PPC MBX board:
27730
27731 @smallexample
27732 (gdb)
27733 -exec-continue
27734 ^running
27735
27736 (gdb)
27737 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
27738 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
27739 line="5"@}
27740 (gdb)
27741 -data-list-changed-registers
27742 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
27743 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
27744 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
27745 (gdb)
27746 @end smallexample
27747
27748
27749 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
27750 @findex -data-list-register-names
27751
27752 @subsubheading Synopsis
27753
27754 @smallexample
27755 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
27756 @end smallexample
27757
27758 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
27759 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
27760 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
27761 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
27762 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
27763 include empty register names.
27764
27765 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27766
27767 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
27768 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
27769 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
27770
27771 @subsubheading Example
27772
27773 For the PPC MBX board:
27774 @smallexample
27775 (gdb)
27776 -data-list-register-names
27777 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
27778 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
27779 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
27780 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
27781 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
27782 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
27783 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
27784 (gdb)
27785 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
27786 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
27787 (gdb)
27788 @end smallexample
27789
27790 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
27791 @findex -data-list-register-values
27792
27793 @subsubheading Synopsis
27794
27795 @smallexample
27796 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
27797 @end smallexample
27798
27799 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
27800 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
27801 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
27802 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
27803
27804 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
27805
27806 @table @code
27807 @item x
27808 Hexadecimal
27809 @item o
27810 Octal
27811 @item t
27812 Binary
27813 @item d
27814 Decimal
27815 @item r
27816 Raw
27817 @item N
27818 Natural
27819 @end table
27820
27821 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27822
27823 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
27824 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
27825
27826 @subsubheading Example
27827
27828 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
27829 don't appear in the actual output):
27830
27831 @smallexample
27832 (gdb)
27833 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
27834 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
27835 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
27836 (gdb)
27837 -data-list-register-values x
27838 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
27839 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
27840 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
27841 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
27842 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
27843 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
27844 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
27845 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
27846 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
27847 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
27848 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
27849 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
27850 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
27851 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
27852 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
27853 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
27854 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
27855 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
27856 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
27857 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
27858 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
27859 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
27860 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
27861 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
27862 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
27863 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
27864 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
27865 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
27866 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
27867 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
27868 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
27869 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
27870 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
27871 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
27872 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
27873 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
27874 (gdb)
27875 @end smallexample
27876
27877
27878 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
27879 @findex -data-read-memory
27880
27881 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
27882
27883 @subsubheading Synopsis
27884
27885 @smallexample
27886 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
27887 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
27888 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
27889 @end smallexample
27890
27891 @noindent
27892 where:
27893
27894 @table @samp
27895 @item @var{address}
27896 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
27897 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
27898 quoted using the C convention.
27899
27900 @item @var{word-format}
27901 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
27902 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
27903 ,Output Formats}).
27904
27905 @item @var{word-size}
27906 The size of each memory word in bytes.
27907
27908 @item @var{nr-rows}
27909 The number of rows in the output table.
27910
27911 @item @var{nr-cols}
27912 The number of columns in the output table.
27913
27914 @item @var{aschar}
27915 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
27916 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
27917 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
27918 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
27919
27920 @item @var{byte-offset}
27921 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
27922 @end table
27923
27924 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
27925 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
27926 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
27927 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
27928 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
27929 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
27930 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
27931 @samp{addr}.
27932
27933 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
27934 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
27935 @samp{prev-page}.
27936
27937 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27938
27939 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
27940 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
27941
27942 @subsubheading Example
27943
27944 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
27945 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
27946 word. Display each word in hex.
27947
27948 @smallexample
27949 (gdb)
27950 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
27951 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
27952 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
27953 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
27954 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
27955 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
27956 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
27957 (gdb)
27958 @end smallexample
27959
27960 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
27961 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
27962
27963 @smallexample
27964 (gdb)
27965 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
27966 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
27967 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
27968 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
27969 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
27970 (gdb)
27971 @end smallexample
27972
27973 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
27974 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
27975 used as the non-printable character.
27976
27977 @smallexample
27978 (gdb)
27979 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
27980 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
27981 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
27982 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
27983 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
27984 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
27985 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
27986 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
27987 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
27988 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
27989 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
27990 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
27991 (gdb)
27992 @end smallexample
27993
27994 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
27995 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
27996
27997 @subsubheading Synopsis
27998
27999 @smallexample
28000 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
28001 @var{address} @var{count}
28002 @end smallexample
28003
28004 @noindent
28005 where:
28006
28007 @table @samp
28008 @item @var{address}
28009 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
28010 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
28011 quoted using the C convention.
28012
28013 @item @var{count}
28014 The number of bytes to read. This should be an integer literal.
28015
28016 @item @var{byte-offset}
28017 The offsets in bytes relative to @var{address} at which to start
28018 reading. This should be an integer literal. This option is provided
28019 so that a frontend is not required to first evaluate address and then
28020 perform address arithmetics itself.
28021
28022 @end table
28023
28024 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
28025 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
28026 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
28027 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
28028 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
28029 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
28030
28031 In general, every single byte in the region may be readable or not,
28032 and the only way to read every readable byte is to try a read at
28033 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
28034 attempt to read all accessible bytes at either beginning or the end
28035 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
28036 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
28037 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
28038 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
28039
28040 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
28041 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
28042 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
28043 and has the following fields:
28044
28045 @table @code
28046 @item begin
28047 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
28048
28049 @item end
28050 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
28051
28052 @item offset
28053 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
28054 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
28055
28056 @item contents
28057 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
28058
28059 @end table
28060
28061
28062
28063 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28064
28065 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
28066
28067 @subsubheading Example
28068
28069 @smallexample
28070 (gdb)
28071 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
28072 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
28073 end="0xbffff15e",
28074 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
28075 (gdb)
28076 @end smallexample
28077
28078
28079 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
28080 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
28081
28082 @subsubheading Synopsis
28083
28084 @smallexample
28085 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
28086 @end smallexample
28087
28088 @noindent
28089 where:
28090
28091 @table @samp
28092 @item @var{address}
28093 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
28094 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
28095 quoted using the C convention.
28096
28097 @item @var{contents}
28098 The hex-encoded bytes to write.
28099
28100 @end table
28101
28102 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28103
28104 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
28105
28106 @subsubheading Example
28107
28108 @smallexample
28109 (gdb)
28110 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
28111 ^done
28112 (gdb)
28113 @end smallexample
28114
28115
28116 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28117 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
28118 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
28119
28120 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
28121 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
28122
28123 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
28124 @findex -trace-find
28125
28126 @subsubheading Synopsis
28127
28128 @smallexample
28129 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
28130 @end smallexample
28131
28132 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
28133 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
28134 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
28135
28136 @table @samp
28137
28138 @item none
28139 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
28140
28141 @item frame-number
28142 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
28143 that index.
28144
28145 @item tracepoint-number
28146 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
28147 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
28148
28149 @item pc
28150 An address is required as parameter. Finds
28151 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
28152 address.
28153
28154 @item pc-inside-range
28155 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
28156 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
28157 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
28158
28159 @item pc-outside-range
28160 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
28161 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
28162 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
28163
28164 @item line
28165 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
28166 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
28167 the specified location.
28168
28169 @end table
28170
28171 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
28172 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
28173
28174 @table @samp
28175 @item found
28176 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
28177 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
28178
28179 @item traceframe
28180 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
28181 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
28182
28183 @item tracepoint
28184 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
28185 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
28186
28187 @item frame
28188 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
28189 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
28190 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
28191
28192 @end table
28193
28194 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28195
28196 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
28197
28198 @subheading -trace-define-variable
28199 @findex -trace-define-variable
28200
28201 @subsubheading Synopsis
28202
28203 @smallexample
28204 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
28205 @end smallexample
28206
28207 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
28208 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
28209 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
28210 with the @samp{$} character.
28211
28212 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28213
28214 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
28215
28216 @subheading -trace-list-variables
28217 @findex -trace-list-variables
28218
28219 @subsubheading Synopsis
28220
28221 @smallexample
28222 -trace-list-variables
28223 @end smallexample
28224
28225 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
28226 table has the following fields:
28227
28228 @table @samp
28229 @item name
28230 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
28231
28232 @item initial
28233 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
28234 field is always present.
28235
28236 @item current
28237 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
28238 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
28239 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
28240 presently running.
28241
28242 @end table
28243
28244 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28245
28246 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
28247
28248 @subsubheading Example
28249
28250 @smallexample
28251 (gdb)
28252 -trace-list-variables
28253 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
28254 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
28255 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
28256 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
28257 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
28258 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
28259 (gdb)
28260 @end smallexample
28261
28262 @subheading -trace-save
28263 @findex -trace-save
28264
28265 @subsubheading Synopsis
28266
28267 @smallexample
28268 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
28269 @end smallexample
28270
28271 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
28272 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
28273 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
28274 to perform the save.
28275
28276 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28277
28278 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
28279
28280
28281 @subheading -trace-start
28282 @findex -trace-start
28283
28284 @subsubheading Synopsis
28285
28286 @smallexample
28287 -trace-start
28288 @end smallexample
28289
28290 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
28291 have any fields.
28292
28293 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28294
28295 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
28296
28297 @subheading -trace-status
28298 @findex -trace-status
28299
28300 @subsubheading Synopsis
28301
28302 @smallexample
28303 -trace-status
28304 @end smallexample
28305
28306 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
28307 the following fields:
28308
28309 @table @samp
28310
28311 @item supported
28312 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
28313 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
28314 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
28315 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
28316 started. This field is always present.
28317
28318 @item running
28319 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
28320 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
28321 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
28322
28323 @item stop-reason
28324 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
28325 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
28326 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
28327 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
28328 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
28329 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
28330 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
28331 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
28332 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
28333
28334 @item stopping-tracepoint
28335 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
28336 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
28337 @samp{passcount}.
28338
28339 @item frames
28340 @itemx frames-created
28341 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
28342 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
28343 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
28344 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
28345
28346 @item buffer-size
28347 @itemx buffer-free
28348 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
28349 remaining space. These fields are optional.
28350
28351 @item circular
28352 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
28353 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
28354 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
28355 and may fill up.
28356
28357 @item disconnected
28358 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
28359 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
28360 that the trace run will stop.
28361
28362 @end table
28363
28364 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28365
28366 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
28367
28368 @subheading -trace-stop
28369 @findex -trace-stop
28370
28371 @subsubheading Synopsis
28372
28373 @smallexample
28374 -trace-stop
28375 @end smallexample
28376
28377 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
28378 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
28379 @samp{running} fields are not output.
28380
28381 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28382
28383 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
28384
28385
28386 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28387 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
28388 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
28389
28390
28391 @ignore
28392 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
28393 @findex -symbol-info-address
28394
28395 @subsubheading Synopsis
28396
28397 @smallexample
28398 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
28399 @end smallexample
28400
28401 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
28402
28403 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28404
28405 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
28406
28407 @subsubheading Example
28408 N.A.
28409
28410
28411 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
28412 @findex -symbol-info-file
28413
28414 @subsubheading Synopsis
28415
28416 @smallexample
28417 -symbol-info-file
28418 @end smallexample
28419
28420 Show the file for the symbol.
28421
28422 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28423
28424 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
28425 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
28426
28427 @subsubheading Example
28428 N.A.
28429
28430
28431 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
28432 @findex -symbol-info-function
28433
28434 @subsubheading Synopsis
28435
28436 @smallexample
28437 -symbol-info-function
28438 @end smallexample
28439
28440 Show which function the symbol lives in.
28441
28442 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28443
28444 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
28445
28446 @subsubheading Example
28447 N.A.
28448
28449
28450 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
28451 @findex -symbol-info-line
28452
28453 @subsubheading Synopsis
28454
28455 @smallexample
28456 -symbol-info-line
28457 @end smallexample
28458
28459 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
28460
28461 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28462
28463 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
28464 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
28465
28466 @subsubheading Example
28467 N.A.
28468
28469
28470 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
28471 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
28472
28473 @subsubheading Synopsis
28474
28475 @smallexample
28476 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
28477 @end smallexample
28478
28479 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
28480
28481 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28482
28483 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
28484
28485 @subsubheading Example
28486 N.A.
28487
28488
28489 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
28490 @findex -symbol-list-functions
28491
28492 @subsubheading Synopsis
28493
28494 @smallexample
28495 -symbol-list-functions
28496 @end smallexample
28497
28498 List the functions in the executable.
28499
28500 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28501
28502 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
28503 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
28504
28505 @subsubheading Example
28506 N.A.
28507 @end ignore
28508
28509
28510 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
28511 @findex -symbol-list-lines
28512
28513 @subsubheading Synopsis
28514
28515 @smallexample
28516 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
28517 @end smallexample
28518
28519 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
28520 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
28521 ascending PC order.
28522
28523 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28524
28525 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
28526
28527 @subsubheading Example
28528 @smallexample
28529 (gdb)
28530 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
28531 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
28532 (gdb)
28533 @end smallexample
28534
28535
28536 @ignore
28537 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
28538 @findex -symbol-list-types
28539
28540 @subsubheading Synopsis
28541
28542 @smallexample
28543 -symbol-list-types
28544 @end smallexample
28545
28546 List all the type names.
28547
28548 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28549
28550 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
28551 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
28552
28553 @subsubheading Example
28554 N.A.
28555
28556
28557 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
28558 @findex -symbol-list-variables
28559
28560 @subsubheading Synopsis
28561
28562 @smallexample
28563 -symbol-list-variables
28564 @end smallexample
28565
28566 List all the global and static variable names.
28567
28568 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28569
28570 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
28571
28572 @subsubheading Example
28573 N.A.
28574
28575
28576 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
28577 @findex -symbol-locate
28578
28579 @subsubheading Synopsis
28580
28581 @smallexample
28582 -symbol-locate
28583 @end smallexample
28584
28585 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28586
28587 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
28588
28589 @subsubheading Example
28590 N.A.
28591
28592
28593 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
28594 @findex -symbol-type
28595
28596 @subsubheading Synopsis
28597
28598 @smallexample
28599 -symbol-type @var{variable}
28600 @end smallexample
28601
28602 Show type of @var{variable}.
28603
28604 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28605
28606 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
28607 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
28608
28609 @subsubheading Example
28610 N.A.
28611 @end ignore
28612
28613
28614 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28615 @node GDB/MI File Commands
28616 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
28617
28618 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
28619 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
28620
28621 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
28622 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
28623
28624 @subsubheading Synopsis
28625
28626 @smallexample
28627 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
28628 @end smallexample
28629
28630 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
28631 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
28632 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
28633 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
28634 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
28635 notification.
28636
28637 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28638
28639 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
28640
28641 @subsubheading Example
28642
28643 @smallexample
28644 (gdb)
28645 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
28646 ^done
28647 (gdb)
28648 @end smallexample
28649
28650
28651 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
28652 @findex -file-exec-file
28653
28654 @subsubheading Synopsis
28655
28656 @smallexample
28657 -file-exec-file @var{file}
28658 @end smallexample
28659
28660 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
28661 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
28662 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
28663 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
28664 notification.
28665
28666 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28667
28668 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
28669
28670 @subsubheading Example
28671
28672 @smallexample
28673 (gdb)
28674 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
28675 ^done
28676 (gdb)
28677 @end smallexample
28678
28679
28680 @ignore
28681 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
28682 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
28683
28684 @subsubheading Synopsis
28685
28686 @smallexample
28687 -file-list-exec-sections
28688 @end smallexample
28689
28690 List the sections of the current executable file.
28691
28692 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28693
28694 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
28695 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
28696 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
28697
28698 @subsubheading Example
28699 N.A.
28700 @end ignore
28701
28702
28703 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
28704 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
28705
28706 @subsubheading Synopsis
28707
28708 @smallexample
28709 -file-list-exec-source-file
28710 @end smallexample
28711
28712 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
28713 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
28714 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
28715 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
28716
28717 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28718
28719 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
28720
28721 @subsubheading Example
28722
28723 @smallexample
28724 (gdb)
28725 123-file-list-exec-source-file
28726 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
28727 (gdb)
28728 @end smallexample
28729
28730
28731 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
28732 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
28733
28734 @subsubheading Synopsis
28735
28736 @smallexample
28737 -file-list-exec-source-files
28738 @end smallexample
28739
28740 List the source files for the current executable.
28741
28742 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
28743 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
28744
28745 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28746
28747 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
28748 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
28749
28750 @subsubheading Example
28751 @smallexample
28752 (gdb)
28753 -file-list-exec-source-files
28754 ^done,files=[
28755 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
28756 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
28757 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
28758 (gdb)
28759 @end smallexample
28760
28761 @ignore
28762 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
28763 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
28764
28765 @subsubheading Synopsis
28766
28767 @smallexample
28768 -file-list-shared-libraries
28769 @end smallexample
28770
28771 List the shared libraries in the program.
28772
28773 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28774
28775 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
28776
28777 @subsubheading Example
28778 N.A.
28779
28780
28781 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
28782 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
28783
28784 @subsubheading Synopsis
28785
28786 @smallexample
28787 -file-list-symbol-files
28788 @end smallexample
28789
28790 List symbol files.
28791
28792 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28793
28794 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
28795
28796 @subsubheading Example
28797 N.A.
28798 @end ignore
28799
28800
28801 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
28802 @findex -file-symbol-file
28803
28804 @subsubheading Synopsis
28805
28806 @smallexample
28807 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
28808 @end smallexample
28809
28810 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
28811 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
28812 produced, except for a completion notification.
28813
28814 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28815
28816 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
28817
28818 @subsubheading Example
28819
28820 @smallexample
28821 (gdb)
28822 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
28823 ^done
28824 (gdb)
28825 @end smallexample
28826
28827 @ignore
28828 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28829 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
28830 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
28831
28832 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
28833
28834 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
28835
28836 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
28837
28838 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
28839
28840 @c @subheading -overlay-map
28841
28842 @c @subheading -overlay-off
28843
28844 @c @subheading -overlay-on
28845
28846 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
28847
28848 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28849 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
28850 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
28851
28852 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
28853
28854 @c @subheading -signal-handle
28855
28856 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
28857
28858 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
28859 @end ignore
28860
28861
28862 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28863 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
28864 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
28865
28866
28867 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
28868 @findex -target-attach
28869
28870 @subsubheading Synopsis
28871
28872 @smallexample
28873 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
28874 @end smallexample
28875
28876 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
28877 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
28878 group, the id previously returned by
28879 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
28880
28881 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28882
28883 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
28884
28885 @subsubheading Example
28886 @smallexample
28887 (gdb)
28888 -target-attach 34
28889 =thread-created,id="1"
28890 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
28891 ^done
28892 (gdb)
28893 @end smallexample
28894
28895 @ignore
28896 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
28897 @findex -target-compare-sections
28898
28899 @subsubheading Synopsis
28900
28901 @smallexample
28902 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
28903 @end smallexample
28904
28905 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
28906 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
28907
28908 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28909
28910 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
28911
28912 @subsubheading Example
28913 N.A.
28914 @end ignore
28915
28916
28917 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
28918 @findex -target-detach
28919
28920 @subsubheading Synopsis
28921
28922 @smallexample
28923 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
28924 @end smallexample
28925
28926 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
28927 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
28928 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
28929
28930 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28931
28932 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
28933
28934 @subsubheading Example
28935
28936 @smallexample
28937 (gdb)
28938 -target-detach
28939 ^done
28940 (gdb)
28941 @end smallexample
28942
28943
28944 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
28945 @findex -target-disconnect
28946
28947 @subsubheading Synopsis
28948
28949 @smallexample
28950 -target-disconnect
28951 @end smallexample
28952
28953 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
28954 generally not resumed.
28955
28956 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28957
28958 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
28959
28960 @subsubheading Example
28961
28962 @smallexample
28963 (gdb)
28964 -target-disconnect
28965 ^done
28966 (gdb)
28967 @end smallexample
28968
28969
28970 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
28971 @findex -target-download
28972
28973 @subsubheading Synopsis
28974
28975 @smallexample
28976 -target-download
28977 @end smallexample
28978
28979 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
28980 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
28981
28982 @table @samp
28983 @item section
28984 The name of the section.
28985 @item section-sent
28986 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
28987 @item section-size
28988 The size of the section.
28989 @item total-sent
28990 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
28991 @item total-size
28992 The size of the overall executable to download.
28993 @end table
28994
28995 @noindent
28996 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
28997 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
28998
28999 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
29000 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
29001
29002 @table @samp
29003 @item section
29004 The name of the section.
29005 @item section-size
29006 The size of the section.
29007 @item total-size
29008 The size of the overall executable to download.
29009 @end table
29010
29011 @noindent
29012 At the end, a summary is printed.
29013
29014 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29015
29016 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
29017
29018 @subsubheading Example
29019
29020 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
29021 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
29022
29023 @smallexample
29024 (gdb)
29025 -target-download
29026 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
29027 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
29028 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
29029 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
29030 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
29031 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
29032 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
29033 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
29034 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
29035 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
29036 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
29037 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
29038 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
29039 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
29040 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
29041 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
29042 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
29043 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
29044 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
29045 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
29046 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
29047 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
29048 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
29049 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
29050 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
29051 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
29052 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
29053 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
29054 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
29055 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
29056 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
29057 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
29058 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
29059 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
29060 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
29061 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
29062 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
29063 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
29064 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
29065 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
29066 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
29067 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
29068 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
29069 write-rate="429"
29070 (gdb)
29071 @end smallexample
29072
29073
29074 @ignore
29075 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
29076 @findex -target-exec-status
29077
29078 @subsubheading Synopsis
29079
29080 @smallexample
29081 -target-exec-status
29082 @end smallexample
29083
29084 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
29085 not, for instance).
29086
29087 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29088
29089 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
29090
29091 @subsubheading Example
29092 N.A.
29093
29094
29095 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
29096 @findex -target-list-available-targets
29097
29098 @subsubheading Synopsis
29099
29100 @smallexample
29101 -target-list-available-targets
29102 @end smallexample
29103
29104 List the possible targets to connect to.
29105
29106 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29107
29108 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
29109
29110 @subsubheading Example
29111 N.A.
29112
29113
29114 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
29115 @findex -target-list-current-targets
29116
29117 @subsubheading Synopsis
29118
29119 @smallexample
29120 -target-list-current-targets
29121 @end smallexample
29122
29123 Describe the current target.
29124
29125 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29126
29127 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
29128 other things).
29129
29130 @subsubheading Example
29131 N.A.
29132
29133
29134 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
29135 @findex -target-list-parameters
29136
29137 @subsubheading Synopsis
29138
29139 @smallexample
29140 -target-list-parameters
29141 @end smallexample
29142
29143 @c ????
29144 @end ignore
29145
29146 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29147
29148 No equivalent.
29149
29150 @subsubheading Example
29151 N.A.
29152
29153
29154 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
29155 @findex -target-select
29156
29157 @subsubheading Synopsis
29158
29159 @smallexample
29160 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
29161 @end smallexample
29162
29163 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
29164
29165 @table @samp
29166 @item @var{type}
29167 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
29168 @item @var{parameters}
29169 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
29170 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
29171 @end table
29172
29173 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
29174 which the target program is, in the following form:
29175
29176 @smallexample
29177 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
29178 args=[@var{arg list}]
29179 @end smallexample
29180
29181 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29182
29183 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
29184
29185 @subsubheading Example
29186
29187 @smallexample
29188 (gdb)
29189 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
29190 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
29191 (gdb)
29192 @end smallexample
29193
29194 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29195 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
29196 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
29197
29198
29199 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
29200 @findex -target-file-put
29201
29202 @subsubheading Synopsis
29203
29204 @smallexample
29205 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
29206 @end smallexample
29207
29208 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
29209 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
29210
29211 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29212
29213 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
29214
29215 @subsubheading Example
29216
29217 @smallexample
29218 (gdb)
29219 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
29220 ^done
29221 (gdb)
29222 @end smallexample
29223
29224
29225 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
29226 @findex -target-file-get
29227
29228 @subsubheading Synopsis
29229
29230 @smallexample
29231 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
29232 @end smallexample
29233
29234 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
29235 on the host system.
29236
29237 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29238
29239 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
29240
29241 @subsubheading Example
29242
29243 @smallexample
29244 (gdb)
29245 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
29246 ^done
29247 (gdb)
29248 @end smallexample
29249
29250
29251 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
29252 @findex -target-file-delete
29253
29254 @subsubheading Synopsis
29255
29256 @smallexample
29257 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
29258 @end smallexample
29259
29260 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
29261
29262 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29263
29264 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
29265
29266 @subsubheading Example
29267
29268 @smallexample
29269 (gdb)
29270 -target-file-delete remotefile
29271 ^done
29272 (gdb)
29273 @end smallexample
29274
29275
29276 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29277 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
29278 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
29279
29280 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
29281
29282 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
29283 @findex -gdb-exit
29284
29285 @subsubheading Synopsis
29286
29287 @smallexample
29288 -gdb-exit
29289 @end smallexample
29290
29291 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
29292
29293 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29294
29295 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
29296
29297 @subsubheading Example
29298
29299 @smallexample
29300 (gdb)
29301 -gdb-exit
29302 ^exit
29303 @end smallexample
29304
29305
29306 @ignore
29307 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
29308 @findex -exec-abort
29309
29310 @subsubheading Synopsis
29311
29312 @smallexample
29313 -exec-abort
29314 @end smallexample
29315
29316 Kill the inferior running program.
29317
29318 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29319
29320 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
29321
29322 @subsubheading Example
29323 N.A.
29324 @end ignore
29325
29326
29327 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
29328 @findex -gdb-set
29329
29330 @subsubheading Synopsis
29331
29332 @smallexample
29333 -gdb-set
29334 @end smallexample
29335
29336 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
29337 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
29338
29339 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29340
29341 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
29342
29343 @subsubheading Example
29344
29345 @smallexample
29346 (gdb)
29347 -gdb-set $foo=3
29348 ^done
29349 (gdb)
29350 @end smallexample
29351
29352
29353 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
29354 @findex -gdb-show
29355
29356 @subsubheading Synopsis
29357
29358 @smallexample
29359 -gdb-show
29360 @end smallexample
29361
29362 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
29363
29364 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29365
29366 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
29367
29368 @subsubheading Example
29369
29370 @smallexample
29371 (gdb)
29372 -gdb-show annotate
29373 ^done,value="0"
29374 (gdb)
29375 @end smallexample
29376
29377 @c @subheading -gdb-source
29378
29379
29380 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
29381 @findex -gdb-version
29382
29383 @subsubheading Synopsis
29384
29385 @smallexample
29386 -gdb-version
29387 @end smallexample
29388
29389 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
29390
29391 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29392
29393 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
29394 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
29395
29396 @subsubheading Example
29397
29398 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
29399 @c box in TeX.
29400 @smallexample
29401 (gdb)
29402 -gdb-version
29403 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
29404 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
29405 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
29406 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
29407 ~ certain conditions.
29408 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
29409 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
29410 ~ details.
29411 ~This GDB was configured as
29412 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
29413 ^done
29414 (gdb)
29415 @end smallexample
29416
29417 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
29418 @findex -list-features
29419
29420 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
29421 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
29422 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
29423 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
29424 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
29425 startup.
29426
29427 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
29428 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
29429 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
29430 is given below.
29431
29432 Example output:
29433
29434 @smallexample
29435 (gdb) -list-features
29436 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
29437 @end smallexample
29438
29439 The current list of features is:
29440
29441 @table @samp
29442 @item frozen-varobjs
29443 Indicates presence of the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
29444 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
29445 of @code{-varobj-create}.
29446 @item pending-breakpoints
29447 Indicates presence of the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
29448 @item python
29449 Indicates presence of Python scripting support, Python-based
29450 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
29451 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
29452 @item thread-info
29453 Indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
29454 @item data-read-memory-bytes
29455 Indicates presense of the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
29456 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
29457
29458 @end table
29459
29460 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
29461 @findex -list-target-features
29462
29463 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
29464 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
29465 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
29466 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
29467 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
29468 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
29469 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
29470 Example output:
29471
29472 @smallexample
29473 (gdb) -list-features
29474 ^done,result=["async"]
29475 @end smallexample
29476
29477 The current list of features is:
29478
29479 @table @samp
29480 @item async
29481 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
29482 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
29483 while the target is running.
29484
29485 @item reverse
29486 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
29487 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
29488
29489 @end table
29490
29491 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
29492 @findex -list-thread-groups
29493
29494 @subheading Synopsis
29495
29496 @smallexample
29497 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
29498 @end smallexample
29499
29500 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
29501 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
29502 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
29503 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
29504 top-level thread groups.
29505
29506 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
29507 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
29508 available on the target.
29509
29510 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
29511 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
29512 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
29513 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
29514 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
29515 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
29516 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
29517 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
29518
29519 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
29520 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
29521 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
29522 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
29523 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
29524 @samp{threads} field.
29525
29526 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
29527 the following caveats:
29528
29529 @itemize @bullet
29530 @item
29531 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
29532 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
29533 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
29534
29535 @item
29536 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
29537 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
29538 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
29539 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
29540 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
29541 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
29542
29543 @end itemize
29544
29545 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
29546 have the following fields:
29547
29548 @table @code
29549 @item id
29550 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
29551 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
29552 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
29553
29554 @item type
29555 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
29556 valid type.
29557
29558 @item pid
29559 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
29560 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
29561
29562 @item num_children
29563 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
29564 absent for an available thread group.
29565
29566 @item threads
29567 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
29568 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
29569 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
29570
29571 @item cores
29572 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
29573 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
29574 such information is not available.
29575
29576 @item executable
29577 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
29578 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
29579 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
29580
29581 @end table
29582
29583 @subheading Example
29584
29585 @smallexample
29586 @value{GDBP}
29587 -list-thread-groups
29588 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
29589 -list-thread-groups 17
29590 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
29591 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
29592 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
29593 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
29594 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
29595 -list-thread-groups --available
29596 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
29597 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
29598 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
29599 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
29600 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
29601 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
29602 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
29603 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
29604 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
29605 @end smallexample
29606
29607
29608 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
29609 @findex -add-inferior
29610
29611 @subheading Synopsis
29612
29613 @smallexample
29614 -add-inferior
29615 @end smallexample
29616
29617 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
29618 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
29619 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
29620 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
29621 field, @samp{thread-group}, whose value is the identifier of the
29622 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
29623
29624 @subheading Example
29625
29626 @smallexample
29627 @value{GDBP}
29628 -add-inferior
29629 ^done,thread-group="i3"
29630 @end smallexample
29631
29632 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
29633 @findex -interpreter-exec
29634
29635 @subheading Synopsis
29636
29637 @smallexample
29638 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
29639 @end smallexample
29640 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
29641
29642 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
29643
29644 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
29645
29646 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
29647
29648 @subheading Example
29649
29650 @smallexample
29651 (gdb)
29652 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
29653 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
29654 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
29655 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
29656 ^done
29657 (gdb)
29658 @end smallexample
29659
29660 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
29661 @findex -inferior-tty-set
29662
29663 @subheading Synopsis
29664
29665 @smallexample
29666 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
29667 @end smallexample
29668
29669 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
29670
29671 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
29672
29673 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
29674
29675 @subheading Example
29676
29677 @smallexample
29678 (gdb)
29679 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
29680 ^done
29681 (gdb)
29682 @end smallexample
29683
29684 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
29685 @findex -inferior-tty-show
29686
29687 @subheading Synopsis
29688
29689 @smallexample
29690 -inferior-tty-show
29691 @end smallexample
29692
29693 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
29694
29695 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
29696
29697 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
29698
29699 @subheading Example
29700
29701 @smallexample
29702 (gdb)
29703 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
29704 ^done
29705 (gdb)
29706 -inferior-tty-show
29707 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
29708 (gdb)
29709 @end smallexample
29710
29711 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
29712 @findex -enable-timings
29713
29714 @subheading Synopsis
29715
29716 @smallexample
29717 -enable-timings [yes | no]
29718 @end smallexample
29719
29720 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
29721 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
29722 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
29723 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
29724
29725 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
29726
29727 No equivalent.
29728
29729 @subheading Example
29730
29731 @smallexample
29732 (gdb)
29733 -enable-timings
29734 ^done
29735 (gdb)
29736 -break-insert main
29737 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29738 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
29739 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
29740 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
29741 (gdb)
29742 -enable-timings no
29743 ^done
29744 (gdb)
29745 -exec-run
29746 ^running
29747 (gdb)
29748 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
29749 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
29750 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
29751 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
29752 (gdb)
29753 @end smallexample
29754
29755 @node Annotations
29756 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
29757
29758 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
29759 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
29760 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
29761 relatively high level.
29762
29763 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
29764 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
29765
29766 @ignore
29767 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
29768 @end ignore
29769
29770 @menu
29771 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
29772 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
29773 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
29774 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
29775 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
29776 * Annotations for Running::
29777 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
29778 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
29779 @end menu
29780
29781 @node Annotations Overview
29782 @section What is an Annotation?
29783 @cindex annotations
29784
29785 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
29786 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
29787 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
29788 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
29789 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
29790 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
29791 cannot contain newline characters.
29792
29793 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
29794 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
29795 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
29796 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
29797 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
29798 means those three characters as output.
29799
29800 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
29801 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
29802 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
29803 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
29804 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
29805 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
29806 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
29807 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
29808 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
29809
29810 @table @code
29811 @kindex set annotate
29812 @item set annotate @var{level}
29813 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
29814 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
29815
29816 @item show annotate
29817 @kindex show annotate
29818 Show the current annotation level.
29819 @end table
29820
29821 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
29822
29823 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
29824
29825 @smallexample
29826 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
29827 GNU gdb 6.0
29828 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
29829 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
29830 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
29831 under certain conditions.
29832 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
29833 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
29834 for details.
29835 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
29836
29837 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
29838 (@value{GDBP})
29839 ^Z^Zprompt
29840 @kbd{quit}
29841
29842 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
29843 $
29844 @end smallexample
29845
29846 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
29847 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
29848 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
29849 output from @value{GDBN}.
29850
29851 @node Server Prefix
29852 @section The Server Prefix
29853 @cindex server prefix
29854
29855 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
29856 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
29857 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
29858 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
29859 a transparent manner.
29860
29861 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
29862 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
29863 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
29864 @code{print} command.
29865
29866 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
29867 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
29868
29869 @node Prompting
29870 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
29871
29872 @cindex annotations for prompts
29873 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
29874 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
29875 over, etc.
29876
29877 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
29878 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
29879 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
29880 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
29881 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
29882 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
29883 features the following annotations:
29884
29885 @smallexample
29886 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
29887 ^Z^Zprompt
29888 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
29889 @end smallexample
29890
29891 The input types are
29892
29893 @table @code
29894 @findex pre-prompt annotation
29895 @findex prompt annotation
29896 @findex post-prompt annotation
29897 @item prompt
29898 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
29899
29900 @findex pre-commands annotation
29901 @findex commands annotation
29902 @findex post-commands annotation
29903 @item commands
29904 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
29905 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
29906
29907 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
29908 @findex overload-choice annotation
29909 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
29910 @item overload-choice
29911 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
29912
29913 @findex pre-query annotation
29914 @findex query annotation
29915 @findex post-query annotation
29916 @item query
29917 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
29918
29919 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
29920 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
29921 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
29922 @item prompt-for-continue
29923 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
29924 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
29925 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
29926 presence of annotations.
29927 @end table
29928
29929 @node Errors
29930 @section Errors
29931 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
29932
29933 @findex quit annotation
29934 @smallexample
29935 ^Z^Zquit
29936 @end smallexample
29937
29938 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
29939
29940 @findex error annotation
29941 @smallexample
29942 ^Z^Zerror
29943 @end smallexample
29944
29945 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
29946
29947 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
29948 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
29949 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
29950 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
29951 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
29952 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
29953 to the top level.
29954
29955 @findex error-begin annotation
29956 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
29957
29958 @smallexample
29959 ^Z^Zerror-begin
29960 @end smallexample
29961
29962 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
29963 message.
29964
29965 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
29966 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
29967 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
29968
29969 @node Invalidation
29970 @section Invalidation Notices
29971
29972 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
29973 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
29974 changed.
29975
29976 @table @code
29977 @findex frames-invalid annotation
29978 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
29979
29980 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
29981 have changed.
29982
29983 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
29984 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
29985
29986 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
29987 deleted a breakpoint.
29988 @end table
29989
29990 @node Annotations for Running
29991 @section Running the Program
29992 @cindex annotations for running programs
29993
29994 @findex starting annotation
29995 @findex stopping annotation
29996 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
29997 @code{step} or @code{continue},
29998
29999 @smallexample
30000 ^Z^Zstarting
30001 @end smallexample
30002
30003 is output. When the program stops,
30004
30005 @smallexample
30006 ^Z^Zstopped
30007 @end smallexample
30008
30009 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
30010 annotations describe how the program stopped.
30011
30012 @table @code
30013 @findex exited annotation
30014 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
30015 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
30016 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
30017
30018 @findex signalled annotation
30019 @findex signal-name annotation
30020 @findex signal-name-end annotation
30021 @findex signal-string annotation
30022 @findex signal-string-end annotation
30023 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
30024 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
30025 annotation continues:
30026
30027 @smallexample
30028 @var{intro-text}
30029 ^Z^Zsignal-name
30030 @var{name}
30031 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
30032 @var{middle-text}
30033 ^Z^Zsignal-string
30034 @var{string}
30035 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
30036 @var{end-text}
30037 @end smallexample
30038
30039 @noindent
30040 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
30041 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
30042 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
30043 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
30044 user's benefit and have no particular format.
30045
30046 @findex signal annotation
30047 @item ^Z^Zsignal
30048 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
30049 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
30050 terminated with it.
30051
30052 @findex breakpoint annotation
30053 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
30054 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
30055
30056 @findex watchpoint annotation
30057 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
30058 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
30059 @end table
30060
30061 @node Source Annotations
30062 @section Displaying Source
30063 @cindex annotations for source display
30064
30065 @findex source annotation
30066 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
30067
30068 @smallexample
30069 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
30070 @end smallexample
30071
30072 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
30073 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
30074 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
30075 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
30076 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
30077 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
30078 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
30079 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
30080 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
30081 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
30082 depend on the language).
30083
30084 @node JIT Interface
30085 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
30086 @cindex just-in-time compilation
30087 @cindex JIT compilation interface
30088
30089 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
30090 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
30091 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
30092 performance while maintaining platform independence.
30093
30094 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
30095 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
30096 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
30097 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
30098 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
30099 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
30100
30101 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
30102 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
30103 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
30104 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
30105 LLVM JIT.
30106
30107 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
30108 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
30109 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
30110 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
30111 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
30112 out about additional code.
30113
30114 @menu
30115 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
30116 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
30117 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
30118 @end menu
30119
30120 @node Declarations
30121 @section JIT Declarations
30122
30123 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
30124 implement the interface:
30125
30126 @smallexample
30127 typedef enum
30128 @{
30129 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
30130 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
30131 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
30132 @} jit_actions_t;
30133
30134 struct jit_code_entry
30135 @{
30136 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
30137 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
30138 const char *symfile_addr;
30139 uint64_t symfile_size;
30140 @};
30141
30142 struct jit_descriptor
30143 @{
30144 uint32_t version;
30145 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
30146 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
30147 uint32_t action_flag;
30148 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
30149 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
30150 @};
30151
30152 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
30153 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
30154
30155 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
30156 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
30157 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
30158 @end smallexample
30159
30160 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
30161 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
30162 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
30163
30164 @node Registering Code
30165 @section Registering Code
30166
30167 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
30168
30169 @itemize @bullet
30170 @item
30171 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
30172 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
30173
30174 @item
30175 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
30176 file.
30177
30178 @item
30179 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
30180
30181 @item
30182 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
30183
30184 @item
30185 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
30186 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
30187 @end itemize
30188
30189 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
30190 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
30191 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
30192 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
30193
30194 @node Unregistering Code
30195 @section Unregistering Code
30196
30197 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
30198
30199 @itemize @bullet
30200 @item
30201 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
30202
30203 @item
30204 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
30205
30206 @item
30207 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
30208 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
30209 @end itemize
30210
30211 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
30212 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
30213
30214 @node GDB Bugs
30215 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
30216 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
30217 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
30218
30219 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
30220
30221 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
30222 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
30223 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
30224 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
30225
30226 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
30227 information that enables us to fix the bug.
30228
30229 @menu
30230 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
30231 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
30232 @end menu
30233
30234 @node Bug Criteria
30235 @section Have You Found a Bug?
30236 @cindex bug criteria
30237
30238 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
30239
30240 @itemize @bullet
30241 @cindex fatal signal
30242 @cindex debugger crash
30243 @cindex crash of debugger
30244 @item
30245 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
30246 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
30247
30248 @cindex error on valid input
30249 @item
30250 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
30251 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
30252 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
30253
30254 @cindex invalid input
30255 @item
30256 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
30257 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
30258 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
30259 for traditional practice''.
30260
30261 @item
30262 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
30263 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
30264 @end itemize
30265
30266 @node Bug Reporting
30267 @section How to Report Bugs
30268 @cindex bug reports
30269 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
30270
30271 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
30272 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
30273 contact that organization first.
30274
30275 You can find contact information for many support companies and
30276 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
30277 distribution.
30278 @c should add a web page ref...
30279
30280 @ifset BUGURL
30281 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
30282 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
30283 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
30284 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
30285 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
30286 be used.
30287
30288 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
30289 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
30290 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
30291 @samp{bug-gdb}.
30292
30293 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
30294 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
30295 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
30296 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
30297 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
30298 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
30299 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
30300 bug reports to the mailing list.
30301 @end ifset
30302 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
30303 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
30304 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
30305 @end ifclear
30306 @end ifset
30307
30308 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
30309 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
30310 fact or leave it out, state it!
30311
30312 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
30313 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
30314 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
30315 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
30316 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
30317 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
30318 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
30319 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
30320 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
30321
30322 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
30323 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
30324 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
30325 self-contained.
30326
30327 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
30328 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
30329 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
30330 bugs properly.
30331
30332 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
30333
30334 @itemize @bullet
30335 @item
30336 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
30337 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
30338 version}.
30339
30340 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
30341 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
30342
30343 @item
30344 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
30345 version number.
30346
30347 @item
30348 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
30349 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
30350
30351 @item
30352 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
30353 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
30354 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
30355 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
30356 those compilers.
30357
30358 @item
30359 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
30360 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
30361 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
30362 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
30363
30364 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
30365 and then we might not encounter the bug.
30366
30367 @item
30368 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
30369 reproduce the bug.
30370
30371 @item
30372 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
30373 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
30374
30375 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
30376 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
30377 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
30378 a chance to make a mistake.
30379
30380 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
30381 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
30382 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
30383 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
30384 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
30385 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
30386 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
30387 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
30388
30389 @pindex script
30390 @cindex recording a session script
30391 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
30392 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
30393 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
30394 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
30395
30396 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
30397 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
30398
30399 @item
30400 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
30401 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
30402 it by context, not by line number.
30403
30404 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
30405 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
30406
30407 @end itemize
30408
30409 Here are some things that are not necessary:
30410
30411 @itemize @bullet
30412 @item
30413 A description of the envelope of the bug.
30414
30415 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
30416 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
30417 changes will not affect it.
30418
30419 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
30420 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
30421 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
30422 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
30423
30424 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
30425 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
30426 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
30427 less time, and so on.
30428
30429 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
30430 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
30431
30432 @item
30433 A patch for the bug.
30434
30435 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
30436 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
30437 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
30438 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
30439
30440 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
30441 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
30442 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
30443 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
30444
30445 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
30446 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
30447 help us to understand.
30448
30449 @item
30450 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
30451
30452 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
30453 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
30454 @end itemize
30455
30456 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
30457 @c and consists of the two following files:
30458 @c rluser.texinfo
30459 @c inc-hist.texinfo
30460 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
30461 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
30462 @include rluser.texi
30463 @include inc-hist.texinfo
30464
30465
30466 @node Formatting Documentation
30467 @appendix Formatting Documentation
30468
30469 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
30470 @cindex reference card
30471 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
30472 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
30473 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
30474 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
30475 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
30476 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
30477
30478 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
30479 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
30480
30481 @smallexample
30482 make refcard.dvi
30483 @end smallexample
30484
30485 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
30486 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
30487 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
30488 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
30489 your @sc{dvi} output program.
30490
30491 @cindex documentation
30492
30493 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
30494 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
30495 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
30496 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
30497 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
30498 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
30499
30500 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
30501 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
30502 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
30503 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
30504 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
30505 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
30506 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
30507 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
30508
30509 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
30510 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
30511 @code{makeinfo}.
30512
30513 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
30514 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
30515 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
30516
30517 @smallexample
30518 cd gdb
30519 make gdb.info
30520 @end smallexample
30521
30522 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
30523 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
30524 Texinfo definitions file.
30525
30526 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
30527 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
30528 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
30529 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
30530 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
30531 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
30532 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
30533
30534 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
30535 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
30536 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
30537 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
30538 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
30539 directory.
30540
30541 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
30542 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
30543 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
30544 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
30545
30546 @smallexample
30547 make gdb.dvi
30548 @end smallexample
30549
30550 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
30551
30552 @node Installing GDB
30553 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
30554 @cindex installation
30555
30556 @menu
30557 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
30558 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
30559 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
30560 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
30561 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
30562 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
30563 @end menu
30564
30565 @node Requirements
30566 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
30567 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
30568
30569 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
30570 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
30571
30572 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
30573 @table @asis
30574 @item ISO C90 compiler
30575 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
30576 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
30577
30578 @end table
30579
30580 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
30581 @table @asis
30582 @item Expat
30583 @anchor{Expat}
30584 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
30585 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
30586 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
30587 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
30588 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
30589 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
30590
30591 Expat is used for:
30592
30593 @itemize @bullet
30594 @item
30595 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
30596 @item
30597 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
30598 @item
30599 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
30600 @item
30601 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
30602 @end itemize
30603
30604 @item zlib
30605 @cindex compressed debug sections
30606 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
30607 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
30608 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
30609 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
30610 information in such binaries.
30611
30612 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
30613 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
30614 @url{http://zlib.net}.
30615
30616 @item iconv
30617 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
30618 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
30619 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
30620 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
30621
30622 On systems with @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
30623 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
30624 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
30625
30626 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
30627 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
30628 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
30629 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
30630 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
30631 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
30632 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
30633 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
30634 @end table
30635
30636 @node Running Configure
30637 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
30638 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
30639 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
30640 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
30641 build the @code{gdb} program.
30642 @iftex
30643 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
30644 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
30645 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
30646 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
30647 @end iftex
30648
30649 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
30650 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
30651 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
30652
30653 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
30654 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
30655
30656 @table @code
30657 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
30658 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
30659
30660 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
30661 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
30662
30663 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
30664 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
30665
30666 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
30667 @sc{gnu} include files
30668
30669 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
30670 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
30671
30672 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
30673 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
30674
30675 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
30676 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
30677
30678 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
30679 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
30680
30681 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
30682 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
30683 @end table
30684
30685 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
30686 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
30687 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
30688
30689 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
30690 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
30691 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
30692 argument.
30693
30694 For example:
30695
30696 @smallexample
30697 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
30698 ./configure @var{host}
30699 make
30700 @end smallexample
30701
30702 @noindent
30703 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
30704 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
30705 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
30706 correct value by examining your system.)
30707
30708 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
30709 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
30710 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
30711 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
30712
30713 @need 750
30714 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
30715 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
30716 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
30717
30718 @smallexample
30719 sh configure @var{host}
30720 @end smallexample
30721
30722 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
30723 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
30724 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
30725 @file{configure}
30726 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
30727 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
30728
30729 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
30730 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
30731 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
30732 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
30733 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
30734 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
30735 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
30736 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
30737 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
30738
30739 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
30740 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
30741 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
30742 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
30743 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
30744
30745 @node Separate Objdir
30746 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
30747
30748 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
30749 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
30750 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
30751 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
30752 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
30753 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
30754 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
30755 program specified there.
30756
30757 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
30758 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
30759 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
30760 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
30761 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
30762 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
30763
30764 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
30765 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
30766
30767 @smallexample
30768 @group
30769 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
30770 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
30771 cd ../gdb-sun4
30772 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
30773 make
30774 @end group
30775 @end smallexample
30776
30777 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
30778 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
30779 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
30780 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
30781 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
30782 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
30783
30784 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
30785 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
30786 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
30787 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
30788 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
30789
30790 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
30791 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
30792 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
30793 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
30794 You specify a cross-debugging target by
30795 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
30796
30797 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
30798 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
30799 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
30800
30801 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
30802 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
30803 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
30804 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
30805 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
30806
30807 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
30808 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
30809 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
30810 with each other.
30811
30812 @node Config Names
30813 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
30814
30815 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
30816 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
30817 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
30818 of information in the following pattern:
30819
30820 @smallexample
30821 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
30822 @end smallexample
30823
30824 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
30825 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
30826 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
30827
30828 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
30829 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
30830 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
30831 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
30832 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
30833 abbreviations---for example:
30834
30835 @smallexample
30836 % sh config.sub i386-linux
30837 i386-pc-linux-gnu
30838 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
30839 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
30840 % sh config.sub hp9k700
30841 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
30842 % sh config.sub sun4
30843 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
30844 % sh config.sub sun3
30845 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
30846 % sh config.sub i986v
30847 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
30848 @end smallexample
30849
30850 @noindent
30851 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
30852 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
30853
30854 @node Configure Options
30855 @section @file{configure} Options
30856
30857 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
30858 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
30859 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
30860 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
30861
30862 @smallexample
30863 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
30864 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
30865 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
30866 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
30867 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
30868 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
30869 @var{host}
30870 @end smallexample
30871
30872 @noindent
30873 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
30874 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
30875 @samp{--}.
30876
30877 @table @code
30878 @item --help
30879 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
30880
30881 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
30882 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
30883 @file{@var{dir}}.
30884
30885 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
30886 Configure the source to install programs under directory
30887 @file{@var{dir}}.
30888
30889 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
30890 @need 2000
30891 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
30892 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
30893 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
30894 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
30895 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
30896 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
30897 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
30898 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
30899 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
30900 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
30901 @var{dirname}.
30902
30903 @item --norecursion
30904 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
30905 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
30906
30907 @item --target=@var{target}
30908 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
30909 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
30910 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
30911
30912 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
30913
30914 @item @var{host} @dots{}
30915 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
30916
30917 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
30918 @end table
30919
30920 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
30921 needed for special purposes only.
30922
30923 @node System-wide configuration
30924 @section System-wide configuration and settings
30925 @cindex system-wide init file
30926
30927 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
30928 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
30929 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
30930
30931 Here is the corresponding configure option:
30932
30933 @table @code
30934 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
30935 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
30936 @var{file}.
30937 @end table
30938
30939 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
30940 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
30941
30942 @itemize @bullet
30943 @item
30944 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
30945 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
30946 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
30947 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
30948 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
30949 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
30950
30951 @item
30952 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
30953 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
30954 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
30955 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
30956 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
30957 @end itemize
30958
30959 @node Maintenance Commands
30960 @appendix Maintenance Commands
30961 @cindex maintenance commands
30962 @cindex internal commands
30963
30964 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
30965 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
30966 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
30967 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
30968 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
30969
30970 @table @code
30971 @kindex maint agent
30972 @kindex maint agent-eval
30973 @item maint agent @var{expression}
30974 @itemx maint agent-eval @var{expression}
30975 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
30976 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
30977 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
30978 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
30979 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
30980 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
30981 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
30982 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
30983 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
30984 addition and return the sum.
30985
30986 @kindex maint info breakpoints
30987 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
30988 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
30989 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
30990 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
30991 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
30992 is shown:
30993
30994 @table @code
30995 @item breakpoint
30996 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
30997
30998 @item watchpoint
30999 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
31000
31001 @item longjmp
31002 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
31003 @code{longjmp} calls.
31004
31005 @item longjmp resume
31006 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
31007
31008 @item until
31009 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
31010
31011 @item finish
31012 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
31013
31014 @item shlib events
31015 Shared library events.
31016
31017 @end table
31018
31019 @kindex set displaced-stepping
31020 @kindex show displaced-stepping
31021 @cindex displaced stepping support
31022 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
31023 @item set displaced-stepping
31024 @itemx show displaced-stepping
31025 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
31026 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
31027 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
31028 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
31029 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
31030
31031 @table @code
31032 @item set displaced-stepping on
31033 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
31034 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
31035
31036 @item set displaced-stepping off
31037 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
31038 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
31039
31040 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
31041 @item set displaced-stepping auto
31042 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
31043 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
31044 architecture supports displaced stepping.
31045 @end table
31046
31047 @kindex maint check-symtabs
31048 @item maint check-symtabs
31049 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
31050
31051 @kindex maint cplus first_component
31052 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
31053 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
31054
31055 @kindex maint cplus namespace
31056 @item maint cplus namespace
31057 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
31058
31059 @kindex maint demangle
31060 @item maint demangle @var{name}
31061 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
31062
31063 @kindex maint deprecate
31064 @kindex maint undeprecate
31065 @cindex deprecated commands
31066 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
31067 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
31068 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
31069 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
31070 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
31071 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
31072 the replacement as part of the warning.
31073
31074 @kindex maint dump-me
31075 @item maint dump-me
31076 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
31077 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
31078 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
31079 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
31080
31081 @kindex maint internal-error
31082 @kindex maint internal-warning
31083 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
31084 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
31085 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
31086 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
31087 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
31088 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
31089 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
31090 @value{GDBN} session.
31091
31092 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
31093 used as the text of the error or warning message.
31094
31095 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
31096
31097 @smallexample
31098 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
31099 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
31100 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
31101 debugging may prove unreliable.
31102 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
31103 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
31104 (@value{GDBP})
31105 @end smallexample
31106
31107 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
31108 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
31109
31110 @kindex maint set internal-error
31111 @kindex maint show internal-error
31112 @kindex maint set internal-warning
31113 @kindex maint show internal-warning
31114 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
31115 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
31116 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
31117 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
31118 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
31119 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
31120 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
31121 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
31122 described in the table below.
31123
31124 @table @samp
31125 @item quit
31126 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
31127 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
31128
31129 @item corefile
31130 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
31131 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do.
31132 @end table
31133
31134 @kindex maint packet
31135 @item maint packet @var{text}
31136 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
31137 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
31138 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
31139 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
31140 checksum.
31141
31142 @kindex maint print architecture
31143 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31144 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
31145 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
31146
31147 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
31148 @item maint print c-tdesc
31149 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
31150 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
31151 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
31152
31153 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
31154 @item maint print dummy-frames
31155 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
31156
31157 @smallexample
31158 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
31159 @dots{}
31160 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
31161 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
31162 58 return (a + b);
31163 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
31164 @dots{}
31165 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
31166 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
31167 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
31168 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
31169 (@value{GDBP})
31170 @end smallexample
31171
31172 Takes an optional file parameter.
31173
31174 @kindex maint print registers
31175 @kindex maint print raw-registers
31176 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
31177 @kindex maint print register-groups
31178 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31179 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31180 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31181 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31182 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
31183
31184 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
31185 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
31186 includes the (cooked) value of all registers, including registers which
31187 aren't available on the target nor visible to user; and the
31188 command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
31189 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
31190 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
31191
31192 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
31193 write the information.
31194
31195 @kindex maint print reggroups
31196 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
31197 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
31198 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
31199 information.
31200
31201 The register groups info looks like this:
31202
31203 @smallexample
31204 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
31205 Group Type
31206 general user
31207 float user
31208 all user
31209 vector user
31210 system user
31211 save internal
31212 restore internal
31213 @end smallexample
31214
31215 @kindex flushregs
31216 @item flushregs
31217 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
31218
31219 @kindex maint print objfiles
31220 @cindex info for known object files
31221 @item maint print objfiles
31222 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
31223 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
31224 and symtabs.
31225
31226 @kindex maint print section-scripts
31227 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
31228 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
31229 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
31230 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
31231 matching @var{regexp}.
31232 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
31233 and the full path if known.
31234 @xref{.debug_gdb_scripts section}.
31235
31236 @kindex maint print statistics
31237 @cindex bcache statistics
31238 @item maint print statistics
31239 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
31240 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
31241 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
31242 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
31243 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
31244 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
31245 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
31246 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
31247 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
31248 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
31249 lengths.
31250
31251 @kindex maint print target-stack
31252 @cindex target stack description
31253 @item maint print target-stack
31254 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
31255 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
31256 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
31257 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
31258 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
31259 address.
31260
31261 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
31262 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
31263
31264 @kindex maint print type
31265 @cindex type chain of a data type
31266 @item maint print type @var{expr}
31267 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
31268 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
31269 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
31270 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
31271 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
31272
31273 @kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
31274 @kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
31275 @item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
31276 @item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
31277 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
31278 information.
31279
31280 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
31281 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
31282 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
31283 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
31284 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
31285 always see the disassembly form.
31286
31287 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
31288
31289 @smallexample
31290 (gdb) info addr argc
31291 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
31292 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
31293 @end smallexample
31294
31295 For more information on these expressions, see
31296 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
31297
31298 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
31299 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
31300 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
31301 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
31302 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
31303
31304 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
31305 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
31306 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
31307 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
31308 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
31309 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
31310 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
31311 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
31312 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
31313
31314 @kindex maint set profile
31315 @kindex maint show profile
31316 @cindex profiling GDB
31317 @item maint set profile
31318 @itemx maint show profile
31319 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
31320
31321 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
31322 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
31323 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
31324 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
31325 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
31326 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
31327 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
31328
31329 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
31330 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
31331
31332 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
31333 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
31334 @cindex hardware debug registers
31335 @item maint set show-debug-regs
31336 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
31337 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
31338 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
31339 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
31340 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
31341 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
31342
31343 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
31344 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
31345 @item maint set show-all-tib
31346 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
31347 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
31348 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
31349 command.
31350
31351 @kindex maint space
31352 @cindex memory used by commands
31353 @item maint space
31354 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
31355 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
31356 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
31357 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
31358 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
31359
31360 @kindex maint time
31361 @cindex time of command execution
31362 @item maint time
31363 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
31364 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
31365 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
31366 The time is not printed for the commands that run the target, since
31367 there's no mechanism currently to compute how much time was spend
31368 by @value{GDBN} and how much time was spend by the program been debugged.
31369 it's not possibly currently
31370 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
31371 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
31372
31373 @kindex maint translate-address
31374 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
31375 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
31376 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
31377 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
31378 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
31379 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
31380 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
31381
31382 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
31383 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
31384 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
31385
31386 @end table
31387
31388 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
31389 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
31390
31391 @table @code
31392 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
31393 @kindex set watchdog
31394 @cindex watchdog timer
31395 @cindex timeout for commands
31396 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
31397 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
31398 reports and error and the command is aborted.
31399
31400 @item show watchdog
31401 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
31402 @end table
31403
31404 @node Remote Protocol
31405 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
31406
31407 @menu
31408 * Overview::
31409 * Packets::
31410 * Stop Reply Packets::
31411 * General Query Packets::
31412 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
31413 * Tracepoint Packets::
31414 * Host I/O Packets::
31415 * Interrupts::
31416 * Notification Packets::
31417 * Remote Non-Stop::
31418 * Packet Acknowledgment::
31419 * Examples::
31420 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
31421 * Library List Format::
31422 * Memory Map Format::
31423 * Thread List Format::
31424 @end menu
31425
31426 @node Overview
31427 @section Overview
31428
31429 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
31430 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
31431 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
31432 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
31433
31434 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
31435 transmitted and received data, respectively.
31436
31437 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
31438 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
31439 @cindex remote serial protocol
31440 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
31441 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
31442 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
31443 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
31444 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
31445
31446 @smallexample
31447 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
31448 @end smallexample
31449 @noindent
31450
31451 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
31452 @noindent
31453 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
31454 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
31455 eight bit unsigned checksum).
31456
31457 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
31458 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
31459
31460 @smallexample
31461 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
31462 @end smallexample
31463
31464 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
31465 @noindent
31466 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
31467 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
31468 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
31469
31470 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
31471 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
31472 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
31473 retransmission):
31474
31475 @smallexample
31476 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
31477 <- @code{+}
31478 @end smallexample
31479 @noindent
31480
31481 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
31482 once a connection is established.
31483 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
31484
31485 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
31486 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
31487 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
31488 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
31489 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
31490 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
31491 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
31492
31493 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
31494 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
31495 exceptions).
31496
31497 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
31498 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
31499 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
31500 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
31501
31502 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
31503 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
31504 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
31505
31506 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
31507 @anchor{Binary Data}
31508 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
31509 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
31510 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
31511 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
31512 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
31513 binary data.
31514
31515 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
31516 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
31517 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
31518 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
31519 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
31520 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
31521 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
31522 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
31523 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
31524 (described next).
31525
31526 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
31527 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
31528 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
31529 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
31530 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
31531 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
31532 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
31533 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
31534 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
31535 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
31536 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
31537 3}} more times.
31538
31539 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
31540 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
31541 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
31542 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
31543 @samp{0*"00}.
31544
31545 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
31546 error number. That number is not well defined.
31547
31548 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
31549 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
31550 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
31551 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
31552 on that response.
31553
31554 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
31555 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
31556 optional.
31557
31558 @node Packets
31559 @section Packets
31560
31561 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
31562 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
31563 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
31564 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
31565
31566 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
31567 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
31568 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
31569 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
31570 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
31571 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
31572 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
31573 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
31574 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
31575 @var{baz}.
31576
31577 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
31578 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
31579 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
31580 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
31581 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
31582 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
31583 pick any thread.
31584
31585 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
31586 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
31587 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
31588 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
31589 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
31590 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
31591 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
31592 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
31593 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
31594 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
31595 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
31596 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
31597 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
31598
31599 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
31600 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
31601 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
31602 more information.
31603
31604 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
31605 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
31606
31607 Here are the packet descriptions.
31608
31609 @table @samp
31610
31611 @item !
31612 @cindex @samp{!} packet
31613 @anchor{extended mode}
31614 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
31615 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
31616 debugged.
31617
31618 Reply:
31619 @table @samp
31620 @item OK
31621 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
31622 @end table
31623
31624 @item ?
31625 @cindex @samp{?} packet
31626 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
31627 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
31628 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
31629
31630 Reply:
31631 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31632
31633 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
31634 @cindex @samp{A} packet
31635 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
31636 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
31637 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
31638
31639 Reply:
31640 @table @samp
31641 @item OK
31642 The arguments were set.
31643 @item E @var{NN}
31644 An error occurred.
31645 @end table
31646
31647 @item b @var{baud}
31648 @cindex @samp{b} packet
31649 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
31650 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
31651
31652 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
31653 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
31654 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
31655
31656 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
31657 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
31658 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
31659 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
31660 of view, nothing actually happened.}
31661
31662 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
31663 @cindex @samp{B} packet
31664 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
31665 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
31666
31667 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
31668 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
31669
31670 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
31671 @anchor{bc}
31672 @item bc
31673 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
31674 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31675
31676 Reply:
31677 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31678
31679 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
31680 @anchor{bs}
31681 @item bs
31682 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
31683 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31684
31685 Reply:
31686 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31687
31688 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
31689 @cindex @samp{c} packet
31690 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
31691 resume at current address.
31692
31693 Reply:
31694 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31695
31696 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
31697 @cindex @samp{C} packet
31698 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
31699 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
31700
31701 Reply:
31702 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31703
31704 @item d
31705 @cindex @samp{d} packet
31706 Toggle debug flag.
31707
31708 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
31709 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
31710
31711 @item D
31712 @itemx D;@var{pid}
31713 @cindex @samp{D} packet
31714 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
31715 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
31716 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
31717
31718 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
31719 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
31720 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
31721 big-endian hex string.
31722
31723 Reply:
31724 @table @samp
31725 @item OK
31726 for success
31727 @item E @var{NN}
31728 for an error
31729 @end table
31730
31731 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
31732 @cindex @samp{F} packet
31733 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
31734 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
31735 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
31736
31737 @item g
31738 @anchor{read registers packet}
31739 @cindex @samp{g} packet
31740 Read general registers.
31741
31742 Reply:
31743 @table @samp
31744 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
31745 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
31746 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
31747 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
31748 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
31749 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
31750 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
31751 @item E @var{NN}
31752 for an error.
31753 @end table
31754
31755 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
31756 @cindex @samp{G} packet
31757 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
31758 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
31759
31760 Reply:
31761 @table @samp
31762 @item OK
31763 for success
31764 @item E @var{NN}
31765 for an error
31766 @end table
31767
31768 @item H @var{c} @var{thread-id}
31769 @cindex @samp{H} packet
31770 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
31771 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
31772 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
31773 operations. The thread designator @var{thread-id} has the format and
31774 interpretation described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
31775
31776 Reply:
31777 @table @samp
31778 @item OK
31779 for success
31780 @item E @var{NN}
31781 for an error
31782 @end table
31783
31784 @c FIXME: JTC:
31785 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
31786 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
31787 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
31788 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
31789 @c described. For example:
31790 @c
31791 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
31792 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
31793 @c otherwise returns current registers.
31794 @c
31795 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
31796 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
31797 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
31798
31799 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
31800 @anchor{cycle step packet}
31801 @cindex @samp{i} packet
31802 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
31803 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
31804 step starting at that address.
31805
31806 @item I
31807 @cindex @samp{I} packet
31808 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
31809 step packet}.
31810
31811 @item k
31812 @cindex @samp{k} packet
31813 Kill request.
31814
31815 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
31816 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
31817 thread?)}.
31818
31819 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
31820 @cindex @samp{m} packet
31821 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
31822 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
31823
31824 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
31825 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
31826 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
31827 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
31828 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
31829 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
31830 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
31831 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
31832
31833 Reply:
31834 @table @samp
31835 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
31836 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
31837 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
31838 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
31839 @item E @var{NN}
31840 @var{NN} is errno
31841 @end table
31842
31843 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
31844 @cindex @samp{M} packet
31845 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
31846 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
31847 hexadecimal number.
31848
31849 Reply:
31850 @table @samp
31851 @item OK
31852 for success
31853 @item E @var{NN}
31854 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
31855 written).
31856 @end table
31857
31858 @item p @var{n}
31859 @cindex @samp{p} packet
31860 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
31861 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
31862 register value is encoded.
31863
31864 Reply:
31865 @table @samp
31866 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
31867 the register's value
31868 @item E @var{NN}
31869 for an error
31870 @item
31871 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
31872 @end table
31873
31874 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
31875 @anchor{write register packet}
31876 @cindex @samp{P} packet
31877 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
31878 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
31879 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
31880
31881 Reply:
31882 @table @samp
31883 @item OK
31884 for success
31885 @item E @var{NN}
31886 for an error
31887 @end table
31888
31889 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
31890 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
31891 @cindex @samp{q} packet
31892 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
31893 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
31894 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
31895
31896 @item r
31897 @cindex @samp{r} packet
31898 Reset the entire system.
31899
31900 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
31901
31902 @item R @var{XX}
31903 @cindex @samp{R} packet
31904 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
31905 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
31906
31907 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
31908
31909 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
31910 @cindex @samp{s} packet
31911 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
31912 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
31913
31914 Reply:
31915 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31916
31917 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
31918 @anchor{step with signal packet}
31919 @cindex @samp{S} packet
31920 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
31921 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
31922
31923 Reply:
31924 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
31925
31926 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
31927 @cindex @samp{t} packet
31928 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
31929 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
31930 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
31931
31932 @item T @var{thread-id}
31933 @cindex @samp{T} packet
31934 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
31935
31936 Reply:
31937 @table @samp
31938 @item OK
31939 thread is still alive
31940 @item E @var{NN}
31941 thread is dead
31942 @end table
31943
31944 @item v
31945 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
31946 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
31947
31948 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
31949 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
31950 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
31951 The process ID is a
31952 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
31953 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
31954 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
31955
31956 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
31957 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
31958 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
31959 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
31960 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
31961 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
31962 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
31963 @c stopping or restarting threads.
31964
31965 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
31966
31967 Reply:
31968 @table @samp
31969 @item E @var{nn}
31970 for an error
31971 @item @r{Any stop packet}
31972 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
31973 @item OK
31974 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
31975 @end table
31976
31977 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
31978 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
31979 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
31980 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
31981 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
31982 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
31983 in their current state in non-stop mode.
31984 Specifying multiple
31985 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
31986 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
31987
31988 Currently supported actions are:
31989
31990 @table @samp
31991 @item c
31992 Continue.
31993 @item C @var{sig}
31994 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
31995 @item s
31996 Step.
31997 @item S @var{sig}
31998 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
31999 @item t
32000 Stop.
32001 @end table
32002
32003 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
32004 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
32005 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
32006
32007 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
32008 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
32009 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
32010 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
32011 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
32012 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
32013 as an implementation detail.
32014
32015 Reply:
32016 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
32017
32018 @item vCont?
32019 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
32020 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
32021
32022 Reply:
32023 @table @samp
32024 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
32025 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
32026 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
32027 @item
32028 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
32029 @end table
32030
32031 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
32032 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
32033 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
32034 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
32035
32036 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
32037 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
32038 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
32039 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
32040 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
32041 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
32042 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
32043 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
32044 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
32045 packet is received.
32046
32047 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
32048 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
32049 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
32050 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
32051 @var{thread-id}.
32052
32053 Reply:
32054 @table @samp
32055 @item OK
32056 for success
32057 @item E @var{NN}
32058 for an error
32059 @end table
32060
32061 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
32062 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
32063 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
32064 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
32065 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
32066 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
32067 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
32068 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
32069 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
32070 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
32071 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
32072 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
32073
32074
32075 Reply:
32076 @table @samp
32077 @item OK
32078 for success
32079 @item E.memtype
32080 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
32081 @item E @var{NN}
32082 for an error
32083 @end table
32084
32085 @item vFlashDone
32086 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
32087 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
32088 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
32089 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
32090 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
32091 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
32092 request is completed.
32093
32094 @item vKill;@var{pid}
32095 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
32096 Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
32097 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
32098 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
32099 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
32100
32101 Reply:
32102 @table @samp
32103 @item E @var{nn}
32104 for an error
32105 @item OK
32106 for success
32107 @end table
32108
32109 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
32110 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
32111 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
32112 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
32113 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
32114 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
32115 state.
32116
32117 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
32118
32119 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
32120
32121 Reply:
32122 @table @samp
32123 @item E @var{nn}
32124 for an error
32125 @item @r{Any stop packet}
32126 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
32127 @end table
32128
32129 @item vStopped
32130 @anchor{vStopped packet}
32131 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
32132
32133 In non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}), acknowledge a previous stop
32134 reply and prompt for the stub to report another one.
32135
32136 Reply:
32137 @table @samp
32138 @item @r{Any stop packet}
32139 if there is another unreported stop event (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
32140 @item OK
32141 if there are no unreported stop events
32142 @end table
32143
32144 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
32145 @anchor{X packet}
32146 @cindex @samp{X} packet
32147 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
32148 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
32149 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
32150
32151 Reply:
32152 @table @samp
32153 @item OK
32154 for success
32155 @item E @var{NN}
32156 for an error
32157 @end table
32158
32159 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
32160 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
32161 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
32162 @cindex @samp{z} packet
32163 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
32164 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
32165 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
32166
32167 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
32168 separately.
32169
32170 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
32171 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
32172 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
32173 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
32174 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
32175 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
32176
32177 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32178 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32179 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
32180 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
32181 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
32182 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
32183
32184 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
32185 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
32186 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
32187 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
32188 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
32189 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
32190 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
32191
32192 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
32193 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
32194 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
32195 target, is not defined.}
32196
32197 Reply:
32198 @table @samp
32199 @item OK
32200 success
32201 @item
32202 not supported
32203 @item E @var{NN}
32204 for an error
32205 @end table
32206
32207 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32208 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32209 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
32210 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
32211 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
32212 address @var{addr}.
32213
32214 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
32215 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. @var{kind}
32216 has the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
32217
32218 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
32219 movement.}
32220
32221 Reply:
32222 @table @samp
32223 @item OK
32224 success
32225 @item
32226 not supported
32227 @item E @var{NN}
32228 for an error
32229 @end table
32230
32231 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32232 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32233 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
32234 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
32235 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
32236 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
32237
32238 Reply:
32239 @table @samp
32240 @item OK
32241 success
32242 @item
32243 not supported
32244 @item E @var{NN}
32245 for an error
32246 @end table
32247
32248 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32249 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32250 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
32251 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
32252 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
32253 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
32254
32255 Reply:
32256 @table @samp
32257 @item OK
32258 success
32259 @item
32260 not supported
32261 @item E @var{NN}
32262 for an error
32263 @end table
32264
32265 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32266 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
32267 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
32268 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
32269 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
32270 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
32271
32272 Reply:
32273 @table @samp
32274 @item OK
32275 success
32276 @item
32277 not supported
32278 @item E @var{NN}
32279 for an error
32280 @end table
32281
32282 @end table
32283
32284 @node Stop Reply Packets
32285 @section Stop Reply Packets
32286 @cindex stop reply packets
32287
32288 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
32289 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
32290 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
32291 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
32292 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
32293 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
32294 @value{GDBN} source code.
32295
32296 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
32297 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
32298 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
32299 components.
32300
32301 @table @samp
32302
32303 @item S @var{AA}
32304 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
32305 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
32306 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
32307
32308 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
32309 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
32310 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
32311 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
32312 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
32313 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
32314 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
32315 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
32316
32317 @itemize @bullet
32318 @item
32319 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
32320 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
32321 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
32322 two-digit hex number.
32323
32324 @item
32325 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
32326 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
32327
32328 @item
32329 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
32330 the core on which the stop event was detected.
32331
32332 @item
32333 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
32334 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
32335 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
32336 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
32337
32338 @item
32339 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
32340 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
32341 future.
32342 @end itemize
32343
32344 The currently defined stop reasons are:
32345
32346 @table @samp
32347 @item watch
32348 @itemx rwatch
32349 @itemx awatch
32350 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
32351 hex.
32352
32353 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
32354 @item library
32355 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
32356 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
32357 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
32358
32359 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
32360 @item replaylog
32361 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
32362 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
32363 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
32364 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
32365 for more information.
32366 @end table
32367
32368 @item W @var{AA}
32369 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
32370 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
32371 applicable to certain targets.
32372
32373 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
32374 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
32375 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
32376 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
32377
32378 @item X @var{AA}
32379 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
32380 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
32381
32382 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
32383 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
32384 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
32385 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
32386
32387 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
32388 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
32389 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
32390 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
32391 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
32392
32393 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
32394 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
32395 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
32396 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
32397 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
32398 system calls.
32399
32400 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
32401 this very system call.
32402
32403 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
32404 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
32405 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
32406 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
32407 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
32408 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
32409
32410 @end table
32411
32412 @node General Query Packets
32413 @section General Query Packets
32414 @cindex remote query requests
32415
32416 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
32417 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
32418 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
32419 sending information to and from the stub.
32420
32421 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
32422 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
32423 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
32424 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
32425 conventions:
32426
32427 @itemize @bullet
32428 @item
32429 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
32430 @item
32431 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
32432 letter.
32433 @item
32434 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
32435 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
32436 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
32437 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
32438 @end itemize
32439
32440 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
32441 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
32442 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
32443 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
32444 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
32445 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
32446 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
32447 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
32448 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
32449 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
32450 packet.}.
32451
32452 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
32453 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
32454 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
32455 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
32456 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
32457
32458 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
32459
32460 @table @samp
32461
32462 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
32463 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
32464 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
32465 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
32466 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
32467 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
32468 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
32469 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
32470 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
32471 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
32472 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
32473
32474 @item qC
32475 @cindex current thread, remote request
32476 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
32477 Return the current thread ID.
32478
32479 Reply:
32480 @table @samp
32481 @item QC @var{thread-id}
32482 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
32483 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
32484 @item @r{(anything else)}
32485 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
32486 @end table
32487
32488 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
32489 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
32490 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
32491 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
32492 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
32493 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
32494 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
32495
32496 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
32497 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
32498 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
32499 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
32500 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
32501 detect trailing zeros.
32502
32503 Reply:
32504 @table @samp
32505 @item E @var{NN}
32506 An error (such as memory fault)
32507 @item C @var{crc32}
32508 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
32509 @end table
32510
32511 @item qfThreadInfo
32512 @itemx qsThreadInfo
32513 @cindex list active threads, remote request
32514 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
32515 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
32516 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
32517 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
32518 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
32519 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
32520 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
32521 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
32522
32523 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
32524
32525 Reply:
32526 @table @samp
32527 @item m @var{thread-id}
32528 A single thread ID
32529 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
32530 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
32531 @item l
32532 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
32533 @end table
32534
32535 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
32536 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
32537 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
32538 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
32539 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
32540 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
32541 fields.
32542
32543 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
32544 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
32545 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
32546 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
32547 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
32548
32549 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
32550 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
32551
32552 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
32553 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
32554 information associated with the variable.)
32555
32556 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
32557 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
32558 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
32559 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
32560 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
32561 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
32562
32563 Reply:
32564 @table @samp
32565 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
32566 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
32567 local storage requested.
32568
32569 @item E @var{nn}
32570 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
32571
32572 @item
32573 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
32574 @end table
32575
32576 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
32577 @cindex get thread information block address
32578 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
32579 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
32580
32581 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
32582
32583 Reply:
32584 @table @samp
32585 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
32586 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
32587 thread information block.
32588
32589 @item E @var{nn}
32590 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
32591 address could not be retrieved.
32592
32593 @item
32594 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
32595 @end table
32596
32597 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
32598 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
32599 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
32600 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
32601 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
32602 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
32603 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
32604
32605 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
32606
32607 Reply:
32608 @table @samp
32609 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
32610 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
32611 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
32612 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
32613 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
32614 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
32615 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
32616 @end table
32617
32618 @item qOffsets
32619 @cindex section offsets, remote request
32620 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
32621 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
32622 image.
32623
32624 Reply:
32625 @table @samp
32626 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
32627 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
32628 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
32629 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
32630 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
32631 segments by the supplied offsets.
32632
32633 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
32634 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
32635 to the @code{Bss} section.}
32636
32637 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
32638 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
32639 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
32640 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
32641 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
32642 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
32643 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
32644 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
32645 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
32646 @end table
32647
32648 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
32649 @cindex thread information, remote request
32650 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
32651 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
32652 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
32653 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
32654
32655 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
32656 (see below).
32657
32658 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
32659
32660 @item QNonStop:1
32661 @item QNonStop:0
32662 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
32663 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
32664 @anchor{QNonStop}
32665 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
32666 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
32667
32668 Reply:
32669 @table @samp
32670 @item OK
32671 The request succeeded.
32672
32673 @item E @var{nn}
32674 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
32675
32676 @item
32677 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
32678 the stub.
32679 @end table
32680
32681 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
32682 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
32683 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
32684 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
32685
32686 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
32687 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
32688 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
32689 @anchor{QPassSignals}
32690 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
32691 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
32692 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
32693 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
32694 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
32695 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
32696 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
32697 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
32698 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
32699
32700 Reply:
32701 @table @samp
32702 @item OK
32703 The request succeeded.
32704
32705 @item E @var{nn}
32706 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
32707
32708 @item
32709 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
32710 the stub.
32711 @end table
32712
32713 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
32714 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
32715 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
32716 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
32717
32718 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
32719 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
32720 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
32721 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
32722 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
32723 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
32724 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
32725 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
32726 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
32727
32728 Reply:
32729 @table @samp
32730 @item OK
32731 A command response with no output.
32732 @item @var{OUTPUT}
32733 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
32734 @item E @var{NN}
32735 Indicate a badly formed request.
32736 @item
32737 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
32738 @end table
32739
32740 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
32741 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
32742 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
32743 packets.)
32744
32745 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
32746 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
32747 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
32748 @anchor{qSearch memory}
32749 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
32750 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
32751 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
32752
32753 Reply:
32754 @table @samp
32755 @item 0
32756 The pattern was not found.
32757 @item 1,address
32758 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
32759 @item E @var{NN}
32760 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
32761 @item
32762 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
32763 @end table
32764
32765 @item QStartNoAckMode
32766 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
32767 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
32768 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
32769 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
32770
32771 Reply:
32772 @table @samp
32773 @item OK
32774 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
32775 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
32776 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
32777 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
32778 @item
32779 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
32780 @end table
32781
32782 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
32783 @cindex supported packets, remote query
32784 @cindex features of the remote protocol
32785 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
32786 @anchor{qSupported}
32787 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
32788 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
32789 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
32790 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
32791 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
32792 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
32793 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
32794 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
32795 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
32796 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
32797 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
32798 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
32799 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
32800 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
32801
32802 Reply:
32803 @table @samp
32804 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
32805 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
32806 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
32807 possible forms).
32808 @item
32809 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
32810 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
32811 @end table
32812
32813 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
32814 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
32815 are:
32816
32817 @table @samp
32818 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
32819 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
32820 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
32821 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
32822 @item @var{name}+
32823 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
32824 need an associated value.
32825 @item @var{name}-
32826 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
32827 @item @var{name}?
32828 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
32829 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
32830 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
32831 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
32832 @end table
32833
32834 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
32835 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
32836 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
32837 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
32838 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
32839
32840 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
32841 are defined:
32842
32843 @table @samp
32844 @item multiprocess
32845 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
32846 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
32847 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
32848 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
32849 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
32850
32851 @item xmlRegisters
32852 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
32853 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
32854 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
32855 description.
32856
32857 @item qRelocInsn
32858 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
32859 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
32860 instruction reply packet}).
32861 @end table
32862
32863 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
32864 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
32865 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
32866 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
32867 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
32868 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
32869 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
32870 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
32871 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
32872 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
32873 all the features it supports.
32874
32875 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
32876 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
32877
32878 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
32879 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
32880 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
32881 form response.
32882
32883 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
32884 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
32885 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
32886 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
32887
32888 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
32889 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
32890 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
32891 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
32892 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
32893
32894 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
32895
32896 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
32897 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
32898 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
32899 @item Feature Name
32900 @tab Value Required
32901 @tab Default
32902 @tab Probe Allowed
32903
32904 @item @samp{PacketSize}
32905 @tab Yes
32906 @tab @samp{-}
32907 @tab No
32908
32909 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
32910 @tab No
32911 @tab @samp{-}
32912 @tab Yes
32913
32914 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
32915 @tab No
32916 @tab @samp{-}
32917 @tab Yes
32918
32919 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
32920 @tab No
32921 @tab @samp{-}
32922 @tab Yes
32923
32924 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
32925 @tab No
32926 @tab @samp{-}
32927 @tab Yes
32928
32929 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
32930 @tab No
32931 @tab @samp{-}
32932 @tab Yes
32933
32934 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
32935 @tab No
32936 @tab @samp{-}
32937 @tab Yes
32938
32939 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
32940 @tab No
32941 @tab @samp{-}
32942 @tab Yes
32943
32944 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
32945 @tab No
32946 @tab @samp{-}
32947 @tab Yes
32948
32949 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
32950 @tab No
32951 @tab @samp{-}
32952 @tab Yes
32953
32954 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
32955 @tab No
32956 @tab @samp{-}
32957 @tab Yes
32958
32959
32960 @item @samp{QNonStop}
32961 @tab No
32962 @tab @samp{-}
32963 @tab Yes
32964
32965 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
32966 @tab No
32967 @tab @samp{-}
32968 @tab Yes
32969
32970 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
32971 @tab No
32972 @tab @samp{-}
32973 @tab Yes
32974
32975 @item @samp{multiprocess}
32976 @tab No
32977 @tab @samp{-}
32978 @tab No
32979
32980 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
32981 @tab No
32982 @tab @samp{-}
32983 @tab No
32984
32985 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
32986 @tab No
32987 @tab @samp{-}
32988 @tab No
32989
32990 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
32991 @tab No
32992 @tab @samp{-}
32993 @tab No
32994
32995 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
32996 @tab No
32997 @tab @samp{-}
32998 @tab No
32999
33000 @item @samp{QAllow}
33001 @tab No
33002 @tab @samp{-}
33003 @tab No
33004
33005 @end multitable
33006
33007 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
33008
33009 @table @samp
33010 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
33011 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
33012 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
33013 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
33014 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
33015 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
33016 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
33017 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
33018 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
33019 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
33020
33021 @item qXfer:auxv:read
33022 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
33023 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
33024
33025 @item qXfer:features:read
33026 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
33027 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
33028
33029 @item qXfer:libraries:read
33030 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
33031 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
33032
33033 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
33034 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
33035 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
33036
33037 @item qXfer:sdata:read
33038 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
33039 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
33040
33041 @item qXfer:spu:read
33042 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
33043 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
33044
33045 @item qXfer:spu:write
33046 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
33047 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
33048
33049 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
33050 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
33051 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
33052
33053 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
33054 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
33055 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
33056
33057 @item qXfer:threads:read
33058 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
33059 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
33060
33061 @item QNonStop
33062 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
33063 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
33064
33065 @item QPassSignals
33066 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
33067 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
33068
33069 @item QStartNoAckMode
33070 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
33071 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
33072
33073 @item multiprocess
33074 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
33075 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
33076 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
33077 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
33078 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
33079 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
33080 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
33081 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
33082 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
33083 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
33084 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
33085
33086 @item qXfer:osdata:read
33087 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
33088 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
33089
33090 @item ConditionalTracepoints
33091 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
33092 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
33093
33094 @item ReverseContinue
33095 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
33096 (@pxref{bc}).
33097
33098 @item ReverseStep
33099 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
33100 (@pxref{bs}).
33101
33102 @item TracepointSource
33103 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
33104 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
33105
33106 @item QAllow
33107 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
33108
33109 @item StaticTracepoint
33110 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
33111 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
33112
33113 @end table
33114
33115 @item qSymbol::
33116 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
33117 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
33118 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
33119 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
33120
33121 Reply:
33122 @table @samp
33123 @item OK
33124 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
33125 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
33126 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
33127 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
33128 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
33129 below.
33130 @end table
33131
33132 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
33133 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
33134
33135 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
33136 target has previously requested.
33137
33138 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
33139 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
33140 will be empty.
33141
33142 Reply:
33143 @table @samp
33144 @item OK
33145 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
33146 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
33147 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
33148 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
33149 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
33150 @end table
33151
33152 @item qTBuffer
33153 @item QTBuffer
33154 @item QTDisconnected
33155 @itemx QTDP
33156 @itemx QTDPsrc
33157 @itemx QTDV
33158 @itemx qTfP
33159 @itemx qTfV
33160 @itemx QTFrame
33161 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
33162
33163 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
33164 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
33165 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
33166 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
33167 the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
33168 see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
33169 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
33170 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
33171 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
33172 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
33173 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
33174
33175 Reply:
33176 @table @samp
33177 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
33178 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
33179 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
33180 the thread's attributes.
33181 @end table
33182
33183 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
33184 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
33185 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
33186 packets.)
33187
33188 @item QTSave
33189 @item qTsP
33190 @item qTsV
33191 @itemx QTStart
33192 @itemx QTStop
33193 @itemx QTinit
33194 @itemx QTro
33195 @itemx qTStatus
33196 @itemx qTV
33197 @itemx qTfSTM
33198 @itemx qTsSTM
33199 @itemx qTSTMat
33200 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
33201
33202 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
33203 @cindex read special object, remote request
33204 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
33205 @anchor{qXfer read}
33206 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
33207 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
33208 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
33209 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
33210 additional details about what data to access.
33211
33212 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
33213 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
33214 formats, listed below.
33215
33216 @table @samp
33217 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33218 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
33219 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
33220 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
33221
33222 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33223 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33224
33225 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
33226 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
33227 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
33228 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
33229 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
33230
33231 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33232 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33233
33234 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
33235 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
33236 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
33237 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
33238 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
33239
33240 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
33241 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
33242 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
33243
33244 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33245 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33246
33247 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33248 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
33249 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
33250 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
33251 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
33252
33253 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33254 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33255
33256 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33257 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
33258
33259 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
33260 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
33261 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
33262 Action Lists}.
33263
33264 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33265 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
33266 (@pxref{qSupported}).
33267
33268 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33269 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
33270 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
33271 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
33272 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
33273
33274 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33275 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
33276 (@pxref{qSupported}).
33277
33278 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
33279 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
33280 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
33281 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
33282 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
33283 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
33284 in that context to be accessed.
33285
33286 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33287 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
33288 (@pxref{qSupported}).
33289
33290 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33291 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
33292 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
33293 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
33294 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
33295
33296 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33297 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33298
33299 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
33300 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
33301 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
33302 @xref{Operating System Information}.
33303
33304 @end table
33305
33306 Reply:
33307 @table @samp
33308 @item m @var{data}
33309 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
33310 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
33311 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
33312 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
33313 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
33314 request.
33315
33316 @item l @var{data}
33317 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
33318 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
33319 than the @var{length} in the request.
33320
33321 @item l
33322 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
33323 There is no more data to be read.
33324
33325 @item E00
33326 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
33327
33328 @item E @var{nn}
33329 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
33330 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
33331
33332 @item
33333 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
33334 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
33335 @end table
33336
33337 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
33338 @cindex write data into object, remote request
33339 @anchor{qXfer write}
33340 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
33341 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
33342 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
33343 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
33344 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
33345 to access.
33346
33347 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
33348 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
33349 formats, listed below.
33350
33351 @table @samp
33352 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
33353 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
33354 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
33355 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
33356 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
33357
33358 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33359 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
33360 (@pxref{qSupported}).
33361
33362 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
33363 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
33364 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
33365 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
33366 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
33367 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
33368 in that context to be accessed.
33369
33370 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
33371 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
33372 @end table
33373
33374 Reply:
33375 @table @samp
33376 @item @var{nn}
33377 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
33378 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
33379
33380 @item E00
33381 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
33382
33383 @item E @var{nn}
33384 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
33385 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
33386
33387 @item
33388 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
33389 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
33390 @end table
33391
33392 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
33393 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
33394 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
33395 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
33396 must respond with an empty packet.
33397
33398 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
33399 @cindex query attached, remote request
33400 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
33401 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
33402 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
33403 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
33404 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
33405 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
33406 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
33407
33408 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
33409 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
33410 the @code{quit} command.
33411
33412 Reply:
33413 @table @samp
33414 @item 1
33415 The remote server attached to an existing process.
33416 @item 0
33417 The remote server created a new process.
33418 @item E @var{NN}
33419 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
33420 @end table
33421
33422 @end table
33423
33424 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
33425 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
33426
33427 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
33428 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
33429 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
33430
33431 @subsection ARM
33432
33433 @subsubsection Breakpoint Kinds
33434
33435 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
33436
33437 @table @r
33438
33439 @item 2
33440 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
33441
33442 @item 3
33443 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
33444
33445 @item 4
33446 32-bit ARM mode breakpoint.
33447
33448 @end table
33449
33450 @subsection MIPS
33451
33452 @subsubsection Register Packet Format
33453
33454 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
33455 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
33456 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
33457 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
33458 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
33459 most-significant - least-significant.
33460
33461 @table @r
33462
33463 @item MIPS32
33464
33465 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
33466 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
33467 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
33468
33469 @item MIPS64
33470
33471 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
33472 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
33473 as @code{MIPS32}.
33474
33475 @end table
33476
33477 @node Tracepoint Packets
33478 @section Tracepoint Packets
33479 @cindex tracepoint packets
33480 @cindex packets, tracepoint
33481
33482 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
33483 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33484
33485 @table @samp
33486
33487 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
33488 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
33489 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
33490 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
33491 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
33492 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
33493 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
33494 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
33495 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
33496 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
33497 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
33498 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
33499 actions.
33500
33501 Replies:
33502 @table @samp
33503 @item OK
33504 The packet was understood and carried out.
33505 @item qRelocInsn
33506 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
33507 @item
33508 The packet was not recognized.
33509 @end table
33510
33511 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
33512 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
33513 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
33514 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
33515 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
33516 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
33517 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
33518
33519 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
33520 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
33521 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
33522 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
33523 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
33524 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
33525 tracepoint actions.
33526
33527 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
33528 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
33529 following forms:
33530
33531 @table @samp
33532
33533 @item R @var{mask}
33534 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
33535 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
33536 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
33537 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
33538 not fit in a 32-bit word.
33539
33540 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
33541 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
33542 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
33543 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
33544 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
33545 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
33546 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
33547
33548 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
33549 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
33550 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
33551 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
33552 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
33553 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
33554 packet).
33555
33556 @end table
33557
33558 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
33559 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
33560 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
33561 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
33562 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
33563 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
33564 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
33565 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
33566
33567 Replies:
33568 @table @samp
33569 @item OK
33570 The packet was understood and carried out.
33571 @item qRelocInsn
33572 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
33573 @item
33574 The packet was not recognized.
33575 @end table
33576
33577 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
33578 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
33579 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
33580 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
33581 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. @var{type}
33582 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
33583 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
33584 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
33585
33586 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
33587 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
33588 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
33589 fit in a single packet.
33590 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
33591 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
33592
33593 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
33594 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
33595 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
33596 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
33597
33598 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
33599 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
33600 query packets.
33601
33602 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
33603 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
33604 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
33605 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
33606 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
33607 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
33608 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
33609 be found.
33610
33611 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}
33612 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
33613 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
33614 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
33615 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
33616 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
33617 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
33618 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
33619 mentioned in expressions.
33620
33621 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
33622 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
33623 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
33624 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
33625
33626 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
33627 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
33628 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
33629 one of the following forms:
33630
33631 @table @samp
33632 @item F @var{f}
33633 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
33634 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
33635 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
33636
33637 @item T @var{t}
33638 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
33639 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
33640
33641 @end table
33642
33643 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
33644 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
33645 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
33646 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
33647
33648 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
33649 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
33650 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
33651 is a hexadecimal number.
33652
33653 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
33654 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
33655 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
33656 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
33657 numbers.
33658
33659 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
33660 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
33661 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
33662
33663 @item QTStart
33664 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
33665 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
33666 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
33667 instruction reply packet}).
33668
33669 @item QTStop
33670 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
33671
33672 @item QTinit
33673 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
33674
33675 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
33676 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
33677 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
33678 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
33679
33680 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
33681 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
33682 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
33683 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
33684
33685 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
33686 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
33687 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
33688 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
33689 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
33690
33691 @item qTStatus
33692 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
33693
33694 The reply has the form:
33695
33696 @table @samp
33697
33698 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
33699 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
33700 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
33701 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
33702
33703 @end table
33704
33705 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
33706 explanations as one of the optional fields:
33707
33708 @table @samp
33709
33710 @item tnotrun:0
33711 No trace has been run yet.
33712
33713 @item tstop:0
33714 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command.
33715
33716 @item tfull:0
33717 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
33718
33719 @item tdisconnected:0
33720 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
33721
33722 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
33723 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
33724
33725 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
33726 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
33727 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
33728 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression).
33729 @var{text} is hex encoded.
33730
33731 @item tunknown:0
33732 The trace stopped for some other reason.
33733
33734 @end table
33735
33736 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
33737 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
33738 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
33739 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
33740 trace.
33741
33742 @table @samp
33743
33744 @item tframes:@var{n}
33745 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
33746
33747 @item tcreated:@var{n}
33748 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
33749 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
33750
33751 @item tsize:@var{n}
33752 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
33753
33754 @item tfree:@var{n}
33755 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
33756
33757 @item circular:@var{n}
33758 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
33759 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
33760 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
33761 and may fill up.
33762
33763 @item disconn:@var{n}
33764 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
33765 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
33766 that the trace run will stop.
33767
33768 @end table
33769
33770 @item qTV:@var{var}
33771 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
33772 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
33773 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
33774
33775 Replies:
33776 @table @samp
33777 @item V@var{value}
33778 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
33779 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
33780 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
33781 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
33782 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
33783 program is running.
33784
33785 @item U
33786 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
33787 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
33788 was not collected.
33789 @end table
33790
33791 @item qTfP
33792 @itemx qTsP
33793 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
33794 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
33795 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
33796 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
33797 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
33798
33799 @item qTfV
33800 @itemx qTsV
33801 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
33802 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
33803 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
33804 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
33805 trace state variables.
33806
33807 @item qTfSTM
33808 @itemx qTsSTM
33809 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
33810 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
33811 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
33812 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
33813
33814 Reply:
33815 @table @samp
33816 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
33817 A single marker
33818 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
33819 a comma-separated list of markers
33820 @item l
33821 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
33822 @item E @var{nn}
33823 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
33824 @item
33825 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
33826 stub.
33827 @end table
33828
33829 @var{address} is encoded in hex.
33830 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
33831
33832 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
33833 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
33834 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
33835 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
33836 @dfn{last}).
33837
33838 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
33839 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
33840 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
33841 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
33842 tracepoint markers.
33843
33844 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
33845 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
33846 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. @var{filename} is encoded
33847 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
33848 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
33849
33850 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
33851 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
33852 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
33853 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
33854 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
33855 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
33856 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
33857 available.
33858
33859 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
33860 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
33861 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
33862
33863 @end table
33864
33865 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
33866 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
33867 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
33868 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
33869 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
33870 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
33871 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
33872 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
33873 it had executed in the original location.
33874
33875 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
33876 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
33877 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
33878 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
33879 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
33880 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
33881 format of the request is:
33882
33883 @table @samp
33884 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
33885
33886 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
33887 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
33888 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
33889 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
33890 memory starting at @var{to}.
33891 @end table
33892
33893 Replies:
33894 @table @samp
33895 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
33896 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. @var{adjusted_size} is
33897 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
33898 @item E @var{NN}
33899 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
33900 relocating the instruction.
33901 @end table
33902
33903 @node Host I/O Packets
33904 @section Host I/O Packets
33905 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
33906 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
33907
33908 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
33909 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
33910 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
33911 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
33912 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
33913 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
33914 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
33915 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
33916 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
33917 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
33918
33919 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
33920 its arguments. They have this format:
33921
33922 @table @samp
33923
33924 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
33925 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
33926 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
33927 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
33928 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
33929 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
33930 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
33931 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
33932 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
33933
33934 @end table
33935
33936 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
33937
33938 @table @samp
33939
33940 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
33941 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
33942 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
33943 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
33944 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
33945 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
33946 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
33947 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
33948 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
33949 @var{attachment}.
33950
33951 @item
33952 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
33953
33954 @end table
33955
33956 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
33957
33958 @table @samp
33959 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
33960 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
33961 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
33962 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
33963 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
33964 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
33965 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
33966
33967 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
33968 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
33969 -1 if an error occurs.
33970
33971 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
33972 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
33973 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
33974 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
33975 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
33976 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
33977 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
33978 @var{count} was zero.
33979
33980 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
33981 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
33982 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
33983 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
33984 some characters were escaped.
33985
33986 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
33987 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
33988 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
33989 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
33990 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
33991 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
33992 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
33993 error occurred.
33994
33995 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
33996 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
33997 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
33998
33999 @end table
34000
34001 @node Interrupts
34002 @section Interrupts
34003 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
34004
34005 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
34006 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
34007 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
34008 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
34009
34010 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
34011 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
34012 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
34013 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
34014 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
34015
34016 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
34017 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
34018 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
34019 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
34020 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
34021 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
34022 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
34023 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
34024
34025 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
34026 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
34027 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
34028
34029 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
34030 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
34031 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
34032 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
34033 currently-executing threads and processes.
34034 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
34035 running program, it should send one of the stop
34036 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
34037 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
34038 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
34039 Interrupts received while the
34040 program is stopped are discarded.
34041
34042 @node Notification Packets
34043 @section Notification Packets
34044 @cindex notification packets
34045 @cindex packets, notification
34046
34047 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
34048 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
34049 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
34050 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
34051 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
34052 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
34053 is not a problem.
34054
34055 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
34056 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
34057 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
34058 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
34059 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
34060 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
34061 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
34062
34063 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
34064 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
34065
34066 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
34067 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
34068 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
34069 not they understand it.
34070
34071 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
34072 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
34073 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
34074 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
34075 recipients.
34076
34077 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
34078 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
34079 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
34080 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
34081 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
34082
34083 The following notification packets from the stub to @value{GDBN} are
34084 defined:
34085
34086 @table @samp
34087 @item Stop: @var{reply}
34088 Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
34089 The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
34090 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
34091 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
34092 @value{GDBN}.
34093 @end table
34094
34095 @node Remote Non-Stop
34096 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
34097
34098 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
34099 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
34100 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
34101 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34102
34103 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
34104 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
34105 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
34106 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
34107 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
34108 probe the target state after a mode change.
34109
34110 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
34111 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
34112 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
34113 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
34114 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
34115 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
34116 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
34117 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
34118 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
34119 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
34120 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
34121
34122 Only one stop reply notification at a time may be pending; if
34123 additional stop events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
34124 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
34125 synchronous transmission in response to @samp{vStopped} packets from
34126 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
34127 the stub is permitted to resend a stop reply notification
34128 if it believes @value{GDBN} may not have received it. @value{GDBN}
34129 ignores additional stop reply notifications received before it has
34130 finished processing a previous notification and the stub has completed
34131 sending any queued stop events.
34132
34133 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} must be prepared to receive a stop reply
34134 notification at any time. Specifically, they may appear when
34135 @value{GDBN} is not otherwise reading input from the stub, or when
34136 @value{GDBN} is expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
34137 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
34138 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
34139 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
34140
34141 After receiving a stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall
34142 acknowledge it by sending a @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{vStopped packet})
34143 as a regular, synchronous request to the stub. Such acknowledgment
34144 is not required to happen immediately, as @value{GDBN} is permitted to
34145 send other, unrelated packets to the stub first, which the stub should
34146 process normally.
34147
34148 Upon receiving a @samp{vStopped} packet, if the stub has other queued
34149 stop events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
34150 normal stop reply response. @value{GDBN} shall then send another
34151 @samp{vStopped} packet to solicit further responses; again, it is
34152 permitted to send other, unrelated packets as well which the stub
34153 should process normally.
34154
34155 If the stub receives a @samp{vStopped} packet and there are no
34156 additional stop events to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK}
34157 response. At this point, if further stop events occur, the stub shall
34158 send a new stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the
34159 notification, and the process shall be repeated.
34160
34161 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
34162 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
34163 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
34164 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
34165 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
34166 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
34167 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
34168 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
34169 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
34170 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
34171 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
34172 @samp{OK}.
34173
34174 @node Packet Acknowledgment
34175 @section Packet Acknowledgment
34176
34177 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
34178 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
34179 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
34180 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
34181 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
34182 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
34183 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
34184
34185 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
34186 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
34187 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
34188 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
34189 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
34190
34191 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
34192 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
34193 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
34194 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
34195
34196 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
34197 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
34198 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
34199 @pxref{qSupported}.
34200 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
34201 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
34202 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
34203 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
34204 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
34205 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
34206 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
34207
34208 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
34209 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
34210 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
34211 connection.
34212 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
34213 new connection is established,
34214 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
34215 for the current connection, once disabled.
34216
34217 @node Examples
34218 @section Examples
34219
34220 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
34221 does not get any direct output:
34222
34223 @smallexample
34224 -> @code{R00}
34225 <- @code{+}
34226 @emph{target restarts}
34227 -> @code{?}
34228 <- @code{+}
34229 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
34230 -> @code{+}
34231 @end smallexample
34232
34233 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
34234
34235 @smallexample
34236 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
34237 <- @code{+}
34238 -> @code{s}
34239 <- @code{+}
34240 @emph{time passes}
34241 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
34242 -> @code{+}
34243 -> @code{g}
34244 <- @code{+}
34245 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
34246 -> @code{+}
34247 @end smallexample
34248
34249 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
34250 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
34251 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
34252
34253 @menu
34254 * File-I/O Overview::
34255 * Protocol Basics::
34256 * The F Request Packet::
34257 * The F Reply Packet::
34258 * The Ctrl-C Message::
34259 * Console I/O::
34260 * List of Supported Calls::
34261 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
34262 * Constants::
34263 * File-I/O Examples::
34264 @end menu
34265
34266 @node File-I/O Overview
34267 @subsection File-I/O Overview
34268 @cindex file-i/o overview
34269
34270 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
34271 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
34272 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
34273 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
34274 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
34275 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
34276
34277 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
34278 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
34279 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
34280 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
34281 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
34282
34283 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
34284 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
34285 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
34286 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
34287 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
34288 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
34289 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
34290
34291 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
34292 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
34293 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
34294 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
34295 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
34296
34297 @smallexample
34298 (@value{GDBP}) continue
34299 <- target requests 'system call X'
34300 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
34301 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
34302 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
34303 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
34304 @end smallexample
34305
34306 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
34307 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
34308 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
34309 system are not supported by this protocol.
34310
34311 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
34312
34313 @node Protocol Basics
34314 @subsection Protocol Basics
34315 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
34316
34317 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
34318 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
34319 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
34320 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
34321 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
34322 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
34323 to call the appropriate host system call:
34324
34325 @itemize @bullet
34326 @item
34327 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
34328
34329 @item
34330 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
34331 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
34332 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
34333 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
34334
34335 @end itemize
34336
34337 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
34338
34339 @itemize @bullet
34340 @item
34341 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
34342 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
34343 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
34344 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
34345 packet.
34346
34347 @item
34348 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
34349 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
34350
34351 @item
34352 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
34353
34354 @item
34355 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
34356
34357 @item
34358 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
34359 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
34360 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
34361 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
34362 packet.
34363
34364 @end itemize
34365
34366 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
34367 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
34368
34369 @itemize @bullet
34370 @item
34371 Return value.
34372
34373 @item
34374 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
34375
34376 @item
34377 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
34378
34379 @end itemize
34380
34381 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
34382 the latest continue or step action.
34383
34384 @node The F Request Packet
34385 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
34386 @cindex file-i/o request packet
34387 @cindex @code{F} request packet
34388
34389 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
34390
34391 @table @samp
34392 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
34393
34394 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
34395 This is just the name of the function.
34396
34397 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
34398 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
34399 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
34400 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
34401 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
34402 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
34403 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
34404
34405 @end table
34406
34407
34408
34409 @node The F Reply Packet
34410 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
34411 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
34412 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
34413
34414 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
34415
34416 @table @samp
34417
34418 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
34419
34420 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
34421
34422 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
34423 representation.
34424 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
34425
34426 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
34427 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
34428 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
34429
34430 @smallexample
34431 F0,0,C
34432 @end smallexample
34433
34434 @noindent
34435 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
34436
34437 @smallexample
34438 F-1,4,C
34439 @end smallexample
34440
34441 @noindent
34442 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
34443
34444 @end table
34445
34446
34447 @node The Ctrl-C Message
34448 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
34449 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
34450
34451 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
34452 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
34453 the target should behave as if it had
34454 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
34455 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
34456 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
34457 packet.
34458
34459 It's important for the target to know in which
34460 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
34461
34462 @itemize @bullet
34463 @item
34464 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
34465
34466 @item
34467 The system call on the host has been finished.
34468
34469 @end itemize
34470
34471 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
34472 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
34473 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
34474 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
34475 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
34476 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
34477
34478 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
34479 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
34480 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
34481 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
34482 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
34483 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
34484 or the full action has been completed.
34485
34486 @node Console I/O
34487 @subsection Console I/O
34488 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
34489
34490 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
34491 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
34492 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
34493 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
34494 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
34495 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
34496 conditions is met:
34497
34498 @itemize @bullet
34499 @item
34500 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
34501 @code{read}
34502 system call is treated as finished.
34503
34504 @item
34505 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
34506 newline.
34507
34508 @item
34509 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
34510 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
34511
34512 @end itemize
34513
34514 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
34515 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
34516 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
34517 is stopped at the user's request.
34518
34519
34520 @node List of Supported Calls
34521 @subsection List of Supported Calls
34522 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
34523
34524 @menu
34525 * open::
34526 * close::
34527 * read::
34528 * write::
34529 * lseek::
34530 * rename::
34531 * unlink::
34532 * stat/fstat::
34533 * gettimeofday::
34534 * isatty::
34535 * system::
34536 @end menu
34537
34538 @node open
34539 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
34540 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
34541
34542 @table @asis
34543 @item Synopsis:
34544 @smallexample
34545 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
34546 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
34547 @end smallexample
34548
34549 @item Request:
34550 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
34551
34552 @noindent
34553 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
34554
34555 @table @code
34556 @item O_CREAT
34557 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
34558 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
34559 are concerned.
34560
34561 @item O_EXCL
34562 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
34563 an error and open() fails.
34564
34565 @item O_TRUNC
34566 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
34567 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
34568 truncated to zero length.
34569
34570 @item O_APPEND
34571 The file is opened in append mode.
34572
34573 @item O_RDONLY
34574 The file is opened for reading only.
34575
34576 @item O_WRONLY
34577 The file is opened for writing only.
34578
34579 @item O_RDWR
34580 The file is opened for reading and writing.
34581 @end table
34582
34583 @noindent
34584 Other bits are silently ignored.
34585
34586
34587 @noindent
34588 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
34589
34590 @table @code
34591 @item S_IRUSR
34592 User has read permission.
34593
34594 @item S_IWUSR
34595 User has write permission.
34596
34597 @item S_IRGRP
34598 Group has read permission.
34599
34600 @item S_IWGRP
34601 Group has write permission.
34602
34603 @item S_IROTH
34604 Others have read permission.
34605
34606 @item S_IWOTH
34607 Others have write permission.
34608 @end table
34609
34610 @noindent
34611 Other bits are silently ignored.
34612
34613
34614 @item Return value:
34615 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
34616 occurred.
34617
34618 @item Errors:
34619
34620 @table @code
34621 @item EEXIST
34622 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
34623
34624 @item EISDIR
34625 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
34626
34627 @item EACCES
34628 The requested access is not allowed.
34629
34630 @item ENAMETOOLONG
34631 @var{pathname} was too long.
34632
34633 @item ENOENT
34634 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
34635
34636 @item ENODEV
34637 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
34638
34639 @item EROFS
34640 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
34641 write access was requested.
34642
34643 @item EFAULT
34644 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
34645
34646 @item ENOSPC
34647 No space on device to create the file.
34648
34649 @item EMFILE
34650 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
34651
34652 @item ENFILE
34653 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
34654 has been reached.
34655
34656 @item EINTR
34657 The call was interrupted by the user.
34658 @end table
34659
34660 @end table
34661
34662 @node close
34663 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
34664 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
34665
34666 @table @asis
34667 @item Synopsis:
34668 @smallexample
34669 int close(int fd);
34670 @end smallexample
34671
34672 @item Request:
34673 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
34674
34675 @item Return value:
34676 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
34677
34678 @item Errors:
34679
34680 @table @code
34681 @item EBADF
34682 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
34683
34684 @item EINTR
34685 The call was interrupted by the user.
34686 @end table
34687
34688 @end table
34689
34690 @node read
34691 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
34692 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
34693
34694 @table @asis
34695 @item Synopsis:
34696 @smallexample
34697 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
34698 @end smallexample
34699
34700 @item Request:
34701 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
34702
34703 @item Return value:
34704 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
34705 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
34706 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
34707
34708 @item Errors:
34709
34710 @table @code
34711 @item EBADF
34712 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
34713 reading.
34714
34715 @item EFAULT
34716 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
34717
34718 @item EINTR
34719 The call was interrupted by the user.
34720 @end table
34721
34722 @end table
34723
34724 @node write
34725 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
34726 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
34727
34728 @table @asis
34729 @item Synopsis:
34730 @smallexample
34731 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
34732 @end smallexample
34733
34734 @item Request:
34735 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
34736
34737 @item Return value:
34738 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
34739 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
34740 is returned.
34741
34742 @item Errors:
34743
34744 @table @code
34745 @item EBADF
34746 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
34747 writing.
34748
34749 @item EFAULT
34750 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
34751
34752 @item EFBIG
34753 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
34754 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
34755
34756 @item ENOSPC
34757 No space on device to write the data.
34758
34759 @item EINTR
34760 The call was interrupted by the user.
34761 @end table
34762
34763 @end table
34764
34765 @node lseek
34766 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
34767 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
34768
34769 @table @asis
34770 @item Synopsis:
34771 @smallexample
34772 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
34773 @end smallexample
34774
34775 @item Request:
34776 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
34777
34778 @var{flag} is one of:
34779
34780 @table @code
34781 @item SEEK_SET
34782 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
34783
34784 @item SEEK_CUR
34785 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
34786 bytes.
34787
34788 @item SEEK_END
34789 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
34790 bytes.
34791 @end table
34792
34793 @item Return value:
34794 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
34795 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
34796 value of -1 is returned.
34797
34798 @item Errors:
34799
34800 @table @code
34801 @item EBADF
34802 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
34803
34804 @item ESPIPE
34805 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
34806
34807 @item EINVAL
34808 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
34809
34810 @item EINTR
34811 The call was interrupted by the user.
34812 @end table
34813
34814 @end table
34815
34816 @node rename
34817 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
34818 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
34819
34820 @table @asis
34821 @item Synopsis:
34822 @smallexample
34823 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
34824 @end smallexample
34825
34826 @item Request:
34827 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
34828
34829 @item Return value:
34830 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
34831
34832 @item Errors:
34833
34834 @table @code
34835 @item EISDIR
34836 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
34837 directory.
34838
34839 @item EEXIST
34840 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
34841
34842 @item EBUSY
34843 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
34844 process.
34845
34846 @item EINVAL
34847 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
34848 of itself.
34849
34850 @item ENOTDIR
34851 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
34852 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
34853 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
34854
34855 @item EFAULT
34856 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
34857
34858 @item EACCES
34859 No access to the file or the path of the file.
34860
34861 @item ENAMETOOLONG
34862
34863 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
34864
34865 @item ENOENT
34866 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
34867
34868 @item EROFS
34869 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
34870
34871 @item ENOSPC
34872 The device containing the file has no room for the new
34873 directory entry.
34874
34875 @item EINTR
34876 The call was interrupted by the user.
34877 @end table
34878
34879 @end table
34880
34881 @node unlink
34882 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
34883 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
34884
34885 @table @asis
34886 @item Synopsis:
34887 @smallexample
34888 int unlink(const char *pathname);
34889 @end smallexample
34890
34891 @item Request:
34892 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
34893
34894 @item Return value:
34895 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
34896
34897 @item Errors:
34898
34899 @table @code
34900 @item EACCES
34901 No access to the file or the path of the file.
34902
34903 @item EPERM
34904 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
34905
34906 @item EBUSY
34907 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
34908 being used by another process.
34909
34910 @item EFAULT
34911 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
34912
34913 @item ENAMETOOLONG
34914 @var{pathname} was too long.
34915
34916 @item ENOENT
34917 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
34918
34919 @item ENOTDIR
34920 A component of the path is not a directory.
34921
34922 @item EROFS
34923 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
34924
34925 @item EINTR
34926 The call was interrupted by the user.
34927 @end table
34928
34929 @end table
34930
34931 @node stat/fstat
34932 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
34933 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
34934 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
34935
34936 @table @asis
34937 @item Synopsis:
34938 @smallexample
34939 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
34940 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
34941 @end smallexample
34942
34943 @item Request:
34944 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
34945 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
34946
34947 @item Return value:
34948 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
34949
34950 @item Errors:
34951
34952 @table @code
34953 @item EBADF
34954 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
34955
34956 @item ENOENT
34957 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
34958 path is an empty string.
34959
34960 @item ENOTDIR
34961 A component of the path is not a directory.
34962
34963 @item EFAULT
34964 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
34965
34966 @item EACCES
34967 No access to the file or the path of the file.
34968
34969 @item ENAMETOOLONG
34970 @var{pathname} was too long.
34971
34972 @item EINTR
34973 The call was interrupted by the user.
34974 @end table
34975
34976 @end table
34977
34978 @node gettimeofday
34979 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
34980 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
34981
34982 @table @asis
34983 @item Synopsis:
34984 @smallexample
34985 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
34986 @end smallexample
34987
34988 @item Request:
34989 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
34990
34991 @item Return value:
34992 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
34993
34994 @item Errors:
34995
34996 @table @code
34997 @item EINVAL
34998 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
34999
35000 @item EFAULT
35001 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
35002 @end table
35003
35004 @end table
35005
35006 @node isatty
35007 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
35008 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
35009
35010 @table @asis
35011 @item Synopsis:
35012 @smallexample
35013 int isatty(int fd);
35014 @end smallexample
35015
35016 @item Request:
35017 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
35018
35019 @item Return value:
35020 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
35021
35022 @item Errors:
35023
35024 @table @code
35025 @item EINTR
35026 The call was interrupted by the user.
35027 @end table
35028
35029 @end table
35030
35031 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
35032 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
35033 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
35034 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
35035 needed.
35036
35037
35038 @node system
35039 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
35040 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
35041
35042 @table @asis
35043 @item Synopsis:
35044 @smallexample
35045 int system(const char *command);
35046 @end smallexample
35047
35048 @item Request:
35049 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
35050
35051 @item Return value:
35052 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
35053 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
35054 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
35055 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
35056 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
35057 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
35058 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
35059
35060 @item Errors:
35061
35062 @table @code
35063 @item EINTR
35064 The call was interrupted by the user.
35065 @end table
35066
35067 @end table
35068
35069 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
35070 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
35071 the host is simplified before it's returned
35072 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
35073 is discarded, and the return value consists
35074 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
35075
35076 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
35077 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
35078 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
35079
35080 @table @code
35081 @item set remote system-call-allowed
35082 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
35083 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
35084 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
35085
35086 @item show remote system-call-allowed
35087 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
35088 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
35089 protocol.
35090 @end table
35091
35092 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
35093 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
35094 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
35095
35096 @menu
35097 * Integral Datatypes::
35098 * Pointer Values::
35099 * Memory Transfer::
35100 * struct stat::
35101 * struct timeval::
35102 @end menu
35103
35104 @node Integral Datatypes
35105 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
35106 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
35107
35108 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
35109 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
35110 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
35111
35112 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
35113 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
35114
35115 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
35116
35117 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
35118 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
35119
35120 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
35121
35122 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
35123 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
35124 byte order.
35125
35126 @node Pointer Values
35127 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
35128 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
35129
35130 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
35131 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
35132 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
35133 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
35134
35135 @smallexample
35136 @code{1aaf/12}
35137 @end smallexample
35138
35139 @noindent
35140 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
35141 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
35142 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
35143 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
35144
35145 @smallexample
35146 @code{123456/d}
35147 @end smallexample
35148
35149 @node Memory Transfer
35150 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
35151 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
35152
35153 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
35154 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
35155 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
35156 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
35157 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
35158 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
35159 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
35160
35161
35162 @node struct stat
35163 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
35164 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
35165
35166 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
35167 is defined as follows:
35168
35169 @smallexample
35170 struct stat @{
35171 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
35172 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
35173 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
35174 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
35175 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
35176 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
35177 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
35178 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
35179 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
35180 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
35181 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
35182 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
35183 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
35184 @};
35185 @end smallexample
35186
35187 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
35188 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
35189 structure is of size 64 bytes.
35190
35191 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
35192 range of values.
35193
35194 @table @code
35195
35196 @item st_dev
35197 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
35198
35199 @item st_ino
35200 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
35201
35202 @item st_mode
35203 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
35204 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
35205
35206 @item st_uid
35207 @itemx st_gid
35208 @itemx st_rdev
35209 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
35210
35211 @item st_atime
35212 @itemx st_mtime
35213 @itemx st_ctime
35214 These values have a host and file system dependent
35215 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
35216 support exact timing values.
35217 @end table
35218
35219 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
35220 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
35221 continuing.
35222
35223 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
35224 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
35225 get truncated on the target.
35226
35227 @node struct timeval
35228 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
35229 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
35230
35231 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
35232 is defined as follows:
35233
35234 @smallexample
35235 struct timeval @{
35236 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
35237 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
35238 @};
35239 @end smallexample
35240
35241 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
35242 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
35243 structure is of size 8 bytes.
35244
35245 @node Constants
35246 @subsection Constants
35247 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
35248
35249 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
35250 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
35251 values before and after the call as needed.
35252
35253 @menu
35254 * Open Flags::
35255 * mode_t Values::
35256 * Errno Values::
35257 * Lseek Flags::
35258 * Limits::
35259 @end menu
35260
35261 @node Open Flags
35262 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
35263 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
35264
35265 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
35266
35267 @smallexample
35268 O_RDONLY 0x0
35269 O_WRONLY 0x1
35270 O_RDWR 0x2
35271 O_APPEND 0x8
35272 O_CREAT 0x200
35273 O_TRUNC 0x400
35274 O_EXCL 0x800
35275 @end smallexample
35276
35277 @node mode_t Values
35278 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
35279 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
35280
35281 All values are given in octal representation.
35282
35283 @smallexample
35284 S_IFREG 0100000
35285 S_IFDIR 040000
35286 S_IRUSR 0400
35287 S_IWUSR 0200
35288 S_IXUSR 0100
35289 S_IRGRP 040
35290 S_IWGRP 020
35291 S_IXGRP 010
35292 S_IROTH 04
35293 S_IWOTH 02
35294 S_IXOTH 01
35295 @end smallexample
35296
35297 @node Errno Values
35298 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
35299 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
35300
35301 All values are given in decimal representation.
35302
35303 @smallexample
35304 EPERM 1
35305 ENOENT 2
35306 EINTR 4
35307 EBADF 9
35308 EACCES 13
35309 EFAULT 14
35310 EBUSY 16
35311 EEXIST 17
35312 ENODEV 19
35313 ENOTDIR 20
35314 EISDIR 21
35315 EINVAL 22
35316 ENFILE 23
35317 EMFILE 24
35318 EFBIG 27
35319 ENOSPC 28
35320 ESPIPE 29
35321 EROFS 30
35322 ENAMETOOLONG 91
35323 EUNKNOWN 9999
35324 @end smallexample
35325
35326 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
35327 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
35328
35329 @node Lseek Flags
35330 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
35331 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
35332
35333 @smallexample
35334 SEEK_SET 0
35335 SEEK_CUR 1
35336 SEEK_END 2
35337 @end smallexample
35338
35339 @node Limits
35340 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
35341 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
35342
35343 All values are given in decimal representation.
35344
35345 @smallexample
35346 INT_MIN -2147483648
35347 INT_MAX 2147483647
35348 UINT_MAX 4294967295
35349 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
35350 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
35351 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
35352 @end smallexample
35353
35354 @node File-I/O Examples
35355 @subsection File-I/O Examples
35356 @cindex file-i/o examples
35357
35358 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
35359 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
35360
35361 @smallexample
35362 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
35363 @emph{request memory read from target}
35364 -> @code{m1234,6}
35365 <- XXXXXX
35366 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
35367 -> @code{F6}
35368 @end smallexample
35369
35370 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
35371 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
35372
35373 @smallexample
35374 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
35375 @emph{request memory write to target}
35376 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
35377 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
35378 -> @code{F6}
35379 @end smallexample
35380
35381 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
35382 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
35383
35384 @smallexample
35385 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
35386 -> @code{F-1,9}
35387 @end smallexample
35388
35389 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
35390 host is called:
35391
35392 @smallexample
35393 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
35394 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
35395 <- @code{T02}
35396 @end smallexample
35397
35398 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
35399 host is called:
35400
35401 @smallexample
35402 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
35403 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
35404 <- @code{T02}
35405 @end smallexample
35406
35407 @node Library List Format
35408 @section Library List Format
35409 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
35410
35411 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
35412 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
35413 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
35414 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
35415 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
35416 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
35417 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
35418 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
35419 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
35420 are loaded.
35421
35422 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
35423 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
35424 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
35425 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
35426
35427 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
35428 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
35429 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
35430 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
35431 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
35432 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
35433
35434 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
35435 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
35436
35437 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
35438 offset, looks like this:
35439
35440 @smallexample
35441 <library-list>
35442 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
35443 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
35444 </library>
35445 </library-list>
35446 @end smallexample
35447
35448 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
35449 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
35450
35451 @smallexample
35452 <library-list>
35453 <library name="sharedlib.o">
35454 <section address="0x10000000"/>
35455 <section address="0x20000000"/>
35456 <section address="0x30000000"/>
35457 </library>
35458 </library-list>
35459 @end smallexample
35460
35461 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
35462
35463 @smallexample
35464 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
35465 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
35466 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
35467 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
35468 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
35469 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
35470 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
35471 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
35472 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
35473 @end smallexample
35474
35475 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
35476 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
35477 section for each library.
35478
35479 @node Memory Map Format
35480 @section Memory Map Format
35481 @cindex memory map format
35482
35483 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
35484 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
35485 memory map.
35486
35487 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
35488 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
35489 lists memory regions.
35490
35491 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
35492 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
35493
35494 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
35495
35496 @smallexample
35497 <?xml version="1.0"?>
35498 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
35499 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
35500 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
35501 <memory-map>
35502 region...
35503 </memory-map>
35504 @end smallexample
35505
35506 Each region can be either:
35507
35508 @itemize
35509
35510 @item
35511 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
35512 bytes from there:
35513
35514 @smallexample
35515 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
35516 @end smallexample
35517
35518
35519 @item
35520 A region of read-only memory:
35521
35522 @smallexample
35523 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
35524 @end smallexample
35525
35526
35527 @item
35528 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
35529 bytes in length:
35530
35531 @smallexample
35532 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
35533 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
35534 </memory>
35535 @end smallexample
35536
35537 @end itemize
35538
35539 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
35540 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
35541 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
35542
35543 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
35544
35545 @smallexample
35546 <!-- ................................................... -->
35547 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
35548 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
35549 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
35550 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
35551 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
35552 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
35553 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
35554 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
35555 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
35556 and its type, or device. -->
35557 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
35558 start CDATA #REQUIRED
35559 length CDATA #REQUIRED
35560 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
35561 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
35562 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
35563 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
35564 @end smallexample
35565
35566 @node Thread List Format
35567 @section Thread List Format
35568 @cindex thread list format
35569
35570 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
35571 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
35572 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
35573 the following structure:
35574
35575 @smallexample
35576 <?xml version="1.0"?>
35577 <threads>
35578 <thread id="id" core="0">
35579 ... description ...
35580 </thread>
35581 </threads>
35582 @end smallexample
35583
35584 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
35585 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
35586 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
35587 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
35588 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
35589
35590 @include agentexpr.texi
35591
35592 @node Trace File Format
35593 @appendix Trace File Format
35594 @cindex trace file format
35595
35596 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
35597 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
35598
35599 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
35600 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
35601 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
35602 in the future.
35603
35604 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
35605 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
35606 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
35607 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
35608 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
35609 of this section.
35610
35611 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
35612
35613 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
35614 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
35615 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
35616 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
35617 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
35618 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
35619 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
35620 endianness.
35621
35622 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
35623
35624 @table @code
35625 @item R @var{bytes}
35626 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
35627 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
35628 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
35629 hexadecimal encoding.
35630
35631 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
35632 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
35633 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
35634 @var{length} bytes.
35635
35636 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
35637 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
35638 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
35639
35640 @end table
35641
35642 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
35643 of blocks.
35644
35645 @node Target Descriptions
35646 @appendix Target Descriptions
35647 @cindex target descriptions
35648
35649 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
35650 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
35651 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
35652
35653 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
35654 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
35655 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
35656 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
35657 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
35658 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
35659 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
35660
35661 @itemize @bullet
35662 @item
35663 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
35664 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
35665 @item
35666 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
35667 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
35668 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
35669 @item
35670 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
35671 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
35672 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
35673 @end itemize
35674
35675 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
35676 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
35677 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
35678 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
35679 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
35680
35681 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
35682 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
35683
35684 @menu
35685 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
35686 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
35687 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
35688 descriptions.
35689 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
35690 @end menu
35691
35692 @node Retrieving Descriptions
35693 @section Retrieving Descriptions
35694
35695 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
35696 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
35697 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
35698 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
35699 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
35700 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
35701 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
35702 Format}.
35703
35704 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
35705 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
35706 specify a file are:
35707
35708 @table @code
35709 @cindex set tdesc filename
35710 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
35711 Read the target description from @var{path}.
35712
35713 @cindex unset tdesc filename
35714 @item unset tdesc filename
35715 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
35716 will use the description supplied by the current target.
35717
35718 @cindex show tdesc filename
35719 @item show tdesc filename
35720 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
35721 @end table
35722
35723
35724 @node Target Description Format
35725 @section Target Description Format
35726 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
35727
35728 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
35729 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
35730 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
35731 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
35732 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
35733 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
35734 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
35735
35736 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
35737 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
35738 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
35739 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
35740 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
35741
35742 Here is a simple target description:
35743
35744 @smallexample
35745 <target version="1.0">
35746 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
35747 </target>
35748 @end smallexample
35749
35750 @noindent
35751 This minimal description only says that the target uses
35752 the x86-64 architecture.
35753
35754 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
35755 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
35756 are explained further below.
35757
35758 @smallexample
35759 <?xml version="1.0"?>
35760 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
35761 <target version="1.0">
35762 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
35763 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
35764 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
35765 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
35766 </target>
35767 @end smallexample
35768
35769 @noindent
35770 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
35771 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
35772 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
35773 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
35774 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
35775 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
35776 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
35777 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
35778 the version mismatch.
35779
35780 @subsection Inclusion
35781 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
35782 @cindex XInclude
35783 @ifnotinfo
35784 @cindex <xi:include>
35785 @end ifnotinfo
35786
35787 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
35788 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
35789 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
35790 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
35791 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
35792
35793 @smallexample
35794 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
35795 @end smallexample
35796
35797 @noindent
35798 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
35799 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
35800 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
35801 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
35802 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
35803 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
35804 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
35805 original description.
35806
35807 @subsection Architecture
35808 @cindex <architecture>
35809
35810 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
35811
35812 @smallexample
35813 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
35814 @end smallexample
35815
35816 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
35817 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
35818
35819 @subsection OS ABI
35820 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
35821
35822 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
35823 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
35824
35825 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
35826
35827 @smallexample
35828 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
35829 @end smallexample
35830
35831 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
35832 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
35833
35834 @subsection Compatible Architecture
35835 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
35836
35837 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
35838 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
35839
35840 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
35841
35842 @smallexample
35843 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
35844 @end smallexample
35845
35846 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
35847 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
35848
35849 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
35850 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
35851 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
35852 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
35853 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
35854 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
35855 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
35856
35857 @smallexample
35858 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
35859 <compatible>spu</compatible>
35860 @end smallexample
35861
35862 @subsection Features
35863 @cindex <feature>
35864
35865 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
35866 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
35867 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
35868 has this form:
35869
35870 @smallexample
35871 <feature name="@var{name}">
35872 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
35873 @var{reg}@dots{}
35874 </feature>
35875 @end smallexample
35876
35877 @noindent
35878 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
35879 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
35880 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
35881 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
35882
35883 @subsection Types
35884
35885 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
35886 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
35887 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
35888 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
35889 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
35890
35891 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
35892 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
35893 Types must be defined before they are used.
35894
35895 @cindex <vector>
35896 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
35897 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
35898 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
35899 @var{count}:
35900
35901 @smallexample
35902 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
35903 @end smallexample
35904
35905 @cindex <union>
35906 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
35907 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
35908 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
35909 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
35910
35911 @smallexample
35912 <union id="@var{id}">
35913 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
35914 @dots{}
35915 </union>
35916 @end smallexample
35917
35918 @cindex <struct>
35919 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
35920 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
35921 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
35922 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
35923 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
35924 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
35925 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
35926 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
35927
35928 @smallexample
35929 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
35930 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
35931 @dots{}
35932 </struct>
35933 @end smallexample
35934
35935 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
35936 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
35937
35938 @smallexample
35939 <struct id="@var{id}">
35940 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
35941 @dots{}
35942 </struct>
35943 @end smallexample
35944
35945 @cindex <flags>
35946 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
35947 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
35948 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
35949 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
35950 are supported.
35951
35952 @smallexample
35953 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
35954 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
35955 @dots{}
35956 </flags>
35957 @end smallexample
35958
35959 @subsection Registers
35960 @cindex <reg>
35961
35962 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
35963
35964 @smallexample
35965 <reg name="@var{name}"
35966 bitsize="@var{size}"
35967 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
35968 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
35969 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
35970 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
35971 @end smallexample
35972
35973 @noindent
35974 The components are as follows:
35975
35976 @table @var
35977
35978 @item name
35979 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
35980
35981 @item bitsize
35982 The register's size, in bits.
35983
35984 @item regnum
35985 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
35986 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
35987 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
35988 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
35989 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
35990 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
35991 in order of increasing register number.
35992
35993 @item save-restore
35994 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
35995 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
35996 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
35997 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
35998 ABI.
35999
36000 @item type
36001 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
36002 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
36003 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
36004 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
36005 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
36006 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
36007
36008 @item group
36009 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
36010 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
36011 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
36012 in @code{info registers}.
36013
36014 @end table
36015
36016 @node Predefined Target Types
36017 @section Predefined Target Types
36018 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
36019
36020 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
36021 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
36022 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
36023 types. The currently supported types are:
36024
36025 @table @code
36026
36027 @item int8
36028 @itemx int16
36029 @itemx int32
36030 @itemx int64
36031 @itemx int128
36032 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
36033
36034 @item uint8
36035 @itemx uint16
36036 @itemx uint32
36037 @itemx uint64
36038 @itemx uint128
36039 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
36040
36041 @item code_ptr
36042 @itemx data_ptr
36043 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
36044 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
36045 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
36046 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
36047 may be marked as data pointers.
36048
36049 @item ieee_single
36050 Single precision IEEE floating point.
36051
36052 @item ieee_double
36053 Double precision IEEE floating point.
36054
36055 @item arm_fpa_ext
36056 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
36057
36058 @item i387_ext
36059 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
36060
36061 @item i386_eflags
36062 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
36063
36064 @item i386_mxcsr
36065 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
36066
36067 @end table
36068
36069 @node Standard Target Features
36070 @section Standard Target Features
36071 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
36072
36073 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
36074 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
36075 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
36076 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
36077 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
36078 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
36079 can recognize them.
36080
36081 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
36082 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
36083 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
36084 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
36085 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
36086 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
36087 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
36088 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
36089
36090 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
36091 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
36092 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
36093
36094 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
36095 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
36096 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
36097 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
36098
36099 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
36100 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
36101 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
36102
36103 @menu
36104 * ARM Features::
36105 * i386 Features::
36106 * MIPS Features::
36107 * M68K Features::
36108 * PowerPC Features::
36109 @end menu
36110
36111
36112 @node ARM Features
36113 @subsection ARM Features
36114 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
36115
36116 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
36117 ARM targets.
36118 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
36119 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
36120
36121 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
36122 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
36123 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
36124 and @samp{xpsr}.
36125
36126 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
36127 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
36128
36129 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
36130 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
36131 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
36132 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
36133
36134 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
36135 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
36136 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
36137 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
36138 halves of the double-precision registers.
36139
36140 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
36141 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
36142 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
36143 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
36144 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
36145 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
36146
36147 @node i386 Features
36148 @subsection i386 Features
36149 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
36150
36151 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
36152 targets. It should describe the following registers:
36153
36154 @itemize @minus
36155 @item
36156 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
36157 @item
36158 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
36159 @item
36160 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
36161 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
36162 @item
36163 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
36164 @item
36165 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
36166 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
36167 @end itemize
36168
36169 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
36170
36171 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
36172 describe registers:
36173
36174 @itemize @minus
36175 @item
36176 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
36177 @item
36178 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
36179 @item
36180 @samp{mxcsr}
36181 @end itemize
36182
36183 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
36184 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
36185 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
36186
36187 @itemize @minus
36188 @item
36189 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
36190 @item
36191 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
36192 @end itemize
36193
36194 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
36195 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
36196
36197 @node MIPS Features
36198 @subsection MIPS Features
36199 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
36200
36201 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
36202 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
36203 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
36204 on the target.
36205
36206 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
36207 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
36208 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
36209
36210 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
36211 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
36212 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
36213 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
36214
36215 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
36216 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
36217 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
36218
36219 @node M68K Features
36220 @subsection M68K Features
36221 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
36222
36223 @table @code
36224 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
36225 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
36226 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
36227 One of those features must be always present.
36228 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
36229 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
36230 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
36231 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
36232
36233 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
36234 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
36235 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
36236 @samp{fpiaddr}.
36237 @end table
36238
36239 @node PowerPC Features
36240 @subsection PowerPC Features
36241 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
36242
36243 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
36244 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
36245 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
36246 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
36247
36248 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
36249 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
36250
36251 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
36252 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
36253 and @samp{vrsave}.
36254
36255 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
36256 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
36257 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
36258 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
36259 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
36260 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
36261
36262 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
36263 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
36264 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
36265 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
36266 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
36267 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
36268 user.
36269
36270 @node Operating System Information
36271 @appendix Operating System Information
36272 @cindex operating system information
36273
36274 @menu
36275 * Process list::
36276 @end menu
36277
36278 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
36279 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
36280 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
36281 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
36282 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
36283 on a different aspect of target.
36284
36285 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
36286 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
36287 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
36288 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
36289
36290 @node Process list
36291 @appendixsection Process list
36292 @cindex operating system information, process list
36293
36294 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
36295 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
36296 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
36297 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
36298
36299 An example document is:
36300
36301 @smallexample
36302 <?xml version="1.0"?>
36303 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
36304 <osdata type="processes">
36305 <item>
36306 <column name="pid">1</column>
36307 <column name="user">root</column>
36308 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
36309 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
36310 </item>
36311 </osdata>
36312 @end smallexample
36313
36314 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
36315 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
36316 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
36317 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
36318 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
36319 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
36320 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
36321
36322 @include gpl.texi
36323
36324 @node GNU Free Documentation License
36325 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36326 @include fdl.texi
36327
36328 @node Index
36329 @unnumbered Index
36330
36331 @printindex cp
36332
36333 @tex
36334 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
36335 % meantime:
36336 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
36337 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
36338 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
36339 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
36340 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
36341 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
36342 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
36343 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
36344 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
36345 \page\colophon
36346 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
36347 @end tex
36348
36349 @bye
This page took 0.74339 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.